Full Book of PP-CRVI-2014 PDF
Full Book of PP-CRVI-2014 PDF
Full Book of PP-CRVI-2014 PDF
PROFESSIONAL PROGRAMME
CORPORATE RESTRUCTURING,
VALUATIONS AND INSOLVENCY
MODULE 1
PAPER 3
ICSI House, 22, Institutional Area, Lodi Road, New Delhi 110 003
tel 011-4534 1000, 4150 4444 fax +91-11-2462 6727
email [email protected] website www.icsi.edu
TIMING OF HEADQUARTERS
Monday to Friday
Office Timings 9.00 A.M. to 5.30 P.M.
Phones
4150444,45341000
Fax
011-24626727
Website
www.icsi.edu
E-mail
[email protected]
(iii)
PROFESSIONAL PROGRAMME
CORPORATE RESTRUCTURING, VALUATION AND INSOLVENCY
Corporate Restructuring is a non-recurring exercise for an organisation but it has a lasting impact
on the business and other concerned agencies due to its numerous considerations and immense
advantages viz., improved corporate performance, better corporate governance etc. The regulatory
provisions and the multitude of judicial and unresolved issues enunciate that the professionals dealing
with restructuring should possess unequivocal and explicit knowledge of the objective approach and
perspective of the subject.
The purpose of this study material is to provide an in-depth understanding of all aspects and
intricacies of law and practical issues affecting and arising out of Corporate Restructuring, Valuation
as well as Insolvency, aims at through each phase of preparation, stressing upon and dealing,
exhaustively with key concepts, legislative aspects and procedures, duly annotated with judicial
references.
Company Secretaryship being a professional course, the examination standards are set very high,
with emphasis on knowledge of concepts, applications, procedures and case laws, for which sole
reliance on the contents of this study material may not be enough. Besides, as per the Company
Secretaries Regulations, 1982, students are expected to be conversant with the amendments to the
laws made upto six months preceding the date of examination. The material may, therefore, be
regarded as the basic material and must be read along with the original Bare Acts, Rules, Regulations,
Case Law, Student Company Secretary bulletin published and supplied to the students by the Institute
as well as recommended readings.
The subject of Corporate Restructuring, Valuation and Insolvency is inherently technical and is
subjected to constant refinement through new legislations, rules and regulations made there under,
court decisions on specific legal issues and corporate business dynamics. It, therefore, becomes
necessary for every student to constantly update himself with the various legislative changes made as
well as judicial pronouncements rendered from time to time by referring to the Institutes journal
Chartered Secretary and bulletin Student Company Secretary as well as other law/professional
journals like Company Law Journal, Corporate Law Advisor, SEBI and Corporate Laws, Company
Cases etc.
His Study Material is based on the Companies Act, 1956 except for the provisions relating to Buy
Back of Shares which are notified upto June 30, 2014 under Companies Act, 2013. However, it may
so happen that some developments might have taken place during the printing of the study material
and its supply to the students.
The students are therefore, advised to refer to the Student Company Secretary and other
publications for updation of the study material.
In the event of any doubt, students may write to the Directorate of Academic in the Institute for
clarification at [email protected].
Although care has been taken in publishing this study material, yet the possibility of errors,
omissions and/or discrepancies cannot be ruled out. This publication is released with an
understanding that the Institute shall not be responsible for any errors, omissions and/or discrepancies
or any action taken in that behalf.
Should there be any discrepancy, error or omission noted in the study material, the Institute shall
be obliged if the same are brought to its notice for issue of corrigendum in the Student Company
Secretary.
(iv)
PROFESSIONAL PROGRAMME
SYLLABUS
FOR
Historical Background
Emerging Trends
Introduction
Legal, Procedural, Economic, Accounting, Taxation and Financial Aspects of Mergers and
Amalgamations including Stamp Duty and Allied Matters
4. Takeover
(v)
Takeover Defences
Funding through various Types of Financial Instruments including Equity and Preference Shares,
Debentures, Securities with Differential Rights, Swaps, Stock Options; ECBs, Funding through
Financial Institutions and Banks
Rehabilitation Finance
6. Financial Restructuring
Reduction of Capital
8. Case Studies
PART B Valuation (30 Marks)
9. Introduction
Principles of Valuation
Legal & Regulatory aspects related to Valuation such as SEBI Regulations/ RBI Regulations
(vi)
Valuation of Intangibles
Valuation of Securities
PART C Insolvency (20 Marks)
13. Introduction
Sick Companies and their Revival with Special Reference to the Law and Procedure relating to
Sick Companies
Special Purpose Vehicle (SPV), Asset Reconstruction Companies (ARCs), Qualified Institutional
Buyers (QIB)
Overview of the Recovery of Debts Due to Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993
16. Winding Up
(vii)
A. Ramaiya
2.
M.C. Bhandari
3.
ICSI
4.
K. R. Sampath
5.
S. Ramanujam
6.
Ray
Important Websites
(a) www.sebi.gov.in
(b) www.rbi.org.in
(c) www.finmin.nic.in
(d) www.dipp.nic.in
(e) www.mca.gov.in
Students are advised to read relevant Bare Acts and Rules and Regulations relating thereto. Student
Company Secretary e-bulletin and Chartered Secretary should also be read regularly for updating the
knowledge.
(viii)
Subject
PART A - Corporate Restructuring
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Takeovers
10.
11.
Financial Restructuring
12.
13.
Case Studies
PART B Valuation
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
Securitization
19.
Debt Recovery
20.
Winding Up
21.
(ix)
PROFESSIONAL PROGRAMME
CONTENTS
Lesson 1
CORPORATE RESTRUCTURING INTRODUCTION & CONCEPTS
Page
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Introduction
Meaning of Corporate Restructuring
Corporate Restructuring as a Business Strategy
Need and Scope of Corporate Restructuring
Planning, Formulation and Execution of Various Restructuring Strategies
Important Aspects to be Considered while Planning or Implementing
Corporate Restructuring Strategies
Corporate Restructuring - Historical Background
Emerging Trends
Doing Deals Successfully in India A Survey b KPMG India and Merger Market in 2012
Expanding Role of Professionals in Corporate Restructuring Process
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
1
1
2
2
2
3
4
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
4
7
7
7
10
11
12
Lesson 2
MERGERS AND AMALGAMATIONS LEGAL AND PROCEDURAL ASPECTS
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Regulatory Framework for Merger/Amalgamation
Provisions of the Companies Act 1956
Approvals in Scheme of Amalgamation
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
13
13
14
15
20
39
39
Lesson 3
ECONOMIC AND COMPETITION LAW ASPECTS OF MERGERS AND AMALGAMATIONS
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Economic Aspects
Reasons for Merger and Amalgamation
Underlying Objectives in Mergers
Competition Aspects of Combinations
Competition Act, 2002
Combination under Competition Act, 2002
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
41
41
42
42
43
46
46
47
(x)
Page
Regulation of Combinations
Inquiry into Combination by the Commission
Procedure for Investigation of Combination
Inquiry into Disclosures under Section 6(2)
Power to Impose Penalty for Non-Furnishing of Information on Combination
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
48
49
50
51
53
53
53
Lesson 4
MERGERS AND AMALGAMATIONS- ACCOUNTING ASPECTS OF AMALGAMATIONS
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Applicability
Methods of Accounting for Amalgamation
The Pooling of Interest Method
The Purchase Method
Consideration for Amalgamation
Treatment of Reserves on Amalgamation
Goodwill on Amalgamation
Balance of Profit and Loss Account
Disclosure Requirements
Amalgamation after the Balance Sheet Date
Requirement under Listing Agreement
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
55
55
56
57
58
58
59
59
60
60
61
61
61
62
62
Lesson 5
FINANCIAL, STAMP DUTY AND TAXATION ASPECTS OF AMALGAMATION
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Financial Aspects of Mergers and Amalgamations
Stamp Duty Aspects of Mergers and Amalgamations
Taxation Aspects of Mergers and Amalgamations
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
63
63
64
65
70
76
76
...
...
...
...
...
...
77
77
78
78
78
79
Lesson 6
INTEREST OF THE SMALL INVESTORS IN MERGER
Lesson Outlines
Learning Objectives
Introduction
Minority and Minority Interest under Companies Act
Rights of Minority Shareholders during Mergers/Amalgamations/Takeovers
Existing Legal Provisions of Companies Act
(xi)
Page
Protection of Minority Interest
The Court Considers Minority Interest While Approving the Scheme of Merger
Some Judicial Pronouncements
Majority Approval cannot Deprive Minority from Raising Objections.
Measures by SEBI to Protect the Interest of Minority Shareholders
Lesson Roundup
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
79
79
80
81
81
83
83
Lesson 7
AMALGAMATION OF BANKING AND GOVERNMENT COMPANIES
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Amalgamation of Banking Companies
Background
Guidelines Issued by RBI for Merger/Amalgamation of Private Sector Banks
Amalgamation between two Banking Companies
Amalgamation of an NBFC with a Banking Company
Prior Approval of RBI in Cases of Acquisition
Approval of Scheme of Amalgamation
Convening General Meeting
Resolution for Approval of the Scheme
Dissenting Shareholders Right to Claim Return of Capital
Approval by Reserve Bank of India
Transfer of Property
Dissolution of Transferor Company
Salient Features of Banking Laws (Amendment) Bill 2012
Procedure for Merger and Amalgamation Related to Government Companies
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
85
85
86
86
86
86
89
89
90
90
90
90
91
91
91
91
92
93
94
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
95
95
96
96
96
97
98
100
100
100
100
100
Lesson 8
CORPORATE DEMERGERS AND REVERSE MERGERS
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Introduction
Demerger under the Companies Act, 1956
Demerger under Income Tax Act 1961
Meaning of Demerged Company
Some ExamplesDemerger
The Meeting Pursuant to Court Order Approving Demerger
The Court Order Approving Demerger
Difference between Demerger and Reconstruction
Types of Demerger
Partial Demerger
(xii)
Page
Complete Demerger
Ways of Demerger
Procedural Aspects of Demerger
Res Judicata
Rules and Forms in Respect of Scheme of Demerger
Steps to be taken for Demerger
Tax Aspects of Demerger
Tax Concession/Incentives in Case of Demerger
Judicial Pronouncements on Demerger
Disclosure of Ratio of Exchange of Shares
Application of AS-14 to Demergers
Reverse Merger
Salient Features of Reverse Mergers under Section 72A
Concept of Reverse Merger under SICA
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
100
101
102
102
102
103
107
108
110
110
111
111
114
115
116
117
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
119
119
120
120
121
121
122
122
122
123
123
128
128
128
129
129
129
130
130
131
132
132
132
132
137
Lesson 9
TAKEOVERS
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Meaning and Concept of Takeovers
Emergence of Concept of Takeover
Objects of Takeover
Kinds of Takeover
Takeover Bids
Type of Takeover Bids
Factors Determining Vulnerability of Companies to Takeover Bids
Legal Aspects of Takeover
Takeover of Unlisted and Closely Held Companies
Takeover of Listed Companies
Listing Agreement
Conditions for Continued Listing
Requirements under SEBI Regulations
Introduction
Meaning of Certain Terms
Disclosures Related Provisions
Computation of Trigger Limits for Disclosures
Open Offer Thresholds
Voluntary Offer
Restrictions on Voluntary Open Offer
Exemptions from Open Offer
Exemption under Regulation 10 (Automatic Exemption)
Open Offer Process
(xiii)
Page
Filing Draft Letter of Offer
Escrow Account
Dispatch of Letter of Offer to Share Holders
Offer Price
Size of an Open Offer
Post Offer Advertisement
Conditional Offer
Competing Offer
Payment of Consideration
Withdrawal of Open Offer
Obligations of the Acquirer
Obligations of the Target Company
Obligations of the Manager to the Open Offer
Defense Strategies to Takeover Bids
Defensive Measures
Types of Anti-Takeover Amendments
Cross Borders Takeovers
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
137
137
139
140
140
142
142
142
143
143
143
143
145
146
146
148
149
151
152
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
153
153
154
154
154
154
156
157
157
162
163
163
164
164
165
...
...
167
167
Lesson 10
FUNDING OF MERGERS AND TAKEOVERS
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Financial Alternatives
Financial Package
Process of Funding
Funding through various types of Financial Instruments
SEBI (ESOP & ESPS) Guidelines, 1999
Funding Through External Commercial Borrowings (ECBs)
Entry Routes
Depository Receipts (DRs)
Funding through Financial Institutions and Banks
Funding through Rehabilitation Finance
Funding through Leveraged Buyouts
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
Lesson 11
FINANCIAL RESTRUCTURING
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
(xiv)
Page
Introduction
Need for Financial Restructuring
Restructuring of Under-Capitalized Company
Restructuring of Over-Capitalized Company
Reorganisation of Capital
Reduction of Share Capital
Modes of Reduction
Reduction of Share Capital without sanction of the Court
Equal Reduction of Shares of one Class
Creditors Right to Object to Reduction
Confirmation and Registration
Conclusiveness of Certificate for Reduction of Capital
Liability of Members in Respect of Reduced Share Capital
Reduction of Share Capital and Scheme of Compromise or Arrangement
Procedure for Reduction of Capital A Flow Chart
Buy-Back of Shares-the Genesis
Concept of Buy-Back of Shares
Legal Framework
Objectives of Buy-Back
Buy Back of Shares A Birds Eye View
Authorisation and Quantum
Sources of Buy-Back
Restrictions/Conditions
Time Limit for Completion of Buy Back
Whether Stamp Duty is Payable on Buy-Back?
Punishment for Default
Transfer of Certain Sums to Capital Redemption Reserve Account
Income Tax Aspects
Rules and Regulations for Buy-Back of Securities
Buy-Back Procedure for Listed Securities
Special Resolution and its Additional Disclosure Requirements
Disclosures under Schedule II Part A
Methods of Buy-Back
Buy-Back from Existing Security-Holders through Tender Offer
Additional Disclosures
Public Announcement and Filing of Offer Documents
Offer Procedure
Buy-Back from Open Market
Buy-Back through the Stock Exchange
Buy-Back through Book-Building
Obligations of the Company
Locked-In Securities not to be Bought-Back
Publication of Post-Buy-Back Advertisement
Obligations of the Merchant Banker
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
168
169
169
170
170
170
171
172
173
173
174
174
175
175
176
177
177
177
177
179
180
181
183
184
185
185
185
185
186
186
186
187
188
188
188
189
189
191
192
192
193
194
194
194
(xv)
Page
Buy-Back Procedure for Private Limited & Unlisted Public Limited Companies
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
194
197
198
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
199
199
200
200
200
201
201
201
201
201
202
202
202
202
202
203
203
203
203
204
204
204
205
209
210
211
214
214
217
218
...
...
...
...
...
219
219
220
220
221
222
Lesson 12
POST MERGER RE-ORGANISATION
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Introduction
Factors in the Post Merger Reorganisation
Change of Name and Logo
Revised Organization Chart
Communication
Employee Compensation, Benefits and Welfare Activities
Aligning Company Policies
Aligning Accounting and Internal Database Management Systems
Re-Visiting Internal Processes
Re-Allocation of People
Engagement with Statutory Authorities
Record Keeping
Immoveable Property
Expansion of Existing Teams to Support Larger Organization
Revised ISO Certification and Similar Other Certifications
Re-Visiting Past Decisions/Government Approvals/Compliances
Contracts
Miscellaneous
Impact of Post Merger Reorganisation
Gain or Loss to Stakeholders
Implementation of Objectives
Integration of Businesses and Operations
Post Merger Success and Valuation
Human and Cultural Aspects
Measuring Post-Merger Efficiency
Measuring Key Indicators
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
Lesson 13
CASE STUDIES
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Case Studies
1. Demerger - Larsen & Toubro Limited
2. Overseas Acquisition Tata-Corus Deal
3. Merger of ICICI with ICICI Bank
(xvi)
Page
4. Slump Sale (Business Transfer) By Piramal to Abbott
5. Multiple Corporate Restructuring Reddy Laboratories Limited
6. Leveraged Buy-Out Bharti-Zain Deal
7. Overseas Acquisition Daiichi-Ranbaxy
8. Acquisition of Patni by Igate
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
222
224
225
226
228
229
229
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
231
231
232
232
232
233
233
235
235
237
237
238
238
243
244
Lesson 14
VALUATION INTRODUCTION AND TECHNIQUES
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Introduction
Need and Purpose
When Valuation is Required?
Valuation/Acquisition Motives
Factors Influencing Valuation
Methods of Valuation (Valuation Techniques)
I. Valuation Based on Assets
II. Valuation Based on Earnings
III. Market Based Approach to Valuation
Market Comparables
Other Aspects as to the Methods of Valuation
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
Lesson 15
REGULATORY ASPECTS OF VALUATION WITH REFERENCE TO
CORPORATE STRATEGIES
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Introduction
Valuation Documentation
Objectives of Documentation in Valuation Exercise
List of Documents
Judicial Pronouncement on Valuation Principles/Valuation Reports
Regulatory Aspects as to Valuation
Pricing in Public Issue as per SEBI (Issue of Capital and Disclosure
Requirements) Regulations, 2009
Valuation for the Purpose of Issue of Sweat Equity Shares
Valuation of Stock Options under the SEBI (ESOP) Guidelines, 1999
Valuation under SEBI (Delisting of Equity Shares) Regulations 2009
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
245
245
246
247
247
248
249
250
...
...
...
...
250
252
253
253
(xvii)
Page
Valuation of Shares under the Sweat Equity Unlisted Companies
(Issue of Shares) Rules, 2003
SEBI (SAST) Regulations 2011
Pricing under Consolidated FDI Policy 2013
What should be the Content of Valuation Report for Corporate Strategies?
Contents of Summarized Valuation Report
Valuation Strategies for Mergers
...
...
...
...
...
...
254
254
255
255
255
258
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
258
263
263
264
265
266
266
266
270
271
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
273
273
274
274
274
275
275
276
276
276
278
280
281
...
...
...
...
...
...
283
283
285
285
285
285
Lesson 16
INSOLVENCY CONCEPTS AND EVOLUTION
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Insolvency/Bankruptcy the Concept
Historical Developments of Insolvency Laws in India
A Brief on the Regulatory Framework for Corporate Insolvency in India
Reforms in Insolvency Law for Corporate Side
Justice Eradi Committee
Dr J J Irani Expert Committee on Company Law
Provisions of Companies Bill 2012 relating to Insolvency Administrators
A Brief on Historical Background on UK Insolvency Framework
The Evolution of U.S. Bankruptcy Law - A Time Line
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
Lesson 17
REVIVAL AND RESTRUCTURING OF SICK COMPANIES
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 [SICA]
The Genesis
The Objectives
Applicability
(xviii)
Page
What is a Sick Industrial Company?
Do You Know?
Operating Agency
Some Procedural Aspects under SICA
Reference to the Board of Industrial and Financial Reconstruction
Inquiry into Working of Sick Industrial Companies
Powers of Board to Make Suitable Order on the Completion of Inquiry
Preparation and Sanction of Scheme for Revival
Rehabilitation by Giving Financial Assistance
Arrangement for Continuing Operations, etc. during Inquiry
Winding Up of Sick Industrial Company
Immunity from Certain Litigations
Direction against Disposal of Assets
Revival and Rehabilitation of Sick Companies under the Companies Bill 2012
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
286
286
287
287
287
287
288
289
290
290
291
292
294
294
296
296
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
297
297
298
299
300
300
302
302
304
305
306
306
307
307
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
308
308
308
309
311
311
312
313
313
Lesson 18
SECURITIZATION
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Introduction
How Securitisation Gained Importance?
Statement of Objects and Reasons of SARFAESI Act
Apex Court Upheld Constitutional Validity of the Securitisation Act
Enforcement of Security Interest and Recovery of Debts Laws (Amendment) Act, 2012
Definitions
Asset Reconstruction Companies [ARC]
Registration of Securitisation or Asset Reconstruction Companies
Prior Approval for Substantial Change
Cancellation of Certificate of Registration
Appeal
Acquisition of Rights or Interest in Financial Assets and Effects of Acquisition
Transfer of Pending Applications to Any One of Debts Recovery Tribunals
in Certain Cases
Measures for Asset Reconstruction
Other Functions of Securitisation or Reconstruction Company
Enforcement of Security Interest by a Creditors
Accounting Aspects
ARCS will be Public Financial Institutions
Assistance by Chief Metropolitan Magistrate or the District Magistrate
Manner and Effect of Takeover of Management
Highlights of the Guidelines are as under
(xix)
Page
Right to Appeal
Appeal to Appellate Tribunal
Right to Lodge a Caveat
Setting Up of Central Registry
Register of Securitisation, Reconstruction and Security Interest Transactions
Filing of Particulars
Satisfaction of Security Interest
Right to Inspect
Penalties
Penalties for Non-Compliance of Direction of Reserve Bank
Offences
Non-Applicability in Certain Cases
Civil Court not to have Jurisdiction
Limitation Act
Applicability of Other Acts
Rule Making Power
Security Interest (Enforcement) Rules, 2002
Demand Notice
Reply to Representation of the Borrower
Procedure after Issue of Notice
Valuation of Movable Secured Assets
Sale of Movable Secured Assets
Issue of Certificate of Sale
Sale of Immovable Secured Assets
Time of Sale, Issue of Sale Certificate and Delivery of Possession, etc.
Appointment of Manager
Procedure for Recovery of Shortfall of Secured Debt
Application to the Tribunal/Appellate Tribunal
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
316
316
316
317
317
317
318
318
318
318
318
318
319
319
319
320
320
320
321
321
322
322
323
323
324
325
326
326
326
327
...
...
...
...
329
329
330
331
...
...
...
...
...
331
331
332
333
333
Lesson 19
DEBT RECOVERY
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Need and Object
Enforcement of Security Interest and Recovery of Debts Laws (Amendment) Act, 2012
Salient Features of the Enforcement of Security Interest and Recovery of
Debt Laws (Amendment) Act, 2012 as under
Important Definitions
Establishment of Tribunal
Composition of Tribunal
Establishment of Appellate Tribunal
(xx)
Page
Composition of Appellate Tribunal
Application to the Tribunal
Appeal to the Appellate Tribunal
Powers of the Tribunal and the Appellate Tribunal
Right to Legal Representation and Presenting Officers
Limitations
Recovery of Debt Determined by Tribunal
Validity of Certificate and Amendment thereof
Stay of Proceedings under Certificate and Amendment or Withdrawal Thereof
Other Modes of Recovery
Application of Certain Provisions of Income-Tax Act
Appeal Against the Order of Recovery Officer
Act to have Over-Riding Effect
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
333
333
337
337
338
338
338
338
339
339
340
341
341
342
343
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
345
345
346
346
347
347
348
348
348
355
355
356
356
357
357
357
357
357
357
358
358
359
359
363
364
Lesson 20
WINDING UP
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Introduction
Can the Company be Adjudged Insolvent?
Is Winding Up and Dissolution are Synonymous?
Can a Company be Dissolved Without Winding Up?
Modes of Winding Up
Winding Up by the Court
Grounds on which a Company may be Wound Up by the Court
Petition by the Company
Petition by Creditor
Debentureholder can file an Application for Winding Up
Petition by Workers not Maintainable
Appeal by Workers Against Winding Up Order Maintainable
A Time Barred Debt cannot be the basis for Winding Up Petition
Pre-Incorporation Debt Unsustainable
Petition by Contributory
Who is a Contributory?
When a Contributory can file a Winding Up Petition?
Petition by Registrar
Petition by Persons Authorised by Central Government
Jurisdiction of Court for Entertaining Winding Up Petition
Compulsory Winding Up by the Court
Appeals from Orders or Decisions in the Matter of Winding Up
Dissolution of Company in Compulsory Liquidation
(xxi)
Page
Courts Power to Declare Dissolution Void
Duties of the Secretary in Respect of Compulsory Winding Up
Voluntary Winding Up
Kinds of Voluntary Winding Up
Members Voluntary Winding Up
Creditors Voluntary Winding Up
Distinction between Members and Creditors Voluntary Winding Up
Provisions Applicable to Every Type of Voluntary Winding Up (i.e. Both Members/
Creditors Voluntary Winding Up)
Distribution of Property of Company
Powers and Duties of Liquidators in Voluntary Winding Up
Body Corporate not to be Appointed
Corrupt Inducement Affecting Appointment as Liquidator
Power of Court to Appoint and Remove Liquidator in Voluntary Winding Up
Notice by Liquidator of his Appointment
Arrangement When Binding on Company and Creditors
Public Examination of Directors Etc.
Cost of Voluntary Winding Up
Duties of the Secretary in case of Voluntary Winding Up
Important Provisions Applicable in Case of Every Mode of Winding Up
(i.e. Compulsory and Voluntary Winding Up)
Consequences of Winding Up
Consequences as to Shareholders Described as Contributories
Nature of Contributorys Liability
List of Contributories
Extent of Liability
Enforcement of Liability of Contributory
Consequences as a Creditor
Secured Creditors
Secured Creditors can Apply for Winding Up
Position of State Financial Corporation
Unsecured Creditors
Order of Priority of Debts
Powers and Duties of Liquidators
Liquidator is not Employer
Power of the Liquidator in Voluntary Winding Up of a Company
Duties and Functions of Voluntary Liquidator
Status of Liquidator
Persons Entitled to be Heard
Procedure after the Winding Up Order
Statement of Affairs by Directors
Report by the Official Liquidator
Committee of Inspection
General Powers of the Court
Offences Antecedent to or in Course of Winding Up
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
365
365
366
367
367
369
371
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
371
371
371
372
372
372
372
373
373
373
373
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
374
379
379
379
380
381
382
382
383
383
384
384
384
384
384
387
389
389
390
390
391
392
392
393
394
(xxii)
Page
Offences of Officers
Penalty for Falsification of Books
Penalty for Frauds by Officers
Liability Where Proper Accounts are not Kept
Fraudulent Conduct of Business
Recovery of Damages from Delinquent Persons
Prosecution of Delinquent Officers and Members
Disposal of Books and Papers of the Company
Annual Statement, if Winding Up is not Concluded within One Year
Court to Ascertain the Wishes of Creditors and Shareholders
Winding Up of Unregistered Companies
When Unregistered Company Unable to Pay its Debts
Winding Up of Foreign Company as Unregistered Company
Contributories in Winding Up of an Unregistered Company
Role of the Secretary in Winding Up
Outsourcing Responsibilities to Professionals
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
394
395
395
395
396
397
398
398
399
399
400
401
401
401
402
404
406
407
...
...
...
409
409
410
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
411
413
414
416
422
428
437
438
440
442
Lesson 21
CROSS BORDER INSOLVENCY
Lesson Outline
Learning Objectives
Introduction
Development of United Nations Commission on International Trade
Law (UNCITRAL) Model Law
General Provisions
Access of Foreign Representatives and Creditors to Courts in State Enacting Model Law
Recognition of a Foreign Proceeding and Relief
UNCITRAL Legislative Guide on Insolvency Laws
US Bankruptcy Code
Lesson Round Up
Self Test Questions
TEST PAPERS
Test Paper 1
Test Paper 2
Lesson 1
CORPORATE RESTRUCTURING
INTRODUCTION & CONCEPTS
LESSON OUTLINE
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
students to understand
Historical Background
Emerging Trends
PP-CRVI
INTRODUCTION
There are primarily two ways of growth of business organization, i.e. organic and inorganic growth.
Organic growth is through internal strategies, which may relate to business or financial restructuring within
the organization that results in enhanced customer base, higher sales, increased revenue, without resulting
in change of corporate entity..
Inorganic growth provides an organization with an avenue for attaining accelerated growth enabling it to skip
few steps on the growth ladder. Restructuring through mergers, amalgamations etc constitute one of the
most important methods for securing inorganic growth.
Growth can be organic or inorganic
A company is said to be growing organically when the growth is through the internal sources without
change in the corporate entity. Organic growth can be through capital restructuring or business
restructuring.
Inorganic growth is the rate of growth of business by increasing output and business reach by
acquiring new businesses by way of mergers, acquisitions and take-overs and other corporate
restructuring Strategies that may create a change in the corporate entity.
The business environment is rapidly changing with respect to technology, competition, products, people,
geographical area, markets, customers. It is not enough if companies keep pace with these changes but are
expected to beat competition and innovate in order to continuously maximize shareholder value. Inorganic
growth strategies like mergers, acquisitions, takeovers and spinoffs are regarded as important engines that
help companies to enter new markets, expand customer base, cut competition, consolidate and grow in size
quickly, employ new technology with respect to products, people and processes. Thus the inorganic growth
strategies are regarded as fast track corporate restructuring strategies for growth.
Lesson 1
of market share, the reduction of profit margins or declines in the power of their corporate brand. Other
motivators of restructuring include the inability to retain talented professionals and major changes to the
marketplace that directly impact the corporation's business model.
Corporate restructuring is the process of significantly changing a company's business model,
management team or financial structure to address challenges and increase shareholder value.
Corporate restructuring is an inorganic growth strategy.
PP-CRVI
Accounting aspects
Lesson 1
1. Merger
Merger is the combination of two or more companies which can be merged together either by way of
amalgamation or absorption. The combining of two or more companies, is generally by offering the
stockholders of one company securities in the acquiring company in exchange for the surrender of their
stock.
Mergers may be
(i) Horizontal Merger: It is a merger of two or more companies that compete in the same industry. It is
a merger with a direct competitor and hence expands as the firm's operations in the same industry.
Horizontal mergers are designed to achieve economies of scale and result in reduce the number of
competitors in the industry.
(ii) Vertical Merger: It is a merger which takes place upon the combination of two companies which
are operating in the same industry but at different stages of production or distribution system. If a
company takes over its supplier/producers of raw material, then it may result in backward
integration of its activities. On the other hand, Forward integration may result if a company decides
to take over the retailer or Customer Company. Vertical merger provides a way for total integration
to those firms which are striving for owning of all phases of the production schedule together with
the marketing network
(iii) Co generic Merger: It is the type of merger, where two companies are in the same or related
industries but do not offer the same products, but related products and may share similar
distribution channels, providing synergies for the merger. The potential benefit from these mergers
is high because these transactions offer opportunities to diversify around a common case of
strategic resources.
(iv) Conglomerate Merger: These mergers involve firms engaged in unrelated type of activities i.e. the
business of two companies are not related to each other horizontally nor vertically. In a pure
conglomerate, there are no important common factors between the companies in production,
marketing, research and development and technology. Conglomerate mergers are merger of
different kinds of businesses under one flagship company. The purpose of merger remains
utilization of financial resources enlarged debt capacity and also synergy of managerial functions. It
PP-CRVI
does not have direct impact on acquisition of monopoly power and is thus favoured throughout the
world as a means of diversification.
2. Demerger
It is a form of corporate restructuring in which the entity's business operations are segregated into one or
more components. A demerger is often done to help each of the segments operate more smoothly, as they
can focus on a more specific task after demerger.
3. Reverse Merger
Reverse merger is the opportunity for the unlisted companies to become public listed company, without
opting for Initial Public offer (IPO).In this process the private company acquires the majority shares of public
company, with its own name.
4. Disinvestment
Disinvestment means the action of an organization or government selling or liquidating an asset or
subsidiary. It is also known as "divestiture".
5. Takeover/Acquisition
Takeover means an acquirer takes over the control of the target company. It is also known as acquisition.
Normally this type of acquisition is undertaken to achieve market supremacy. It may be friendly or hostile
takeover.
Friendly takeover: In this type, one company takes over the management of the target company with
the permission of the board.
Hostile takeover: In this type, one company takes over the management of the target company without
its knowledge and against the wish of their management.
7. Strategic Alliance
Any agreement between two or more parties to collaborate with each other, in order to achieve certain
objectives while continuing to remain independent organizations is called strategic alliance.
8. Franchising
Franchising may be defined as an arrangement where one party (franchiser) grants another party
(franchisee) the right to use trade name as well as certain business systems and process, to produce and
market goods or services according to certain specifications.
Lesson 1
The franchisee usually pays a one-time franchisee fee plus a percentage of sales revenue as royalty and
gains.
9. Slump sale
Slump sale means the transfer of one or more undertaking as a result of the sale of lump sum consideration
without values being assigned to the individual assets and liabilities in such sales. If a company sells or
disposes of the whole or substantially the whole of its undertaking for a predetermined lump sum
consideration, then it results in a slump sale.
EMERGING TRENDS
Doing Deals Successfully in India A Survey by KPMG India and Merger Market in 2012
In order to present a composite view of effective practices that have emerged from inbound investors
experience conducting M&A in India. KPMG in India and mergermarket in the year 2012, shortlisted a
PP-CRVI
number of successful deals based on their size and prominence in the Indian marketplace.
They conducted interviews with key M&A Heads or equivalent from International companies involved in
these transactions over the course of 2012. The report represents a summary of these conversations and the
learnings that have emerged from these transactions.
Almost all participants acknowledged that India was an important part of their overall global expansion
strategy, and by and large, participants have been pleased with the success of their respective deals despite
the fact that some are still in the process of completing integration.
The key insights that emerged are as follows:
Acquirers come to India for its domestic market and the innovation capabilities of its companies
The primary attraction for acquirers when investing in India is the potential of its domestic market and the
opportunity to use India as a springboard to access some of the regional South Asian, Middle East and even
African markets. Participants also cited capabilities for innovation that Indian companies have built over the
last two decades, especially to serve low cost value conscious consumers in the emerging markets as a key
reason behind doing deals in India.
Investable targets are hard (but not impossible) to find
Given Indias size, its federal regulatory structure and socio-political diversity, most businesses take a
regional approach to market growth in the country, and as a result, few truly national players exist. Having
said that, many of the regional markets these businesses serve have the potential of being as large as or
even larger than national markets in other countries.
Coverage and availability of information on domestic companies in India is still patchy, making secondary
market scans difficult. And while auction processes are prevalent, many deals are done based on local
relationships and a deep understanding of the regional operations of potential targets. In fact, for many of the
successful acquisitions and partnerships highlighted in this report, acquirers were in India building
relationships well before their transactions materialized either by forming an Indian subsidiary or by
maintaining trading relationships.
Even once a potential deal is on the table it can take time for a seller to furnish historical financials and
realistic forecasts that link back to past performance. Most acquirers tended to take an independent view of a
targets growth prospects while factoring in the right level of investment support post deal.
It takes time and effort to get to know the family
Managing the relationship with the promoter (seller) can be of paramount importance for a successful deal.
Promoters are also typically involved in direct management of the business, and selling would mean losing
regular income, personal status and an important family asset. Furthermore, promoter-led businesses often
have more than one decision maker and depending on family history, internal politics often become part of the
M&A process. For International Companies looking to acquire in India, it means spending considerable months
to get to know and understand the promoters and the family well, before starting a transaction conversation.
The process can seem long and complicated (because it often is)
The deal process in India can initially seem long even when there is no competitive bidding process. Finding
issues with compliance, tax or historical financial performance is common during diligence and these may
seem like deal breakers at first.
Lesson 1
To manage these challenges, acquirers preferred to implement transaction structures that allow buyers to
leave liabilities behind with the sellers where possible, while ensuring sufficient engagement from promoters
to ensure a smooth transition post deal. Participants also highlighted the need to build a business forecast
bottom up, seeking independent verification of future contract commitments and an assessment of the
dependence on promoter relationships for continuity of business.
Respondents to this study also highlighted the fact that sellers in India are often inexperienced in the M&A
process and can start the process without adequate preparation. Where possible, buyers should request
involvement of professional advisors on the sell side and ask for a well managed process including electronic
data rooms, verified financial information, explanation of discrepancies with published results, etc., at the
start of the process.
The hard work begins once the deal is done
Most participants had a small base in India prior to the acquisition and hence integration of local domestic
operations with the target was not really a big challenge. Key focus during the integration revolved around
navigating cultural differences, managing employee expectations from an international acquirer and
alignment of management styles. Their approach was cautious, with over half the respondents spending
between 1-3 years to complete the integration activities. In almost all the cases, integration was a distinct
project led by teams based locally and with significant senior management involvement.
Reflecting on the overall success of the transaction, most respondents felt that they were by and large happy
with the overall outcome of the deal and with the quality of management that they had acquired as a result of
the transaction.
10
PP-CRVI
India. The gradual stabilization of the rupee and key stock indices in the second half of the year offer
promising signs, and were hopeful this cautiously positive sentiment will lead to resurgence in M&A activity
following the 2014 elections. India corporate and otherwise is bracing itself, while looking ahead.
Table 1: Deal summary for Indian M&A and PE activity for 2011-2013
Deal Summary
Volume
Value (US$bn)
2011
2012
2013
2011
2012
2013
Domestic
216
234
220
5.04
6.08
5.75
Cross Border
288
262
221
39.58
14.51
17.89
140
102
59
14.80
4.55
Total M&A
644
598
500
44.61
35.38
28.19
PE
373
401
450
8.75
7.38
10.39
1,017
999
950
53.36
42.76
38.58
Inbound
142
140
139
28.73
5.96
8.64
Outbound
146
122
82
10.84
8.55
9.25
Grand Total
Cross Border includes:
Lesson 1
11
Proviso to Section 230(3) Notice relating to compromise or arrangement and other documents to
be placed on the website of the company.
Section 230(5) Notice of meeting for approval of the scheme of compromise or arrangement be
sent to various regulators including:
1. The Central Government;
2. Income-tax Authorities;
3. Reserve Bank of India (`RBI);
4. Securities Exchange Board of India (`SEBI);
5. The Registrar;
6. Respective Stock Exchange;
8. The Competition Commission of India; if necessary; and
9. Other Sectoral regulators which could likely be affected by the scheme. Representation, if any,
by the above authorities will have to be made within a period of 30 days from receipt of notice.
Proviso to Section 230(4) Persons holding not less than 10% of the shareholdings or persons
having outstanding debt amounting to not less than 5% of the total outstanding debt as per the
latest audited financial statement, entitled to object the scheme of compromise or arrangement.
Section 234 Cross border Merger permitted. The 1956 act permits merger of foreign company
wit h Indian company and not vice versa.
Section 233 (10) Abolishing the practice of companies holding their own shares through a
trust (Treasury Stock) in case of merger of holding and subsidiary companies. Ultimately the
shares are to be cancelled.
Section 233 Fast track mergers introduced. The new Act enables fast track merger without
the approval of NCLT, between:
if accounting
1. Two or more small companies. Small company is defined under the Act.
2. Holding and wholly owned subsidiary company
3. Other class of companies as may be prescribed
Section 230(6) Approval of scheme by postal ballot thereby involving wider participation;
Section 230(11) Any compromise or arrangement may also include takeover offer made in
prescribed manner. In case of listed companies, takeover offer shall be as per the regulations
framed by SEBI.
12
PP-CRVI
LESSON ROUND UP
Growth of organization may be organic/inorganic growth. Growth in the factors of production is organic
growth, whereas corporate restructuring initiatives leads to inorganic growth which is relatively faster.
The most commonly applied tools of corporate restructuring are amalgamation, merger, demerger,
acquisition, joint venture, disinvestments etc.
The important aspects to be considered during Corporate Restructuring process are financial, valuation,
stamp duty, taxation and accounting aspects.
The regulatory framework for corporate restructuring includes, The Companies Act, 1956, notified Sections
of Companies Act, 2013, SEBI(SAST) Regulations; 2011, Listing agreement, Indian Stamp Act, 1899,
Companies(Court) Rules; etc.
The restructuring process over the years has expanded the role of professionals in the restructuring
process at various stages.
The companies Bill; 2012 has provided several provisions for revamping the corporate restructuring
process in India.
Lesson 2
MERGERS AND AMALGAMATIONS
LEGAL AND PROCEDURAL ASPECTS
LESSON OUTLINE
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Regulatory Framework
While
merger/amalgamation,
the
transferor/transferee
company has to comply with a number of regulations
Process/steps
mergers/Amalgamation
in
mergers/amalgamation
involved
implementing
the
strategic
decision
of
14
PP-CRVI
Lesson 2
15
company, it is necessary to send a copy of the scheme to the stock exchanges where the shares of the said
company are listed to obtain their No Objection Certificate (NOC). Generally stock exchanges raise several
queries and on being satisfied that the scheme does not violate any laws concerning securities such as the
takeover code or the SEBI (ICDR) Regulations, Stock Exchanges accord their approval. Where the shares
are listed on BSE or NSE, other Stock Exchanges wait for the approval by BSE or NSE before granting their
approval.
5. Under the Indian Stamp Act
It is necessary to refer to the Stamp Act to check the stamp duty payable on transfer of undertaking through
a merger or demerger.
6. Competition Act, 2002
The provisions of Competition Act and the Competition Commission of India (Procedure in regard to the
Transaction of Business relating to Combinations) Regulations, 2011 are to be complied with.
16
PP-CRVI
Lesson 2
17
order is not filed with the Registrar, it will not have any effect. The requirement under this section is limited to
filing of the order of the court and it does not specify the need for the Registrar to register it.
The order of the court under Section 391 sanctioning compromise or arrangement will not have effect unless
filed with Registrar of Companies.
Sub-section (4) Memorandum to be annexed to the copy of court order while filing.
It is necessary to annex a copy of every such order to every copy of the Memorandum of company issued
after the filing of the certified copy of the order. In the case of a company not having a memorandum the
order aforesaid shall be annexed to every copy of the instrument constituting or defining the constitution of
the company.
Sub-section (5) Penalty.
Any default in complying with Sub-section (4) invites the penalty prescribed in this sub-section. As per the
penal clause contained in this sub-section, the company and every officer of the company who is in default
shall be punishable with fine which may extend to `100/- for each copy in respect of which the default is
made.
Sub-section (6)
The court has powers to stay the commencement of or continuation of any suit or proceeding against the
company on such terms as it thinks fit until the application is finally disposed of.
Section 392 Power to enforce compromise and arrangement.
Sub-section (1)
The court has the power to supervise the carrying out of the scheme. The court may give such directions or
make such modifications to the scheme for the purpose of proper working of the scheme.
Sub-section (2)
The court has the power to order winding up of the company if it thinks that the scheme sanctioned cannot
work satisfactorily.
Section 393 Information as to compromise or arrangements with creditors and members.
Sub-section (1)
Every notice of any meeting called as per orders of court under Section 391, should include an explanatory
statement. The statement should set out the terms of compromise or arrangement and all material interests
of the directors, managing director or manager of the company and effect of such interest on the scheme. It
can also be given by way of an advertisement containing the above mentioned particulars.
Sub-section (2)
Such disclosure shall also be made, in the case of a scheme affecting debenture holders, about the interest
of the debenture trustees.
Sub-section (3)
If the notice states that creditors or members can have copies of the scheme from the company, the
company shall provide copies of the scheme of compromise or arrangement, to the creditor or member who
applies for the same.
18
PP-CRVI
Sub-section (4)
This sub-section is a penal clause. In case of default in complying with the requirements of Section 393, the
default is a punishable offence.
Sub-section (5)
Every director, managing director, manager or as the case may be, the debenture trustees, shall give all
necessary information to the company failing which they shall be liable for the penal consequences
stipulated in this sub-section.
Section 394 Provisions for facilitating reconstruction and amalgamation of companies.
It is only in Section 394 of the Act there is reference to reconstruction of any company or companies or
amalgamation of any two or more companies.
Sub-section (1)
Where the scheme involves reconstruction of any company or companies or amalgamation of any two or
more companies and vesting of the whole or substantially the whole of the properties or liabilities of any
company concerned in the scheme (Transferor Company) to another company (Transferee company), the
court may make provision for the following matters also:
Transfer to the Transferee Company of the whole or any part of the undertaking, property or
liabilities of any transferor company;
The allotment or appropriation by the Transferee company of any shares, debentures to any person
under the scheme.
Continuation of proceedings by or against the Transferee Company of any legal matters pending by
or against any Transferor Company.
The dissolution, without winding up, of any Transferor Company.
Provision to be made for any person who does not agree to the scheme.
Such incidental, consequential and supplemental orders passed by the court as it may think fit so
that the reconstruction or amalgamation could be fully and effectively carried out.
As per the proviso under this sub-section, it is necessary to have the report from the Registrar of Companies
in case the scheme involves a company that is being wound up and the report of the liquidator, in case the
scheme involves the dissolution of a company. These reports are mandatory in order to ensure that the
affairs of the company in question have not been conducted in a manner prejudicial to the interests of its
members or to public interest.
Sub-section (2)
The sub-section provides for the order of the Court and the vesting of the properties and liabilities of the
transferor company to the transferee company.
Sub-section (3)
Under this sub-section, the time limit for filing the order of the Court for registration by the Registrar is 30
days after the making of the order.
Sub-section (4)
As per clause (a), the expression property has been defined to include property, rights and powers of every
description and the expression liabilities includes duties of every description. As per clause (b), Transferee
Lesson 2
19
Company does not include any company other than a company within the meaning of this Act but
Transferor company includes any body corporate, whether a company within the meaning of this Act or not.
Thus, the transferee company in a scheme of merger or amalgamation has to be necessarily a company
within the meaning of the Act.
Section 394A
The court is supposed to give notice of every scheme under Section 391 or 394 to the Central Government
and consider representation, if any by the said Government.
Therefore, merger or amalgamation under a scheme of arrangement as provided under Sections 391-394 of
the Act is the most convenient and most common method of a complete merger or amalgamation between
the companies. There is active involvement of the Court and an amalgamation is complete only after the
Court sanctions it under Section 394(2) and takes effect when such order of court is filed with the Registrar
of Companies. In fact, Sections 391 to 394 of the Act read with Companies (Court) Rules, 1959 serve as a
complete code in themselves in respect of provisions and procedures relating to sponsoring of the scheme,
the approval thereof by the creditors and members, and the sanction thereof by the Court.
Accordingly, amalgamation can be effected in any one of the following ways:
(i) Transfer of undertaking by order of the High Court (Section 394 of the Companies Act, 1956)
Under Section 394 of the Companies Act, the High Court may sanction a scheme of amalgamation
proposed by two or more companies after it has been approved by a meeting of the members of the
company convened under the orders of the court with majority in number of shareholders holding
more than 75 percent of the shares who vote at the meeting, approve the scheme of amalgamation,
and the companies make a petition to the High Court for approving the Scheme. The High Court
serves a copy of petition on the Regional Director, Company Law Board and if they do not object to
the amalgamation, the Court sanctions it. Once the Court sanctions the scheme, it is binding on all
the members of the respective companies.
(ii) Purchase of shares of one company by another company (Section 395 of the Companies Act, 1956)
Under Section 395 of the Companies Act, 1956, the undertaking of one company can be takenover
by another company by the purchase of shares. This section obviates the need to obtain the High
Courts sanction. While purchasing shares, the company which acquires shares should comply with
the requirements of SEBI (Substantial Acquisition of Shares and Takeovers) Regulations, 2011 and
Section 372A of the Companies Act, 1956. This Section also provides the procedure for acquiring
the shares of dissenting members.
(iii) Amalgamation of Companies in National Interest (Section 396)
Where the Central Government is satisfied that an amalgamation of two or more companies is
essential in the public interest, then the Government may, by an order notified in the Official
Gazette, provide for the amalgamation of those companies into a single company. The
amalgamated company shall have such constitution, property, powers, rights, interest and privileges
as well as such liabilities, duties and obligations as may be specified in the Governments order.
(iv) Amalgamation for Revival and Rehabilitation
The Board for Financial and Industrial Reconstruction (BIFR) can in exceptional cases order
20
PP-CRVI
amalgamation for the revival and rehabilitation of a sick industrial company under the provisions of
Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985.
Lesson 2
21
scheme is approved by all concerned, a petition is presented to the court for sanctioning of the scheme of
arrangement.
If the court is satisfied that the scheme is just and fair and not prejudicial to the interest of the members/class
of members or creditors/class of creditors, as the case may be, then the court may sanction it.
A subsidiary company being a creditor cannot be included along with other unsecured creditors; their interest
in supporting a scheme proposed by the holding company would not be the same as the interest of the other
unsecured creditors [Hindustan Development Corporation Ltd. v. Shaw Wallace & Co. Ltd. (supra)]. Secured
creditors should not be clubbed together with the unsecured creditors. Their interest would not be the same.
Scheme to be approved by special majority
The Scheme must be approved by a resolution passed with the special majority stipulated in Section 391(2),
namely a majority in number representing three-fourths in value of the creditors, or class of creditors, or
members, or class of members, as the case may be, present and voting either in person or, by proxy.
Thus, 51% majority in number, and 75% in value present and voting at the meeting must approve the
scheme. [Section 391(2)]. For example, if at the meeting 100 persons (members in person and proxies) are
present, at least 51 of them must vote in favour the resolution and they must be holding at least 75% of the
paid-up share capital carrying voting rights. In the case of creditors, those voting in favour must have the
claim not less than 75% of the total amount of claim of all the creditors present and voting.
The majority is dual, in number and in value. A simple majority of those voting is sufficient, whereas the
three - fourths requirement relates to value. The three-fourths value is to be computed with reference to
paid-up capital held by members (or to total amount owed by company to creditors) present and voting at the
meeting. [Re Maknam Investments Ltd. (1995) 6 SCL 93 Cal; Re Mafatlal Industries Ltd. (1995) 84 Comp
Cas 230 (Guj)].
A full bench of the Punjab and Haryana High Court in Hind Lever Chemicals Limited and Another [2005] 58S
CL 211(Punj. & Har.) held that In our view, the language of Section 391(2) of the Act is totally unambiguous
and a plain reading of this provision clearly shows that the majority in number by which a compromise or
arrangement is approved should represent three-fourth in value of the creditors/ shareholders who are
'present and voting' and not of the total value of the shareholders or creditors of the company.
This is neither an ordinary resolution nor a special resolution within the purview of Section 189 of the Act.
This is an extraordinary resolution. A copy of this resolution need not be filed with the Registrar of
Companies under Section 192.
Where a Scheme is not approved at a meeting, by the requisite majority, but is subsequently approved by
individual affidavits, the court may sanction the Scheme as Section 391(2) is not mandatory but is merely
directory and there should be substantial compliance thereof. [SM Holdings Finance Pvt Ltd. v. Mysore
Machinery Mfrs Ltd. (1993) 78 Comp Cas 432 (Kar)].
In Kaveri Entertainment Ltd., in re. (2003) 17 Comp Cas 245 (Bom.): (2003) 45 SCL 294 (Bom): (2003) 57
CLA 127 (Bom), a learned Judge of the Bombay High Court expounded the requirement of Sub-section (2)
as:
Sub-section (2) of Section 391 of the Act requires that the resolution approving the scheme of arrangement
should be passed by majority in number representing 3/4th in value of the creditors or class of creditors
and/or members or class of members as the case may be. If the resolution granting approval to the scheme
of arrangement is passed by more than 3/4th in value of the creditors but, is not carried by the majority in
22
PP-CRVI
number of the creditors, the scheme would not be approved by the court. The majority in number of the
creditors is provided in the section for safeguarding the interests of the large number of small creditors
whose voice is often lost amongst small number of big creditors. The conditions of approval by majority in
number and 3/4th in value of credit are cumulative.
In determining whether a resolution has been passed by the requisite majority or not, the members remaining
neutral or not participating in voting are to be ignored. This is because the section clearly provides that the
votes of only the members present and voting either in person or, by proxy, are to be taken into account. Where
in a meeting for the sanction of a scheme, holders of shares of the value of
`6,42,700 were present but holders of shares of the value of `4,42,700 alone voted in favour of the resolution
and the others remained neutral, voting neither in favour of, nor against, the resolution, it was held that there
was a unanimous passing of the resolution and the requisite majority contemplated by Section 391(2) agreed to
the scheme. [Hindustan General Electric Corporation Ltd., in re. (1959) 29 Comp Cas 46 (Cal)].
In Re: Kirloskar Electric Company Ltd., [2003] 116 Com Cas 413 (Kar): The Karnatka High Court held that
the three-fourth majority required under Sub-section (2) of Section 391 of the Act was of the value
represented by the members who were not only present but who had also voted. In fact, it went a step further
to hold that the creditors who were present and had even voted but whose votes had been found to be
invalid, could not be said to have voted because casting an invalid vote is no voting in the eyes of law. Thus,
it was held that "the proper construction to be placed in calculating whether any resolution is approved or
passed by a three-fourth majority present and voting necessarily mean the value of the valid votes and out of
the same whether the resolution has been passed with three-fourth the majority"
(iii) Approval of the Stock Exchanges
As per Clause 24(f) of the Listing Agreement all the listed companies are required to file the scheme of
merger or amalgamation with all the stock exchanges where it is listed at least one month prior to filing it with
High Court and obtain its No Objection to scheme.
(iv) Approval of Financial Institutions
The approval of the Financial Institutions, trustees to the debenture holders and banks, investment
corporations would be required if the Company has borrowed funds either as term loans, working capital
requirements and/or have issued debentures to the public and have appointed any one of them as trustees
to the debenture holders.
(v) Approval from the Land Holders
If the land on which the factory is situated is the lease-hold land and the terms of the lease deed so specifies,
the approval from the lessor will be needed.
(vi) Approval of the High Court
Both companies (amalgamating as well as amalgamated) involved in a scheme of compromise or
arrangement or reconstruction or amalgamation are required to seek approval of the respective
High Courts for sanctioning the scheme.
Every amalgamation, except those, which involve sick industrial companies, requires sanction of
High Court which has jurisdiction over the State/area where the registered office of a company is
situated.
If transferor and transferee companies are under the jurisdiction of different High Courts, separate
approvals are necessary.
Lesson 2
23
If both are under jurisdiction of one High Court, joint application may be made. [Mohan Exports Ltd.
v. Tarun Overseas P. Ltd. (1994) 14 CLA 279 (Del) dissenting from Re Electro Carbonium P. Ltd.
(1979) 49 Comp Cas 825 (Kar) wherein it was held that a joint application cannot be made].
Alternatively, where both the companies are situated in the same State and only one company
moves the court under Section 391, the other company may be made a party to the petition (DCA
Circular No.14 of 1973 dated 5th June, 1973).
The notice of every application filed with the Court has to be given to the Central Government
(Regional Director, having jurisdiction of the State concerned).
After the hearing is over, the Court will pass an order sanctioning the Scheme of amalgamation,
with such directions in regard to any matter and with such modifications in the Scheme as the Judge
may think fit to make for the proper working of the Scheme. [Section 391(2); Rule 81, Companies
(Court) Rules].
The court under Section 391-394 of the Act is also empowered to order the transfer of undertaking, property
or liabilities either wholly or in part, allotment of shares or debentures and on other supplemental and
incidental matters.
(vii) Approval of Reserve Bank of India
Where the scheme of amalgamation envisages issue of shares/cash option to Non-Resident Indians, the
amalgamated company is required to obtain the permission of Reserve Bank of India subject to conditions
prescribed under the Foreign Exchange Management (Transfer or Issue of Security by a Person Resident
Outside India) Regulations, 2000.
(viii) Approvals from Competition Commission of India (CCI)
The provisions relating to regulation of combination as provided under Sections 5 and 6 of the Competition
Act, 2002 would also be required to be complied with by companies, if applicable. These provisions would be
effective from June 01, 2011.
STEPS INVOLVED IN MERGER - A FLOW CHART
Process of Merger and Amalgamation
Preparation of scheme of
Amalgamation
If no
Amend the
Object Clause
24
PP-CRVI
Convene Board meeting to approve
the scheme, valuation report, swap ratio
Inform Stock
Exchanges before
meeting and
outcome of the
meeting
Inform the
Stock Exchanges
as and when
required
Lesson 2
25
26
PP-CRVI
Since the amalgamation will involve issue of shares by the transferee company to the shareholders of the
transferor companies, a general meeting convened for the purpose of the amendment of the Object Clause
of Memorandum of Association of the transferee company to incorporate the object of the transferor
company, should also cover resolutions relating to the increase of authorised capital, consequential changes
in the Articles of Association and resolution under Section 81(1A) of the Companies Act, 1956 authorising
the Directors to issue shares of the shareholders of the transferor companies without offering them to the
existing shareholders of the company. It is also a normal practice that alongwith the special resolution for
amendment of the Object Clause, special resolution is also passed under Section 149(2A) of the Companies
Act, 1956 authorising the transferee company to commence the business of the transferor company or
companies as soon as the amalgamation becomes effective.
Convening a Board Meeting
A Board Meeting is to be convened and held to consider and approve in principle, amalgamation and appoint
an expert for valuation of shares to determine the share exchange ratio.
Consequent upon finalisation of scheme of amalgamation, another Board Meeting is to be held to approve
the scheme.
Preparation of Valuation Report
Simultaneously, Chartered Accountants are requested to prepare a Valuation Report and the swap ratio for
consideration by the Boards of both the transferor and transferee companies and if necessary it may be
prudent to obtain confirmation from merchant bankers on the valuation to be made by the Chartered
Accountants.
Preparation of scheme of amalgamation or merger
All the companies, which are desirous of effecting amalgamation of or merger must interact through their
companies auditors, legal advisors and practicing company secretary who should report the result of their
interaction to their respective Board of directors. The Boards of the involved companies should discuss and
determine details of the proposed scheme of amalgamation or merger and prepare a draft of the scheme of
amalgamation or merger. If need be, they can obtain opinion of experts in the matter. The drafts of the
scheme finally prepared by the Boards of both the companies should be exchanged and discussed in their
respective Board meetings. After such meetings a final draft scheme will emerge. The scheme must define
the effective date from which it shall take effect subject to the approval of the High Courts.
Contents of Amalgamation Scheme
Any model scheme of amalgamation should include the following:
Appointed Date or Transfer Date: This is usually the first day of the financial year preceding the
financial year for which audited accounts are available with the companies. In other words, this is a
cut-off date from which all the movable and immovable properties including all rights, powers,
privileges of every kind, nature and description of the transferor-company shall be transferred or
deemed to be transferred without any further act, deed or thing to the transferee company.
Effective Date: This is the date on which the transfer and vesting of the undertaking of the transferorcompany shall take effect i.e., all the requisite approvals would have been obtained, i.e., date of filing
of High Court order with ROC.
Arrangement with shareholders (equity and preference): This refers to the exchange ratio, which will
Lesson 2
27
have to be worked out based on the valuation of shares of the respective companies as per the
audited accounts and accepted methods and valuation guidelines.
Cancellation of share capital/reduction of share capital: This will be necessitated when the shares of
the transferor-company(ies) are held by the transferee-company and/or its subsidiary(ies) or vice
versa.
28
PP-CRVI
Within 15 minutes after the Board Meeting, the Regional Stock Exchange and all other Stock
Exchanges are required to be given intimation of the decision of the Board as well the swap ratio
before such information is given to the shareholders and the media.
Pursuant to clause 24 of the listing agreement, all listed companies shall have to file
scheme/petition proposed to be filed before any Court/Tribunal under Sections 391, 394 and 101 of
Companies Act, 1956, with the stock exchange, for approval, at least a month before it is presented
to the Court or Tribunal.
Lesson 2
29
conducted and the scheme is approved by the prescribed majority in value of the members/creditors, the
court is bound to sanction the scheme.
The court looks into the fairness of the scheme before ordering a meeting because it would be no use putting
before the meeting, a scheme containing illegal proposals which are not capable of being implemented. At
that stage, the court may refuse to pass order for the convening of the meeting.
According to Rule 69 of the said Rules, upon hearing of the summons, or any adjourned hearing thereof, the
judge shall, unless he thinks fit for any reasons to dismiss the summons, give directions as he may think
necessary in respect of the following matters:
(i) determining the members/creditors whose meeting or meetings have to be held for considering the
proposed scheme of merger or amalgamation;
(ii) fixing time and place for such meetings;
(iii) appointing a chairman or chairmen for the meetings;
(iv) fixing quorum and procedure to be followed at the meetings including voting by proxy;
(v) determining the values of the members/creditors, whose meetings have to be held;
(vi) notice to be given of the meetings and the advertisement of such notice; and
(vii) the time within which the chairman of the meeting or chairmen of the meetings are to report to the
Court the result of the meeting or meetings as the case may be.
The order made on the summons shall be in Form No. 35 of the said rules, with such variations as may be
necessary. Draft Notice, Explanatory statement under Section 393 of the Companies Act, 1956 and form of
proxy are required to be filed and settled by the concerned High Court before they can be printed and
dispatched to the shareholders.
After obtaining the courts order containing directions to hold meeting(s) of members/creditors, the company
should make arrangement for the issue of notice(s) of the meeting(s). The notice should be in Form No. 36 of
the said Rules and must be sent by the person authorised by the court in this behalf. The person authorised
may be the person appointed by the court as chairman of the meeting, or if the court so directs by the
company or its liquidator if the company is in liquidation, or by any other person as the court may direct. The
court usually appoints an advocate to be the chairman of such a meeting.
Notice of the meeting should be sent under certificate of posting to the creditors/members of the company, at
their last known addresses at least twenty-one clear days before the date fixed for the meeting. The notice
must be accompanied by a copy of the scheme for the proposed compromise or arrangement and of the
statement required to be furnished under Section 393 setting forth the terms of the proposed compromise or
arrangement explaining its effects and an explanatory statement in terms of the provision of clause (a) of
Sub-section (1) of Section 393 of the Companies Act.
A form of proxy in Form No. 37, as prescribed in the said rules, is also required to be sent to the
shareholders/creditors to enable them to attend the meeting by proxy, if they so desire.
Notice by advertisement
Generally, the Court directs that the notice of meeting of the creditors and members or any class of them be
given through newspapers advertisements also. Where the court has directed that the notice of the meetings
should also be given by newspaper advertisements, such notices are required to be given in the prescribed
30
PP-CRVI
Form and published once in an English newspaper and once in the regional language of the state in which
the registered office of the company is situated.
The notice must particularly disclose any material interest of the directors, managing director or manager
whether as shareholders or creditors or otherwise and the effect on their interests on the compromise or
arrangement, if, and in so far as, it is different from the effect on the like interests of other persons. Such
information must also be included in the form of a statement in the notice convening the meeting, where such
notice is given by a newspaper advertisement, or, if this is not practicable, such advertised notice must give
notification of the place at and the manner in which creditors or members entitled to attend the meeting may
obtain copies of such a statement. If debenture holders are affected, the statement must give like information
as far as it affects the trustees for the debenture holders. Statements which have to be supplied to creditors
and members as a result of press notification must be supplied by the company to those entitled, free of
charge. The Chairman appointed by the High Court has to file an affidavit atleast 7 days before the meeting
confirming that the direction relating to issue of notices and the advertisement has been duly complied with,
as required under Rule 76 of the said Rules.
Information as to merger or amalgamation
Section 393(1) of the Companies Act, 1956 lays down that where a meeting of creditors or members or any
class of them is called under Section 391:
(a) with every notice calling the meeting which is sent to a creditor or a member, there shall be sent
also a statement setting forth the terms of the compromise or arrangement and explaining its
effects; and in particular, stating any material interests of the directors, managing director or
manager of the company, whether in their capacity as such or as members or creditors of the
company or otherwise and the effect on those interests, of the compromise or arrangement, if, and
in sofar as, it is different from the effect on the like interests of other persons; and
(b) in every notice calling the meeting which is given by advertisement, there shall be included either
such a statement as aforesaid or a notification of the place at which and the manner in which
creditors or members entitled to attend the meeting may obtain copies of such a statement as
aforesaid.
Sub-section (2) lays down that where the arrangement affects the rights of debenture holders of the
company, the said statement should give the like information and explanation as respects the trustees of any
deed for securing the issue of the debentures as it is required to give as respects the companies directors.
According to Sub-section (3) of Section 393, where a notice given by advertisement includes a notification
that copies of the statement setting forth the terms of the compromise or arrangement proposed and
explaining its effect can be obtained by creditors or members entitled to attend the meeting, every creditor or
member so entitled shall, on making an application in the manner indicated by the notice, be furnished by the
company, free of charge, with a copy of the statement.
Every director, managing director or manager of the Company and every trustee for debentureholders of the
company, must give notice to the company of such matter relating to himself as may be necessary for the
purposes of this section. A failure to do so is an offence punishable under Section 393(5).
Holding meeting(s) as per Courts direction
The meetings are to be held as per directions of the Court under the chairmanship of the person appointed
by the Court for the purpose. Normally, the Court appoints a Chairman and alternate Chairman of each
meeting.
Lesson 2
31
32
PP-CRVI
meeting was advertised or in such other papers as the court may direct, not less than 10 days before the
date fixed for hearing. (Rule 80) The court also directs that notices of petition be sent to the concerned
Regional Director, Registrar of Companies and the official liquidator.
Obtaining order of the court sanctioning the scheme
An order of the court on summons for directions should be obtained which will be in Form No. 41 (Refer Rule
69).
Filing of copy of Courts order with ROC
According to the provisions of Section 391(3) and Section 394(3) of the Companies Act, a certified copy of
the order passed by the Court under both the sub-sections is required to be filed with the concerned
Registrar of Companies. This is required to be filed with e-Form No. 21 as prescribed in the Companies
(Central Governments) General Rules and Forms, 1956.
Conditions precedent and subsequent to courts order sanctioning scheme of arrangement
The court shall not sanction a scheme of arrangement for amalgamation, merger etc. of a company which is
being wound up with any other company or companies unless it has received a report from the Company
Law Board (Central Govt. acting through Regional Director) or the Registrar of Companies to the effect that
the affairs of the company have not been conducted in a manner prejudicial to public interest. When an order
has been passed by the court for dissolution of the transferor company, the transferor company is required to
deliver to the Registrar a certified copy of the order for registration within thirty days and the order takes
effect from the date on which it is so delivered.
Copies of the order of High Court are required to be affixed to all copies of Memorandum and Articles of
Association of the transferee company issued after certified copy has been filed as aforesaid. The transferor
company or companies will continue in existence till such time the court passes an order for dissolution
without winding up, prior to which it must receive a report from the official liquidator to the effect that the
affairs of the company have not been conducted in a manner prejudicial to the interest of the members or to
public interest. The practice in India is that in certain High Courts the Order on amalgamation is passed only
after the Report of the Official Liquidator is received, whereas in certain cases the order of dissolution is
passed after which amalgamation is approved by the concerned High Court.
The above sets out briefly the procedure relating to merger and amalgamation in India. It will be obvious from
the foregoing that considerable amount of paper work and documents are required to be prepared during the
course of the process of merger. Since the law requires approval of the shareholders both in majority in
number and three-fourth in value, it has to be ensured that adequate number of shareholders, whether in
person or by proxy attend the meeting so that the resolution can be passed by the requisite majority as
mentioned above. Normally the time frame for such merger will depend on the opposition, if any, to the
proposed merger from shareholders or creditors but in normal case it may take anything between six months
to one year to complete the merger from the time the Board approves the scheme of amalgamation till the
merger becomes effective on filing of the certified copies of the Courts Order.
JUDICIAL PRONOUNCEMENTS
Broad Principles evolved by Courts in Sanctioning the Scheme
(a) The resolutions should be passed by the statutory majority in accordance with Section 391(2) of
Companies Act, at a meeting(s) duly convened and held. The court should not usurp the right of the
members or creditors;
Lesson 2
33
(b) Those who took part in the meetings are fair representative of the class and the meetings should
not coerce the minority in order to promote the adverse interest of those of the class whom they
purport to represent;
(c) the scheme as a whole, having regard to the general conditions and background and object of the
scheme, is a reasonable one ; it is not for court to interfere with the collective wisdom of the
shareholders of the company. If the scheme as a whole is fair and reasonable, it is the duty of the
court not to launch an investigation upon the commercial merits or demerits of the scheme which is
the function of those who are interested in the arrangement;
(d) There is no lack of good faith on the part of the majority;
(e) The scheme is not contrary to public interest;
(f) The scheme should not be a device to evade law.
In Miheer H Mafatlal v. Mafatlal Industries Ltd. (1996) 4 Comp. LJP. 124, The Supreme Court explained the
contours of the court jurisdictions, as follows:
(i) The sanctioning court has to see to it that all the requisite statutory procedures for supporting such
a scheme have been complied with and that the requisite meetings as contemplated by Section
391(1)(a) of the Companies Act, 1956 have been held.
(ii) That the scheme put up for sanction of the court is backed up by the requisite majority vote as
required by Section 391(2) of the Act.
(iii) That the concerned meetings of the creditors or members or any class of them had the relevant
material to enable the voters to arrive at an informed decision for approving the scheme in question.
That the majority decision of the concerned class of voters is just and fair to the class as a whole so
as to legitimately bind even the dissenting members of that class.
(iv) That all the necessary material indicated by the Section 393(1)(a) of the Act is placed before the
voters at the concerned meetings as contemplated by Section 391(1) of the Act.
(v) That all the requisite material contemplated by the proviso of Sub-section (2) of Section 391 of the
Act is placed before the court by the concerned applicant seeking sanction for such a scheme and
the court gets satisfied about the same.
(vi) That the proposed scheme of compromise and arrangement is not found to be violative of any
provision of law and is not contrary to public policy. For ascertaining the real purpose underlying the
scheme with a view to be satisfied on this aspect, the court, if necessary, can pierce the veil of
apparent corporate purpose underlying the scheme and can judiciously x-ray the same.
(vii) That the Company Court has also to satisfy itself that members or class of members or creditors or
class of creditors, as the case may be, were acting bona fide and in good faith and were not
coercing the minority in order to promote any interest adverse to that of the latter comprising of the
same class whom they purported to represent.
(viii) That the scheme as a whole is also found to be just, fair and reasonable from the point of view of
prudent men of business taking a commercial decision beneficial to the class represented by them
for whom the scheme is meant.
(ix) Once the aforesaid broad parameters about the requirements of a scheme for getting sanction of
court are found to have been met, the court will have no further jurisdiction to sit in appeal over the
commercial wisdom of the majority of the class of persons who with their open eyes have given their
34
PP-CRVI
approval to the scheme even if in the view of the court, there could be a better scheme for the
company and its members or creditors for whom the scheme is framed. The court cannot refuse to
sanction such a scheme on that ground as it would otherwise amount to the court exercising
appellate jurisdiction over the scheme rather than its supervisory jurisdiction.
Lesson 2
35
The Bombay High Court has held in Sadanand S. Varde v. State of Maharashtra [(2001) 30 SCL 268 (Bom.)]
that Sections 391 to 394 of the Companies Act constitutes a complete code on the subject of amalgamation.
The court has no special jurisdiction under Article 226 of the Constitution to sit in appeal over an order made
under Section 391 of the Companies Act, 1956 which has become final, binding and conclusive. Ministry of
Industry need not be impleaded or heard, on the ground that its approval for the transfer of letter of intent to
the transferee company is required. [Re: Ucal Fuel Systems Ltd. (supra)].
Also in PMP Auto Industries Ltd., S.S. Mirando Ltd. and Morarjee Goculdas Spg & Wvg Co. Ltd., (1994) 80
Comp Cases 289 (Bom) it has been held that not only is Section 391 a complete code (as is the view of
various High Courts), it is intended to be in the nature of single window clearance system to ensure that the
parties are not put to avoidable, unnecessary and cumbersome procedure of making repeated applications
to the court for various other alterations or changes which might be needed effectively to implement the
sanctioned scheme whose overall fairness and feasibility has been judged by the court under Section 394.
There is a statutory power of amalgamation under the Act even if the objects of the company are construed
as not specifically empowering companies to amalgamate [Aimco Pesticides Ltd. (2001) 103 Comp Cas
4163 (Bom)].
No special notice need be given to Income Tax Dept. to find out whether there is a motive of tax
evasion in the proposed amalgamation; general public notice in newspapers is sufficient. [Re: Vinay
Metal Printers Pvt. Ltd. (1996) 87 Comp Cas 266 (AP)].
The compromise or arrangement should be within the powers of the company and not ultra vires. If
it is beyond the companys objects or power, the court will have no jurisdiction to sanction it.
[Oceanic Steam Navigation Co., Re, (1939) Com Cases 229: (1938) 3 All ER 740 (Ch.D)]
It is not necessary that the parties to the amalgamation need be financially unsound or under
winding-up as per Section 390(a). For purposes of Section 391 company means any company
liable to be wound up. But it does not debar amalgamation of financially sound companies. [Re:
Rossell Inds Ltd. (1995) 6 SCL 79 Cal].
Section 390(a) is applicable to a company incorporated outside India. If court has jurisdiction to
wind up such a company on any of the grounds specified in the Act, court has jurisdiction to
sanction scheme of amalgamation if a company incorporated outside India is a transferor company.
[Bombay Gas Co. Pvt. Ltd. v. Regional Director (1996) 21 CLA 269 (Bom)].
There is no bar to a company amalgamating with a fifteen-day old company having no assets and
business. [Re: Apco Industries Ltd. (1996) 86 Comp Cas 457 (Guj)].
Amalgamation of a company licensed under Section 25 of the Companies Act with a commercial,
trading or manufacturing company could be sanctioned under Section 391/394. [Re: Sir Mathurdas
Vissanji Foundation (1992) 8 CLA 170 (Bom); Re: Walvis Flour Mills Company P. Ltd. (1996) 23
CLA 104]. There is nothing in law to prevent a company carrying on business in shares from
amalgamating with one engaged in transport. [Re: EITA India Ltd. (1997) 24 CLA 37 (Cal)].
In Vishnu Chemicals (P) Limited, In Re [2002] 35 SCL 459 (AP), the Andhra Pradesh High Court held that
when a class of creditors does not agree to the proposed scheme of arrangement it is the duty of the court to
examine whether the consent is unreasonably withheld or in the alternative if the sanction would prejudicially
affect that set of creditors who have withheld their consent.
A scheme is a document of an arrangement of settlement or agreement which can be interpreted on the
personal perception of each group or members of group of creditors, so it will not be legal to say at the
36
PP-CRVI
preliminary stage, before the scheme comes up for the courts consideration after examination by the
creditors and members, to go into the details of allegations made against the company or any of the
transactions into which it had entered with the scheme till the preliminary formalities are completed and the
scheme comes up for detailed consideration in the court. Commerz Bank AG v. Arvind Mills Ltd. (2002) 49
CLA 392: (2002) CLC 1136: (2002) 39 SCL 9 (Guj).
Where the written consent to the proposed scheme is granted by all the members and secured and
unsecured creditors, separate meeting of members and secured and unsecured creditors can be dispensed
with. Re Feedback Reach Consultancy Services (P) Ltd. (2003) 52 CLA 260: (2003) CLC 498: (2003) 42
SCL 82: (2003) 115 Comp Cas 897 (Del).
In Milind Holdings (P) Ltd. & Darshan Holdings (P) Ltd. v. Mihir Engineers Ltd. (1996) 7 SCL 172 (Bom), it
was held that the sanction of the court is necessary even where the petitioner company had no secured
creditor and all unsecured creditors had accorded their approval to the proposed scheme along with the
shareholders of both the companies and their official liquidator also did not raise any objections to the
scheme
As per section 391(2), any compromise or arrangement approved by a majority of creditors will be binding on
all the creditors only if the said compromise or arrangement is sanctioned by the Court. Till the time sanction
is not granted by the Court to the scheme of arrangement, it cannot be said that the scheme is binding on all
creditors or that the creditors are not entitled to file the individual application. Smt. Promila v. DCM Financial
Services Ltd. (2001) 45 CLA 292 (Del.)
When the majority of the shareholders with their open eyes have given their approval to the scheme, even if
in the view of the Court there would be a better scheme, for the company and its members, the Court cannot
refuse to sanction such a scheme on that ground as it would otherwise amount to the Court exercising
appellate jurisdiction over the scheme rather than its supervisory jurisdiction. Alembic Ltd. v. Dipak Kumar
J. Shah (2003) 41 SCL 145: (2003) 52 CLA 272: (2002) 6 Comp LJ 513 (Guj).
In National Organic Chemical Industries Limited v. Miheer H.Mafatlal [JT 2004 (5) SC 612] / [2004] XXXIV
CS LW 83, the question before Supreme Court was whether the company court can decide the issue of
shareholding of a member when the issue was pending before a civil court. The Supreme Court held that
there was no statutory need for the company court to decide this issue and the findings of the company
court of the title of the appellant over the shares or beyond the jurisdiction of the company and on that
ground the Supreme Court set aside the said findings.
The full bench of Punjab and Haryana High Court in Hind Lever Chemicals Limited In Re [2004] 61 CLA 32
(P&H)/[2004] XXXIV CS LW 85, held that the words and phrases employed in Sub-section (2) of Section 391
clearly shows that the requirement of three-fourth majority relates to the value of shares/credit represented
by the shareholders or creditors who are present and voting and not of the total value of shares or credit of
the company.
In TCI Industries Limited In Re [2004] 118 Comp Cas 373 (AP), the scheme was approved by the majority of
the shareholders. The ROC representing the Central Government raised on objection that the purpose of the
scheme is to buy shares and as such the company ought to have followed the provisions of Section 77A.
The court held that Section 77A is merely an enabling provision and the courts powers under Section 391 is
not in any way affected. Similarly, the conditions for a buy back under Section 77A cannot be applied to a
scheme under Sections 100 to 104 and Section 391. The two provisions operate in independent fields.
In Larsen & Toubro Limited In re [2004] 60 CLA 335 (Bom) [2004] XXXIV CS LW 72 the Mumbai High Court
Lesson 2
37
held that a composite scheme could be made involving de-merger, of one of the undertakings of the
transferor company, for the transfer of the demerged undertaking of a subsidiary company and for the
reduction in the capital of the transferor-company.
In Jaypee Cement Limited v. Jayprakash Industries Limited [2004] 2 Comp LJ 105 (All) / [2004] XXXIV CS
LW 50 the Allahabad High Court held that the combining of the authorised share capital of the transferor
company with that of the transferee company resulting in increase in the authorised share capital of the
transferee company does not require the payment of registration fee or the stamp duty because there is no
reason why the same fee should be paid again by the transferee company on the same authorised capital.
In SEBI/Union of India v. Sterlite Industries (India) Limited [2002] 113 Comp Cas 273 (Bom), the division
bench of the Bombay High Court held that the word arrangement is of a wider import and is not restricted to
a compulsory purchase or acquisition of shares. There is no reason as to why a cancellation of shares and
the consequent reduction of capital cannot be covered by Section 391 read with Section 100 merely because
a shareholder is given an option to cancel or to retain his shares. In view of the foregoing discussion, the
objection of the appellants based on Section 77A must be rejected.
FILING OF VARIOUS FORMS IN THE PROCESS OF MERGER/ AMALGAMATION
The following forms, reports, returns etc. are required to be filed with the Registrar of Companies, SEBI and
Stock Exchanges at various stages of the process of merger/amalgamation:
1. (a) when the objects clause of the memorandum of association of the transferee company is
altered to provide for amalgamation/merger, for which special resolution under Section 17 of the
Companies Act, 1956, is passed;
(b) the companys authorised share capital is increased to enable the company to issue shares to
the shareholders of the transferor company in exchange for the shares held by them in that
company for which a special resolution under Section 31 of the Act for alteration of its articles is
passed;
(c) a special resolution under Section 81(1A) of the Act is passed to authorise the companys Board
of directors to issue shares to the shareholders of the transferor company in exchange for the
shares held by them in that company; and
(d) a special resolution is passed under Section 149(2A) of the Act authorising the transferee
company to commence the business of the transferor company or companies as soon as the
amalgamation/merger becomes effective; the company should file with ROC within thirty days of
passing of the aforementioned special resolutions, e-Form No. 23. The following documents
should be annexed to the said e-form: (i) certified true copies of all the special resolutions; (ii)
certified true copy of the explanatory statement annexed to the notice for the general meeting at
which the resolutions are passed, for registration of the resolution under Section 192 of the Act.
This e-form should be digitally signed by Managing Director/Director/Manager or Secretary of
the Company duly authorized by Board of Directors. This e-form should also be certified by
Company Secretary or Chartered Accountant or Cost Accountant (in whole time practice) by
digitally signing the e-form.
2. When a special resolution is passed under Section 149(2A) of the Act, authorising the transferee
company to commence the business of the transferor company or companies as soon as the
amalgamation/merger becomes effective, the transferee company should also file with the Registrar
38
PP-CRVI
of Companies, a duly verified declaration of compliance with the provisions of Section 149(2A) by
one of the directors or the secretary or, where the company has not appointed a secretary, a
secretary in whole-time practice in e-Form No. 20A. The original duly filled in and signed e-form 20A
on stamp paper, of the value applicable in the State where declaration is executed, is also required
to be sent to the concerned ROC office simultaneously, failing which the filing will not be considered
and legal action will be taken.
3. In compliance with the listing agreement, the transferee company is required to give notice to the
stock exchanges where the securities of the company are listed, and to the Securities and
exchange Board of India (SEBI), of the Board meeting called for the purpose of discussing and
approving amalgamation.
4. In compliance with the listing agreement, the transferee company is required to give intimation to
the stock exchanges where the securities of the company are listed, of the decision of the Board
approving amalgamation and also the swap ratio, before such information is given to the
shareholders and the media.
5. The transferee company is required to file with the Registrar of Companies, e-Form No. 21 along
with a certified copy of the High Courts order on summons directing the convening and holding of
meetings of equity shareholders/creditors including debentures holders etc. as required under
Section 391(3) of the Companies Act. This e-form should be digitally signed by the Managing
Director or Director or Manager or Secretary of the Company duly authorized by the Board of
Directors. However, in case of foreign company, the e-form should be digitally signed by an
authorized representative of the company duly authorized by the Board of Directors.
The original certified copy of the Courts order is also required to be submitted at the concerned
ROC office simultaneously of filing e-form 21, failing which the filing will not be considered and legal
action will be taken.
6. In compliance with the listing agreement, the transferee company is required to simultaneously
furnish to the stock exchanges where the securities of the company are listed, copy of every notice,
statement, pamphlet etc. sent to members of the company in respect of a general meeting in which
the scheme of arrangement of merger/amalgamation is to be approved.
7. In compliance with the listing agreement, the transferee company is required to furnish to the stock
exchanges where the securities of the company are listed, minutes of proceedings of the general
meeting in which the scheme of arrangement of merger/amalgamation is approved.
8. To file with ROC within thirty days of passing of the special resolution, e-Form No. 23. The following
documents should be annexed to the said e-form: (i) certified true copy of the special resolution
approving the scheme of arrangement of merger/amalgamation; (ii) certified true copy of the
explanatory statement annexed to the notice for the general meeting at which the resolution is
passed, for registration of the resolution under Section 192 of the Act. This e-form should be
digitally signed by Managing Director/ Director/Manager or Secretary of the Company duly
authorized by Board of Directors. The e-form should also be certified by Company Secretary or
Chartered Accountant or Cost Accountant (in whole time practice) by digitally signing the e-form.
9. The transferee company is required to file with the Central Government notice of every application
made to the court under Section 391 to 394 of the Companies Act, 1956. No notice need be given
to the Central Government once again when the Court proceeds to pass final order to dissolve the
transferor company.
Lesson 2
39
10. To file with the Registrar of Companies within thirty days of allotment of shares to the shareholders
of the transferor company in lieu of the shares held by them in that company in accordance with the
shares exchange ratio incorporated in the scheme of arrangement for merger/amalgamation, eForm No. 2 the return of allotment along with the prescribed filing fee as per requirements of
Sections 75 of the Act. This e-form should be digitally signed by Managing Director or Director or
Manager or Secretary of the Company duly authorised by the Board of Directors. The e-form should
also be certified by Company Secretary or Chartered Accountant or Company Secretary (in whole
time practice) by digitally signing the e-form.
LESSON ROUND UP
Amalgamation is a legal process by which two or more companies are joined together to form a new entity.
Merger and amalgamation have various advantages e.g. synergy, economies of scale, reduction in
production and other expenses, tax advantages, competitive advantage etc.
While implementing the strategic decision of merger/amalgamation, the transferor/transferee company has
to comply with a number of regulations viz., the Companies Act, 1956, Companies(Court) Rules, 1959,
Income Tax Act, 1961, Listing Agreement , The Indian Stamp Act, 1899, The Competition Act, 2002 etc.,
Section 391 is relating to the power of the company to compromise or to make arrangement with its
creditors and members.
Section 393 deals with regard to information as to compromises and arrangements with creditors and
members.
Section 394A deals with a notice to be given to the Central Government in respect of applications under
Section 391 and 394.
Section 395 deals with provisions regarding the power and duty to acquire shares of shareholders
dissenting from scheme or contract approved by majority shareholders.
Section 396 contains provisions as to the power of the central government to provide for amalgamation of
companies in national interest.
Rules 67-87 contains provisions dealing with the procedure for carrying out a scheme of compromise or
arrangement including amalgamation or reconstruction.
Mergers involves approvals from Board of Directors, Shareholders, Court, Stock Exchanges etc.,
40
PP-CRVI
5. ABC & Co (P) Ltd. and XYZ Ltd. have finalized a scheme of arrangement. The registered offices of
both the companies are located in Delhi. A joint-petition is proposed to be filed before the High Court
for sanction of the scheme.
Give your brief opinion in the light of the provisions of the Companies Act, 1956 and the Companies
(Court) Rules, 1959 whether such a joint-petition can be filed.
6. Discuss the law as laid down by the Supreme Court in Miheer H. Mafatlal v. Mafatlal Industries
Ltd. with regard to the role of the court in sanctioning scheme of arrangement under Section 391 of
the Companies Act, 1956.
Lesson 3
ECONOMIC AND COMPETITION LAW
ASPECTS OF MERGERS AND
AMALGAMATIONS
LESSON OUTLINE
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Underlying
mergers
Combination thresholds
Regulation of combinations
and technology.
The paradigm requires the
corporates to possess multiple expertise, through
Exemptions
Inquiry
into
Commission
economic
objectives
combination
by
in
the
42
PP-CRVI
ECONOMIC ASPECTS
Reasons for Merger and Amalgamation
Mergers must form part of the business and corporate strategies aimed at creating sustainable competitive
advantage for the company. Mergers and amalgamations are important strategic decisions leading to the
maximisation of a companys growth.
Mergers and amalgamations are usually intended to achieve any or all of the following purposes:
(1) Synergistic operational advantages Coming together to produce a new or enhanced effect
compared to separate effects.
(2) Economies of scale (scale effect) Reduction in the average cost of production and hence in the
unit costs when output is increased, to enable to offer products at more competitive prices and thus
to capture a larger market share.
(3) Reduction in production, administrative, selling, legal and professional expenses.
(4) Benefits of integration Combining two or more companies under the same control for their mutual
benefit by reducing competition, saving costs by reducing overheads, capturing a larger market
share, pooling technical or financial resources, cooperating on research and development, etc.
Integration may be horizontal (or lateral) or vertical and the later may be backward integration or
forward integration.
(5) Optimum use of capacities and factors of production.
(6) Tax advantages Carry forward and set off of losses of a loss-making amalgamating company
against profits of a profit-making amalgamated company, e.g. Section 72A of the Income-Tax Act,
1961.
(7) Financial constraints for expansion A company which has the capacity to expand but cannot do so
due to financial constraints may opt for merging into another company which can provide funds for
expansion.
(8) Strengthening financial position.
(9) Diversification.
(10) Advantage of brand-equity.
(11) Loss of objectives with which several companies were set up as independent entities.
(12) Survival.
(13) Competitive advantage: The factors that give a company an advantage over its rivals.
(14) Eliminating or weakening competition.
(15) Revival of a weak or sick company.
(16) Sustaining growth.
(17) Accelerating companys market power and reducing the severity of competition.
Lesson 3
43
44
PP-CRVI
product so that reputation and goodwill associated with a brand name of the company could be
advantageously exploited. In this situation, the company would be either installing a manufacturing facility
for the new product or looking for a good party in the market with a reasonable market share. If the
company acquires its manufacturing facility, the company can save a lot of time and energy in creating a
new industry. The combination of the ability of the company to takeover the manufacturing facility and
build the said product with the companys brand name develops a great market for the company.
On the one hand, the company has bought a competitor because the party from whom the company had
bought the unit would have given up the said line of business. Another advantage is that the company with
its definite name and reputation and with plenty of money would be able to establish a strong presence for
its new product and create a higher market share. At the same time, there could be a case, where the
company has a production facility but its market share for the said product is abysmally low. Inspite of its
best efforts the product may not receive encouraging response from customers or consumers. In such a
situation the company, for strategic reasons, may wish to acquire a brand name by buying out the entire
market share of another party who may be having strong presence for the said product.
This acquisition can happen in certain circumstances only. An aggressive player in the market will be
always on the look out for such possibilities and cash on when opportunity strikes. Thus through
amalgamation, it is possible to acquire either the entire production facility including human resources or a
new brand for an existing product or range of products. However, in acquisition of a facility, the difficulties
of getting the required know-how from reliable sources, installing and commissioning a plant and then
launching the new product which may take a lot of time and result in heavy cost, could be avoided.
Amalgamation in such cases would make available ready-made facilities, which would provide a quicker
entry for encashing the comparative advantage of the new product before new entrants make the market
much more competitive and much less profitable.
Diversifying the Portfolio
Another reason for merger is to diversify the companys dependence on a number of segments of the
economy. Diversification implies growth through the combination in unrelated businesses. All businesses go
through cycles and if the fortunes of a company were linked to only one or a few products then in the decline
stage of their product life cycles, the company would find it difficult to sustain itself. The company therefore
looks for either related or unrelated diversifications, and may decide to do so not internally by setting up new
projects, but externally by merging with companies of the desired product profile. Such diversification helps
to widen the growth opportunities for the company and smoothen the ups and downs of their life cycles.
Strategic integration
Considering the complementary nature of the businesses of the concerned companies, in terms of their
commercial strengths, geographic profiles and site integration, the amalgamated entity may be able to
conduct operations in the most cost effective and efficient manner. The amalgamation can also enable
optimal utilization of various infrastructural and manufacturing assets, including utilities and other site
facilities.
Synergies
Synergy refers to a situation where the combined entity is more valuable than the sum of individual
combining firms (2+2=5). The combination of operations can create a unique level of integration for the
amalgamated entity spanning the entire value chain in the line of business. This enables the amalgamated
entity to achieve substantial savings on costs and significantly enhancing its earnings potential.
Lesson 3
45
Synergies can be expected to flow from more focused operational efforts, rationalization, standardization and
simplification of business processes, productivity improvements, improved procurement, and the elimination
of duplication. The main criteria for synergy lies in the ability of an organization to leverage on resources to
deliver more than its optimum levels. By combining the strengths of two complementary organizations, not
only one could achieve synergy but also eliminate the disadvantages each had. One of the most important
reasons for mergers and amalgamations is to realize synergy; either through cost effective production bases
or by cost savings and pooling of resources in R&D marketing and distribution.
Taxation or Investment Incentives
A company, which has incurred losses in the past, can carry forward such losses and offset them against
future taxable profits and reduce tax liabilities. Such a company when merged with a company with large
taxable profits would help to absorb the tax liability of the later.
A similar advantage exists when a company is modernizing or investing heavily in plant and machinery,
which entitles it to substantial investment incentives, but has not much taxable profits to offset them with.
Acquiring or merging such a company with a highly profitable company would help make full use of the
investment incentives for the later.
Survey findings
In the early seventies, the Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development (OECD) published a
Report of their Committee of Experts on Restrictive Business Practices, on Mergers and Competition Policy.
The report listed twelve motives most often cited for mergers, which may be grouped together under the
following categories:
Category
A. Economies of Scale
B. Market share
C. Financial Synergy
Motives
1
Build an empire
Rationalize production
Limiting Competition
It would be wrong to conclude that mergers limit or restrict competition from the consumers point of view. In
mergers business enterprises achieve what could be termed as a buy out of the competitions market shares
or stake. The purpose of such acquisition could be to consolidate or to eliminate the competition posed by
the acquired enterprise. It does not mean new competitive forces cannot emerge or survive. It is only natural
for business enterprises and the people who drive such enterprises to look at opportunities for acquiring
more and more market stake. Mergers therefore are tools in the hands of the entrepreneurial community to
keep a watch on the competition and take appropriate action.
46
PP-CRVI
Acquisition and Mergers were identified as one of the key factor to overcome economic
recession
2008 was a traumatic year for the global economy. A decade of global economic growth had come to a
sudden, grinding halt. However, there has been improvement in the global economy since the last review in
July 2009.
New Zealand Trade & Enterprise has conducted a research on corporates during world economic recession
as to how they adopt strategies to survive during the recession and to succeed subsequently. This research
focused primarily on 13 companies that were established members of the Global Fortune 500 index. They
were the examples of organisations that have adapted, survived, and prospered during recessionary periods.
All of the companies studied achieved dramatic increases in growth and profitability during the period of
economic downturn or in the following recovery period. These companies were chosen because they exhibit
characteristics and strategies that enabled them to achieve success from difficult economic periods. The
study has identified seven key factors to have greatest impact on firms ability to emerge strongly from
recessionary periods. Among other key factors, they have identified acquisitions and strategic alliances as a
key factor to overcome economic recession to strengthen, re-focus, and position the company for increased
growth and profitability. The study identified that companies also made acquisitions to access new markets,
products, technologies, customers and talent at an accelerated pace.
Lesson 3
47
Preamble
An Act to provide for, keeping in view of the economic development of the country, the establishment of a
Commission to prevent practices having adverse effect on competition, to promote and sustain competition
in markets, to protect the interest of consumers and to ensure freedom of trade carried on by other
participants in market, in India, and for matters connected therewith or incidental thereto.
Individual: Either the combined assets of the enterprises are more than Rs. 1,500 crore in India or
the combined turnover of the enterprise is more than Rs. 4,500 crore in India. In case either or both
of the enterprises have assets/turnover outside India also, then the combined assets of the
enterprises are more than US$750 crore in India, or turnover is more than US$ 2,250 million,
including at leasts Rs. 2,250 crore in India.
Group: The group to which the enterprise whose control, shares assets or voting rights are being
acquired would belong after the acquisition or the group to which the enterprise remaining the
merger or amalgamation would belong has either Rs. 6,000 crore in India or turnover more than Rs.
18,000 crore in India. Where the group has presence in India as well as outside India then the group
has assets more than US$3 billion including at least Rs. 750 crore in India or turnover more than US
$9 billion including at least Rs. 2,250 crore in India.
The term Group has been explained in the Act. Two enterprises belong to a Group if one is in
position to exercise at least 26 percent voting rights or appoint at least 50 per cent of the directors or
controls the management or affairs in the other. Vide notification S.O. 481(E) dated 4 March, 2011,
the government has exempted Group exercising less than fifty per cent of voting rights in other
enterprise from the provisions of section 5 of the Act for a period of five years.
In exercise of the powers conferred by clause (a) of section 54 of the Competition Act, 2002 (12 of
2003), the Central Government, in public interest, hereby exempts an enterprise, whose control,
shares, voting rights or assets are being acquired has either assets of the value of not more than Rs.
250 crore in India or turnover of not more than Rs.750 crore in India from the provisions of section 5
of the said Act for a period of five years.
48
PP-CRVI
Assets
Turnover
Individual
` 1,500 Cr.
` 4,500 Cr.
Group
` 6,000 Cr.
`18,000 Cr.
Applicable to
Assets
Total
In India and
Outside
Turnover
Minimum
Indian
Component
Total
Minimum
Indian
Component
out of Total
Individual
parties
$750 m
` 750 Cr.
$ 2,250 m
` 2,250 Cr.
Group
$ 3 bn.
` 750 Cr.
$ 9 bn.
` 2,250 Cr.
The turnover shall be determined by taking into account the value of sales of goods or services. The value of
assets shall be determined by taking the book value of the assets as shown in the audited books of account
of the enterprise, in the financial year immediately preceding the financial year in which the date of proposed
combination falls, as reduced by any depreciation. The value of the assets shall include the brand value,
value of goodwill, or intellectual Property Rights etc. referred to in explanation (c) to section 5 of the Act.
Regulation of combinations
Section 6 of the Combination Act prohibits any person or enterprise from entering into a combination which
causes or is likely to cause an appreciable adverse effect on competition within the relevant market in India
and if such a combination is formed, it shall be void.
Notice to the Commission disclosing details of the proposed combination
Section 6(2) envisages that any person or enterprise, who or which proposes to enter into any combination,
shall give a notice to the Commission disclosing details of the proposed combination, in the form prescribed
and submit the form together with the fee prescribed by regulations. Such intimation should be submitted
within 30 days of:
(a) approval of the proposal relating to merger or amalgamation, referred to in section 5(c), by the
board of directors of the enterprise concerned with such merger or amalgamation, as the case may
be;
(b) execution of any agreement or other document for acquisition referred to in section 5(a) or acquiring
of control referred to in section 5(b).
Compulsory wait period
The Competition Commission of India (CCI) has been empowered to deal with such notice in accordance
with provisions of sections 29, 30 and 31 of the Act. Section 29 prescribes procedure for investigation of
combinations. Section 30 empowers the Commission to determine whether the disclosure made to it under
section 6(2) is correct and whether the combination has, or is likely to have, an appreciable adverse effect on
the competition. Section 31 provides that the Commission may allow the combination if it will not have any
appreciable adverse effect on competition or pass an order that the combination shall not take effect, if in its
opinion, such a combination has or is likely to have an appreciable adverse effect on competition.
Lesson 3
49
Exemptions
The provisions of section 6 do not apply to share subscription or financing facility or any acquisition, by a
public financial institution, foreign institutional investor, bank or venture capital fund, pursuant to any
covenant of a loan agreement or investment agreement. This exemption appears to have been provided in
the Act to facilitate raising of funds by an enterprise in the course of its normal business. Under section 6(5),
the public financial institution, foreign institutional investor, bank or venture capital fund, are required to file in
prescribed form, details of the control, the circumstances for exercise of such control and the consequences
of default arising out of loan agreement or investment agreement, within seven days from the date of such
acquisition or entering into such agreement, as the case may be.
As per the explanation to section 6(5):
(a) foreign institutional investor ahs the same meaning as assigned to it in clause (a) of the
Explanation to section 115AD of the Income-tax Act, 1961;
(b) venture capital fund has the same meaning as assigned to it in clause (b) of the Explanation to
clause (23FB) of section 10 of the Income-tax Act, 1961.
It may be noted that under the law, the combinations are only regulated whereas anti-competitive
agreements and abuse of dominance are prohibited.
50
PP-CRVI
(h) market share, in the relevant market, of the persons or enterprise in a combination, individually and
as a combination;
(i) likelihood that the combination would result in the removal of a vigorous and effective comeptitior or
competitors in the market;
(j) nature and extent of vertical integration in the market;
(k) possibility of a failing business;
(l) nature and extent of innovation;
(m) relative advantage, by way of the contribution to the economic development, by any combination
having or likely to have appreciable adverse effect on competition;
(n) whether the benefits of the combination outweigh the adverse impact of the combination, if any.
The above yardsticks are to be taken into account irrespective of the fact whether an inquiry is instituted, on
receipt of notice under section 6(2) or upon its own knowledge. The scope of assessment of adverse effect
on competition will be confined to the relevant market. Most of the facts enumerated in section 20(4) are
external to an enterprise. It is noteworthy that sub clause (n) of Section 20(4) requires to invoke principles of
a balancing. It requires the Commission to evaluate whether the benefits of the combination outweigh the
adverse impact of the combination, if any. In other words if the benefits of the combination outweigh the
adverse effect of the combination, the Commission will approve the combination. Conversely, the
Commission may declare such a combination as void.
Lesson 3
51
(vi) After receipt of all the information and within 45 days from expiry of period for filing further
information, the Commission shall proceed to deal with the case, in accordance with provisions
contained in section 31 of the Act.
Thus, the provisions of section 29 provides for a specified timetable within which the parties to the
combination or parties likely to be affected by the combination are required to submit the information or
further information to the Commission to ensure prompt and timely conduct of the investigation. It further
imposes on Commission a time limit of 45 working days from the receipt of additional or other information
called for by it under sub-section (4) of section 29 for dealing with the case of investigation into a
combination, which may have an adverse effect of the competition.
52
PP-CRVI
provisions of the Act.
(v) Where the parties to the Combination do not accept the proposed modification such parties may
within 30 days of modification proposed by the Commission, submit amendment to the modification
proposed by the Commission.
(vi) Where the Commission agrees with the amendment submitted by the parties, it shall, by an order
approve the combination.
(vii) Where the Commission does not accept the amendment, parties shall be allowed a further period of
30 days for accepting the amendment proposed by the Commission.
(viii) Where the parties to the combination fail to accept the modification within thirty days, then it shall be
deemed that the combination has an appreciable adverse effect on competition and will be dealt
with in accordance with the provisions of the Act.
(ix) Where Commission directs under section 31(2) that the combination shall not take effect or it has,
or is likely to have an appreciable adverse effect, it may order that,
(a) the acquisition referred to in section 5(a); or
(b) the acquiring of control referred to in section 5(b); or
(c) the merger or the amalgamation referred to in section 5(c) shall not be given effect to by the
parities.
As per proviso the Commission may, if it considers appropriate, frame a scheme to implement its
order in regard to the above matters under section 31(10).
(x) A deeming provision has been introduced by section 31(11). It provides that, if the Commission
does not, on expiry of a period of 210 days from the date of filing of notice under section 6(2) pass
an order or issue any direction in accordance with the provisions of section 29(1) or section 29(2) or
section 29(7), the combination shall be deemed to have been approved by the Commission. In
reckoning the period of 210 days, the period of thirty days specified in section 29(6) and further
period of thirty working days specified in section 29(8) granted by Commission shall be excluded.
(xi) Further more where extension of time is granted on the request of parties the period of two hundred
ten days shall be reckoned after deducting the extended time granted at the request of the parties.
(xii) Where the Commission has ordered that a combination is void, as it has an appreciable adverse
effect on competition, the acquisition or acquiring of control or merger or amalgamation referred to
in section 5, shall be dealt with by other concerned authorities under any other law for the time
being in force as if such acquisition or acquiring of control or merger or amalgamation had not taken
place and the parties to the combination shall be dealt with accordingly.
(xiii) Section 29(14) makes it clear that nothing contained in Chapter IV of the Act shall affect any
proceeding initiated or may be initiated under any other law for the time being in force. It implies that
provisions of this Act are in addition to and not in derogation of provisions of other Acts.
Thus, approval under one law does not make out a case for approval under another law.
Extra Territorial Jurisdiction of Commission
Section 32 extends the jurisdiction of Competition Commission of India to inquire and pass orders in
accordance with the provisions of the Act into an agreement or dominant position or combination, which is
likely to have, an appreciable adverse effect on competition in relevant market in India, notwithstanding that,
(a) an agreement referred to in section 3 has been entered into outside India; or
Lesson 3
53
LESSON ROUND UP
The economic aspects of merger include market leadership, acquiring new product/brand name, imposing
economies of scale, rationalization in production etc.
The preamble of the Competition Act, 2002 states that this is an Act to establish a Commission to prevent
anti-competitive practices, promote and sustain competition, protect the interests of the consumers and
ensure freedom of trade in markets in India.
Combination means acquisition of control, shares, voting rights or assets, acquisition of control by a person
over an enterprise where such person has direct or indirect control over another enterprise engaged in
competing businesses, mergers and amalgamations between or amongst enterprises.
Any person or enterprise, who or which proposes to enter into any combination, shall give a notice to the
Commission disclosing details of the proposed combination, in the form, prescribed and submit the form
together with the fee prescribed by regulations. Such intimation should be submitted within 30 days of
approval of the proposal relating to merger or amalgamation by the board of directors of the enterprise
concerned with such merger or amalgamation, as the case may be, or execution of any agreement or other.
Section 32 of the Competition Act, 2002 extends the extra territorial jurisdiction of the Competition
Commission of India to enquiry and pass orders in accordance with the provisions of the Act in to an
agreement, dominant position and regulates combinations i.e. mergers and acquisitions with a view to
ensure that there is no adverse effect on competition in India.
54
PP-CRVI
Lesson 4
MERGERS AND AMALGAMATIONSACCOUNTING ASPECTS OF
AMALGAMATIONS
LESSON OUTLINE
Applicability
Types of amalgamation under AS 14
i. Amalgamation in the nature of
merger
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Accounting Standard 14(AS 14) deals with
Accounting for amalgamations. According to AS 14
amalgamation may be either in the nature of merger
or in the nature of purchase. It prescribes certain
conditions to be fulfilled for consideration of
amalgamation in the nature of merger. It includes
aspects relating to transfer of assets and liabilities,
shareholders of transferor companies becoming
shareholders of transferee company, consideration
for amalgamation continuity of business of transferor
Company(ies) etc.,
AS 14 further prescribes that amalgamation in the
nature of merger should be accounted for under
pooling of interest method and amalgamation in the
nature of purchase should be accounted for under
the purchase method. It also covers aspects such as
treatment of reserves/goodwill in a scheme of
amalgamation, amalgamation after the balance-sheet
etc., After reading this lesson you will be able to
understand the applicability of AS 14 to various
strategic decisions, accounting methods, disclosure
requirements etc.
56
PP-CRVI
APPLICABILITY
Accounting Standard-14 Accounting for Amalgamations lays down the accounting and disclosure
requirements in respect of amalgamations of companies and the treatment of any resultant goodwill or
reserves.
Exception
This standard does not deal with cases of acquisitions which arise when there is a purchase by one
company (acquiring company) of the whole or part of the shares, or the whole or part of the assets, of
another company (acquired company) in consideration by payment in cash or by issue of shares or other.
Securities in the acquiring company or partly in one form and partly in the other. The distinguishing feature of
an acquisition is that the acquired company is not dissolved and its separate entity continues to exist.
Lesson 4
57
accounting principles as also Accounting Standard - 14 which provide that any profit arising out of a capital
transaction ought to be treated as capital profit and, hence, would be transferred to capital reserve and not
to general reserve. It was held that the observation of Regional Director was not in consonance with
accounting principles in general and Accounting Standard-14 in particular, as Accounting Standard-14 is
applicable only in case of amalgamation and not in case of demerger, as envisaged in instant
scheme.
TYPES OF AMALGAMATION
Accounting Standard (AS)-14 recognizes two types of amalgamation:
(a) Amalgamation in the nature of merger.
(b) Amalgamation in the nature of purchase.
An amalgamation should be considered to be an amalgamation in the nature of merger when all the following
conditions are satisfied:
(i) All the assets and liabilities of the transferor company become, after amalgamation, the assets and
liabilities of the transferee company.
(ii) Shareholders holding not less than 90% of the face value of the equity shares of the transferor
company (other than the equity shares already held therein, immediately before the amalgamation,
by the transferee company or its subsidiaries or their nominees) become equity shareholders of the
transferee company by virtue of the amalgamation.
(iii) The consideration for the amalgamation receivable by those equity shareholders of the transferor
company who agree to become equity shareholders of the transferee company is discharged by the
transferee company wholly by the issue of equity shares in the transferee company, except that
cash may be paid in respect of any fractional shares.
(iv) The business of the transferor company is intended to be carried on, after the amalgamation, by the
transferee company.
(v) No adjustment is intended to be made to the book values of the assets and liabilities of the
transferor company when they are incorporated in the financial statements of the transferee
company except to ensure uniformity of accounting policies.
An amalgamation should be considered to be an amalgamation in the nature of purchase, when any one or
more of the conditions specified above is not satisfied. These amalgamations are in effect a mode by which
one company acquires another company and hence, the equity shareholders of the combining entities do not
continue to have a proportionate share in the equity of the combined entity or the business of the acquired
company is not intended to be continued after amalgamation.
58
PP-CRVI
Lesson 4
59
be maintained for legal compliance. The statute under which a statutory reserve is created may require the
identity of such reserve to be maintained for a specific period.
Where the requirements of the relevant statute for recording the statutory reserves in the books of the
transferee company are complied with such statutory reserves of the transferor company should be recorded
in the financial statements of the transferee company by crediting the relevant statutory reserve account. The
corresponding debit should be given to a suitable account head (e.g., Amalgamation Adjustment Account)
which should be disclosed as a part of miscellaneous expenditure or other similar category in the balance
sheet. When the identify the statutory reserves is no longer required to be maintained, both the reserves and
the aforesaid account should be reserved.
Let us recapitulate
There are two types of amalgamation and two methods of accounting for amalgamations under AS 14. The
types of amalgamation are amalgamation, in the nature of merger and amalgamation in the nature of
purchase. There are two main methods of accounting for amalgamations viz. the pooling of interests method;
and the purchase method. The pooling of interests method is used in case of amalgamation in the nature of
merger. The purchase method is used in accounting for amalgamations in the nature of purchase.
60
PP-CRVI
Goodwill on Amalgamation
Goodwill arising on amalgamation represents a payment made in anticipation of future income and it is
appropriate to treat it as an asset to be amortised to income on a systematic basis over its useful life. Due to
nature of goodwill, it is difficult to estimate its useful life, but estimation is done on a prudent basis.
Accordingly, it should be appropriate to amortise goodwill over a period not exceeding five years unless a
somewhat longer period can be justified.
The following factors are to be taken into account in estimating the useful life of goodwill:
(i) the forceable life of the business or industry;
(ii) the effects of product obsolescence, changes in demand and other economic factors;
(iii) the service life expectancies of key individuals or groups of employees;
(iv) expected actions by competitors or potential competitors; and
(v) legal, regulatory or contractual provisions affecting the useful life.
Lesson 4
61
In the case of an amalgamation in the nature of purchase, the balance of the Profit and Loss Account
appearing in the financial statements of the transferor company, whether debit or credit, loses its identity.
Disclosure Requirements
(a) For amalgamations of every type of the following disclosures should be made in the first
financial statements following the amalgamations:
(i) names and general nature of business of the amalgamating companies;
(ii) effective date of amalgamation for accounting purposes;
(iii) the method accounting used to reflect the amalgamation; and
(iv) particulars of the scheme sanctioned under a statute.
(b) In case of amalgamations accounted for under the pooling of interests method, the following
additional disclosures are required to be made in the first financial statements following the
amalgamation :
(i) description and number of shares issued, together with the percentage of each companys
equity shares exchanged to effect the amalgamation;
(ii) the amount of any difference between the consideration and the value of net identifiable assets
acquired, and the treatment thereof.
(c) In case of amalgamations accounted for under the purchase method the following additional
disclosures are required to be made in the first financial statements following the amalgamations:
(i) consideration for the amalgamation and a description of the consideration paid or contingently
payable, and
(ii) the amount of any difference between the consideration and the value of net identifiable assets
required, and the treatment thereof including the period of amortization of any goodwill arising
on amalgamation.
Requirement under
amalgamations
listing
agreement
with
respect
to
accounting
treatment
for
While filing for approval any draft Scheme of amalgamation/merger/ reconstruction, etc. with the stock
exchange under the listing agreement, the company is also required to file an auditors certificate to the
effect that the accounting treatment contained in the scheme is in compliance with all the Accounting
Standards specified by the Central Government in Section 211(3C) of the Companies Act, 1956.
However, in case of companies where the respective sectoral regulatory authorities have prescribed norms
for accounting treatment of items in the financial statements contained in the scheme, the requirements of
the regulatory authorities shall prevail.
For this purpose, mere disclosure of deviations in accounting treatments shall not be deemed as compliance.
62
PP-CRVI
LESSON ROUND UP
Accounting Standard-14 Accounting for Amalgamations lays down the accounting and disclosure
requirements in respect of amalgamations of companies and the treatment of any resultant goodwill or
reserves.
AS 14 provides for two types of amalgamations viz amalgamation, in the nature of merger and
amalgamation in the nature of purchase.
There are two main methods of accounting for amalgamations viz the pooling of interests method; andthe
purchase method.
The pooling of interests method is used in case of amalgamation in the nature of merger. The purchase
method is used in accounting for amalgamations in the nature of purchase.
The consideration for amalgamation means the aggregate of the shares and other securities issued and the
payment made in the form of cash or other assets by the transferee company to the shareholders of the
transferor company.
If the amalgamation is an amalgamation in the nature of merger, the identity of the reserves is preserved
and they appear in the financial statements of the transferee company in the same form in which they
appeared in the financial statements of the transferor company.
If the amalgamation is an amalgamation in the nature of purchase, the identity of the reserves, other than
the statutory reserves is not preserved, dealt within the certain circumstances specified.
Goodwill arising on amalgamation represents a payment made in anticipation of future income and it is
appropriate to treat it as an asset to be amortised to income on a systematic basis over its useful life.
While an amalgamation is effected after the balance sheet date but before the issuance of the financial
statements of either party to the amalgamation, disclosure should be made as per the provisions of AS-4,
Contingencies and Events Occurring after the Balance Sheet Date, but the amalgamation should not be
incorporated in that financial statements.
While filing for approval any draft Scheme of amalgamation/merger/ reconstruction, etc. with the stock
exchange under the listing agreement, the company is also required to file an auditors certificate to the
effect that the accounting treatment contained in the scheme is in compliance with all the Accounting
Standards.
Lesson 5
Financial, Stamp Duty and Taxation
Aspects of Amalgamation
LESSON OUTLINE
Financial
aspects
of
mergers
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
and
amalgamations
stamp duty
Taxation aspects
amalgamation
of
mergers
and
64
PP-CRVI
Lesson 5
65
existing capacities. This would effectively mean a make (build) or buy decision of capital nature. The
decision criteria in such a situation would be the present value of the differential cash flows. These
differential cashflows would, therefore, be the limit on the premium which the acquirer would be willing to
pay. On the other hand, if the acquisition is motivated by financial considerations (specifically taxation and
asset-stripping), the expected financial gains would form the limit on the premium, over and above the price
of physical assets in the company. The cashflow from operations may not be the main consideration in such
situations. Similarly, a merger with financial restructuring as its objective will have to be valued mainly in
terms of financial gains. It would, however, not be easy to determine the level of financial gains because the
financial gains would be a function of the use to which these resources are put. Finally, the pricing of
behaviourally motivated acquisitions is not really guided by the financial considerations. Since the
acquisitions are not really the market driven transactions, a set of non-financial considerations will also affect
the price. The price could be affected by the number and the motives of other bidders. The value of a target
is effected not only by the motive of the acquiring company, but also by the target companys own objectives.
The motives of the target company could also be viewed as to be strategic, financial or behavioural. In
addition, if the target company is an unwilling dis-investor, the price of an acquisition may not have much to
do with the potential financial benefits.
66
PP-CRVI
List II entry 63
63. Rates of stamp duty in respect of documents other than those specified in the provisions of List I
with regard to stamp duty.
List III entry 44
44. Stamp duties other than duties or fees collected by means of judicial stamps, but not including rates
of stamp duties.
In exercise of power conferred by Entry 63, List II the State Legislature can make amendment in the Indian
Stamp Act under article 372, in regard to the rates of stamp duty in respect of documents other than those
specified in provisions of List I.
Stamp duty is levied in India on almost all, except a few documents, by the States and hence the rate and
incidence of stamp in different states varies. The State Legislature has jurisdiction to levy stamp duty under
entry 44, List III of the Seventh Schedule of the Constitution of India and prescribe rates of stamp duty under
entry 63, List 11.
By sanctioning of amalgamation scheme, the property including the liabilities are transferred as provided in
sub-section (2) of section 394 of the Companies Act and on that transfer instrument, stamp duty is levied.
Therefore, it cannot be said that the State legislature has no jurisdiction to levy such duty on an order of the
High Court sanctioning a scheme of compromise or arrangement under section 394 of the Companies Act,
1956. [Li taka Pharmaceuticals Ltd. and another v. State of Maharashtra and others ibid].
Stamp Duty Payable on a High Court Order Sanctioning Amalgamation
1. In amalgamation the undertaking comprising property, assets and liabilities, of one (or more)
company (amalgamating or transferor company) are absorbed by and transferred company merges
into or integrates with transferee company. The former loses its entity and is dissolved (without
winding up).
2. The transfer and vesting of transferor companys property, assets, etc. into transferee company
takes place by virtue of the High Courts order. [Section 394(2)]. Thus, the vesting of the property
occurs on the strength of the order of the High Court sanctioning the scheme of amalgamation,
without any further document or deed. Property includes every kind of property, rights and powers
of every description. [Section 394(4)(d)].
3. For the purpose of conveying to the transferee company the title to the immovable property of the
transferor company, necessary registration in the lands records in the concerned office of the State
in which the property is situated, will be done on the basis of the High Court order sanctioning the
amalgamation. If any stamp duty is payable under the Stamp Act of the State in which the property
is situated, it will be paid on the copy of the High Court order.
4. An order of the High Court under section 394 is founded and based on the compromise or
arrangement between the two companies for transferring assets and liabilities of the transferor
company to the transferee company and that order is an instrument as defined in Section 2(1) of the
Bombay Stamp Act which included every document by which any right or liability is transferred [Li
taka Pharmaceuticals Ltd. v. State of Maharashtra (1996) 22 CLA 154: AIR 1997 Bom 7].
5. Thus, an order of the High Court sanctioning a scheme of amalgamation under Section 394 of the
Companies Act is liable to stamp duty only in those states where the states stamp law provides.
Lesson 5
67
In Hindustan Lever Ltd. v. State of Maharashtra (2003)117 Comp Cas SC 758 the Supreme Court
considered this issue. Tata Oil Mills Company Ltd (TOMCO) was merged with the Hindustan Lever
Ltd (HLL). The State imposed stamp duty on the order sanctioning the scheme of merger. The
demand was challenged by the company on two grounds that State Legislature is not competent to
impose stamp duty on the order of amalgamation passed by a court and such order of the court is
neither instrument nor document (transferring properties from transferor company to transferee
company) liable to stamp duty.
The Supreme Court dismissed the appeal of the company on following reasons:
Transfer of property has been defined to mean an act by which a living person conveys property, in
present or in future, to one or more living persons. Companies or associations or bodies of
individuals, whether incorporated or not, have been included amongst living persons. It clearly
brings out that a company can effect transfer of property. The word inter vivos in the context of
section 394 of the Companies Act would include, within its meaning, also a transfer between two
juristic persons or a transfer to which a juristic person is one of the parties. The company would be
a juristic person created artificially in the eyes of law capable of owning and transferring the
property. The method of transfer is provided in law. One of the methods prescribed is dissolution of
the transferee company along with all its assets and liabilities. Where any property passes by
conveyance, the transaction is said to be inter vivos as distinguished from a case of succession or
devise. The Supreme Court dismissed the appeal on following reasons.
The State Legislature would have the jurisdiction to levy the stamp duty under entry 44 List III of the
Seventh Schedule of the constitution and prescribes rate of stamp duty under entry 63, List II. It
does not in any way impinge upon any entry in List I. Entry 44 of List III empowers the State
Legislature to prescribe rates of stamp duty in respect of documents other than those specified in
List I. By sanctioning a scheme of amalgamation, the property including the liabilities are transferred
as provided in Section 394 of the Companies Act and on that transfer instrument stamp duty is
levied. It, is therefore, cannot be said that the State Legislature has no jurisdiction to levy such duty.
Under the scheme of amalgamation, the whole or any part of the undertaking, properties or liability
of any company concerned in the scheme are to be transferred to the other company. The intended
transfer is a voluntary act of the contracting parties. The transfer is a voluntary act of the contracting
parties. The transfer has all trappings of a sale. While exercising its power in sanctioning a scheme
of arrangement, the court has to examine as to whether the provisions of the statute have been
complied with. Once the court finds that the parameters set out in section 394 of the Companies Act
have been met then the court would have no further jurisdiction to sit in appeal over the commercial
wisdom of the lass of persons who with their eyes open give their approval, even if, in the view of
the court a better scheme could have been framed. Two broad principles underlying a scheme of
amalgamation are that the order passed by the court amalgamating the company is based on a
compromise or arrangement arrived at between the parties; and that the jurisdiction of the company
court while sanctioning the scheme is supervisory only. Both these principles indicate that there is
no adjudication by the court on merits as such.
The order of the court under sub-section (2) of section 391 has to be presented before the Registrar
of Companies within 30 days for registration and shall not have effect till a certified copy of the order
has been filed with the Registrar and the Registrar of Companies certifies that the transferor
company stands amalgamated with the transferee company along with all its assets and liabilities.
Thus, the amalgamation scheme sanctioned by the court would be an instrument within the
meaning of section 2(i) of the Bombay Stamp Act, 1958. By the said instrument the properties are
68
PP-CRVI
transferred from the transferor company to the transferee company, the basis of which is the
compromise or arrangement arrived at between the two companies. A document creating or
transferring a right is an instrument. An order effectuating the transfer is also a document.
6. The company will provide to the Collector of Stamps
application for adjudication of the High Court order for determination of stamp duty payable;
proof of the market value of equity shares of the transferor company (Stock Exchange quotation
or a certificate from Stock Exchange) as of the appointed day;
certificate from an approved valuer or valuation of the immovable property being transferred to
the transferee company.
7. The Collector thereafter will adjudicate the order and determine stamp duty.
8. The stamp duty will be paid in the manner prescribed under the Stamp Rules. The duty-paid Order
will be registered with the Sub-Registrar of Assurances where the lands and buildings are located.
Lesson 5
69
70
PP-CRVI
Lesson 5
71
company or companies (other than shares already held therein immediately before the
amalgamation by, or by a nominee for, the amalgamated company or its subsidiary) become
shareholders of the amalgamated company by virtue of the amalgamation, otherwise than as a
result of the acquisition of the property of one company by another company pursuant to the
purchase of such property by the other company or as a result of the distribution of such property to
the other company after the winding up of the first mentioned company.
Thus, for a merger to be qualified as an amalgamation for the purpose of the Income Tax Act, the above
three conditions have to be satisfied.
Carry forward and set off of accumulated loss and unabsorbed depreciation allowance
Under Section 72A, a special provision is made which relaxes the provision relating to carrying forward and
set off of accumulated business loss and unabsorbed depreciation allowance in certain cases of
amalgamation. Where there has been an amalgamation of a company owning an industrial undertaking or a
ship or a hotel with another company, or an amalgamation of a banking company referred to in clause (c) of
Section 5 of the Banking Regulations Act, 1949 with a specified bank, or one or more public sector company
or companies engaged in the business of operation of aircraft with one or more public sector company or
companies engaged in similar business, then, notwithstanding anything contained in any other provision of
this Act, the accumulated loss and the unabsorbed depreciation of the amalgamating company shall be
deemed to be the loss or; as the case may be, allowance for depreciation of the amalgamated company for
the previous year in which the amalgamation was effected, and other provisions of this Act relating to set-off
and carry forward of loss and allowance for depreciation shall apply accordingly.
It is to be noted that as Unabsorbed losses of the amalgamating company are deemed to be the losses for
the previous year in which the amalgamation was effected, the amalgamated company will have the right to
carry forward the loss for a period of eight assessment years immediately succeeding the assessment year
relevant to the previous year in which the amalgamation was effected.
However, the above relaxations shall not be allowed in the assessment of the amalgamated company unless
(a) the amalgamated company
(i) has been engaged in the business in which the accumulated loss occurred or depreciation
remains unabsorbed, for three or more years;
(ii) has held continuously as on date of the amalgamation at least three fourth of the book value of
fixed assets held by it two years prior to the date of amalgamation;
(b) the amalgamated company
(i) holds continuously for a minimum of five years from the date of amalgamation at least three
fourths of the book value of fixed assets of the amalgamating company acquired in a scheme of
amalgamation;
(ii) continues the business of the amalgamating company for a minimum period of five years from
the date of amalgamation;
(iii) fulfills such other conditions as may be prescribed to ensure the revival of the business of the
amalgamating company or to ensure that the amalgamation is for genuine business purpose.
It further provides that in case where any of the above conditions are not complied with, the set off of loss or
allowance of depreciation made in any previous year in the hands of the amalgamated company shall be
72
PP-CRVI
deemed to be the income of amalgamated company chargeable to tax for the year in which such conditions
are not complied with.
For the purpose of this section, accumulated loss means so much of the loss of the predecessor firm or the
proprietary concern or the amalgamating company or demerged company, as the case may be, under the
head Profit and gains of business or profession (not being a loss sustained in a speculation business)
which such predecessor firm or the proprietary concern or the amalgamated company or demerged
company, would have been entitled to carry forward and set off under the provisions of Section 72 if the
reorganization of business or amalgamation or demerger had not taken place. Similarly unabsorbed
depreciation means so much of the allowance for depreciation of the predecessor firm or the proprietary
concern or the amalgamating company or demerged company, as the case may be, which remains to be
allowed and which would have been allowed to the predecessor firm or the proprietary concern or
amalgamating company or demerged company, as the case may be, under the provisions of this Act, if the
reorganization of business or amalgamation or demerger had not taken place.
Amendments in Finance Act 2010 which will be effective from 1-4-2011
In may be noted that under Finance Act 2010, the definition of accumulated loss and unabsorbed
depreciation is as follows.
accumulated loss means so much of the loss of the predecessor firm or the proprietary concern or
the private company or unlisted public company before conversion into limited liability partnership or
the amalgamating company or the demerged company, as the case may be, under the head Profits
and gains of business or profession (not being a loss sustained in a speculation business) which
such predecessor firm or the proprietary concern or the company or amalgamating company or
demerged company, would have been entitled to carry forward and set off under the provisions of
section 72 if the reorganisation of business or conversion or amalgamation or demerger had not
taken place;
unabsorbed depreciation means so much of the allowance for depreciation of the predecessor firm or
the proprietary concern or the private company or unlisted public company before conversion into limited
liability partnership or the amalgamating company or the demerged company, as the case may be, which
remains to be allowed and which would have been allowed to the predecessor firm or the proprietary
concern or the company or amalgamating company or demerged company, as the case may be, under
the provisions of this Act, if the reorganisation of business or conversion or amalgamation or demerger
had not taken place;
The following sub-section (6A) shall be inserted after sub-section (6) of section 72A by the Finance Act,
2010, w.e.f. 1-4-2011:
(6A) Where there has been reorganisation of business whereby a private company or unlisted public
company is succeeded by a limited liability partnership fulfilling the conditions laid down in the proviso to
clause (xiiib) of section 47, then, notwithstanding anything contained in any other provision of this Act, the
accumulated loss and the unabsorbed depreciation of the predecessor company, shall be deemed to be the
loss or allowance for depreciation of the successor limited liability partnership for the purpose of the previous
year in which business reorganisation was effected and other provisions of this Act relating to set off and
carry forward of loss and allowance for depreciation shall apply accordingly:
Provided that if any of the conditions laid down in the proviso to clause (xiiib) of section 47 are not complied
with, the set off of loss or allowance of depreciation made in any previous year in the hands of the successor
limited liability partnership, shall be deemed to be the income of the limited liability partnership chargeable to
tax in the year in which such conditions are not complied with.
Lesson 5
73
74
PP-CRVI
for a period of 14 years in equal instalments. The amalgamated company gets the right to claim the
unexpired instalments as a deduction from its total income.
The deduction under this section is however available for expenditure incurred before 1st April, 1998 only.
Expenditure on Amalgamation
Section 35DD provides that where an assessee being an Indian company incurs any expenditure, on or after
the 1st day of April, 1999, wholly and exclusively for the purposes of amalgamation or demerger of an
undertaking, the assessee shall be allowed a deduction of an amount equal to one-fifth of such expenditure
for each of the five successive previous years beginning with the previous year in which the amalgamation or
demerger takes place.
Expenditure on know-how
Section 35AB(3) of the Income-tax Act provides that where there is a transfer of an undertaking under a
scheme of amalgamation or demerger and the amalgamating or the demerged company is entitled to a
deduction under this section, then the amalgamated or the resulting company, as the case may be, shall be
entitled to claim deduction under this section in respect of such undertaking to the same extent and in
respect of the residual period as it would have been allowable to the amalgamating company or the
demerged company, as the case may be, had such amalgamation or demerger not taken place.
The deduction under this section is however available for any lump sum consideration paid in any previous
year relevant to the assessment year commencing on or before 1.4.1998.
Expenditure for obtaining Licence to Operate Telecommunication Services (Section 35ABB)
The provisions of the section 35ABB of the Income Tax Act relating to deduction of expenditure, incurred for
obtaining licence to operate communication services shall, as far as may be, apply to the amalgamated
company as they would have applied to the amalgamating company if the latter had not transferred the
licence.
TAX ASPECTS ON SLUMP SALE
Section 293 of the Companies Act empowers the Board of Directors of a company, after obtaining the
consent of the company in general meeting to sell lease or otherwise dispose off the whole or substantially
the whole of the undertaking(s) of a company.
The transaction in this case, is normally of either of the following type:
(a) Sale of a running concern.
(b) Sale of a concern which is being wound up.
(a) Sale of a Running Concern
This type of sale as a going concern provides for the continuation of the running of the undertaking without
any interruption. But there is always a problem of fixing a value in the case of a running concern for all
tangible and intangible assets including fixing a value for the infrastructure and other environmental facilities
available. In view of all this, the seller normally fixes a lump sum price called slump price.
The noun slump means a gross amount, a lump. Similarly, slump sum means a lump sum [Chambers
Twentieth Century Dictionary, 1983 Edn., p 1220). A slump sale or a slump transaction would, therefore,
mean a sale or a transaction which has a lump sum price for consideration.
Lesson 5
75
76
PP-CRVI
the undertaking. When an undertaking as a whole is transferred as a going concern together with its goodwill
and all other assets, what is sold is not the individual itemised property but what is sold is the capital asset
consisting of the business of the undertaking and any tax that can be attracted to such a transaction for a
slump price at book value would be merely capital gains tax and nothing else but capital gains tax. Plant or
machinery of any fixture or furniture is not being sold as such. What is sold is the business of undertaking for
a slump price. If the capital asset, namely, the business of the undertaking, has a greater value than its
original cost of acquisition, then, capital gains may be attracted in the ordinary case of a sale of an
undertaking.
The Bombay High Court also recognised that there will be a capital gains tax when a sale of business as a
whole occurs (Refer Killic Nixon and Co. v. CIT 49 ITR 244).
LESSON ROUND UP
Financial aspects of mergers denotes financial benefits, i.e., increase in productivity, improved profitability
and enhanced paying capacity.
The incidence of stamp duty is an important consideration in the planning of any merger. In fact, in some
cases, the whole form in which the merger is sought to take place is selected taking into account the
savings in stamp duty. The incidence of stamp duty, more particularly on transfer of immovable property is
fairly high to merit serious consideration. The fact that, in India, stamp duty is substantially levied by the
States has given considerable scope for savings in stamp duty.
Usually, in a merger, several other documents, agreements, indemnity bonds, etc. are executed, depending
on the facts of each case and requirements of the parties. Stamp duty would also be leviable as per the
nature of the instrument and its contents.
Under Section 72A, a special provision is made which relaxes the provision relating to carrying forward and
set off of accumulated business loss and unabsorbed depreciation allowance in certain cases of
amalgamation.
Capital gains tax is leviable if there arises capital gain due to transfer of capital assets.
Lesson 6
Interest of the Small Investors
in Mergers
LESSON OUTLINE
Judicial pronouncements
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Shareholders have important rights which they can
exercise democratically at the general meeting. They
have the power to control and supervise
management of the company. The term shareholder
democracy relates to the different ways in which
shareholders can influence or even determine a
companys course of life. As regards mergers, the
minority shareholders interest may be protected
through rational valuation, proper disclosure etc.,
After reading this lesson you will be able to
understand the regulatory aspects, case laws, recent
SEBI initiatives for the protection of minority
shareholders in mergers.
Section 230-240 of Companies Act, 2013 are not yet
notified and accordingly the provisions of Companies
Act, 1956 are dealt in this lesson.
78
PP-CRVI
INTRODUCTION
The fundamental principle defining operation of shareholders democracy is that the rule of majority shall
prevail. However, it is also necessary to ensure that this power of the majority is placed within reasonable
bounds and does not result in oppression of the minority and mis-management of the company. The minority
interests, therefore, have to be given a voice to make their opinions known at the decision making levels.
The law should provide for such a mechanism. If necessary, in cases where minority has been unfairly
treated in violation of the law, the avenue to approach an appropriate body for protecting their interests and
those of the company should be provided for. The law must balance the need for effective decision making
on corporate matters on the basis of consensus without permitting persons in control of the company, i.e.,
the majority, to stifle action for redressal arising out of their own wrong doing.
Minority and Minority Interest under Companies Act
1. At present, in case of a company having share capital, not less than 100 members or not less than 1/10th
of total number of members, whichever is less or any member or members holding not less than 1/10th of
issued share capital have the right to apply to CLB/NCLT in case of oppression and mismanagement. In
case of companies not having share capital, not less than 1/5th of total number of members have the right to
apply.
2 To reflect the interest of the Minority, a 10% criteria in case of companies having share capital and a
20% criteria in the case of other companies is provided for in the existing Act. In Section 395 of the Act, the
dissenting shareholders have been put at the limit of 10% of shares. Thus Minority could be defined as
holding not more than 10% shares for the limited purpose of agitating their rights before the appropriate
forum.
3 Oppression is defined in section 397(2). It is defined as conducting the companys affairs in a manner
prejudicial to public interest or in a manner oppressive to any member or members. Mis-management has
been defined in section 398(1) of the Act, as conducting the affairs of the company in a manner prejudicial to
public interest or in a manner prejudicial to the interests of the company.
Rights of minority shareholders during mergers/amalgamations/ takeovers
1 As per existing provisions of the Act, approval of High Court/Tribunal is required in case of corporate
restructuring (which, inter-alia, includes, mergers/amalgamations etc.) by a company. The Scheme is also
required to be approved by shareholders, before it is filed with the High Court. The scheme is circulated to all
shareholders along with statutory notice of the court convened meeting and the explanatory statement u/s
393 of the Act for approving the scheme by shareholders.
2 Though there may not be any protection to any dissenting minority shareholders on this issue, the Courts,
while approving the scheme, follow judicious approach by mandating publicity about the proposed scheme in
newspaper to seek objections, if any, against the scheme from the shareholders. Any interested person
(including a minority shareholder) may appear before the Court. There have been, however, occasions when
shareholders holding miniscule shareholdings, have made frivolous objections against the scheme, just with
the objective of stalling or deferring the implementation of the scheme. The courts have, on a number of
occasions, overruled their objections.
3 It is therefore, felt that there should be specific provision in the Act to put a limit (either according to a
* Source : http://www.mca.gov.in/Ministry/chapter6.html
Lesson 6
79
minimum number of persons or according to a minimum percentage of shareholding) for entitling any body to
object such a scheme. It would also be appropriate to provide for acquisition of remaining 10% shares in a
company, of which 90% has been acquired by an acquirer. Such acquisition of 10% shares should be as per
Rules to be framed by Central Government. The Committee has also made recommendations separately in
para 19 of Chapter X, concerning a threshold limit for maintainability of objections by barring minority
shareholders with insignificant stake from obstructing schemes of arrangement.
4 In case of Takeovers, as per SEBI (Substantial Acquisition of Shares and Takeover) Regulations, SEBI
has powers to appoint investigating officer to undertake investigation, in case complaints are received from
the investors, intermediaries or any other person on any matter having a bearing on the allegations of
substantial acquisition of shares and takeovers. SEBI may also carry out such investigation suo moto upon
its own knowledge or information about any breach of these regulations. Under section 395 of the Act, a
transferee company, which has acquired 90% shares of a transferor company through a scheme or contract,
is entitled to acquire shares of remaining 10% shareholders. Dissenting shareholders have been provided
with an opportunity to approach Court/Tribunal. This scheme of things appears to be fair and should be
continued. In order to object a scheme of amalgamation by investors, a limit shall be determined either
according to the minimum number of members or according to the minimum percentage of shareholding;
Existing legal provisions of Companies Act, with respect to Minority interest in Mergers/
Amalgamation etc.
Sections 391 to 396 of The Companies Act, 1956 guide the legal procedure for corporate strategies,
including mergers, amalgamations and reconstructions.
Sections 391 to 394 inter-alia give the Court the power to sanction enforce and supervise a compromise or
arrangement between a company and its creditors/members subject to certain conditions. These include
providing for the availability of information required by creditors and members of the concerned company
when acceding to such an arrangement and facilitating the reconstruction and amalgamation of companies,
by making an appropriate application to the Court.
Section 395 gives the right to acquire the shares of dissenting shareholders from the scheme or contract,
which has been approved by the majority. Section 396 deals with the powers of the Central Government to
provide for an amalgamation of companies in the national interest.
In any scheme of amalgamation, both the amalgamating company and the amalgamated company are
required to comply with the requirements specified in Sections 391 to 394 and submit the details of all the
formalities for consideration of the Court.
Protection of minority Interest
Section 394(1) authorises the court to make provision for those who dissent from a scheme. Thus, the courts
have to play a very vital role. It is not only a supervisory role but also a pragmatic role which requires the
forming of an independent and informed judgement as regards the feasibility or proper working of the
scheme and making suitable modifications in the scheme and issuing appropriate directions with that end in
view [Mafatlal Industries Ltd. In re. (1995) 84 Comp. Cas. 230 (Guj.)].
The court considers Minority interest while approving the scheme of merger
As per existing provisions of the Act, approval of High Court/Tribunal is required in case of corporate
restructuring (which, inter-alia, includes, mergers/amalgamations etc.) by a company. The Scheme is also
80
PP-CRVI
required to be approved by shareholders, before it is filed with the High Court. The scheme is circulated to all
shareholders along with statutory notice of the court convened meeting and the explanatory statement u/s
393 of the Act for approving the scheme by shareholders
Though there may not be any protection to any dissenting minority shareholders on this issue, the Courts,
while approving the scheme, follow judicious approach by mandating publicity about the proposed scheme in
newspaper to seek objections, if any, against the scheme from the shareholders. Any interested person
(including a minority shareholder) may appear before the Court. There have been, however, occasions when
shareholders holding miniscule shareholdings, have made frivolous objections against the scheme, just with
the objective of stalling or deferring the implementation of the scheme. The courts have, on a number of
occasions, overruled their objections.
Some Judicial Pronouncements
There have been occasions when the minority shareholders have raised objections and have succeeded in
preventing the implementation of a scheme of arrangement. A lone minority shareholder of Tainwala
Polycontainers Ltd (TPL), Dinesh V Lakhani, had apparently forced the company to call off its merger plans
with Tainwala Chemicals and Plastics (India) Ltd (TCPL). Lakhani had opposed the proposed merger on
several grounds including allegations of willful suppression of material facts and malafide intention of
promoters in floating separate companies (TPL and TCPL).
A division bench of the Bombay High Court had stayed the proposed TPL-TCPL merger. After almost two
years of courtroom battle, the company decided to withdraw the amalgamation petition without citing any
reasons.
Frivolous objections by Minority shareholders are not entertained by Court
There have however been some instances when shareholders holding a small number of shares, have made
frivolous objections against the scheme, just with the objective of deferring the implementation of the
scheme. The courts have, on a number of occasions, overruled their objections. But Companies had to bear
the consequences in the form of time and cost over-runs.
In case of Parke-Davis India Limited
In 2003, Parke-Davis India Limited and Pfizer Limited were considering implementation of a Scheme of
Merger. The Minority shareholders of Parke-Davis India Ltd objected to the Scheme on the grounds that the
approval from the requisite majority as prescribed under the Companies Act, 1956 had not been obtained.
They filed an urgent petition before the division bench of the Bombay High Court. The division bench of the
Bombay High Court by its order executed a stay order in March 2003 restraining the company from taking
further steps in the implementation of the scheme of amalgamation, which was further extended till
September 2003. The dissenting shareholders filed a Special Leave Petition with the Supreme Court. The
turmoil came to an end when the Supreme Court dismissed the petition filed by the shareholders. ParkeDavis then proceeded to complete the implementation of the scheme of amalgamation with Pfizer.
In case of Tomco with HLL Merger
Similarly, in the case of the merger of Tomco with HLL, the minority shareholders put forward an argument
that, as a result of the amalgamation, a large share of the market would be captured by HLL. However, the
court turned down the argument and observed that there was nothing unlawful or illegal about it.
Lesson 6
81
82
PP-CRVI
Similarly, schemes which allow listing of unlisted companies require approval of the SEBI after the scheme is
approved by the High Court. As per the circular, SEBI has observed that, in the recent past, the applications
received for seeking exemption, contained inadequate disclosures, convoluted schemes of arrangement,
exaggerated valuations, etc and is of the view that granting listing permission or exemption based on such
applications may not be in the interest of minority shareholders.
The amended provisions now require Stock Exchanges to give their reasoned observations on the scheme
and refer the same to SEBI. SEBI would also analyse the scheme, the valuation report etc. and give their
observations on very Scheme of Merger/Demerger and Reduction of Capital. Besides this all relevant
information and documents would be made public by the Company as well as Stock Exchanges and
Comments/Objections received during 21 days would be addressed by the Company and considered by the
Stock Exchanges/SEBI while granting No Objection. The other important change is mandatory Postal Ballot
approval and e-Voting on the scheme. SEBI also mandated approval of the scheme by at least 2/3rd of
Minority shareholders. These changes would create much better transparency and protection of minority
investors. The process has become very much similar to Takeover Offers/Rights Issues.
The Circular is applicable with immediate effect and would be applicable to:
Listed companies which are entering into the Scheme of Arrangements but have not submitted the Scheme
with the Honble High Court; and
The companies that have submitted the Draft Scheme with the stock exchanges under Clause 24(f) of Listing
Agreement and such schemes have not yet been submitted with the Hon'ble High Court for approval.
All scheme which have already got their No Objection from Stock Exchanges but have not yet filed with High
Court would require resubmission with the Stock Exchange
The salient features of the revised rules include the following:
OBLIGATIONS OF LISTED COMPANIES
1. It shall file the Draft Scheme of Arrangement, with the Stock Exchange in accordance with Clause
24 (f) of the Listing Agreement;
2. It shall place before its Audit Committee the Valuation Report obtained from an Independent
Chartered Accountant. The Audit Committee shall furnish a report recommending the Draft Scheme,
taking into consideration, inter alia, the aforementioned valuation report;
3. Immediately upon filing of the Draft Scheme with the stock exchanges, it shall disclose the Draft
Scheme and all the documents on its website.
4. It is required to:
Include the observation letter of the Stock Exchange in the notice sent to the shareholders;
Bring the same to the notice of the Honble High Court at the time of seeking approval of the
Scheme;
Disclose the Observation Letter of the stock exchanges on its website within 24 hours of
receiving the same.
5. It shall ensure that the Scheme provides for obtaining shareholders approval through special
resolution passed through postal ballot and e-voting. The Scheme shall also provide that the
special resolution shall be acted upon only if the votes cast by public shareholders in favor of the
proposal amount to at least two times the number of votes cast by public shareholders against it.
Lesson 6
83
6. It shall submit to stock exchanges a Complaints Report which shall contain the details of
complaints/comments received by it on the Draft Scheme from various sources prior to obtaining
Observation Letter from stock exchanges
7.
Complaints Report shall also be included in the notice sent to the shareholders while seeking
approval of the Scheme.
8.
Complaints Report, shall be submitted to the stock exchanges within 7 days of expiry of 21 days
from the date of filing of Draft Scheme with stock exchanges
9. Upon sanction of Scheme by the Honble High Court, the listed company shall submit the
documents, to the stock exchanges.
10.
11.
SEBI shall endeavour to offer its comments/approval, to the designated stock exchange in 30 days.
LESSON ROUNDUP
At present, in case of a company having share capital, not less than 100 members or not less than 1/10th
of total number of members, whichever is less or any member or members holding not less than 1/10th of
issued share capital have the right to apply to CLB/NCLT in case of oppression and mismanagement.
Section 394(1) authorises the court to make provision for those who dissent from a scheme.
There have been occasions when the minority shareholders have raised objections and have succeeded in
preventing the implementation of a scheme of arrangement.
SEBI has observed that, in the recent past, the applications received for seeking exemption, contained
inadequate disclosures, convoluted schemes of arrangement, exaggerated valuations, etc and is of the
view that granting listing permission or exemption based on such applications may not be in the interest of
minority shareholders and has issued circulars in the interest of minority for corporate restructuring
decisions.
84
PP-CRVI
Lesson 7
Amalgamation of Banking and
Government Companies
LESSON OUTLINE
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Background
Guidelines
issued
by
RBI
for
Procedure
for
amalgamation
government companies
of
companies.
After reading this lesson you will be able to
understand the procedural aspects as to the merger
of private sector banks, amalgamation of NBFC with
a banking company, procedural aspects relating to
amalgamation of government companies under
Section 396 of the companies.
86
PP-CRVI
Transferor Bank
Transferee Bank
2001
Bank of Madura
2002
Bank of Baroda
2003
Bank Muscat
2004
2005
2006
2007
Sangli Bank
2008
2009
2010
Bank of Rajasthan
Lesson 7
87
banking companies. When according this approval, the Boards need to give particular consideration
to the following matters:(a) The values at which the assets, liabilities and the reserves of the amalgamated company are
proposed to be incorporated into the books of the amalgamating banking company and whether
such incorporation will result in a revaluation of assets upwards or credit being taken for
unrealized gains.
(b) Whether due diligence exercise has been undertaken in respect of the amalgamated company.
(c) The nature of the consideration, which, the amalgamating banking company will pay to the
shareholders of the amalgamated company.
(d) Whether the swap ratio has been determined by independent valuers having required
competence and experience and whether in the opinion of the Board such swap ratio is fair and
proper.
(e) The shareholding pattern in the two banking companies and whether as a result of the
amalgamation and the swap ratio the shareholding of any individual, entity or group in the
amalgamating banking company will be violative of the Reserve Bank guidelines or require its
specific approval.
(f) The impact of the amalgamation on the profitability and the capital adequacy ratio of the
amalgamating banking company.
(g) The changes which are proposed to be made in the composition of the board of directors of the
amalgamating banking company, consequent upon the amalgamation and whether the resultant
composition of the Board will be in conformity with the Reserve Bank guidelines in that behalf.
Section 44A of the Banking Regulation Act, 1949 also requires that after the scheme of
amalgamation is approved by the requisite majority of shareholders in accordance with the
provisions of the Section, it shall be submitted to the Reserve Bank for sanction.
To enable the Reserve Bank to consider the application for sanction, the amalgamating banking
company should submit to the Reserve Bank the information and documents specified below:
1. Draft scheme of amalgamation as placed before the shareholders of the respective banking
companies for approval.
2. Copies of the notices of every meeting of the shareholders called for such approval together
with newspaper cuttings evidencing that notices of the meetings were published in newspapers
at least once a week for three consecutive weeks in two newspapers circulating in the locality or
localities in which the registered offices of the banking companies are situated and that one of
the newspapers was in a language commonly understood in the locality or localities.
3. Certificates signed by each of the officers presiding at the meeting of shareholders certifying the
following:
(a) a copy of the resolution passed at the meeting;
(b) the number of shareholders present at the meeting in person or by proxy;
(c) the number of shareholders who voted in favour of the resolution and the aggregate
number of shares held by them;
(d) the number of shareholders who voted against the resolution and the aggregate number of
88
PP-CRVI
shares held by them;
(e) the number of shareholders whose votes were declared as invalid and the aggregate
number of shares held by them;
(f) the names and ledger folios of the shareholders who voted against the resolution and the
number of shares held by each such shareholder;
(g) the names and designations of the scrutineers appointed for counting the votes at the
meeting together with certificates from such scrutineers confirming the information given in
items (c) to (f) above;
(h) the name of shareholders who have given notice in writing to the Presiding Officer that they
dissented from the scheme of amalgamation together with the number of shares held by
each of them.
4. Certificates from the concerned officers of the banking companies giving names of shareholders
who have given notice in writing at or prior to the meeting to the banking company that they
dissented from the scheme of amalgamation together with the number of shares held by each of
them.
5. The names, addresses and occupations of the Directors of the amalgamating banking company
as proposed to be reconstituted after the amalgamation and indicating how the composition will
be in compliance with Reserve Bank regulations.
6. The details of the proposed Chief Executive Officer of the amalgamating banking company after
the amalgamation.
7. Copies of the reports of the valuers appointed for the determination of the swap ratios.
8. Information which is considered relevant for the consideration of the scheme of amalgamation
and the swap ratio.
9. Information certified by the valuers as is considered relevant to understand the proposed swap
ratio including in particular:
(a) the methods of valuation used by the valuers;
(b) the information and documents on which the valuers have relied and the extent of the
verification, if any, made by the valuers to test the accuracy of such information;
(c) if the valuers have relied upon projected information, the names and designations of the
persons who have provided such information and the extent of verification, if any, made by
the valuers in relation to such information;
(d) details of the projected information on which the valuers have relied;
(e) detailed computations of the swap ratios containing explanations for adjustments made to
the published financial information for the purposes of the valuation;
(f) if these adjustments are made based on valuations made by third parties, details regarding
the persons who have made such valuations;
(g) capitalisation factor and weighted average cost of capital (WACC) used for the purposes of
the valuation and justification for the same;
(h) if market values of shares have been considered in the computation of the swap ratio, the
Lesson 7
89
market values considered and the source from which such values have been derived;
(i) if there are more than one valuer, whether each of the valuers have recommended a
different swap ratio and if so, the above details should be given separately in respect of
each valuer and it may be indicated how the final swap ratio is arrived at.
10. Such other information and explanations as the Reserve Bank may require.
To enable the Reserve Bank to determine such value, the amalgamated banking company should
submit the following:(a) a report on the valuation of the share of the amalgamated company made for this purpose by
the valuers appointed for the determination of the swap ratio
(b) detailed computation of such valuation
(c) where the shares of the amalgamated company are quoted on the stock exchange:(i) details of the monthly high and low of the quotation on the exchange where the shares are
most widely traded together with number of shares traded during the six months
immediately preceding the date on which the scheme of amalgamation is approved by the
Boards.
(ii) the quoted price of the share at close on each of the fourteen days immediately preceding
the date on which the scheme of amalgamation is approved by the Boards.
(d) Such other information and explanations as the Reserve Bank may require.
Prior approval of RBI in cases of acquisition or transfer of control of deposit taking NBFCs
As per, Non-Banking Financial Companies (Deposit Accepting) (Approval of Acquisition or Transfer of
Control) Directions, 2009, any takeover or acquisition of control of a deposit taking NBFC, whether by
acquisition of shares or otherwise, or any merger/amalgamation of a deposit taking NBFC with another
entity, or any merger/amalgamation of an entity with a deposit taking NBFC, shall require prior written
approval of Reserve Bank of India. The Reserve Bank of India may, if it considers necessary for avoiding any
hardship or for any other just and sufficient reason, exempt any NBFC or class of NBFCs, from all or any of
the provisions of these Directions either generally or for any specified period, subject to such conditions as
the Reserve Bank of India may impose.
90
PP-CRVI
Lesson 7
91
the shares held by him in that company, their value as determined by the RBI when sanctioning the
scheme [section 44A(3)].
The determination by the RBI regarding the value of the shares to be paid to the dissenting
shareholders shall be final for all purposes [section 44A(3)].
Transfer of property
On the sanctioning of a scheme of amalgamation by the RBI, the property of the amalgamated
banking company, i.e. the transferor company, shall, by virtue of the order of sanction, be
transferred to and vest in the transferee company. No other or further document will be necessary
for effecting the transfer and vesting of the property from the transferor company to the transferee
company [section 44A(6)].
Similarly, the liabilities of the transferor company shall, by virtue of the said order, be transferred to,
and become the liabilities of the transferee company [section 44A(6)].
92
PP-CRVI
The salient features of the Bill from the point of view of restructuring are as follows:
To enable banking companies to issue preference shares subject to regulatory guidelines by the
RBI;
To provide prior approval of RBI for acquisition of 5% or more of shares or voting rights in a banking
company by any person and empowering RBI to impose such conditions as it deems fit in this
respect.
To empower RBI to collect information and inspect associate enterprises of banking companies;
To enable the nationalized banks to raise capital through bonus and rights issue and also enable
them to increase or decrease the authorized capital with approval from the Government and RBI
without being limited by the ceiling of a maximum of Rs. 3000 crore under the Banking Companies
(Acquisition and Transfer of Undertakings) Act, 1970/80.
RELATED
TO
GOVERNMENT
The Ministry of Corporate Affairs (MCA) have been dealing with the amalgamation of Government
Companies in the Public Interest under section 396 of the Companies Act, 1956 by following the procedures
prescribed under Companies (Court) Rules, 1959 which are applicable to amalgamation under Sections 391394 of the Companies Act, 1956. Without prejudice to the generality of Section 396, it has now been decided
that, in appropriate cases, simpler procedures shall be adopted for the amalgamation of Government
Companies under section 396 of the Companies Act, 1956 as given below:(1) (a) Every Central Government Company which is applying to the Central Government for
amalgamation with any other Government Company or Companies under the simplified
prescribed procedure, shall obtain approval of the Cabinet i.e. Union Council of Ministers to the
effect that the proposed amalgamation is essential in the public interest.
(b) In the case of State government companies, the approval of the State Council of Ministers
would be required.
(c) Where both central and state government companies are involved, approval of both State
Cabinet(s) and Central Cabinet shall be necessary.
(2) (i) A Government Company may, by a resolution passed at its general meeting decide to
amalgamate with any other Government Company, which agrees to such transfer by a
resolution passed at its general meeting;
(ii) Any two or more Government Companies may, by a resolution passed at any general meetings
of its Members, decide to amalgamate and with a new Government Company.
(3) Every resolution of a Government Company under this section shall be passed at its general
meeting by members holding 100% of the voting power and such resolution shall contain all
particulars of the assets and liabilities of amalgamating government companies.
(4) Before passing a resolution under this section, the Government Company shall give notice thereof
of not less than 30 days in writing together with a copy of the proposed resolution to all the
Members and creditors.
(5) A resolution passed by a Government Company under this section shall not take effect until (i) the
assent of all creditors has been obtained, or (ii) the assent of 90% of the creditors by value has
been received and the company certifies that there is no objection from any other creditor.
Lesson 7
93
(6) The resolutions passed by the transferor and transferee companies along with written confirmation
of the Cabinet decision shall then be submitted to the Central Government which shall, if it is
satisfied that all the requirements of Section 396 and the circular issued by MCA on this behalf have
been fulfilled, order by notification in the Gazette that the said amalgamation shall take effect.
(7) The order of the Central Government shall provide:(a) for the transfer to the transferee company of the whole or any part of the undertaking, property
or liabilities of any transferor company
(b) that the amalgamation of companies under the foregoing sub-sections shall not in any manner
whatsoever affect the pre-existing rights or obligations and any legal proceedings that might
have been continued or commenced by or against any erstwhile company before the
amalgamation, may be continued or commenced by, or against, the concerned resulting
company, or transferee company, as the case may be.
(c) for such incidental, consequential and supplemental matters as are necessary to secure that the
amalgamation shall be fully and effectively carried out
(8) The Cabinet decision referred to in para (1) above may precede or follow the passing of the
resolution referred to in para (2).
(9) When an order has been passed by the Central Government under this section, it shall be a
sufficient conveyance to vest the assets and liabilities in the transferee.
(10) Where one government company is amalgamated with another government company, under these
provisions, the registration of the first-mentioned Company i.e. transferor company, shall stand
cancelled and that Company shall be deemed to have been dissolved and shall cease to exist
forthwith as a corporate body.
(11) Where two or more Government Companies are amalgamated into a new Government Company in
accordance with these provisions and the Government Company so formed is duly registered by the
Registrar, the registration of each of the amalgamating companies shall stand cancelled forthwith on
such registration and each of the Companies shall thereupon cease to exist as a corporate body.
(12) The amalgamation of companies under the foregoing sub-sections shall not in any manner
whatsoever affect the pre-existing rights or obligations, and any legal proceedings that might have
been continued or commenced by or against any erstwhile company before the amalgamation, may
be continued or commenced by, or against, the concerned resulting company, or transferee
company, as the case may be.
(13) The Registrar shall strike off the names of every Government Company deemed to have been
dissolved under sub-sections (10) to (11).
(14) Government companies are not prevented from applying for amalgamation before the Central
Government under Sections 391-394 of the Companies Act.
LESSON ROUND UP
Amalgamation of one banking company with another banking company is governed by the provisions of
Banking Regulation Act, 1949. The provisions of the Companies Act, 1956 are not applicable in this case.
Section 44A of the Banking Regulation Act, 1949 requires that the draft scheme of amalgamation has to be
approved by the shareholders of each banking company by a resolution passed by a majority in number
representing two-thirds in value of the shareholders, present in person or by proxy at a meeting called for
the purpose.
Where the NBFC is proposed to be amalgamated into a banking company, the banking company should
94
PP-CRVI
obtain the approval of the Reserve Bank of India after the scheme of amalgamation is approved by its
Board but before it is submitted to the High Court for approval.
Without prejudice to the generality of Section 396, it has now been notified by the Ministry of Corporate
Affairs that, in appropriate cases, simpler procedures shall be adopted for the amalgamation of Government
Companies under section 396 of the Companies Act, 1956.
Lesson 8
Corporate Demergers and Reverse
Mergers
LESSON OUTLINE
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Companies have to downsize their operations in
Difference
between
reconstruction
Modes of demerger
Procedural aspects
Taxation aspects
Reverse merger
demerger
and
96
PP-CRVI
INTRODUCTION
In the era of globalization, corporates all over the world are moving towards consolidation and redefining
core competencies to survive and achieve their objectives. The corporate sector in India is also resorting to
various mechanism of corporate restructuring to improve efficiency. Over the last few years, different modes
of corporate restructuring such as stock splits, capital restructuring, mergers and acquisitions etc. have been
adopted by companies in India.
Companies have to downsize or contract their operations in certain circumstances such as when a division
of the company is performing poorly or simply because it no longer fits into the companys plans or to give
effect to rationalisation or specialisation in the manufacturing process. This may also be necessary to undo a
previous merger or acquisition which proved unsuccessful. This type of restructuring can take various forms
such as demerger or spin off, split off, etc.
Large entities sometimes hinder entrepreneurial initiative, sideline core activities, reduce accountability and
promote investment in non-core activities. There is an increasing realisation among companies that
demerger may allow them to strengthen their core competence and realise the true value of their business.
Lesson 8
97
immediately before the demerger, become the liabilities of the resulting company by virtue of the
demerger;
(iii) the property and the liabilities of the undertaking or undertakings being transferred by the demerger
company are transferred at values appearing in its books of account immediately before the
demerger;
(iv) the resulting company issues, in consideration of the demerger, its shares to the shareholders of the
demerged company on a proportionate basis;
(v) the shareholders holding not less than three-fourths in value of the shares in the demerged
company (other than shares already held therein immediately before the demerger, or by a nominee
for, the resulting company or, its subsidiary) become shareholders of the resulting company or
companies by virtue of the demerger, otherwise than as a result of the acquisition of the property or
assets of the demerged company or any undertaking thereof by the resulting company;
(vi) the transfer of the undertaking is on a going concern basis;
(vii) the demerger is in accordance with the conditions, if any, notified under sub-section (5) of section
72A by the Central Government in this behalf.
Explanation 1. For the purposes of this clause, undertaking shall include any part of an undertaking, or a
unit or division of an undertaking or a business activity taken as a whole, but does not include individual
assets or liabilities or any combination thereof not constituting a business activity.
Explanation 2. For the purposes of this clause, the liabilities referred to in sub-clause (ii), shall include(a) the liabilities which arise out of the activities or operations of the undertaking;
(b) the specific loans or borrowings (including debentures) raised, incurred and utilised solely for the
activities or operations of the undertaking; and
(c) in cases, other than those referred to in clause (a) or clause (b), so much of the amounts of general
or multipurpose borrowings, if any, of the demerged company as stand in the same proportion
which the value of the assets transferred in a demerger bears to the total value of the assets of such
demerged company immediately before the demerger.
Explanation 3. For the determining the value of the property referred to in sub-clause (iii), any change in
the value of assets consequent to their revaluation shall be ignored.
Explanation 4. For the purposes of this clause, the splitting up or the reconstruction of any authority of a
body constituted or established under a Central, State or Provincial Act, or a local authority or a public sector
company, into separate authorities or bodies or local authorities or companies, as the case may be, shall be
deemed to be a demerger if such split up or reconstruction fulfills such conditions as may be notified in the
Official Gazette by the Central Government.
98
PP-CRVI
demerger and, the resulting company in consideration of such transfer of undertaking, issues shares to the
shareholders of the demerged company and includes any authority or body or local authority or public sector
company or a company established, constituted or formed as a result of demerger.
Reliance
Industries Limited
Reliance Communication
Ventures Limited (Resulting
Company)
Lesson 8
99
turnkey businesses.
Let us understand the recent Wipro Demerger which was approved by Karnataka High Court
in March 2013
The scheme
The demerger of the
Medical Diagnostic Product & Services business (through its strategic joint venture),
into a separate company to be named Wipro Enterprises Limited(Resulting Company). Wipro Limited
(Demerged Company) will remain a publicly listed company that will focus exclusively on information
technology. Wipro Enterprises Limited will be an unlisted company.
Background
In fiscal year 2011-12, the IT Business contributed to 86% of revenue and 94% of operating profit of Wipro
Limited. The demerger is anticipated to provide fresh impetus for both Wipro Limited and Wipro Enterprises
Limited to pursue their individual growth strategies. The demerger is also expected to improve the
competitiveness in their respective markets.
According to the restructuring scheme as currently proposed, resident Indian shareholders of Wipro Limited
on the record date can choose from multiple options as per their investment objectives. They may opt to:
(i) receive one equity share with face value of Rs.10 in Wipro Enterprises Limited for every five equity
shares with face value of Rs.2 each in Wipro Limited that they hold; or
(ii) receive one 7% Redeemable Preference Share in Wipro Enterprises Limited, with face value of
Rs.50, for every five equity shares of Wipro Limited that they hold; or
(iii) exchange the equity shares of Wipro Enterprises Limited and receive as consideration equity
shares of Wipro Limited held by the Promoter. The exchange ratio will be 1 equity share in Wipro
Limited for every 1.65 equity shares in Wipro Enterprises Limited.
Non-resident shareholders (excluding ADR holders) and the ADR holders on the record date would be
entitled to receive equity shares of Wipro Enterprises Limited in the aforesaid ratio. The Non-resident
shareholders (excluding ADR holders) shall further have the option to exchange the Wipro Enterprises
Limited equity shares that they are entitled to and receive equity shares of Wipro Limited held by the
Promoter in the aforesaid ratio.
100 PP-CRVI
TYPES OF DEMERGER
Partial Demerger
In a partial demerger, one of the undertakings or a part of the undertaking or a department or a division of an
existing company is separated and transferred to one or more new company/companies, formed with
substantially the same shareholders, who are allotted shares in the new company in the same proportion as
the separated division, department etc. bears to the total undertaking of the company.
Complete Demerger
In the first case, i.e. in the case of partial demerger, the existing company also continues to maintain its
separate legal identity and the new company, a separate legal identity, carries on the separated or spun off
business and undertaking of the existing company.
In a complete demerger, an existing company transfers its various divisions, undertakings etc. to one or
Lesson 8
101
more new companies formed for this purpose. The existing company is dissolved by passing a special
resolution for members voluntary winding up and also authorising the liquidator to transfer its undertakings,
divisions etc. to one or more companies as per the scheme of demerger approved by the shareholders of the
company by a special resolution. The shareholders of the dissolved company are issued and allotted shares
in the new company or companies, as the case may be, on the basis of the pre-determined shares exchange
ratio, as per the scheme of demerger.
In the case of complete demerger, the existing company disappears from the corporate scene. It is
voluntarily wound up and its entire business, undertakings etc. are transferred to one or more new
companies.
WAYS OF DEMERGER
Demerger could be affected by either of the following three ways:
(i) Demerger by agreement between promoters; or
(ii) Demerger under the scheme of arrangement with approval by the court under section 391;
(iii) Demerger under voluntary winding up and the power of liquidator.
102 PP-CRVI
company can be demerged or split into, through a scheme of demerger or division with the sanction of
respective High Courts under the provisions of the Companies Act, 1956. The Memorandum of Association
of the Company must contain provisions of demerger or split in order to accomplish the same.
Res judicata
Where a proposed scheme of compromise or arrangement has already been rejected by the court and the
same persons propose another scheme which is substantially the same as the earlier one, the general
principle of res judicata applies to bar the second scheme.
Summons for directions to convene a class meeting under Section 391 Rule 67.
Form No. 34
Form No. 35
Form No. 36
Form No. 37
Form No. 38
Lesson 8
Form No. 39
Form No. 40
Form No. 41
103
104 PP-CRVI
has the discretion to give whatever directions that it may deem proper.
Before an application under Section 391 of the Act is made by a company, as a matter of common
procedure, the Chairman of the Board of directors of the company which is proposed to be
reconstructed by demerger should send a circular letter to the members of the company explaining
details of the scheme of reconstruction and the reasons which have prompted the Board to propose
reconstruction. The circular letter should specify how the scheme would affect the shareholdings of
the members. Copies of the circular should also be sent to the stock exchanges, where the shares
of the company or companies are listed.
The petition must pray for appropriate orders and directions under Section 394 of the Act for
facilitating the reconstruction (by demerger) of the company.
3. Obtaining courts order for holding meetings of members/creditors
On receiving a petition the court may order meeting(s) of the members/ creditors of the company, to
be called, held and conducted in a prescribed manner. Once the ordered meeting(s) is/are duly
convened, held and conducted and the scheme is approved by the prescribed majority in value of
the creditors or number of members, as the case may be, the court is bound to sanction the
scheme.
The court shall look into the fairness of the scheme before ordering meeting(s) because it would be
no use putting before the meeting(s), a scheme containing proposals which are not capable of being
implemented. At that stage, the court may refuse to pass an order for the convening of the
meeting(s).
The court must also ensure that the circular about the details of the scheme which is sent to the
members and creditors should give a fair picture of the proposed scheme.
Upon the hearing of the summons, or any adjourned hearing thereof, the judge shall, unless he
thinks fit for any reason to dismiss the summons, give directions as he may think necessary in
respect of the following matters:
(i) determining the class or classes of creditors and/or members whose meeting or meetings have
to be held for considering the proposed scheme of demerger;
(ii) fixing the time and place for such meeting or meetings;
(iii) appointing a Chairman or Chairmen for the meeting or meetings to be held, as the case may be;
(iv) fixing the quorum and procedure to be followed at the meeting or meetings, including voting by
proxy;
(v) determining the values of the creditors and/or the members, or the creditors or members of any
class, as the case may be whose meetings have to be held;
(vi) notice to be given of the meeting or meetings and the advertisement of such notice; and
(vii) the time within which the Chairman of the meeting or Chairmen of the meetings should report to
the Court the result of the meeting or meetings, as the case may be;
and such other matters as the Court may deem necessary.
The order made on the summons should be in Form No. 35 of the Court Rules, with such variations
as may be necessary. Within 3 days of orders being received by the Companies from the Court, the
companies are required to get the draft explanatory statement, notice of meeting, draft resolutions,
Lesson 8
105
proxy forms, publication also translated in regional language in Form No. 38 vouched by Registry of
High Court.
An application under Sub-section (6) of Section 391 for stay of commencement or continuation of
any suit or proceeding against the company may be moved by a Judges summons ex-parte,
provided where a petition for winding up or that under Section 397 or 398 is pending, notice of
application shall be given to petitioner where a stay order has been made. Any person aggrieved by
such order may apply to the court by a Judges summons to vacate or vary such order.
4. Notice of the meetings of members/creditors
After obtaining the courts order containing directions to hold the meeting(s) of the
creditors/members of company, the company should make arrangement for the issue of notice of
the meeting(s) to them. The notice of such meeting(s) should be sent individually in Form No. 36 of
the said rules and must be sent by the person authorised by the court in this behalf, who may be the
Chairman appointed by the court for the meeting, or if the court so directs, by the company or by
any other person as the court may direct. The notice should be sent by post under certificate of
posting to their last known address at least twenty-one clear days before the date fixed for the
meeting. The notice must be accompanied by a copy of the scheme for the proposed demerger and
of the statement required to be furnished under Section 393 setting forth the terms of the proposed
compromise or arrangement explaining its effects, and a form of proxy in Form No. 37 of the said
rules. According to Rule 70 voting by proxies shall be permitted provided a proxy in the prescribed
form duly signed by the person entitled to attend and vote at the meeting is filed with the company
at its registered office not later than 48 hours before the meeting. Also Rules 227 to 229 relating to
proxies apply to proxies lodged under this rule.
The notice must particularly disclose any material interest of the directors, managing director or
manager whether as shareholders or creditors or otherwise and the effect on their interests of the
compromise or arrangement, if, and in so far as, it is different from the effect on the like interests of
other persons. Such information must also be included in the form of a statement in the notice
convening the meeting, where such notice is given by advertisement, or, if this is not practicable,
such advertised notice must give notification, of the place at and the manner in which creditors or
members entitled to attend the meeting may obtain copies of such a statement. If debenture holders
are affected, the statement referred to must give like information as far as it affects the trustees for
the debenture holders. Statements which have to be supplied to creditors and members as a result
of press notification must be supplied by the company to those entitled, free of charge. (Section
393)
The notice of the meeting shall be advertised in such newspapers and in such manner as the Judge
may direct, not less than 21 clear days from the date fixed for the meeting. Advertisement shall be
in Form No. 38.
Every creditor or member entitled to attend the meeting shall be furnished by the company, free of
charge and within 24 hours of a requisition being made for the same, with a copy of the proposed
compromise or arrangement together with a copy of the statement required to be furnished, unless
the same had already been furnished to such member/creditor.
According to Rule 76, the Chairman appointed for the meeting or other person directed to issue the
advertisement and the notices of the meeting shall file an affidavit not less than seven days before
the date fixed for the holding of the meeting or first of the meetings, showing that the directions
regarding the issue of notices and the advertisement have been duly complied with. Along with the
106 PP-CRVI
affidavit, the paper publications, one in English and another in vernacular daily and proof of
certificate of posting are to be filed one week before the date of meeting.
5. Holding meeting(s) of members/creditors
Pursuant to the directions, the meeting(s) should be held. The chairman of the meeting, or where
there are separate meetings, the chairman of each meeting, shall report the result thereof to the
court. The report shall state accurately the number of creditors or class of creditors or the number of
members or class of members, as the case may be, who were present and who voted at the
meeting either in person or by proxy, their individual values and the way they voted.
6. Reporting the result of the meeting by the Chairman to the court
The result of the meeting must be decided only by taking poll and by separately counting the votes
in favour and against the resolution. The chairman of the meeting should within the time fixed by the
court or where no time has been fixed, within seven days after the conclusion of the meeting, report
the result of the meeting in the prescribed Form 39 to the Court. (Rule 78)
7. Petition to the court for sanctioning the scheme of demerger
When the scheme of demerger has been approved by the required majority of shareholders/
creditors, i.e. majority in number representing three-fourths in value of the creditors, or class of
creditors, or members or class of members, as the case may be, present and voting either in
person, or, where proxies are allowed, by proxy, at the meeting, a petition must be made to the
court for sanctioning the scheme of demerger. The petition must be made by the company. The
petition is required to be made in Form No. 40 of the said rules. The following documents are
necessary for enabling the High Court to sanction the scheme: (Rule 79)
(a) Company Petition (Form No. 40 with Court Fee).
(b) An affidavit verifying petition in Form No. 3.
(c) Scheme.
(d) Memorandum and Articles of Association.
(e) Audited Accounts.
(f) Independent professional valuers report.
(g) Copy of the Chairmans Report in Form No. 35.
(h) Six copies of Form No. 5 being the advertisement of petition and Form No. 6 being the notice of
petition to be issued to Regional Director, Department of Company Affairs and Registrar of
Companies.
The Court shall fix a date for the hearing of the petition, and notice of hearing shall be advertised in
the same papers in which notice of the meeting was advertised, or in such other papers, as the
court may direct not less than 10 days before the date fixed for hearing.
8. Obtaining order of the court sanctioning the scheme
Obtain an order of the court sanctioning the scheme of demerger. Where the Court sanctions the
compromise or arrangement, the order shall include such directions in regard to any matter and
such modifications as the Judge may think fit. The order shall direct that a certified copy of the same
shall be filed with the Registrar of Companies within 14 days from the date of the order or such
other time as may be fixed by the Court. (Rule 81)
Lesson 8
107
108 PP-CRVI
Lesson 8
109
110 PP-CRVI
(e) Treatment of expenditure on prospecting, etc. of certain minerals [Section 35E(7A)]
Where the undertaking of an Indian company which is entitled to deduction on account of
prospecting of minerals, is transferred before the expiry of period of 10 years to another company in
a scheme of demerger, such expenditure of prospecting, etc. which is not yet written off shall be
allowed as deduction to the resulting company in the same manner as would have been allowed to
the demerged company.
The demerged company will not be entitled to the deduction thereafter.
(f) Treatment of bad debts [Section 36(1)(vii)]
Where due to demerger the debts of the demerged company have been taken over by the resulting
company and subsequently by such debt or part of debt becomes bad such bad debt will be allowed
as a deduction to the resulting company. This is based upon the decision of the Supreme Court in
the case of CIT v. Veerabhadra Rao (T.), K. Koteswara Rao & Co. (1985) 155 ITR 152 (SC) which
was decided in the case of amalgamation of companies.
(g) Amortisation of expenditure in case of demerger [Section 35DD]
Where an assessee, being an Indian company, incurs any expenditure, on or after the 1st day of
April, 1999, wholly and exclusively for the purposes of demerger of an undertaking, the assessee
shall be allowed a deduction of an amount equal to one-fifth of such expenditure for each of the five
successive previous years beginning with the previous year in which the demerger takes place.
No deduction shall be allowed in respect of the expenditure mentioned in sub-section (1) under any
other provision of this Act.
(h) Carry forward and set off of business losses and unabsorbed depreciation of the demerged
company [Section 72A(4) & (5)]
The accumulated loss and unabsorbed depreciation, in a demerger, should be allowed to be carried
forward by the resulting company if these are directly relatable to the undertaking proposed to be
transferred. Where it is not possible to relate these to the undertaking, such loss and depreciation
shall be apportioned between the demerged company and the resulting company in proportion of
the assets coming to the share of each as a result of demerger.
In Central Government may, for the purposes of this Act, by notification in the Official Gazette,
specifying such conditions on it considers necessary to ensure that the demerger is for genuine
business purpose.
(i) Deduction available under section 80-1A(12) or 80-1B(12)
Where an undertaking which is entitled to deduction under section 80-1A (12)/80-1B (12) is
transferred before the expiry of the period to another Indian company in a scheme of amalgamation
or dermerger
(i) no deduction under section 80-1A(12)/80-1B(12) shall be available to the demerged company
for the previous year in which amalgamation takes place; and
(ii) the provisions of section 80-1A (12)/80-1B(12) shall apply to the resulting company in such
manner in which they would have applied to the demerged company.
Lesson 8
111
company/demerged-company filed a petition under section 391 for sanction of proposed scheme of its
demerger - Pursuant to an order of Court, meeting of creditors of demerged company was convened and
they unanimously approved proposed scheme of demerger - Advertisement of petition was published in
newspapers and notices were issued to Official Liquidator and Regional Director - Official Liquidator had no
objection to proposed scheme - However, Regional Director had objected to proposed scheme by stating
that ratio of exchange of shares had not been disclosed - It was found that objection in respect of ratio of
exchange of shares had been explained before authorities It was held that scheme of arrangement or
demerger was in interest of shareholders/creditors of companies, proposed scheme was to be approved.
REVERSE MERGER
It must be understood at the outset that amalgamation and merger are corporate restructuring methods. Both
the terms are synonymous. The procedure to be adopted for both is the same and the consequences of both
are also the same. For achieving amalgamation as well as merger, an existing company (which is referred to
as the amalgamating or merging or transferor company), under a scheme of amalgamation or merger,
loses its own legal identity and is dissolved without being wound up and its assets, properties and liabilities
are transferred to another existing company (which is referred to as the amalgamated or merged or
transferee company).
Generally, a loss making or less profit earning company merges with a company with track record, to obtain the
benefits of economies of scale of production, marketing network, etc. This situation arises when the sick
companys survival becomes more important for strategic reasons and to conserve the interest of community.
In a reverse merger, a healthy company merges with a financially weak company. The main reason for this
type of reverse merger is the tax savings under the Income-Tax Act, 1961. Section 72A ensures the tax
relief, which becomes attractive for such reverse mergers, since the healthy and profitable company can take
advantage of the carry forward losses/of the other company. The healthy units loses its name and surviving
sick company retains its name. In the context of the Companies Act, 1956 there is no difference between a
merger and a reverse merger. It is like any amalgamation. A reverse merger is carried out through the High
Court route. However, where one of the merging companies is a sick industrial company in terms of the Sick
112 PP-CRVI
Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985, such merger has necessarily to be through the Board
for Industrial and Financial Reconstruction (BIFR). On the reverse merger becoming effective, the name and
objects of the sick company (merged company) may be changed to that of the healthy company.
To save the Government from social costs in terms of loss of production and employment and to relieve the
Government of the uneconomical burden of taking over and running sick industrial units, Section 72A was
introduced in Income Tax Act, 1961.
Provisions relating to carry forward and set off of accumulated loss and unabsorbed depreciation allowance
in amalgamation or demerger, etc.
Section 72A of Income Tax Act, 1961 is meant to facilitate rejuvenation of sick industrial undertaking by
merging with healthier industrial companies possessing incentives of tax savings, to benefit the general
public through continued productivity, increased avenues for employment and revenue generation.
The provisions of Section 72A relating to reverse merger are given hereunder.
(1) Where there has been an amalgamation of a company owning an industrial undertaking or a ship or a
hotel with another company or an amalgamation of a banking company referred to in clause (c) of Section 5
of the Banking Regulation Act, 1949 (10 of 1949) with a specified bank, then, notwithstanding anything
contained in any other provision of this Act, the accumulated loss and the unabsorbed depreciation of the
amalgamating company shall be deemed to be the loss or, as the case may be, allowance for depreciation of
the amalgamated company for the previous year in which the amalgamation was reflected, and other
provisions of this Act relating to set off and carry forward of loss and allowance for depreciation shall apply
accordingly.
W.e.f. 1.4.2008 (A.Y. 2009-10):
(1) Where there has been an amalgamation of
(a) a company owning an industrial undertaking or a ship or a hotel with another company; or
(b) a banking company referred to in clause (c) of Section 5 of the Banking Regulation Act, 1949 (10 of
1949) with a specified bank; or
(c) one or more public sector company or companies engaged in the business of operation of aircraft
with one or more public sector company or companies engaged in similar business,
then, notwithstanding anything contained in any other provision of this Act, the accumulated loss and the
unabsorbed depreciation of the amalgamating company shall be deemed to be the loss or, as the case may
be, allowance for unabsorbed depreciation of the amalgamated company for the previous year in which the
amalgamation was effected, and other provisions of this Act relating to set off and carry forward of loss and
allowance for depreciation shall apply accordingly.
(2) Notwithstanding anything contained in Sub-section (1), the accumulated loss shall not be set off or
carried forward and the unabsorbed depreciation shall not be allowed in the assessment of the amalgamated
company unless
(a) the amalgamating company
(i) has been engaged in the business, in which the accumulated loss occurred or depreciation
remains unabsorbed, for three or more years;
(ii) has held continuously as on the date of the amalgamation at least three-fourths of the book
value of fixed assets held by it two years prior to the date of amalgamation;
Lesson 8
113
114 PP-CRVI
would have been entitled to carry forward and set off under the provisions of Section 72 if the
reorganization of business or amalgamation or demerger had not taken place;
(aa) industrial undertaking means any undertaking which is engaged in
(i) the manufacture or processing of goods; or
(ii) the manufacture of computer software; or
(iii) the business of generation or distribution of electricity or any other form of power; or
(iiia) the business of providing telecommunication services, whether basic or cellular, including radio
paging, domestic satellite service, network of trunking, broadband network and internet
services; or
(iv) mining; or
(v) the construction of ships, aircrafts or rail systems;
(b) unabsorbed depreciation means so much of the allowance for depreciation of the predecessor firm
or the proprietary concern or the amalgamating company or the demerged company, as the case
may be, which remains to be allowed and which would have been allowed to the predecessor firm
or the proprietary concern or amalgamating company or demerged company, as the case may be,
under the provisions of this Act, if the reorganization of business or amalgamation or demerger had
not taken place;
(c) specified bank means the State Bank of India constituted under the State Bank of India Act, 1955
(23 of 1955) or a subsidiary bank as defined in the State Bank of India (Subsidiary Banks) Act, 1959
(38 of 1959) or a corresponding new bank constituted under Section 3 of the Banking Companies
(Acquisition and Transfer of Undertakings) Act, 1970 (5 of 1970) or under Section 3 of the Banking
Companies (Acquisition and Transfer of Undertakings) Act, 1980 (40 of 1980).
In the discussion that follows, reverse merger means reverse amalgamation and vice versa. SICA used
the term amalgamation, which means merger also.
Lesson 8
115
resources or its liabilities have exceeded its assets and is on the brink of insolvency. The second requisite
qualification associated with financial unviability is the accumulation of losses for past few years.
5. Amalgamation should be in the public interest i.e. it should not be against public policy, should not defeat
the basic tenets of law, and must safeguard the interest of employees, consumers, customers, creditors and
shareholders apart from the promoters of the company through the revival of the company.
6. The merger should result into the following benefits to the amalgamated (acquired/target) company i.e. (a)
carry forward of accumulated business losses of the amalgamating company; (b) carry forward of
unabsorbed depreciation of the amalgamating company and (c) accumulated loss would be allowed to be
carried forward and set of for eight subsequent years under Section 72A of the Income-tax Act, from the A.Y.
2009-10, the accumulated loss or the case may be, allowance for unabsorbed depreciation of amalgamating
company shall be deemed to be the loss or as the case may be, allowance for unabsorbed depreciation of
the amalgamated company for the previous year in which the amalgamation was effected and other
provisions of the Income Tax Act relating to set off and carry forward of loss and allowance for depreciation.
7. Accumulated loss should arise from Profits and Gains from business or profession and not be loss under
the head Capital Gains or Speculation.
8. For qualifying carry forward loss, the provisions of Section 72 should not have been contravened.
9. Similarly for carry forward of unabsorbed depreciation the conditions of Section 32 should not have been
violated.
10. Specified Authority has to be satisfied of the eligibility of the company for the relief under Section 72 of
the Income-tax Act. It is only on the recommendation of the specified authority that Central Government may
allow the relief.
11. The company should make an application to the specified authority for requisite recommendation of the
case to the Central Government for granting or allowing the relief.
12. Procedure for merger or amalgamation to be followed in such cases is the same as discussed above.
Specified Authority makes recommendation after taking into consideration the courts direction on scheme of
amalgamation.
116 PP-CRVI
The concept is that while ordinarily a sick and economically weak company seeks the support and strength
of a healthy and fit company by amalgamating itself with such a company. In a reverse merger, a healthy,
strong and economically viable company amalgamates itself with a sick and economically weak company,
thereby giving up its own identity to the sick company.
Relevant extracts of certain other provisions, of the Act, which provide for amalgamation or merger or
reverse merger are produced hereunder
Section 18(2): The scheme may provide, inter alia, for the following:
(i) Alteration of the memorandum or articles of association of the sick industrial company or the
transferee company for the purpose of altering the capital structure thereof, or for such other
purposes as may be necessary to give effect to the reconstruction or amalgamation.
(ii) Any other terms and conditions for the reconstruction or amalgamation of the sick industrial
company.
(iii) Such incidental, consequential and supplemental matters as may be necessary to secure that the
reconstruction or amalgamation or other measures mentioned in the scheme are fully and
effectively carried out.
Section 18(3)(a):
The scheme prepared by the operating agency shall be examined by the BIFR and copies of the scheme
with modifications, if any, made by BIFR, shall be sent to the sick industrial company, the operating agency
and in case of amalgamation, also to any other company concerned and the BIFR shall also publish or
caused to be published the draft scheme in brief in such daily newspapers as the BIFR may consider
necessary for suggestions and objections if any, within the specified period.
With the above amendments, for a reverse merger of a sick industrial company, the compliance under
Section 72A of the Income tax Act, 1961 is not required. Similarly, once the reverse merger is approved by
the BIFR, the procedures outlined in Sections 391 or 394 of the Companies Act, 1956 are not required to be
followed. The BIFR can thus make distinctive provisions in a scheme of rehabilitation of a sick company
through reverse merger.
LESSON ROUND UP
Companies have to downsize or contract their operation in certain circumstances such as when a division
of the company is performing poorly or simply because it no longer fits into the companys plans or to give
effect to rationalization.
Demerger may take the shape of spin off, split off or split up.
Demerger may be by agreement between promoters or under scheme of arrangement with approval by the
court under section 391 or under voluntary winding up.
There are various tax incentives to demerged company, to shareholders of demerged company and to
resulting company.
In a reverse merger, a healthy company merges with a financially weak company. The chapter provides for
salient features of reverse merger and the provisions of Section 72A of Income-tax Act,1961.
Lesson 8
117
118 PP-CRVI
Lesson 9
Takeovers
LESSON OUTLINE
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Concept of takeover
Kinds of takeover
Takeover bids
Takeover Defenses
120 PP-CRVI
Lesson 9
Takeovers 121
who are in command are protected but also the investors. It would be in the interests of all concerned that
the takeover is carried out in a transparent manner.
When adequate checks and balances are introduced and ensured, takeovers become a good tool. That is
the reason why regulations have been put in place and these regulations require sufficient disclosures at
every stage of acquisition. These regulations take so much care that they cover not only direct acquisition of
the acquirer but also includes acquisitions through relatives and associates and group concerns.
In India, the process of economic liberalisation and globalisation ushered in the early 1990s created a highly
competitive business environment, which motivated many companies to restructure their corporate
strategies. The restructuring process led to an unprecedented rise in strategies like amalgamations, mergers
including reverse mergers, demergers, takeovers, reverse takeovers and other strategic alliances.
Objects of takeover
The objects of a takeover may inter alia be
(i) To effect savings in overheads and other working expenses on the strength of combined resources;
(ii) To achieve product development through acquiring firms with compatible products and
technological/manufacturing competence, which can be sold to the acquirers existing marketing
areas, dealers and end users;
(iii) To diversify through acquiring companies with new product lines as well as new market areas, as
one of the entry strategies to reduce some of the risks inherent in stepping out of the acquirers
historical core competence;
(iv) To improve productivity and profitability by joint efforts of technical and other personnel of both
companies as a consequence of unified control;
(v) To create shareholder value and wealth by optimum utilisation of the resources of both companies;
(vi) To achieve economy of numbers by mass production at economical costs;
(vii) To secure advantage of vertical combination by having under one command and under one roof, all
the stages or processes in the manufacture of the end product, which had earlier been available in
two companies at different locations, thereby saving loading, unloading, transportation costs and
other expenses and also by affecting saving of time and energy unnecessarily spent on excise
formalities at different places and stages;
(viii) To secure substantial facilities as available to a large company compared to smaller companies for
raising additional capital, increasing market potential, expanding consumer base, buying raw
materials at economical rates and for having own combined and improved research and
development activities for continuous improvement of the products, so as to ensure a permanent
market share in the industry;
(ix) To increase market share;
(x) To achieve market development by acquiring one or more companies in new geographical
territories or segments, in which the activities of acquirer are absent or do not have a strong
presence.
KINDS OF TAKEOVER
Takeovers may be broadly classified into three kinds:
(i) Friendly Takeover: Friendly takeover is with the consent of taken over company. In friendly
takeover, there is an agreement between the management of two companies through negotiations
122 PP-CRVI
and the takeover bid may be with the consent of majority or all shareholders of the target company.
This kind of takeover is done through negotiations between two groups. Therefore, it is also called
negotiated takeover.
(ii) Hostile Takeover: When an acquirer company does not offer the target company the proposal to
acquire its undertaking but silently and unilaterally pursues efforts to gain control against the wishes
of existing management.
(iii) Bail Out Takeover: Takeover of a financially sick company by a profit earning company to bail out
the former is known as bail out takeover. There are several advantages for a profit making company
to takeover a sick company. The price would be very attractive as creditors, mostly banks and
financial institutions having a charge on the industrial assets, would like to recover to the extent
possible. Banks and other lending financial institutions would evaluate various options and if there is
no other go except to sell the property, they will invite bids. Such a sale could take place in the form
by transfer of shares. While identifying a party (acquirer), lenders do evaluate the bids received, the
purchase price, the track record of the acquirer and the overall financial position of the acquirer.
Thus a bail out takeover takes place with the approval of the Financial Institutions and banks.
TAKEOVER BIDS
Takeover bid is an offer to the shareholders of a company, whose shares are not closely held, to buy their
shares in the company at the offered price within the stipulated period of time. It is addressed to the
shareholders with a view to acquiring sufficient number of shares to give the offeror company, voting control
of the target company.
A takeover bid is a technique, which is adopted by a company for taking over control of the management and
affairs of another company by acquiring its controlling shares.
Lesson 9
Takeovers 123
124 PP-CRVI
Accordingly, the transferor company shall be entitled and bound to acquire these shares on the terms on
which it acquires under the scheme (the binding provision).
The advantage of going through the route contained in Section 395 of the Act is the facility for acquisition of
minority stake. The transferee company shall give notice to the minority dissenting shareholders and express
its desire to acquire their shares within 2 months of the expiry of the period of 4 months envisaged under
Section 395 of the Act.
When a Company intends to take over another Company through acquisition of 90% or more in value of the
shares of that Company, the procedure laid down under Section 395 of the Act could be beneficially utilized.
When one Company has been able to acquire more than 90% control in another Company, the shareholders
holding the remaining control in the other Company are reduced to a miserable minority. They do not even
command a 10% stake so as to make any meaningful utilization of the power. Such minority can not even
call an extra-ordinary general meeting under Section 168 of the Act nor can they constitute a valid strength
on the grounds of their proportion of issued capital for making an application to Company Law Board under
Section 397 and 398 of the Act alleging acts of oppression and/or mismanagement. Hence the statute itself
provides them a meaningful exit route.
The advantage of going through the route is the facility for acquisition of minority stake. But even without
going through this process, if an acquirer is confident of acquiring the entire control, there is no need to go
through Section 395 of the Act. It is purely an option recognized by the statute.
The merit of this scheme is that without resort to tedious court procedures the takeover is affected. Only in
cases where any dissentient shareholder or shareholders exist, the procedures prescribed by this section will
have to be followed. It provides machinery for adequately safeguarding the rights of the dissentient
shareholders also.
Section 395 lays down two safeguard in respect of expropriation of private property (by compulsory
acquisition of majority shares). First the scheme requires approval of a large majority of shareholders.
Second the Courts discretion to prevent compulsory acquisition.
Section 395 requires mandatory compliance of certain formalities including registration of a scheme or
contract for acquisition of shares of Transferor Company. The scheme or contract between the Transferee
Company and Transferor Company is solemnized with blessings of the Board of Directors of both the
companies.
The following are the important ingredients of the Section 395 route:
The Company, which intends to acquire control over another Company by acquiring share, held by
shareholders of that another Company is known under Section 395 of the Act as the Transferee
Company.
The Company whose shares are proposed to be acquired is called the Transferor Company.
The Transferee Company and Transferor Company join together at the Board level and come
out with a scheme or contract.
Every offer or every circular containing the terms of the scheme shall be duly approved by the
Board of Directors of the companies and every recommendation to the members of the transferor
Company by its directors to accept such offer. It shall be accompanied by such information as
provided under the said Act.
Lesson 9
Takeovers 125
Every offer shall contain a statement by or on behalf of the Transferee Company, disclosing the
steps it has taken to ensure that necessary cash will be available. This condition shall apply if the
terms of acquisition as per the scheme or the contract provide for payment of cash in lieu of the
shares of the Transferor Company which are proposed to be acquired.
Every circular containing or recommending acceptance of the offer made by the transferee
Company shall be duly accompanied by e-Form No. 35A of the Companies (Central Govt.s)
General Rules and Forms, 1956. They shall be filed with the Registrar for registration. Only after
such registration can the Transferee Company arrange for circulation of the scheme or contract or
the recommendatory letter, if any, of the directors of the transferor company to the shareholders of
the Transferor Company.
The Registrar may refuse to register any such circular, which does not contain the prescribed
information, if such information is given in a manner likely to give a false impression.
An appeal shall lie to the Court against an order of the Registrar refusing to register any such
circular.
Any person issuing a circular containing any false statement or giving any false impression or
containing any omission shall be punishable with fine, which may extend to five hundred rupees.
After the scheme or contract and the recommendation of the Board of Directors of the transferor
Company, if any, shall be circulated and approval of not less than 9/10th in value of Transferor
Company should be obtained within 4 months from the date of circulation. It is necessary that the
Memorandum of Association of the transferee company should contain as one of the objects of the
company, a provision to takeover the controlling shares in another company. If the memorandum
does not have such a provision, the company must alter the objects clause in its memorandum, by
convening an extra ordinary general meeting. The approval is not required to be necessarily
obtained in a general meeting of the shareholders of the Transferor Company.
Once approval is available, the Transferee Company becomes eligible for the right of compulsory
acquisition of minority interest.
The Transferee Company has to send notice to the shareholders who have not accepted the offer
(i.e. dissenting shareholders) intimating them the need to surrender their shares.
Once the acquisition of shares in value, not less than 90% has been registered in the books of the
transferor Company, the transferor Company shall within one month of the date of such registration,
inform the dissenting shareholders of the fact of such registration and of the receipt of the amount or
other consideration representing the price payable to them by the transferee Company.
The transferee Company having acquired shares in value not less than 90% is under an obligation
to acquire the minority stake as stated aforesaid and hence it is required to transfer the amount or
other consideration equal to the amount or other consideration required for acquiring the minority
stake to the transferee Company. The amount or consideration required to be so transferred by the
transferee Company to the transferor company, shall not in any way, less than the terms of
acquisition offered under the scheme or contract.
Any amount or other consideration received by the Transferor Company in the manner aforesaid
shall be paid into a separate bank account. Any such sums and any other consideration so received
shall be held by the transferor Company in trust for the several persons entitled to the shares in
respect of which the said sums or other consideration were respectively received.
The takeover achieved in the above process through this Section 395 of the Act will not fall within the
126 PP-CRVI
meaning of amalgamation under the Income Tax Act and as such benefits of amalgamation provided under
the said Act will not be available to the acquisition under consideration. The takeover in the above process
will not enable carrying forward of unabsorbed depreciation and accumulated losses of the transferor
Company in the transferee Company for the reason that the takeover does not result in the transferor
Company losing its identity.
Check list
Transferor Company
The transferor company has to take care of the following points:
1. The offer of a company (Transferee Company) to acquire shares of a Transferor Company should
be received from the transferee company.
2. It should have been approved by the Board of Directors at a duly convened and held meeting. If
proviso to Sub-section (1) of Section 395 is attracted, the terms of offer should be same for all the
holders of that class of shares, whose transfer is involved.
3. Offer received from the transferee company along with other documents, particulars etc. should
have been circulated to the members of the company in e-Form No. 35A prescribed in the
Companies (Central Governments) General Rules and Forms, 1956. [For e-form 35A, see Part B of
the Company Secretarial Practice Study]
4. E-form No. 35A must be filed with the Registrar of companies before issuing to the members of the
company.
5. The scheme or contract for transfer of shares of the company to the transferee company has been
approved by the shareholders of not less than nine-tenths in value of the shares within the
stipulated period of four months. If proviso to Sub-section (1) of Section 395 is attracted, the number
of such approving shareholders should comprise not less than three-fourths in number of the
holders of the shares proposed to be transferred.
6. Comply with any order of the court if any dissenting shareholder had approached the Court against
the proposed transfer and if the Court had passed any order contrary to the proposed transfer.
7. If the transferee company wanted to acquire the shares held by dissenting shareholders, the
transferor company has received from the transferee company a copy of the notice sent by the
transferor company to the dissenting shareholders together with duly filled in and signed transfer
instruments along with value of the shares sought to be transferred.
8. The transferee company should have been registered as holder of the transferred shares and the
consideration received for the shares has been deposited in a separate bank account to be held in
trust for the dissenting shareholders.
Documents etc. involved in this process:
1. Offer of a scheme or contract from the transferee company.
2. Minutes of Board meeting containing consideration of the offer and its acceptance or rejection.
3. Notice calling general meeting.
4. e-form No. 35A circulated to the members.
5. Minutes of general meeting of the company containing approval of the offer by statutory majority in
value and in numbers also, if required.
Lesson 9
Takeovers 127
128 PP-CRVI
9. Register of Investments.
10. Duly filled in and executed instrument(s) of transfer for shares held by the dissenting shareholders.
11. Balance Sheets showing investments in the shares of the transferor company.
Listing Agreement
Conditions for continued listing
Clauses 40A and 40B of the listing agreement were amended to bring them in consonance with the
Regulations. These clauses are placed under the heading Conditions for Continued Listing.
40A. Minimum level of public shareholding
(i) The issuer company agrees to comply with the requirements specified in Rule 19(2) and Rule 19A
of the Securities Contracts (Regulation) Rules, 1957.
(ii) Where the issuer company is required to achieve the minimum level of public shareholding
specified in Rule 19(2)(b) and/or Rule 19A of the Securities Contracts (Regulation) Rules, 1957,
it shall adopt any of the following methods to raise the public shareholding to the required
level:(a) issuance of shares to public through prospectus; or
(b) offer for sale of shares held by promoters to public through prospectus; or
(c) sale of shares held by promoters through the secondary market in terms of SEBI circular
CIR/MRD/DP/05/2012 dated February 1, 2012; or
(d) Institutional Placement Programme (IPP) in terms of Chapter VIIIA of SEBI (Issue of Capital and
Disclosure Requirements) Regulations, 2009, as amended; or
(e) Rights Issues to public shareholders, with promoter/promoter group shareholders forgoing their
entitlement to equity shares, whether present or future, that may arise from such issue; or
(f) Bonus Issues to public shareholders, with promoter/promoter group shareholders forgoing their
entitlement to equity shares, whether present or future, that may arise from such issue; or
(g) any other method as may be approved by SEBI, on a case to case basis.
40 B Take Over Offer
A company agrees that it is a condition for continued listing that whenever the take-over offer is made or
there is any change in the control of the management of the company, the person who secures the control of
the management of the company and the company whose shares have been acquired shall comply with the
relevant provisions of the SEBI (Substantial Acquisition of Shares and Take-overs) Regulations.
Lesson 9
Takeovers 129
While, the SEBI (Substantial Acquisition of Shares and Takeovers) Regulations, 1994 which were
notified in November 1994 made way for regulation of hostile takeovers and competitive offers for
the first time; the subsequent regulatory experience from such offers brought out certain
inadequacies existing in those Regulations. As a result, the SEBI (Substantial Acquisition of Shares
and Takeovers) Regulations, 1997 were introduced and notified on February 20, 1997, pursuant to
repeal of the 1994 Regulations.
Owing to several factors such as the growth of Mergers & Acquisitions activity in India as the
preferred mode of restructuring, the increasing sophistication of takeover market, the decade long
regulatory experience and various judicial pronouncements, it was felt necessary to review the
Takeover Regulations 1997. Accordingly, SEBI formed a Takeover Regulations Advisory Committee
(TRAC) in September 2009 under the Chairmanship of (Late) Shri. C. Achuthan, Former Presiding
Officer, Securities Appellate Tribunal (SAT) for this purpose. After extensive public consultation on
the report submitted by TRAC, SEBI came out with the SAST Regulations 2011 which were notified
on September 23, 2011. The Takeover Regulations, 1997 stand repealed from October 22, 2011, i.e.
the date on which SAST Regulations, 2011 come into force.
130 PP-CRVI
Provided that a director or officer of a target company shall not be considered to be in control over such
target company, merely by virtue of holding such position;
Lesson 9
Takeovers 131
Company A has 100 equity shares, 50 partly convertible Debentures (PCDs) and 10 GDRs. 1 GDR
carries 1 voting right.
Person B has 8+7+1 =16 shares (shares for disclosure purpose includes convertible securities)
Since person B is holding more than 5% of shares or voting rights, he is required to make disclosures for any
acquisition/ sale of 2% or more of shares or voting rights.
Acquisition by Person B
Scenario I
In terms of voting rights, person B has acquired 2/110= 1.8% of voting rights
Since acquisition done by person B represents 2 % or more of shares, the disclosure obligation is
triggered.
Scenario II
In terms of shares, person B has acquired 20 shares, i.e. 20/160 i.e. 12.5% shares.
In terms of voting rights, he has not acquired a single voting right i.e. 0 voting right
However, since acquisition done by person B represents 2% or more of shares (though no voting
rights), the disclosure obligations is triggered.
132 PP-CRVI
Maximum Permissible non-Public Shareholding means Such percentage shareholding in the target Company
excluding the minimum Public Shareholding required under Securities Contracts Regulation (Rules) 1957.
The SCRR requires minimum Public Shareholding in case of every listed company other than Public Sector
Company to be at least 25%. In case of listed public sector company minimum Public Shareholding to be
maintained at least 10%. Thus maximum permissible non public Share holder may be 75% and in case of
Public Sector company 90%.
Lesson 9
Takeovers 133
Provided that for purposes of availing of the exemption under this clause,
(i) If the shares of the target company are frequently traded, the acquisition price per
share shall not be higher by more than twenty-five per cent of the volume-weighted
average market price for a period of sixty trading days preceding the date of issuance
of notice for the proposed inter se transfer under sub-regulation (5), as traded on the
stock exchange where the maximum volume of trading in the shares of the target
company are recorded during such period, and if the shares of the target company are
infrequently traded, the acquisition price shall not be higher by more than twenty-five
percent of the price determined in terms of clause (e) of sub-regulation (2) of
regulation 8; and
(ii) the transferor and the transferee shall have complied with applicable disclosure
requirements set out in Chapter V.
(b) acquisition in the ordinary course of business by,
(i) an underwriter registered with the Board by way of allotment pursuant to an underwriting
agreement in terms of the Securities and Exchange Board of India (Issue of Capital and
Disclosure Requirements) Regulations, 2009;
(ii) a stock broker registered with the Board on behalf of his client in exercise of lien over the
shares purchased on behalf of the client under the bye-laws of the stock exchange where such
stock broker is a member;
(iii) a merchant banker registered with the Board or a nominated investor in the process of market
making or subscription to the unsubscribed portion of issue in terms of Chapter XB of the
Securities and Exchange Board of India (Issue of Capital and Disclosure Requirements)
Regulations, 2009;
(iv) any person acquiring shares pursuant to a scheme of safety net in terms of regulation 44 of the
Securities and Exchange Board of India (Issue of Capital and Disclosure Requirements)
Regulations, 2009;
(v) a merchant banker registered with the Board acting as a stabilizing agent or by the promoter or
pre-issue shareholder in terms of regulation 45 of the Securities and Exchange Board of India
(Issue of Capital and Disclosure Requirements) Regulations, 2009;
(vi) by a registered market-maker of a stock exchange in respect of shares for which he is the
market maker during the course of market making;
(vii) a Scheduled Commercial Bank, acting as an escrow agent; and
(viii) invocation of pledge by Scheduled Commercial Banks or Public Financial Institutions as a
pledgee.
(c) acquisitions at subsequent stages, by an acquirer who has made a public announcement of an
open offer for acquiring shares pursuant to an agreement of disinvestment, as contemplated in such
agreement:
Provided that,
(i) both the acquirer and the seller are the same at all the stages of acquisition; and
(ii) full disclosures of all the subsequent stages of acquisition, if any, have been made in the public
announcement of the open offer and in the letter of offer.
(d) acquisition pursuant to a scheme,
134 PP-CRVI
(i) made under section 18 of the Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 (1 of
1986) or any statutory modification or re-enactment thereto;
(ii) of arrangement involving the target company as a transferor company or as a transferee
company, or reconstruction of the target company, including amalgamation, merger or
demerger, pursuant to an order of a court or a competent authority under any law or regulation,
Indian or foreign; or
(iii) of arrangement not directly involving the target company as a transferor company or as a
transferee company, or reconstruction not involving the target companys undertaking, including
amalgamation, merger or demerger, pursuant to an order of a court or a competent authority
under any law or regulation, Indian or foreign, subject to,
(A) the component of cash and cash equivalents in the consideration paid being less than
twenty-five per cent of the consideration paid under the scheme; and
(B) where after implementation of the scheme of arrangement, persons directly or indirectly
holding at least thirty-three per cent of the voting rights in the combined entity are the same
as the persons who held the entire voting rights before the implementation of the scheme.
(e) acquisition pursuant to the provisions of the Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets
and Enforcement of Security Interest Act, 2002 (54 of 2002);
(f) acquisition pursuant to the provisions of the Securities and Exchange Board of India (Delisting of
Equity Shares) Regulations, 2009;
(g) acquisition by way of transmission, succession or inheritance;
(h) acquisition of voting rights or preference shares carrying voting rights arising out of the operation of
sub-section (2) of section 87 of the Companies Act, 1956 (1 of 1956).
(2) The acquisition of shares of a target company, not involving a change of control over such target
company, pursuant to a scheme of corporate debt restructuring in terms of the Corporate Debt Restructuring
Scheme notified by the Reserve Bank of India vide circular no. B.P.BC 15/21.04, 114/2001 dated August 23,
2001, or any modification or re-notification thereto provided such scheme has been authorised by
shareholders by way of a special resolution passed by postal ballot, shall be exempted from the obligation to
make an open offer under regulation 3.
(3) An increase in voting rights in a target company of any shareholder beyond the limit attracting an
obligation to make an open offer under sub-regulation (1) of regulation 3, pursuant to buy-back of shares
shall be exempt from the obligation to make an open offer provided such shareholder reduces his
shareholding such that his voting rights fall to below the threshold referred to in sub-regulation (1) of
regulation 3 within ninety days from the date on which the voting rights so increase.
(4) The following acquisitions shall be exempt from the obligation to make an open offer under sub-regulation
(2) of regulation 3,
(a) acquisition of shares by any shareholder of a target company, upto his entitlement, pursuant to a
rights issue;
(b) acquisition of shares by any shareholder of a target company, beyond his entitlement, pursuant to a
rights issue, subject to fulfillment of the following conditions,
(i) the acquirer has not renounced any of his entitlements in such rights issue; and
(ii) the price at which the rights issue is made is not higher than the ex-rights price of the shares of
Lesson 9
Takeovers 135
136 PP-CRVI
(7) In respect of any acquisition of or increase in voting rights pursuant to exemption provided for in clause
(a) of sub-regulation (1), sub-clause (iii) of clause (d) of sub regulation (1), clause (h) of sub-regulation (1),
sub-regulation (2), sub-regulation (3) and clause (c) of sub-regulation (4), clauses (a), (b) and (f) of subregulation (4), the acquirer shall, within twenty-one working days of the date of acquisition, submit a report in
such form as may be specified along with supporting documents to the Board giving all details in respect of
acquisitions, along with a non-refundable fee of rupees twenty five thousand by way of a bankers cheque or
demand draft payable in Mumbai in favour of the Board.
Explanation. For the purposes of sub-regulation (5), sub-regulation (6) and sub regulation (7) in the case of
convertible securities, the date of the acquisition shall be the date of conversion of such securities.
Exemptions by the SEBI (Regulation 11)
(1) SEBI(The Board) may for reasons recorded in writing, grant exemption from the obligation to make an
open offer for acquiring shares under these regulations subject to such conditions as the Board deems fit to
impose in the interests of investors in securities and the securities market.
(2) The Board may for reasons recorded in writing, grant a relaxation from strict compliance with any
procedural requirement under Chapter III and Chapter IV subject to such conditions as the Board deems fit
to impose in the interests of investors in securities and the securities market on being satisfied that,
(a) the target company is a company in respect of which the Central Government or State Government
or any other regulatory authority has superseded the board of directors of the target company and
has appointed new directors under any law for the time being in force, if,
(i) such board of directors has formulated a plan which provides for transparent, open, and
competitive process for acquisition of shares or voting rights in, or control over the target
company to secure the smooth and continued operation of the target company in the interests
of all stakeholders of the target company and such plan does not further the interests of any
particular acquirer;
(ii) the conditions and requirements of the competitive process are reasonable and fair;
(iii) the process adopted by the board of directors of the target company provides for details
including the time when the open offer for acquiring shares would be made, completed and the
manner in which the change in control would be effected; and
(b) the provisions of Chapter III and Chapter IV are likely to act as impediment to implementation of the
plan of the target company and exemption from strict compliance with one or more of such
provisions is in public interest, the interests of investors in securities and the securities market.
(3) For seeking exemption under sub-regulation (1), the acquirer shall, and for seeking relaxation under subregulation (2) the target company shall file an application with the Board, supported by a duly sworn affidavit,
giving details of the proposed acquisition and the grounds on which the exemption has been sought.
(4) The acquirer or the target company, as the case may be, shall along with the application referred to under
sub-regulation (3) pay a non-refundable fee of rupees fifty thousand, by way of a bankers cheque or demand
draft payable in Mumbai in favour of the Board.
(5) The Board may after affording reasonable opportunity of being heard to the applicant and after
considering all the relevant facts and circumstances, pass a reasoned order either granting or rejecting the
exemption or relaxation sought as expeditiously as possible:
Lesson 9
Takeovers 137
Provided that the Board may constitute a panel of experts to which an application for an exemption under
sub-regulation (1) may, if considered necessary, be referred to make recommendations on the application to
the Board.
(6) The order passed under sub-regulation (5) shall be hosted by the Board on its official website.
138 PP-CRVI
b.
Escrow Amount
25% of the consideration
An additional amount equal
10%
to
It is further provided that where offer is made conditional upon minimum level of acceptance, then higher of
following two shall be deposited in the Escrow Account:
Hundred percent of the consideration payable in
respect of minimum level of acceptance
If the Acquirer makes any upward revision in the open offer, whether by way of increase in offer price, or of
the offer size, then the Acquirer shall make corresponding increases to the amount kept in escrow account
prior to making such revision. [Regulation 17(2)]
Details
17(4)
17(5)
Cash deposit
17(6)
Bank Guarantee
Lesson 9
Takeovers 139
Securities
140 PP-CRVI
the expiry of the stipulated period in sub-regulation (4) of regulation 16:
Provided that where local laws or regulations of any jurisdiction outside India may expose the acquirer or the
target company to material risk of civil, regulatory or criminal liabilities in the event the letter of offer in its final
form were to be sent without material amendments or modifications into such jurisdiction, and the
shareholders resident in such jurisdiction hold shares entitling them to less than five per cent of the voting
rights of the target company, the acquirer may refrain from dispatch of the letter of offer into such jurisdiction:
Provided further that every person holding shares, regardless of whether he held shares on the identified
date or has not received the letter of offer, shall be entitled to tender such shares in acceptance of the open
offer.
Letter of offer to the custodian of shares underlying depository receipts (Regulation 18(3)
Simultaneously with the dispatch of the letter of offer in terms of sub-regulation (2), of regulation 18 the
acquirer shall send the letter of offer to the custodian of shares underlying depository receipts, if any, of the
target company.
Offer Price
Offer price is the price at which the acquirer announces to acquire shares from the public shareholders under
the open offer. The offer price shall not be less than the price as calculated under regulation 8 of the SEBI
(SAST) Regulations, 2011 for frequently or infrequently traded shares.
Revision of offer price [Regulation 18(4&5)]
Irrespective of whether a competing offer has been made, an acquirer may make upward revisions to the
offer price, and subject to the other provisions of these regulations, to the number of shares sought to be
acquired under the open offer, at any time prior to the commencement of the last three working days before
the commencement of the tendering period.
In the event of any revision of the open offer, whether by way of an upward revision in offer price, or of the
offer size, the acquirer shall,
(a) make corresponding increases to the amount kept in escrow account under regulation 17 prior to
such revision;
(b) make an announcement in respect of such revisions in all the newspapers in which the detailed
public statement pursuant to the public announcement was made; and
(c) simultaneously with the issue of such an announcement, inform the Board, all the stock exchanges
on which the shares of the target company are listed, and the target company at its registered
office.
Lesson 9
Takeovers 141
in concert with him of any shares of the target company in such form as may be specified, to each of the
stock exchanges on which the shares of the target company are listed and to the target company at its
registered office within twenty-four hours of such acquisition, and the stock exchanges shall forthwith
disseminate such information to the public:
Provided that the acquirer and persons acting in concert with him shall not acquire or sell any shares of the
target company during the period between three working days prior to the commencement of the tendering
period and until the expiry of the tendering period.
Advertisement before the tendering period [Regulation 18(6)]
The acquirer shall issue an advertisement in such form as may be specified, one working day before the
commencement of the tendering period, announcing the schedule of activities for the open offer, the status of
statutory and other approvals, if any, whether for the acquisition attracting the obligation to make an open
offer under these regulations or for the open offer, unfulfilled conditions, if any, and their status, the
procedure for tendering acceptances and such other material detail as may be specified:
Provided that such advertisement shall be,
(a) published in all the newspapers in which the detailed public statement pursuant to the public
announcement was made; and
(b) simultaneously sent to the Board, all the stock exchanges on which the shares of the target
company are listed, and the target company at its registered office.
Offer period and tendering period
The term offer period pertains to the period starting from the date of the event triggering open offer till
completion of payment of consideration to shareholders by the acquirer or withdrawal of the offer by the
acquirer as the case may be.
The term tendering period refers to the 10 working days period falling within the offer period, during which
the eligible shareholders who wish to accept the open offer can tender their shares in the open offer.
Tenure of tendering period [Regulation 18(8)]
The tendering period shall start not later than twelve working days from date of receipt of comments from the
Board under sub-regulation (4) of regulation 16 and shall remain open for ten working days.
Tendered shares shall not been withdrawn [Regulation 18(9)]
Shareholders who have tendered shares in acceptance of the open offer shall not be entitled to withdraw
such acceptance during the tendering period.
Completion of requirements [Regulation 18(10&11)]
The acquirer shall, within ten working days from the last date of the tendering period, complete all
requirements under these regulations and other applicable law relating to the open offer including payment of
consideration to the shareholders who have accepted the open offer.
142 PP-CRVI
The acquirer shall be responsible to pursue all statutory approvals required by the acquirer in order to
complete the open offer without any default, neglect or delay:
Provided that where the acquirer is unable to make the payment to the shareholders who have accepted the
open offer within such period owing to non-receipt of statutory approvals required by the acquirer, the Board
may, where it is satisfied that such non-receipt was not attributable to any willful default, failure or neglect on
the part of the acquirer to diligently pursue such approvals, grant extension of time for making payments,
subject to the acquirer agreeing to pay interest to the shareholders for the delay at such rate as may be
specified:
Provided further that where the statutory approval extends to some but not all shareholders, the acquirer
shall have the option to make payment to such shareholders in respect of whom no statutory approvals are
required in order to complete the open offer.
Lesson 9
Takeovers 143
Statutory approvals required for the open offer or for effecting the acquisitions attracting the
obligation to make an open offer have been refused subject to such requirement for approvals
having been specifically disclosed in the DPS and the letter of offer;
Any condition stipulated in the SPA attracting the obligation to make the open offer is not met for
reasons outside the reasonable control of the acquirer, subject to such conditions having been
specifically disclosed in the DPS and the letter of offer;
Such circumstances which in the opinion of SEBI merit withdrawal of open offer.
144 PP-CRVI
board of directors of such target company shall ensure that during the offer period, the business of the target
company is conducted in the ordinary course consistent with past practice.
(2) During the offer period, unless the approval of shareholders of the target company by way of a special
resolution by postal ballot is obtained, the board of directors of either the target company or any of its
subsidiaries shall not,
(a) alienate any material assets whether by way of sale, lease, encumbrance or otherwise or enter into
any agreement therefor outside the ordinary course of business;
(b) effect any material borrowings outside the ordinary course of business;
(c) issue or allot any authorised but unissued securities entitling the holder to voting rights:
Provided that the target company or its subsidiaries may,
(i) issue or allot shares upon conversion of convertible securities issued prior to the public
announcement of the open offer, in accordance with pre-determined terms of such conversion;
(ii) issue or allot shares pursuant to any public issue in respect of which the red herring prospectus
has been filed with the Registrar of Companies prior to the public announcement of the open
offer; or
(iii) issue or allot shares pursuant to any rights issue in respect of which the record date has been
announced prior to the public announcement of the open offer;
(d) implement any buy-back of shares or effect any other change to the capital structure of the target
company;
(e) enter into, amend or terminate any material contracts to which the target company or any of its
subsidiaries is a party, outside the ordinary course of business, whether such contract is with a
related party, within the meaning of the term under applicable accounting principles, or with any
other person; and
(f) accelerate any contingent vesting of a right of any person to whom the target company or any of its
subsidiaries may have an obligation, whether such obligation is to acquire shares of the target
company by way of employee stock options or otherwise.
(3) In any general meeting of a subsidiary of the target company in respect of the matters referred to in subregulation (2), the target company and its subsidiaries, if any, shall vote in a manner consistent with the
special resolution passed by the shareholders of the target company.
(4) The target company shall be prohibited from fixing any record date for a corporate action on or after the
third working day prior to the commencement of the tendering period and until the expiry of the tendering
period.
(5) The target company shall furnish to the acquirer within two working days from the identified date, a list of
shareholders as per the register of members of the target company containing names, addresses,
shareholding and folio number, in electronic form, wherever available, and a list of persons whose
applications, if any, for registration of transfer of shares are pending with the target company:
Provided that the acquirer shall reimburse reasonable costs payable by the target company to external
agencies in order to furnish such information.
(6) Upon receipt of the detailed public statement, the board of directors of the target company shall constitute
a committee of independent directors to provide reasoned recommendations on such open offer, and the
Lesson 9
Takeovers 145
146 PP-CRVI
of the tendering period, in such form as may be specified, confirming status of completion of various open
offer requirements.
Defensive Measures
Adjustments in Asset and Ownership Structure
Firstly, consideration has to be given to steps, which involve defensive restructuring that create barriers
specific to the bidder. These include purchase of assets that may cause legal problems, purchase of
controlling shares of the bidder itself, sale to the third party of assets which made the target attractive to the
bidder, and issuance of new securities with special provisions conflicting with aspects of the takeover
attempt.
A second common theme is to create a consolidated vote block allied with target management.
Thus, securities were issued through private placements to parties friendly or in business alliance with
management or to the management itself. Moreover, another method can be to repurchase publicly held
shares to increase an already sizable management-allied block in place.
A third common theme is the dilution of the bidders vote percentage through issuance of new equity claims.
However, this option in India is strictly regulated vide Section 81A and Regulation 23 of the Takeover Code,
1997. A hostile bidder in these circumstances usually fails in the bid if the bidder has resource constraints in
increasing its interest proportionately.
The Crown Jewel Strategy
The central theme in such a strategy is the divestiture of major operating unit most coveted by the biddercommonly known as the crown jewel strategy. Consequently, the hostile bidder is deprived of the primary
intention behind the takeover bid. A variation of the crown jewel strategy is the more radical scorched earth
approach. Vide this novel strategy, the target sells off not only the crown jewel but also properties to
diminish its worth. Such a radical step may however be, self-destructive and unwise in the companys
interest. However, the practice in India is not so flexible. The Companies Act, 1956 has laid down certain
restrictions on the power of the Board. Vide Section 293(1), the Board cannot sell the whole or substantially
the whole of its undertakings without obtaining the permission of the company in a general meeting.
However, the SEBI (Substantial Acquisitions and Takeover) Regulations, 1997 vide Regulation 23 prescribes
general obligations for the Board of Directors of the target company. Under the said regulation, it will be
difficult for any target company to sell, transfer, encumber or otherwise dispose of or enter into an agreement
to sell, transfer, encumber or for dispose of assets once the predator has made a public announcement.
Thus, the above defense can only be used before the predator/bidder makes the public announcement of its
intention to takeover the target company.
Lesson 9
Takeovers 147
148 PP-CRVI
something that the Act forbids. Secondly, the power of alteration is subject to the conditions contained in the
memorandum of association i.e. alter only the articles of the company as relate to the management of the
company but not the very nature and constitution of the company. Also the alteration should not constitute a
fraud on the minority.
Lesson 9
Takeovers 149
150 PP-CRVI
The firms engaged in Cross borders takeovers can be of three types:
First, firm incorporated in one country listed in different countries including its own e.g. ARCELOR.
Second, firm incorporated in one country listed exclusively in a foreign country e.g. TELVENT.
And lastly, firms incorporated in one country listed in more than one foreign country e.g. EADS.
Expansion and diversification are one of the primary reasons to cross the border as the domestic
markets usually do not provide the desired growth opportunities. One has to look outside its boundaries
and play out in the global arena to seek new opportunities and scale new heights. Such companies have
already improved profitability through better cost management and diversification at the national field.
Another main reason for cross border takeovers is to attain monopoly. Acquirer company is always on the
look out for companies which are financially vulnerable but have untapped resources or intellectual capital
that can be exploited by the purchaser.
Globalization has certainly helped in the recent spurt in cross border takeovers. The key feature of
globalization is that it integrates world economies together. Many nations have opened their economies and
made laws and regulations that attract new companies to come into the country.
What are the legal implications to a cross border merger and takeover? International law prescribes that in a
cross-border merger, the target firm becomes a national of the country of the acquirer. Among other effects, the
change in nationality implies a change in investor protection, because the law that is applicable to the newly
merged firm changes as well. More generally, the newly created firm shares features of the corporate
governance systems of the two merging firms. Therefore, Cross-border mergers provide a natural experiment
to analyse the effects of changes-both improvements and deteriorations, in corporate governance on firm
value.
There are various benefits of cross border takeovers. Firstly, they provide newer and better technology. It
also provides employment opportunities as the firm is bigger than before and more employees are to be
inducted in the merged company. It generally enhances the market capitalization of the combined entity.
Global takeovers are complex processes. Despite some harmonized rules, taxation issues are mainly dealt
within national rules, and are not always fully clear or exhaustive to ascertain the tax impact of a crossborder merger or acquisition. This uncertainty on tax arrangements sometimes require seeking of special
agreements or arrangements from the tax authorities on an ad hoc basis, whereas in the case of a domestic
deal the process is much more deterministic.
Gross-border takeover bids are complex transactions that may involve the handling of a significant number of
legal entities, listed or not, and which are often governed by local rules (company law, market regulations,
self regulations, etc.). Not only a foreign bidder might be hindered by a potential lack of information, but also
some legal complexities might appear in the merger process resulting in a deadlock, even though the bid
would be friendly. This legal uncertainty may result in a significant execution risk and act as a major hurdle
to cross-border consolidation.
There are various challenges to cross border takeovers. Global takeovers may result into a skyrocketing
share prices because merger and acquisition have a substantial effect on the whole economy. Management
also faces a big challenge as there is explosion of new services, new products, new industries and new
markets and new technological innovations as well.
But the biggest challenge to a cross border merger and takeover are the cultural issues. According to KPMG
study, 83% of all the mergers and acquisitions failed to produce any benefit for the shareholders and over
half actually destroyed value. Interviews of over 100 senior executives involved in these 700 deals over a
two year period revealed that the overwhelming cause of failure is the people and the cultural differences.
So, the cultural issues are to be aptly dealt with.
Lesson 9
Takeovers 151
It is expected that the cross borders takeovers will increase in the near future. The companies will have to
keep in mind that global takeovers are not only business proposals but also a corporate bonding for which
both the entities have to sit and arrive at a meaningful and deep understanding of all the issues as
mentioned above. It will also help them to get meaningful solutions.
There has been a substantial increase in the quantum of funds flowing across nations in search of takeover
candidates. The UK has been the most important foreign investor in the USA in recent years, with British
companies making large acquisitions. With the advent of the Single Market, the European Union now
represents the largest single market in the world. European as well as Japanese and American companies
have sought to increase their market presence by acquisitions.
Many cross-border deals have been in the limelight. The biggest were those of Daimler Benz-Chrysler, BPAmoco, Texas Utilities-Energy Group, Universal Studios-Polygram, Northern Telecom-Bay Networks and
Deutsche Bank-Bankers Trust. Nearly 80 per cent of the transactions were settled in stock rather than
through cash.
The going global is rapidly becoming Indian Companys mantra of choice. Indian companies are now looking
forward to drive costs lower, innovate speedily, and increase their International presence. Companies are
discovering that a global presence can help insulate them from the vagaries of domestic market and is one of
the best ways to spread the risks. Indian Corporate sector has witnessed several strategical acquisitions.
Tata Motors acquisition of Daewoo Commercial Vehicle Company, Tata Steel acquisition of Singapores
NatSteel, Reliances acquisition of Flag is the culmination of Indian Companys efforts to establish a
presence outside India.
Students may note that the economic, accounting, taxation, financial, stamp duty aspects are explained in Chapter 3.
Activities to do
1. Reading and referring to open offer document filed with SEBI/published in the news paper
2. Reading various case studies on Indian and overseas takeovers.
3. Reading of SEBI (SAST) Regulation 2011 and SEBI FAQs on takeovers.
LESSON ROUND UP
Takeover is a corporate device whereby one company acquires control over another company, usually by
purchasing all or a majority of its shares.
Takeovers may be classified as friendly takeover, hostile takeover and bail out takeover.
Consideration for takeover could be in the form of cash or in the form of shares.
When a company intends to take over another company through acquisition of 90% or more in value of the
shares of that company, the procedure laid down under Section 395 of the Act could be beneficially utilised.
Transferor and transferee companies are required to take care of the check points as specified in the
chapter.
152 PP-CRVI
Takeover of companies whose securities are listed or one or more stock exchanges is regulated by the
provisions of listed agreements and SEBI (Substantial Acquisition of Shares and Takeovers) Regulation,
2011.
Financial, accounting, taxation and legal aspects are vital in planning a takeover and hence covered in
detail in the chapter.
An increasingly used defense mechanism is anti takeover amendments, which is called Shark Repellants.
Lesson 10
Funding of Mergers and Takeovers
LESSON OUTLINE
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Financial alternatives
Considerations for
financial package
Process of funding
Funding through
the
selection
of
Equity shares
Preference shares
Options and securities with differential rights
Swaps
154 PP-CRVI
FINANCIAL ALTERNATIVES
Selection of financial package shall depend upon many factors as mentioned below:
(i) It should suit to the financial structures of both the acquirer and the acquiree companies.
(ii) It should provide a desirable gearing level which may suit to the financial structure of the acquirer.
(iii) The package should be found acceptable by the vendors.
(iv) The package should also prove economical to the acquirer.
Financial Package
The acquirer can select a suitable financial package to make payment of consideration to acquiree from the
following alternatives:
(i) Payment of cash or by issue of securities.
(ii) Financial package of loans etc. involving financial institutions and banks.
(iii) Rehabilitation finance.
(iv) Leveraged buy-outs.
PROCESS OF FUNDING
Mergers and takeovers may be funded by a company (i) out of its own funds, comprising increase in paid up
equity and preference share capital, for which shareholders are issued equity and preference shares or (ii) out
of borrowed funds, which may be raised by issuing various financial instruments. (iii) A company may borrow
funds through the issue of debentures, bonds, deposits from its directors, their relatives, business associates,
shareholders and from public in the form of fixed deposits, (iv) external commercial borrowings, issue of
securities, loans from Central or State financial institutions, banks, (v) rehabilitation finance provided to sick
industrial companies under the Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, etc.
Form of payment may be selected out of any of the modes available such as (a) cash payment, (b) issue of
equity shares, (c) mix of equity and cash, (d) debt or loan stock, (e) preference shares, convertible securities,
junk bonds etc.
Well-managed companies make sufficient profits and retain them in the form of free reserves, and as and
when their Board of Director propose any form of restructuring, it is financed from reserves, i.e. internal
accruals.
Where available funds are inadequate, the acquirer may resort any one or more of the options available for
the purpose of raising the required resources. The most prominent routes are the borrowing and issue of
securities. The required funds could be raised from banks and financial institutions or from public by issue of
debentures or by issue of shares depending upon the quantum and urgency of their requirements.
Generally a cash rich company use their surplus funds for taking over the control of other companies, often
in the same line of business, to widen their product range and to increase market share.
Lesson 10
a company is not required to pay to its equity shareholders any fixed amount return in the form of interest
which would be the case if the company were to borrow issue of bonds or other debt instruments. In issue of
shares, the commitment will be to declare dividends consistently if profits permit. Raising moneys from the
public by issue of shares to them is a time consuming and costly exercise. The process of issuing equity
shares or bonds/debentures by the company takes a lot of time. It would require several things to be in place
and several rounds of discussion would take place between the directors, and key promoters having the
controlling stake, between the Board of Directors and consultants, analysts, experts, company secretaries,
chartered accountants and lawyers. Moreover it requires several legal compliances. Therefore planning an
acquisition by raising funds through a public issue may be complicated and a long drawn process. One
cannot think of raising moneys through public issue without identifying the company to be acquired.
B. PREFERENTIAL ALLOTMENT
Private placement in the form of a preferential allotment of shares is possible and such issues could be
organized in a much easier way rather than an issue of shares to public.
156 PP-CRVI
arbitrageur will sell half as many shares of the purchasing firm as he or she buys of the target company.) By
going long and short in this ratio, the manager ensures that the number of shares for which the long position
will be swapped is equal to the number of shares sold short. When the deal is completed, the manager will
cover the short and collect the spread that has been locked in.
As with all mergers, stock swap mergers may involve event risk. In addition to the normal event risks, stock
swap mergers involve risks associated with fluctuations in the stock prices of the two companies.
The terms of the deal involve an exchange of shares and are predicted on the prices of the two companies
stock at the time of the announcement, drastic changes in the shares prices of one or both of the companies
can cause the entire deal to be re-evaluated. Merger arbitrageurs derive returns from stock swap mergers
when the spread or potential return justifies the perceived risk of the deals failing.
Lesson 10
The Board of Directors have to inter alia, disclose either in the Directors Report or in the annexure to the
Directors Report, the details of the ESOS, as specified in the regulations.
As a safeguard, the regulations provide that no ESOS can be offered to the employee of a company unless
the shareholders of the company approve ESOS by passing a special resolution in a general meeting.
Issue of Sweat Equity Shares
A company whose shares are listed on a recognised stock exchange can also issue sweat equity shares in
accordance with the provisions of Section 79A of the Companies Act, 1956 and the Securities and Exchange
Board of India (Issue of Sweat Equity) Regulations, 2002.
ENTRY ROUTES
ECB can be accessed under two routes, viz., (i) Automatic Route and (ii) Approval Route).
(A) AUTOMATIC ROUTE
The following types of proposals for ECBs are covered under the Automatic Route
(i) Eligible Borrowers
(a) Corporates, including those in the hotel, hospital, software sectors (registered under the Companies
Act, 1956) and Infrastructure Finance Companies (IFCs) except financial intermediaries, such as
158 PP-CRVI
banks, financial institutions (FIs), Housing Finance Companies (HFCs) and Non-Banking Financial
Companies (NBFCs),other than those specifically allowed by Reserve Bank, are eligible to raise
ECB. Individuals, Trusts (other than those engaged in Micro-finance activities) and Non-Profit
making organizations are not eligible to raise ECB.
(b) Units in Special Economic Zones (SEZ) are allowed to raise ECB for their own requirement.
However, they cannot transfer or on-lend ECB funds to sister concerns or any unit in the Domestic
Tariff Area (DTA).
(c) Non-Government Organizations (NGOs) engaged in micro finance activities are eligible to avail of
ECB.
(d) Micro Finance Institutions (MFIs) engaged in micro finance activities are eligible to avail of ECBs.
MFIs registered under the Societies Registration Act, 1860, MFIs registered under Indian Trust Act,
1882, MFIs registered either under the conventional state-level cooperative acts, the national level
multi-state cooperative legislation or under the new state-level mutually aided cooperative acts
(MACS Act) and not being a co-operative bank, Non-Banking Financial Companies (NBFCs)
categorized as Non Banking Financial Company-Micro Finance Institutions (NBFC-MFIs) and
complying with the certain norms prescribed and Companies registered under Section 25 of the
Companies Act, 1956 and are involved in micro finance activities.
(e) NGOs engaged in micro finance and MFIs registered as societies, trusts and co-operatives and
engaged in micro finance (i) should have a satisfactory borrowing relationship for at least 3 years
with a scheduled commercial bank authorized to deal in foreign exchange in India and (ii) would
require a certificate of due diligence on `fit and proper status of the Board/ Committee of
management of the borrowing entity from the designated AD bank.
(f) Small Industries Development Bank of India (SIDBI) can avail of ECB for on-lending to MSME
sector, as defined under the Micro, Small and Medium Enterprises Development (MSMED) Act,
2006.
(ii) Recognised Lenders
Borrowers can raise ECB from internationally recognized sources, such as (a) international banks, (b)
international capital markets, (c) multilateral financial institutions (such as IFC, ADB, CDC, etc.)/regional
financial institutions and Government owned development financial institutions, (d) export credit agencies, (e)
suppliers of equipments, (f) foreign collaborators and (g) foreign equity holders [other than erstwhile
Overseas Corporate Bodies (OCBs)].
NGOs engaged in micro finance and MFIs registered as societies, trusts and co-operatives can avail of
ECBs from (a) international banks, (b) multilateral financial institutions, (c) export credit agencies (d)
overseas organisations and (e) individuals.
NBFC-MFIs will be permitted to avail of ECBs from multilateral institutions, such as IFC, ADB etc./regional
financial institutions/international banks/foreign equity holders and overseas organizations.
Companies registered under Section 25 of the Companies Act,1956 and are engaged in micro finance will be
permitted to avail of ECBs from international banks, multilateral financial institutions, export credit agencies,
foreign equity holders, overseas organizations and individuals.
A "foreign equity holder" to be eligible as recognized lender under the automatic route would require
minimum holding of paid-up equity in the borrower company as set out below:
(i) For ECB up to USD 5 million - minimum paid-up equity of 25 per cent held directly by the lender,
Lesson 10
(ii) For ECB more than USD 5 million - minimum paid-up equity of 25 per cent held directly by the
lender and ECB liability-equity ratio not exceeding 4:1
Besides the paid-up capital, free reserves (including the share premium received in foreign currency) as per
the latest audited balance sheet shall be reckoned for the purpose of calculating the equity of the foreign
equity holder in the term ECB liability-equity ratio. Where there are more than one foreign equity holder in the
borrowing company, the portion of the share premium in foreign currency brought in by the lender(s)
concerned shall only be considered for calculating the ECB liability-equity ratio for reckoning quantum of
permissible ECB.
For calculating the ECB liability, not only the proposed borrowing but also the outstanding ECB from the
same foreign equity holder lender shall be reckoned.
Overseas organizations and individuals providing ECB need to comply with the following safeguards:
(i) Overseas Organizations proposing to lend ECB would have to furnish to the AD bank of the
borrower a certificate of due diligence from an overseas bank, which, in turn, is subject to regulation
of host-country regulator and adheres to the Financial Action Task Force (FATF) guidelines. The
certificate of due diligence should comprise the following (i) that the lender maintains an account
with the bank for at least a period of two years, (ii) that the lending entity is organised as per the
local laws and held in good esteem by the business/local community and (iii) that there is no
criminal action pending against it.
(ii) Individual Lender has to obtain a certificate of due diligence from an overseas bank indicating that
the lender maintains an account with the bank for at least a period of two years. Other evidence
/documents such as audited statement of account and income tax return which the overseas lender
may furnish need to be certified and forwarded by the overseas bank. Individual lenders from
countries wherein banks are not required to adhere to Know Your Customer (KYC) guidelines are
not eligible to extend ECB.
(iii) Amount and Maturity
(a) The maximum amount of ECB which can be raised by a corporate other than those in the hotel,
hospital and software sectors is USD 750 million or its equivalent during a financial year.
(b) Corporates in the services sector viz. hotels, hospitals and software sector are allowed to avail
of ECB up to USD 200 million or its equivalent in a financial year for meeting foreign currency
and/ or Rupee capital expenditure for permissible end-uses. The proceeds of the ECBs should
not be used for acquisition of land.
(c) NGOs engaged in micro finance activities and Micro Finance Institutions (MFIs) can raise ECB
up to USD 10 million or its equivalent during a financial year. Designated AD bank has to
ensure that at the time of drawdown the forex exposure of the borrower is fully hedged.
(d) SIDBI can avail of ECB to the extent of 50 per cent of their owned funds including the
outstanding ECB, subject to a ceiling of USD 500 million per financial year.
(e) ECB up to USD 20 million or its equivalent in a financial year with minimum average maturity of
three years. An illustration of average maturity period calculation is provided at Annex VI.
(f) ECB above USD 20 million or equivalent and up to USD 750 million or its equivalent with a
minimum average maturity of five years.
160 PP-CRVI
(g) ECB up to USD 20 million or equivalent can have call/put option provided the minimum average
maturity of three years is complied with before exercising call/put option.
(h) All eligible borrowers can avail of ECBs designated in INR from foreign equity holders as per
the extant ECB guidelines.
(i) NGOs engaged in micro finance activities can avail of ECBs designated in INR, from overseas
organizations and individuals as per the extant guidelines.
(B) APPROVAL ROUTE
(i) Eligible Borrowers
The following types of proposals for ECB are covered under the Approval Route:
(a) On lending by the EXIM Bank for specific purposes will be considered on a case by case basis.
(b) Banks and financial institutions which had participated in the textile or steel sector restructuring
package as approved by the Government are also permitted to the extent of their investment in the
package and assessment by the Reserve Bank based on prudential norms. Any ECB availed for
this purpose so far will be deducted from their entitlement.
(c) ECB with minimum average maturity of 5 years by Non-Banking Financial Companies (NBFCs)
from multilateral financial institutions, reputable regional financial institutions, official export credit
agencies and international banks to finance import of infrastructure equipment for leasing to
infrastructure projects.
(d) Infrastructure Finance Companies (IFCs) i.e. Non-Banking Financial Companies (NBFCs),
categorized as IFCs, by the Reserve Bank, are permitted to avail of ECBs, including the outstanding
ECBs, beyond 50 per cent of their owned funds, for on-lending to the infrastructure sector as
defined under the ECB policy, subject to their complying with the certain conditions:
(e) Foreign Currency Convertible
following minimum criteria: (i)
previous three years shall not
minimum size of FCCB is USD
utilization of funds.
(f) Special Purpose Vehicles, or any other entity notified by the Reserve Bank, set up to finance
infrastructure companies/projects exclusively, will be treated as Financial Institutions and ECB by
such entities will be considered under the Approval Route.
(g) Multi-State Co-operative Societies engaged in manufacturing activity and satisfying the following
criteria i) the Co-operative Society is financially solvent and ii) the Co-operative Society submits its
up-to-date audited balance sheet.
(h) SEZ developers can avail of ECBs for providing infrastructure facilities within SEZ, as defined in the
extant ECB policy like (i) power, (ii) telecommunication, (iii) railways, (iv) roads including bridges, (v)
sea port and airport, (vi) industrial parks, (vii) urban infrastructure (water supply, sanitation and
sewage projects), (viii) mining, exploration and refining and (ix) cold storage or cold room facility,
including for farm level pre-cooling, for preservation or storage of agricultural and allied produce,
marine products and meat.
(i) Developers of National Manufacturing Investment Zones (NMIZs) can avail of ECB for providing
Lesson 10
infrastructure facilities within SEZ, as defined in the extant ECB policy like (i) power, (ii)
telecommunication, (iii) railways, (iv) roads including bridges, (v) sea port and airport, (vi) industrial
parks, (vii) urban infrastructure (water supply, sanitation and sewage projects), (viii) mining,
exploration and refining and (ix) cold storage or cold room facility, including for farm level precooling, for preservation or storage of agricultural and allied produce, marine products and meat.
(j) Eligible borrowers under the automatic route other than corporates in the services sector viz. hotel,
hospital and software can avail of ECB beyond USD 750 million or equivalent per financial year.
(k) Corporates in the services sector viz. hotels, hospitals and software sector can avail of ECB beyond
USD 200 million or equivalent per financial year.
(l) Service sector units, other than those in hotels, hospitals and software, subject to the condition that
the loan is obtained from foreign equity holders. This would facilitate borrowing by training
institutions, R & D, miscellaneous service companies, etc.
(m) Small Industries Development Bank of India (SIDBI) is eligible to avail of ECB for on-lending to
MSME sector, as defined under the Micro, Small and Medium Enterprises Development (MSMED)
Act, 2006, beyond 50 per cent of their owned funds, subject to a ceiling of USD 500 million per
financial year provided such on-lending by SIDBI shall be to the borrowers for permissible end-use
and having natural hedge by way of foreign exchange earnings. SIDBI may on-lend either in INR or
in foreign currency (FCY). In case of on-lending in INR, the foreign currency risk shall be fully
hedged by SIDBI.
(n) Low Cost Affordable Housing Projects: Developers/builders/Housing Finance Companies
(HFCs)/National Housing Bank (NHB) may avail of ECB for low cost affordable housing projects
(o) Corporates Under Investigation: All entities against which investigations/adjudications/appeals by
the law enforcing agencies are pending, may avail of ECBs as per the current norms, if they are
otherwise eligible, notwithstanding the pending investigations/adjudications/appeals, without
prejudice to the outcome of such investigations/adjudications/appeals. Accordingly, in case of all
applications where the borrowing entity has indicated about the pending investigations/
adjudications/appeals, the Reserve Bank of India while approving the proposal shall intimate the
concerned agencies by endorsing the copy of the approval letter.
(p) Cases falling outside the purview of the automatic route limits and maturity period are indicated at
paragraph A (iii).
(ii) Recognised Lenders
(a) Borrowers can raise ECB from internationally recognised sources, such as (i) international banks,
(ii) international capital markets, (iii) multilateral financial institutions (such as IFC, ADB, CDC, etc.)/
regional financial institutions and Government owned development financial institutions, (iv) export
credit agencies, (v) suppliers' of equipment, (vi) foreign collaborators and (vii) foreign equity holders
(other than erstwhile OCBs).
(b) A "foreign equity holder" to be eligible as recognized lender under the approval route would
require minimum holding of paid-up equity in the borrower company as set out below:
(i) For ECB up to USD 5 million - minimum paid-up equity of 25 per cent held directly by the
lender,
(ii) For ECB more than USD 5 million - minimum paid-up equity of 25 per cent held directly by the
162 PP-CRVI
lender and ECB liability-equity ratio not exceeding 7:1
(c) ECB from indirect equity holders provided the indirect equity holding by the lender in the Indian
company is at least 51 per cent;
(d) ECB from a group company provided both the borrower and the foreign lender are subsidiaries of
the same parent.
Besides the paid-up capital, free reserves (including the share premium received in foreign currency) as per
the latest audited balance sheet shall be reckoned for the purpose of calculating the equity of the foreign
equity holder in the term ECB liability-equity ratio. Where there are more than one foreign equity holder in the
borrowing company, the portion of the share premium in foreign currency brought in by the lender(s)
concerned shall only be considered for calculating the ECB liability-equity ratio for reckoning quantum of
permissible ECB.
For calculating the ECB liability, not only the proposed borrowing but also the outstanding ECB from the
same foreign equity holder lender shall be reckoned.
The total outstanding stock of ECBs (including the proposed ECBs) from a foreign equity lender should not
exceed seven times the equity holding, either directly or indirectly of the lender (in case of lending by a group
company, equity holdings by the common parent would be reckoned).
(iii) Amount and Maturity
Eligible borrowers under the automatic route other than corporates in the services sector viz. hotel, hospital
and software can avail of ECB beyond USD 750 million or equivalent per financial year. Corporates in the
services sector viz. hotels, hospitals and software sector are allowed to avail of ECB beyond USD 200 million
or its equivalent in a financial year for meeting foreign currency and/ or Rupee capital expenditure for
permissible end-uses. The proceeds of the ECBs should not be used for acquisition of land.
Indian companies which are in the infrastructure sector, as defined under the extant ECB guidelines, can
avail of ECBs in Renminbi (RMB), subject to an annual ceiling of USD one billion for the entire sector,
pending further review.
For further details please refer to Master Circular 2013 dated 01 July 2013 issued by RBI on External
Commercial Borrowings and Trade Credits.
Lesson 10
improves marketability of the issue, and enhances prestige of the company and credibility with international
investors.
164 PP-CRVI
financial institutions and banks having financial stakes in the acquiree company to ensure rehabilitation and
recovery of dues from the acquirer. BIFR has been arranging such takeover from time to time in which creditor
financial institutions and banks have been providing consortium financial packages in promoting mergers.
Merger or takeover may be provided for in a scheme of rehabilitation under the Sick Industrial Companies
(Special Provisions) Act, 1985.
The Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 provides for reference to the Board for
Industrial and Financial Reconstruction (BIFR) of a sick industrial company. Once a reference is made, BIFR
will cause an enquiry, appoint an operating agency for determination of measures necessary for
rehabilitation of the sick company, direct the preparation of a rehabilitation scheme, which may provide, inter
alia, for
(i) rehabilitation finance for the sick company;
(ii) merger of the sick company with a healthy company or merger of a healthy company with the sick
company;
(iii) takeover of the sick company by a healthy company;
(iv) such other preventive, ameliorative and remedial measures as may be appropriate.
The scheme is prepared by the operating agency, and after the same is sanctioned becomes operative and
binding on all the concerned parties including the sick company and other companies amalgamating,
merging, the amalgamated or the merged companies.
LESSON ROUND UP
Mode of payment for mergers and acquisition to be selected from an optimum mix of available modes of
payment of consideration.
Selection of financial package depend on many considerations such as: to suit the financial structure of
acquirer and acquiree, to provide a desirable gearing level, to be acceptable to vendors. Further it should
prove economic to acquirer.
Funding through preference share capital, unlike equity share capital, involves the payment of fixed
preference dividend like interest on debentures or bonds or a fixed rate of dividend.
Funding through shares with differential voting rights gives the companies an additional source of fund
without interest cost and without an obligation to repay, as these are other form of equity capital.
Lesson 10
Funding can also be done through swaps and employees stock option scheme. The share capital that may
be raised through the scheme of employees stock option can only be a fraction of the entire issue.
External commercial borrowings are permitted by the Government as a source of finance for Indian
corporates for expansion of existing capacity as well as for fresh investment.
The other modes of funding are through financial institutions and banks, rehabilitation finance and
management and leveraged buy outs. All these have got its own merits and demerits.
166 PP-CRVI
Lesson 11
Financial Restructuring
LESSON OUTLINE
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Financial
Reorganisation of capital
restructuring
of a
company
involves
SEBI
(Buy
back
of
Securities)
Regulations, 1998
168 PP-CRVI
The Provisions relating to alteration of Share Capital and of buy-back of Shares have already been
notified under Companies Act, 2013. However, the provisions relating to reduction of capital are not
yet notified as it involves approval of National Company Law Tribunal. Accordingly the lesson
covers provisions of Companies Act 2013 relating to buy-back of shares and provisions of
Companies Act, 1956 for reduction of capital.
INTRODUCTION
Companies have access to a range of sources from which they finance business. These funds are called
Capital. The sources of capital can be divided into two categories; internally generated funds and funds
provided by third parties. Whichever form of capital is used, it will fall into one of the two categories debt or
equity.
Lesson 11
170 PP-CRVI
ALTERATION OF CAPITAL
Power of limited company to alter its share capital (Section 61)
According to section 61 of the Companies Act 2013 a limited company having a share capital derives its
power to alter its share capital through its articles of association. As per the section the company may alter
its memorandum in its general meeting to
(a) increase its authorised share capital by such amount as it thinks expedient;
(b) consolidate and divide all or any of its share capital into shares of a larger amount than its existing
shares.
The proviso to Section 61(1)(b) clarifies that No consolidation and division which results in changes
in the voting percentage of shareholders shall take effect unless it is approved by the Tribunal on an
application made in the prescribed manner (This proviso yet to be notified).
(c) convert all or any of its fully paid-up shares into stock, and reconvert that stock into fully paid-up
shares of any denomination;
(d) sub-divide its shares, or any of them, into shares of smaller amount than is fixed by the
Lesson 11
memorandum, so, however, that in the sub-division the proportion between the amount paid and
the amount, if any, unpaid on each reduced share shall be the same as it was in the case of the
share from which the reduced share is derived;
(e) cancel shares which, at the date of the passing of the resolution in that behalf, have not been taken
or agreed to be taken by any person, and diminish the amount of its share capital by the amount of
the shares so cancelled. The cancellation of shares shall not be deemed to be a reduction of share
capital.
REORGANISATION OF CAPITAL
In accordance with Section 390(b) Companies Act 1956, the expression arrangement includes a reorganisation of the share capital of the Company by the consolidation of shares of different classes or by
division of shares of one class into shares of different classes or by both these methods.
Accordingly, as per Section 390(b), the reorganization of share capital of a company may take place
(1) by the consolidation of shares of different classes, or
(2) by the division of shares of one class into shares of different classes, or
(3) by both these methods [Section 390(b)].
Besides, a company may reorganize its capital in different ways, such as (a) reduction of paid-up share
capital; (b) conversion of one type of shares into another etc.,
Authorisation in Articles
Confirmation of court
The need for reduction of capital may arise in various circumstances such as
trading losses
heavy capital expenses and assets of reduced or doubtful value.
As a result, the original capital may either have become lost or a company may find that it has more
resources than it can profitably employ. In either case, the need may arise to adjust the relation between
capital and assets [Indian National Press (Indore) Ltd., In re. (1989) 66 Com Cases 387, 392 (MP)].
Do you know?
Section 100 Companies Act 1956 is applicable to a company limited by shares or a company limited by
guarantee and having share capital. An unlimited company can reduce the share capital in the manner
specified in the Articles and Memorandum of the company, as Section 100 Companies Act 1956 is not
applicable.
172 PP-CRVI
MODES OF REDUCTION
The mode of reduction, as laid down in Section 100 of the Companies Act, is as follows:
A company limited by shares or a company limited by guarantee and having a share capital may, if
authorised by its articles, by special resolution, and subject to its confirmation by the Court on petition,
reduce its share capital in any way and in particular:
(a) by reducing or extinguishing the liability of members in respect of uncalled or unpaid capital e.g.,
where the shares are of Rs. 100 each with Rs. 75 paid-up, reduce them to Rs. 75 fully paid-up
shares and thus relieve the shareholders from liability on the uncalled capital of Rs. 25 per share;
(b) by paying off or returning paid-up capital not wanted for the purposes of the company, e.g., where
the shares are fully paid-up, reduce them to Rs. 75 each and pay back, Rs. 25 per share;
(c) by paying off the paid-up capital on the conditions that it may be called up again so that the liability
is not extinguished;
(d) by following a combination of any of the preceding methods;
(e) by writing off or canceling the capital which has been lost or is under represented by the available
assets e.g. a share of Rs. 100 fully paid-up is represented by Rs. 75 worth of assets. In such a
situation reality can be re-introduced by writing off Rs. 25 per share. This is the most common
method of reduction of capital. The assets side of the balance sheet may include useless assets
which are cancelled. On the other side i.e. on the liability side share capital is reduced.
Case Laws on Reduction of Capital
1. Can appeal against order of Single Judge allowing reduction, by a sole public shareholder, be
allowed, when there is no fault in reasoning of Single Judge?
Where a company, reducing its share capital by cancelling and extinguishing some equity shares held by its
subsidiary and some shares held by the public, passes the requisite resolution approving the reduction by a
special majority in an extraordinary general meeting called for in this regard, and there is no fault in the
reasoning given by the Single Judge approving the same, and also the valuation of shares, the appeal by a
sole shareholder objecting to the said reduction is liable to be dismissed.
(Chander Bhan Gandhi v. Reckitt Benckiser (India) Ltd. [2012] 107 CLA 511 (Del.))
2. Whether the role of the court, while approving scheme of reduction of capital is limited to the
extent of ensuring that the scheme is not unconscionable or illegal or unfair or unjust?
The role of the court, while approving scheme of reduction of capital, is limited to the extent of ensuring that
the scheme is not unconscionable or illegal or unfair or unjust. Merely because the determination of the
share exchange ratio or the valuation of shares is done by a different method which might result in a different
conclusion would not justify interference of the court, unless found to be unfair. The court does not have the
expertise nor the jurisdiction to delve into the deep commercial wisdom exercised by the creditors and
members of the company who have approved the scheme by the requisite majority. Thus, where the valuer
has used widely accepted methodologies, i.e., the discounted cash flow methodology and the comparable
companies methodology which inter alia include the P/E multiple analysis for valuation of shares, there is no
reason why the valuation report of the valuer, which is fair, reasonable and based on cogent reasoning, and
which has also been accepted by a majority of the non-promoter shareholders of the company, should not be
accepted by the court.
Lesson 11
Rejecting the objections of the interveners/objectors that the fair value of shares arrived at by the valuer is
not in the interest of the promoter shareholders, the High Court approved the valuation of shares and allowed
the petition confirming reduction of share capital.
Wartsila India Ltd.v. Janak Mathuradas and Others[2010] 99 CLA 463 (Bom.)
3. Can the share premium account be utilized for reducing share capital?
The capital was proposed to be reduced by utilization of the Securities Premium Account and General
Reserve. There was to be no dimunition of liabilities or repayment of paid up capital. No reduction of issued,
subscribed or paid up capital was involved. The Court said that the proposed reduction not being prejudicial
in any manner was, therefore to be allowed.
(Alembic Ltd., Re (2008) 144 Com Cases 105 :(2009)89 SCL 19(Guj)
4. Can the reduction result in extinguishment of class of shares?
A scheme of amalgamation and arrangement involved reduction of share capital by extinguishment of shares
of a particular class. The reduction was approved by majority of shareholders and creditors of transferee
company. The court approved the reduction and extinguishment of portion of shares was held to be
permissible as no one was prejudicially affected.
Siel Ltd., Re (2008) 144 Com Cases 469 :(2009)89 SCL 434(Del)
174 PP-CRVI
(c) Diminution of capital Where the company cancels shares which have not been taken or agreed to
be taken by any person .
(d) Redemption of redeemable preference shares.
(e) Purchase of shares of a member by the company..
(f) Buy-back of its own shares.
Does buy back of shares requires courts confirmation as prescribed under Section 100?
Ans : No
Lesson 11
proposed reduction should be obtained or he should be paid off or his payment be secured. The Court, in
deciding whether or not to confirm the reduction will take into consideration the minority shareholders and
creditors.
A Company might decide to return a part of its capital when its paid-up share capital is in excess of its needs.
It is not simply handed over to shareholders in proportion to their holdings. Their class rights will be
considered with the Court treating the reduction as though it was analogous to liquidation. Therefore, the
preference shareholders who have priority to return of capital in liquidation will be the first to have their share
capital returned to them in a share capital reduction, even if they prefer to remain members of the company.
There is no limitation on the power of the Court to confirm the reduction except that it must first be satisfied
that all the creditors entitled to object to the reduction have either consented or been paid or secured [British
and American Trustee and Finance Corpn. v. Couper, (1894) AC 399, 403: (1991-4) All ER Rep 667].
When exercising its discretion, the Court must ensure that the reduction is fair and equitable. In short, the
Court shall consider the following, while sanctioning the reduction:
(i) The interests of creditors are safeguarded;
(ii) The interests of shareholders are considered; and
(iii) Lastly, the public interest is taken care of.
176 PP-CRVI
Lesson 11
Check Articles of
Association whether it
authorizes reduction of
capital.
If no alter the
Articles
No
within 7 days from the date of filing the list, the notice
and the list of creditors should be advertised in the
manner directed by the judge and an affidavit proving
such dispatch and publication, to be filed with the
court.
178 PP-CRVI
Authorisation
The primary requirement is that the articles of association of the company should authorise buyback. In case,
such a provision is not available, it would be necessary to alter the articles of association to authorise buyback. Buy-back can be made with the approval of the Board of directors at a meeting and/or by a special
resolution passed by shareholders in a general meeting, depending on the quantum of buy back. In case of a
listed company, approval of shareholders shall be obtained only by postal ballot.
Quantum of Buyback
(a) Board of directors can approve buy-back up to 10% of the total paid-up equity capital and free
reserves of the company and such buy back has to be authorized by the board by means of a
resolution passed at the meeting.
(b) Shareholders by a special resolution can approve buy-back up to 25% of the total paid-up capital
and free reserves of the company. In respect of any financial year, the shareholders can approve by
special resolution upto 25% of total equity capital in that year.
The buy-back of the shares or other specified securities listed on any recognised stock exchange is
in accordance with the regulations made by the Securities and Exchange Board in this behalf; and
Lesson 11
The buy-back in respect of shares or other specified securities other than listed securities in is in
accordance with such rules made under Chapter IV of the Companies Act, 2013.
Time gap
No offer of buy-back under this sub-section shall be made within a period of one year reckoned from the date
of the closure of the preceding offer of buy-back, if any.
Explanatory statement
The notice of the meeting at which the special resolution is proposed to be passed shall be accompanied by
an explanatory statement stating
(a) a full and complete disclosure of all material facts;
(b) the necessity for the buy-back;
(c) the class of shares or securities intended to be purchased under the buy-back;
(d) the amount to be invested under the buy-back; and
(e) the time-limit for completion of buy-back.
(Rule 17 of Companies (Share Capital and Debentures) Rules 2014 (hereinafter called the rules)
Additionally the Rules provide for following disclosures in explanatory statement with respect to private
companies and unlisted public companies:
(a) the date of the board meeting at which the proposal for buyback was approved by the board of
directors of the company;
(b) the objective of the buy-back;
(c) the class of shares or other securities intended to be purchased under the buy-back;
(d) the number of securities that the company proposes to buyback;
(e) the method to be adopted for the buy-back;
(f) the price at which the buy-back of shares or other securities shall be made;
(g) the basis of arriving at the buy-back price;
(h) the maximum amount to be paid for the buy-back and the sources of funds from which the buy-back
would be financed;
(i) the time-limit for the completion of buy-back;
(j) (i) the aggregate shareholding of the promoters and of the directors of the promoter, where the
promoter is a company and of the directors and key managerial personnel as on the date of the
notice convening the general meeting;
(ii) the aggregate number of equity shares purchased or sold by persons mentioned in sub-clause
(i) during a period of twelve months preceding the date of the board meeting at which the buyback was approved and from that date till the date of notice convening the general meeting;
(iii) the maximum and minimum price at which purchases and sales referred to in sub-clause (ii)
were made along with the relevant date;
(k) if the persons mentioned in sub-clause (i) of clause (j) intend to tender their shares for buy-back
180 PP-CRVI
(i) the quantum of shares proposed to be tendered;
(ii) the details of their transactions and their holdings for the last twelve months prior to the date of the
board meeting at which the buy-back was approved including information of number of shares
acquired, the price and the date of acquisition;
(l) a confirmation that there are no defaults subsisting in repayment of deposits, interest payment
thereon, redemption of debentures or payment of interest thereon or redemption of preference
shares or payment of dividend due to any shareholder, or repayment of any term loans or interest
payable thereon to any financial institution or banking company;
(m) a confirmation that the Board of directors have made a full enquiry into the affairs and prospects of
the company and that they have formed the opinion(i) that immediately following the date on which the general meeting is convened there shall be no
grounds on which the company could be found unable to pay its debts;
(ii) as regards its prospects for the year immediately following that date, that, having regard to their
intentions with respect to the management of the companys business during that year and to
the amount and character of the financial resources which will in their view be available to the
company during that year, the company shall be able to meet its liabilities as and when they fall
due and shall not be rendered insolvent within a period of one year from that date; and
(iii) the directors have taken into account the liabilities(including prospective and contingent
liabilities), as if the company were being wound up under the provisions of the Companies Act,
2013
(n) a report addressed to the Board of directors by the companys auditors stating that(i) they have inquired into the companys state of affairs;
(ii) the amount of the permissible capital payment for the securities in question is in their view
properly determined;
(iii) that the audited accounts on the basis of which calculation with reference to buy back is done is
not more than six months old from the date of offer document; and
(iv) the Board of directors have formed the opinion as specified in clause (m) on reasonable
grounds and that the company, having regard to its state of affairs, shall not be rendered
insolvent within a period of one year from that date.
Procedure
According to Rule 17(2) the company which has been authorized by a special resolution shall, before the
buy-back of shares, file with the Registrar of Companies a letter of offer in Form No.SH-8, along with the fee
as prescribed. Such letter of offer shall be dated and signed on behalf of the Board of directors of the
company by not less than two directors of the company, one of whom shall be the managing director, where
there is one.
Lesson 11
two directors of the company, one of whom shall be the managing director, if any, in such form as may be
prescribed and verified by an affidavit as specified in said form.
182 PP-CRVI
(c) the company shall not utilize the proceeds of an earlier issue of the same kind of shares or same
kind of other specified securities for the buy-back.
(c) by purchasing the securities issued to employees of the company pursuant to a scheme of stock
option or sweat equity.
Lesson 11
if a default, is made by the company, in the repayment of deposits accepted either before or after the
commencement of this Act, interest payment thereon, redemption of debentures or preference
shares or payment of dividend to any shareholder, or repayment of any term loan or interest payable
thereon to any financial institution or banking company: However, the buy-back is not prohibited, if
the default is remedied and a period of three years has lapsed after such default ceased to subsist.
No company shall, directly or indirectly, purchase its own shares or other specified securities in case
such company has not complied with the provisions of sections 92(Annual Return), 123(Declaration
of Dividend), 127(punishment for failure to distribute dividend) and section 129 (Financial
Statement).
184 PP-CRVI
Lesson 11
(b) aggregate number of shares or other specified securities purchased or sold by persons
including persons mentioned in (a) above from a period of six months preceding the date of the
Board Meeting at which the buyback was approved till the date of notice convening the general
meeting;
(c) the maximum and minimum price at which purchases and sales referred to in (b) above were
made along with the relevant dates;
(viii) Intention of the promoters and persons in control of the company to tender shares or other specified
securities for buy-back indicating the number of shares or other specified securities ,details of
acquisition with dates and price;
(ix) A confirmation that there are no defaults subsisting in repayment of deposits, redemption of
debentures or preference shares or repayment of term loans to any financial institutions or banks;
(x) A confirmation that the Board of Directors has made a full enquiry into the affairs and prospects of
the company and that they have formed the opinion(a) that immediately following the date on which the General Meeting or the meeting of the Board of
Directors is convened there will be no grounds on which the company could be found unable to
pay its debts;
(b) as regards its prospects for the year immediately following that date that, having regard to their
intentions with respect to the management of the companys business during that year and to
the amount and character of the financial resources which will in their view be available to the
company during that year, the company will be able to meet its liabilities as and when they fall
due and will not be rendered insolvent within a period of one year from that date; and
(c) in forming their opinion for the above purposes, the directors shall take into account the
liabilities as if the company were being wound up under the provisions of the Companies Act,
1956 (including prospective and contingent liabilities);
(xi) A report addressed to the Board of Directors by the companys auditors stating that(i) they have inquired into the companys state of affairs;
(ii) the amount of the permissible capital payment for the securities in question is in their view
properly determined; and
(iii) the Board of Directors have formed the opinion as specified in clause (x) on reasonable grounds
and that the company will not, having regard to its state of affairs, will not be rendered insolvent
within a period of one year from that date.
METHODS OF BUY-BACK
According to Regulation 4 of the Regulations, a company may buy back its own shares or other specified
securities by any one of the following methods:
(a) from the existing security-holders on a proportionate basis through the tender offer;
(b) from the open market through:
(i) book-building process,
(ii) stock exchange
(c) from odd-lot holders.
186 PP-CRVI
It may be noted that no offer of buy back for 15% or more of paid up capital and free reserves, shall be
made from the open market.
In terms of Regulation 4(4) a company shall not make any offer of buy-back within a period of one year
reckoned from the date of closure of the preceding offer of buy-back, if any.
Can a company buy back its shares or any specified securities through negotiated deal on or of the
stock exchange?
No, Regulation 4(2) does not permit buy back through negotiated deals(of and on stock exchange), private
arrangement, spot transactions.
Additional Disclosures.
In addition to disclosure required under Schedule II Part A, regulation 7 requires the following disclosures to
be made to the explanatory statement.
(a) the maximum price at which the buy-back of shares or other specified securities shall be made and
whether the Board of Directors of the company are being authorised at the general meeting to
determine subsequently the specific price at which the buy-back may be made at the appropriate
time;
(b) if the promoter intends to offer their shares or other specified securities,
(i) the quantum of shares or other specified securities proposed to be tendered, and
(ii) the details of their transactions and their holdings for the last six months prior to the passing of
the special resolution for buy-back including information of number of shares or other specified
securities acquired, the price and the date of acquisition.
Lesson 11
of the draft letter of offer. In the event the Board has sought clarifications or additional information from the
merchant banker to the buyback offer, the period of issuance of comments shall be extended to the seventh
working day from the date of receipt of satisfactory reply to the clarification or additional information sought.
In the event the Board specifies any changes, the merchant banker to the buyback offer and the company
shall carryout such changes in the letter of offer before it is dispatched to the shareholders.
The company shall file along with the draft letter of offer, a declaration of solvency in the prescribed form and
in a manner prescribed in the Companies Act.
Escrow account
Regulation 10 of the SEBI Regulations provides that1. the company should as and by way of security for performance of its obligations under the
Regulations, on or before the opening of the offer, deposit in an escrow account the sum as
specified in Sub-regulation (2).
2. the escrow amount is payable in the following manner:
(i) if the consideration payable does not exceed Rs 100 crores25 per cent of the consideration
payable;
(ii) if the consideration payable exceeds Rs 100 crores25 per cent upto Rs 100 crores and 10
per cent thereafter;
3. the escrow account referred to above shall consist of:
188 PP-CRVI
(a) cash deposited with a scheduled commercial bank, or
(b) bank guarantee in favour of the merchant banker, or
(c) deposit of acceptable securities with appropriate margin, with the merchant banker, or
(d) a combination of (a), (b) and (c) above;
4. where the escrow account consists of deposit with a scheduled commercial bank, the company
while opening the account, should empower the merchant banker to instruct the bank to issue a
bankers cheque or demand draft for the amount lying to the credit of the escrow account, as
provided in the Regulations;
5. where the escrow account consists of bank guarantee, such bank guarantee shall be in favour of
the merchant banker and valid until thirty days after the closure of the offer;
6. where the escrow account consists of securities, the company should empower the merchant
banker to realise the value of such escrow account by sale or otherwise. If there is any deficit on
realisation of the value of the securities, the merchant banker shall be liable to make good any such
deficit;
7. in case the escrow account consists of bank guarantee or approved securities, these shall not be
returned by the merchant banker till the completion of all obligations under the Regulations;
8. where the escrow account consists of bank guarantee or deposit of approved securities, the
company is also required to deposit with the bank in cash, a sum of at least one per cent of the total
consideration payable, as and by way of security for fulfilment of the obligations under the
Regulations by the company;
9. on payment of consideration to all the security-holders who have accepted the offer and after
completion of all the formalities of buy-back, the amount, guarantee and securities in the escrow, if
any, should be released to the company;
10. SEBI, in the interest of the security-holders, may, in case of non-fulfillment of obligations under the
Regulations by the company forfeit the escrow account either in full or in part;
11. the amount so forfeited may be distributed pro rata amongst the security-holders who accepted the
offer and the balance, if any, shall be utilised for investor protection.
Lesson 11
acceptance of the shares or other specified securities. The company shall also ensure that all the securities
bought - back are extinguished within seven days of the last date of completion of buy back.
The shares or other specified securities offered for buy-back if already dematerialised shall be extinguished
and destroyed in the manner specified under the Securities and Exchange Board of India (Depositories and
Participants) Regulations, 1996, and the bye-laws framed thereunder.
The company shall, furnish a certificate to the Board certifying compliance as specified above and duly
certified and verified by (i) the registrar and whenever there is no registrar by the merchant banker;
(ii) two directors of the company one of whom shall be a managing director where there is one;
(iii) the statutory auditor of the company,
The certificate shall be furnished to the Board on a monthly basis by the seventh day of the month
succeeding the month in which the securities certificates are extinguished and destroyed.
The company shall furnish, the particulars of the security certificates extinguished and destroyed, to the
stock exchanges where the shares of the company are listed on a monthly basis by the seventh day of the
month succeeding the month in which the securities certificates are extinguished and destroyed. The
company shall also maintain a record of security certificates which have been cancelled and destroyed as
prescribed in the Companies Act.
the special resolution/ board resolution as under Regulation 5 and 5A respectively, should specify
the maximum price at which the buy-back will be made;
the buy-back of securities should not be from the promoters or persons in control of the company;
the company should appoint a merchant banker and make a public announcement as referred to in
Regulation 8 within seven days from the date of passing the resolution under Regulation 5 and 5A;
the public announcement shall be made within 7 working days from the date of passing special
resolution;
190 PP-CRVI
simultaneously with the issue of such public announcement, the company shall file a copy of the
public announcement with the Board.
the company shall submit the information regarding the shares or other specified securities boughtback, to the stock exchange on a daily basis in such form as may be specified by the Board and the
stock exchange shall upload the same on its official website immediately;
the company shall upload the information regarding the shares or other specified securities boughtback on its website on a daily basis;
the buy-back offer shall open not later than seven working days from the date of public
announcement and shall close within six months from the date of opening of the offer."
the buy-back should be made only on stock exchanges having Nationwide Trading Terminal facility
and only through the order matching mechanism except all or none order matching system;
the company shall submit information regarding the shares or other specified securities bought
back, to the stock exchange on daily basis in such form as may be specified by the board;
the identity of the company as a purchaser would appear on the electronic screen when the order is
placed.
The company shall upload the information regarding the shares or other specified securities bought
back, on its website on daily basis.
Lesson 11
(2) The escrow account referred to in sub-regulation (1) may be in the form of,
(a) cash deposited with any scheduled commercial bank; or
(b) bank guarantee issued in favour of the merchant banker by any scheduled commercial bank.
(3) For such part of the escrow account as is in the form of a cash deposit with a scheduled commercial
bank, the company shall while opening the account, empower the merchant banker to instruct the bank to
make payment of the amounts lying to the credit of the escrow account, to meet the obligations arising out of
the buy-back.
(4) For such part of the escrow account as is in the form of a bank guarantee:
(a) the same shall be in favour of the merchant banker and shall be kept valid for a period of thirty days
after the closure of the offer or till the completion of all obligations under these regulations,
whichever is later.
(b) the same shall not be returned by the merchant banker till completion of all obligations under the
regulations.
(5) Where part of the escrow account is in the form of a bank guarantee, the company shall deposit with a
scheduled commercial bank, in cash, a sum of at least 2.5 per cent of the total amount earmarked for buyback as specified in the resolutions referred to in regulation 5 or regulation 5A. as and by way of security for
fulfillment of the obligations under the regulations by the company.
(6) The escrow amount may be released for making payment to the shareholders subject to atleast 2.5% of
the amount earmarked for buy-back as specified in the resolutions referred to in regulation 5 or regulation 5A
remaining in the escrow account at all points of time.
(7) On fulfilling the obligation specified at sub regulation (3) of Regulation 14, the amount and the guarantee
remaining in the escrow account, if any, shall be released to the company.
(8) In the event of non-compliance with sub-regulation (3) of regulation 14, except in cases where,a. volume weighted average market price (VWAMP) of the shares or other specified securities of the
company during the buy-back period was higher than the buy-back price as certified by the
Merchant banker based on the inputs provided by the Stock Exchanges.
b. inadequate sell orders despite the buy orders placed by the company as certified by the Merchant
banker based on the inputs provided by the Stock Exchanges.
c. such circumstances which were beyond the control of the company and in the opinion of the Board
merit consideration, the Board may direct the merchant banker to forfeit the escrow account, subject
to a maximum of 2.5 per cent of the amount earmarked for buy-back as specified in the resolutions.
(9) In the event of forfeiture for non-fulfillment of obligations specified in sub regulation (8), the amount
forfeited shall be deposited in the Investor Protection and Education Fund of Securities and Exchange Board
of India.
192 PP-CRVI
(3) The company shall extinguish and physically destroy the security certificates so bought back during the
month in the presence of a Merchant Banker and the Statutory Auditor, on or before the fifteenth day of the
succeeding month:
Provided that the company shall ensure that all the securities bought-back are extinguished within seven
days of the last date of completion of buyback.
Lesson 11
misleading information and must state that the directors of the company accept the responsibility for
the information contained in such documents;
(b) the company shall not issue any specified securities including by way of bonus till the date of
closure of the offer is made under these Regulations;
(c) the company shall pay consideration only by cash;
(d) the company shall not withdraw the offer to buy-back after the draft letter of offer is filed with the
SEBI or public announcement of the offer to buy-back is made;
(e) the promoter or the person shall not deal in the specified securities of the company in the stock
exchange or off market, including inter-se transfer of shares among the promotersduring the period
from the date of passing the resolution under regulation 5 or regulation 5A till the closing of the
offer.
(f) the company shall not raise further capital for a period of one year from the closure of buy-back
offer, except in discharge of its subsisting obligations.
No public announcement of buy-back shall be made during the pendency of any scheme of amalgamation or
compromise or arrangement pursuant to the provisions of the Companies Act.
The company should nominate a compliance officer and investors service centre for compliance with the
buy-back regulations and to redress the grievances of the investors [Sub-regulation (3)].
The particulars of the said security certificates extinguished and destroyed should be furnished by the
company to the stock exchanges where the securities of the company are listed, within seven days of
extinguishment and destruction of the certificates [Sub-regulation (4)].
The company should not buy-back the locked-in securities and non-transferable securities till the pendency
of the lock-in or till the securities become transferable [Sub-regulation (5)].
The company should issue, within two days of the completion of buy-back, a public advertisement in a
national daily, inter alia, disclosing the following:
(i) number of securities bought;
(ii) price at which the securities were bought;
(iii) total amount invested in the buy-back;
(iv) details of the security-holders from whom securities exceeding one per cent of the total securities
were bought-back; and
(v) the consequent changes in the capital structure and the shareholding pattern after and before the
buy-back.
194 PP-CRVI
(c) firm arrangements for monies for payment to fulfil the obligations under the offer are in place;
(d) the public announcement of buy-back is made and the letter of offer has been filed in terms of the
Regulations;
(e) the merchant banker should furnish to SEBI, a due diligence certificate which should accompany
the draft letter of offer;
(f) the merchant banker should ensure that the contents of the public announcement of offer as well as
the letter of offer are true, fair and adequate and quoting the source wherever necessary.
(g) the merchant banker should ensure compliance of Section 77A and Section 77B of the Companies
Act, and any other applicable laws or rules in this regard;
(h) upon fulfillment of all obligations by the company under the Regulations, the merchant banker
should inform the bank with whom the escrow or special amount has been deposited to release the
balance amount to the company and send a final report to SEBI in the specified form, within 15 days
from the date of closure of the buy-back offer.
LESSON ROUND UP
According to section 61 of the Companies Act 2013 a limited company having a share capital derives its
power to alter its share capital through its articles of association.
In accordance with Section 390(b) Companies Act 1956, the expression arrangement includes a reorganisation of the share capital of the Company by the consolidation of shares of different classes or by
division of shares of one class into shares of different classes or by both these methods
A company limited by shares or a company limited by guarantee and having a share capital may, if
authorised by its articles, by special resolution, and subject to its confirmation by the Court on petition,
reduce its share capital.
Surrender of shares means the surrender of shares already issued to the company by the registered
holder of shares. Where shares are surrendered to the company, whether by way of settlement of a dispute
or for any other reason, it will have the same effect as a transfer in favour of the company and amount to a
reduction of capital.
Diminution of capital, the company cancels shares which have not been taken or agreed to be taken by any
person.
According to Section 68(1) of the Companies Act, 2013 a company whether public or private, may purchase
its own shares or other specified securities out of:(i) its free reserves; or(ii) the securities premium account;
or (iii) the proceeds of any shares or other specified securities.
When a company buys back its shares or other specified securities , it shall maintain a register of the
shares or securities so bought, the consideration paid for the shares or securities bought back, the date of
cancellation of shares or securities, the date of extinguishing and physically destroying the shares or
securities and such other particulars as may be prescribed.
Section 46A of the Income Tax Act, 1961 provides that any consideration received by a security holder from
any company on buy back shall be chargeable to tax on the difference between the cost of acquisition and
the value of consideration received by the security holder as capital gains.
All the listed companies are required to comply with SEBI (Buy Back of Securities) Regulations 1998 and
as amended from time to time, in addition to the provisions of the Companies Act, 2013.
Lesson 11
196 PP-CRVI
Lesson 12
Post Merger Re-Organisation
LESSON OUTLINE
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Corporate restructuring leads to significant changes
198 PP-CRVI
INTRODUCTION
Post-merger reorganisation is a wide term which encompasses the reorganisation of each and every aspect
of the companys functional areas to achieve the objectives planned and aimed at. The parameters of post
merger reorganisation are to be established by the management team of every amalgamating company
differently depending upon its requirements, objectives of merger and management corporate policy.
A merger can join two cultures, two sets of procedures and protocols, two sets of policies and change the
employment environment and prospects of several hundreds of employees, who have been the bed rock of
past successes and the key to future value. Timely integration of systems, applications and data provide the
corporate information needed to achieve the post-merger objectives.
The relevance of Post-merger organisation and integration cannot be overstated. Continuous appraisal and
improvement are the basic elements in the success of a merger or an acquisition. Due to the complexity of
numerous activities and occurrence of many unanticipated events, it is quite possible that the process gets
off the track and results are not realized.
In fact the main reason, why so many mergers either fail or fall short of expectations is a lack of adequate
efforts to integrate the purchased company into the buyers existing operations. It should be realised that
once the deal is put through, the real work has only begun. Often, the buying company underestimates as
to how long it will take to get the two companies to act as one. Therefore, where importance is placed on
whether it is a good idea to purchase a company and figure out the right price, it is equally essential to
understand the target company with an eye to post-merger efforts.
Lesson 12
199
3. Communication
The company should provide proper and timely communication about the restructuring in the organization to
all its employees, which would provide updated status, bring clarity on what's happening at the organizational
level and avoid miscommunication.
Also, it would be useful to send a communication regarding changes in company policies as well. The
company should also consider sending appropriate communication to bankers, auditors, advisors, etc. upon
formal completion of the restructuring activity.
200 PP-CRVI
8. Re-allocation of people
Restructuring typically would entail re-allocation of persons operating on various positions/ grades in similar
functions. At times, allocation in support functions becomes a challenge as now two persons handle the
similar profile e.g. personnel in HR, finance, administration etc. This would require re-allocation of
responsibilities or re-defining the responsibilities to specific geography/ line of business/ business units. In
addition, a situation may arise where new positions get created to fit into the new organization structure post
restructure. A careful planning is needed to avoid overlapping, underutilization of staff and to take care of
career progression.
Lesson 12
201
order of the Hon'ble Court is sufficient to bring legal effect to a merger/ amalgamation, the bank may require
formal intimation in the prescribed form within 7 days or so.
15. Contracts
It is a onerous exercise to check provisions in the existing contracts having connection to any form of
restructuring. While order of the Hon'ble Court would prevail and shall ensure that the contracts entered by
the merging entity shall continue to be transferred in the name of merged entity as if merged entity was the
signing party from the relevant date, provisions contained in a contract with third party may require company
to inform about such merger or may give rise to the other party to terminate the contract.
202 PP-CRVI
A lease agreement having committed period clause (providing for minimum period of lease during which the
lease contract is not terminable by the landlord) may release the landlord from such restriction in the event of
a restructure of the lessee entity. Likewise, the company may lose the benefits/ concessions under existing
contract, unless company is able to re-negotiate those terms to its favor. Or a contract may provide for lifting
the restrictions around fixed fees say for a period of three years, consequent to restructure. It is now
imperative for the merged entity to check all such provisions triggering from a restructure rather than
criticizing how badly the contract was negotiated by merging entity.
Further, the merged entity would need to check various rights and obligations spelt out in the contracts with
third parties and should allocate teams to identify and ensure compliance of those requirements. A loan
agreement may insist on the borrower company
to obtain prior permission from the Bank. Restructuring is likely to trigger termination rights for other party to
the contract, which could turn out to be dangerous from business continuity perspective.
16. Miscellaneous
A restructure would require changes to data displayed on the website of the company/ new entity as the case
may be. It would require bringing appropriate changes in company's branding strategy, marketing material,
employee visiting cards, employee identity cards, changes to any power of attorneys issued by the erstwhile
entity, consolidation of existing bank accounts with the same bank, any action related to existing bank
guarantees and other miscellaneous items such as crockery bearing company's logo, etc.
There could be many more aspects to a restructure beyond those stated above, depending on the
peculiarities of restructuring by a company. A company should plan for a restructure and try to cover as
many aspects as possible to ensure smooth transition and taking necessary actions to complete the
restructuring process to its logical end.
Lesson 12
203
opened on 14.10.2002 did not receive favourable response in view of Sterlites offer at ` 221/- per
share made in 1998 against which the shareholders tendered their shares. There is a good chance
for upward revision in the offer price or a strategic deal between Sterlite and AV Birla group. It may
also be beneficial to the small shareholders.
4. The takeover by Mr. Arun Bajoria for Bombay Dyeing provided a golden opportunity to the small
shareholders to exit at ` 110/- per share against the market price ruling between ` 60-75 per share.
5. The takeover bid by Mr. Abhishek Dalmia for the Gesco Corporation resulted in upward revision in
offer price to ` 45/- after acquiring 45% shares at `27/- per share. The Dalmias sold their entire
10.5% stake at ` 54 per share to Sheth Mahiaha combine.
6. The takeover bids for Ahmedabad Electricity Company (AEC) by Gujarat Torrent group and the
Bombay Dyeing resulted in increasing the offer price from ` 65/- per share to ` 132/- per share and
at this price Gujarat Torrent Group acquired AEC; undoubtedly, the small shareholders were
benefited prior to acquisition of AEC.
7. Similarly, the takeover bid of Mr. Arun Bajoria for Ballarpur Industries resulted in a surge of the scrip
price from around ` 50/- to ` 68/- when it was made public.
From the above it is evidently clear that such acquisition attempts cause an increase in share price, which
benefits the share holders of the target company. For the post acquisition or merger achievements,
reorganisational efforts of the acquirer or merged company are very important. Improving the acquisition
integration process is one of the most compelling challenge facing businesses today. The results are
dependent on the actions suggested by the consultants and merchant bankers and the actions taken by the
finance executives, operational heads, HRD head and legal advisors.
2. IMPLEMENTATION OF OBJECTIVES
We have so far discussed various objectives, motives, reasons and purposes which are to be achieved and
accomplished by implementing them after completion of merger, amalgamation or acquisition. Much of the
senior managements attention must be focused on developing a post-transaction strategy and integration
plan that will generate the revenue enhancements and cost savings that initially prompted the merger or
acquisition. After merger or acquisition, the resources of two or more companies should be put together for
producing better results through savings in operating costs because of combined management of production,
marketing, purchasing, resources etc. These economies are known as synergistic operative economies.
Synergy is also possible in the areas of Research and Development function of the combined company for
optimum utilization of technological development, which could not be taken up by the separate companies for
want of resources.
A key challenge in mergers and acquisitions is their effective implementation as there are chances that
mergers and acquisitions may fail because of slow integration. The key is to formulate in advance integration
plans that can effectively accomplish the goals of the M&A processes. Since time is money and competitors
do not stand still, integration must not only be done well but also done expeditiously.
To implement the objectives of mergers or acquisitions, there are various factors, which are required to be
reorganized in the post merged or acquired company. Such factors can be grouped in the followed heads:
204 PP-CRVI
regulations, distribution channels and dealers network, suppliers relations, labour etc. In all or in some of
these cases legal documentation would be involved. If foreign collaborators are involved, their existing
agreements would need a mandatory documentation to protect their interests if their terms and conditions so
require. Secured debenture holders and unsecured creditors would also seek legal protection to their rights
with new or changed management of the amalgamating company. Regulatory bodies like the RBI, Stock
Exchanges, the SEBI, etc. would also ensure adherence to their respective guidelines, regulations or
directives. In this way, the legal counsel of the amalgamating company or its consultant would have to
ensure that the company meets its legal obligations in all related and requisite areas. Issuing shares and
other securities to the shareholders of the transferor company and preservation of the books and papers of
that company are also the functions required to be carried out after merger.
Lesson 12
205
important to revamp the financial resources of the company to ensure optimum utilisation of the financial
resources available and the liquidity requirements. Better debtors realisation is also important as it improves
financial resources and reduces finance costs.
Even in those cases where merger is arranged by the BIFR for revival of a sick unit, the scheme would spell
out the financing plans, terms of loans from financial institutions and banks, promoters contribution, etc. but
sometimes on happening of certain uncontrollable events these financing plans have got to be verified,
reviewed and changed depending upon the change in pre-planned technology adaptation, acceptance or
deletion of foreign collaboration or participation, eliminating borrowings from institutions by going public for
raising equity and vice-versa etc.
206 PP-CRVI
cost-reduction without affecting product quality. This demands attention to the following aspects:
1. Efficiency of management
2. Degree of technological adaptation
3. Size of plant
4. Rate of output and utilisation of existing capacity of fixed assets
5. Productivity and quality of input factors including manpower and material management.
The important economic tools which are used for cost reduction includes the following:
(1) Short-run and long-run cost analysis techniques.
(2) Break-even chart is also a tool which is used for adjusting fixed and variable cost to profit volume for
desired cost reductions.
(3) Inventory analysis.
(4) Linear programming, a recent technique, used in cost reduction by taking into consideration the
opportunity cost factor.
(5) Reviewing input materials in view of substitutes made available and other options.
(6) Technological improvements.
To tone up production, it is also necessary that available resources are properly allocated for prudent and
planned programme for utilisation of scarce and limited resources available to an enterprise so as to direct
the production process to result into optimal production and operational efficiency. Resource allocation can
be accomplished by a company using the following techniques:
(a) Production function analysis with one or two or more variables;
(b) Input output analysis;
(c) Linear programming when there are more than two variables in the production activity;
(d) Examining the available options, substitutes and alternative processes.
Revamping of marketing strategy becomes essential, which is accomplished on the basis of market surveys,
and recommendation of marketing experts. Marketing surveys may cover both established as well as new
products. Pricing policy also deserves attention for gaining competitive strength in the different market
segments. Reorganisation of marketing network and rationalisation of marketing strategy is equally
important.
Lesson 12
207
The company planning is associated with the management control so that deviations in the planned targets
and achievements are recorded and their causes are traced out for remedial measures. In other words,
control, as an activity of management, involves comparison of performance with predetermined standards,
ascertaining causes for deviations and prescribing corrective action to reinforce the planned programme. In
each area of corporate activities whether it is personnel management, material management, real estate
management or financial management, planning is associated with control.
Control techniques which are used by the corporate units would require changes from traditional to modern
control techniques.
The traditional control techniques include (1) Budgeting control; (2) Standard costing; (3) Financial ratios; (4)
Internal audit, whereas the modern control techniques are: (1) Performance budgeting; (2) Zero Base
Budgeting; (3) Programme Planning & Budgeting System (PPBS); (4) Programme Evaluation and Review
Technique (PERT) and (5) Critical Path Method (CPM). All these techniques are now computer based for
which softwares are easily available.
Review of the control techniques could be better done if responsibility centres are defined. In an organisation
there may be four responsibility centres viz. Revenue centres, expense centres, profit centres and
investment centres. In revenue centres, the output is measured in monetary terms. These centres relate to
marketing activities and sales budget focuses main attention on control systems. In expenses centres, inputs
are measured in monetary and quality terms. Profit centres which measure both input and output in terms of
expenses and revenue respectively, are created when manufacturing and marketing is done by the same
organisation.
These decisions about management structure, key roles, reporting relationships, restructuring, etc. should be
made, announced and implemented as soon as possible after the deal is signed. Creeping changes,
uncertainty and anxiety that last for months are debilitating and start to drain value from an acquisition.
It would be relevant to mention some of the leading common mistakes, made by the corporates, leading to
pitfalls in mergers and acquisition:
1. Ego problems on both sides buyer and seller rear up very frequently and resulting clashes make
bad situations worse. Trying to have two chiefs is a formula for disaster.
2. Attempt to hasten the integration between both the parties raises the likelihood of making serious
errors. Sudden and radical changes such as relocating the companys entire production operations
should be carefully considered before implementation.
3. Many buyers assert their ownership by moving quickly to convert the acquired company. This does
not always work in the right direction.
4. A cautious approach should be applied to competitor end runs. While the company is focussed on
integration, it furnishes an ideal time for competitors to make a run on the market.
5. Unless the acquired business is in the exact same field, different dynamics might apply.
6. One of the most common and damaging mistakes is to lay off crucial employees from the acquired
company. This is a very complicated, delicate matter and even the seller might not have an
accurate idea as job titles can be misleading.
208 PP-CRVI
Focus on people and their incentives:
Innovation is not a mechanical process but depends on key employees and the incentive structure
to which they are subject. These, which are perhaps the most important assets of the firm, are
nonetheless not automatically part of the deal but need to be co-opted into it. Just maintaining the
R&D budget will not necessarily do the trick. Subtle changes in the vision, leadership or
organization of the newly-formed firm can have important effects on how potential innovators
perceive the relevant costs and benefits.
Integrate selectively:
It may make sense to integrate the distribution operations of two employees. It hardly makes sense
to integrate their creative units. Competition has to be maintained in the areas where innovation is
more important and intense. The areas where the processes are more standardized and less
human capital-intensive are in general more amenable to integration.
Do not delay decisions and communicate clearly the new rules:
As any other economic activity, the efforts put into innovation critically depend on the expected
rewards. Delaying or ineffectively communicating the new rules of the game unnecessarily brings
additional uncertainty into the process. Highly mobile human capital may well not be very patient.
Suppressing competition with coordination and control may not be a win-win proposition after all. Constant
innovation and adaptation is critical for the long-term survival of an organization. Without competition- the
fear to fall behind there is not much rationale for constant re-invention. This fact must be taken into
account in the way that the various parts of the new organization are integrated.
Lesson 12
209
6. Fair market value is one of the valuation criteria for measuring the success of post merger
company. Fair market value is understood as the value in the hands between a willing buyer and
willing seller, each having reasonable knowledge of all pertinent facts and neither being under
pressure or compulsion to buy or sell. Such valuation is generally made in pre merger cases.
7. In valuing the whole enterprise, one must seek financial data of comparable companies in order to
determine ratios that can be used to give an indication of the company position. The data is
analyzed to estimate reasonable future earnings for the subject company.
The following information must be made available and analyzed for post-merger valuation:
(i) All year-end balance sheets and income statements, preferably audited, for a period of five
years and the remaining period upto the valuation date.
(ii) All accounting control information relating to the inventory, sales, cost, and profit contribution by
product line or other segment; property cost and depreciation records; executives and
managerial compensation; and corporate structure.
(iii) All records of patents, trademarks, contracts, or other agreements.
(iv) A history of the company, including all subsidiaries.
Analysis of these items provides data upon which forecasts of earnings, cash flow, etc. can be
made.
8. Gains to shareholders have so far been measured in terms of increase or decrease in share prices
of the merged company. However, share prices are influenced by many factors other than the
performance results of a company. Hence, this cannot be taken in isolation as a single factor to
measure the success or failure of a merged company.
9. In some mergers there is not only increase in the size of the merged or amalgamated company in
regard to capital base and market segments but also in its sources and resources which enable it to
optimize its end earnings.
10. In addition to the above factors, a more specific consideration is required to be given to factors like
improved debtors realisation, reduction in non-performing assets, improvement due to economies of
large scale production and application of superior management in sources and resources available
relating to finance, labour and materials.
210 PP-CRVI
In such cases what is normally forgotten is the centrality of cultural integration. The issues of cultural
integration and the issues of human behaviour need to be addressed simultaneously if not well before the
issues of financial and legal integration are considered. Implementation of structural nature may be
financially and legally successful. But if cultural issues are ignored, the success may only be transient.
Culture of an organisation means the sum total of things the people do and the things the people do not do.
Behavioral patterns get set because of the culture. These patterns create mental blocks for the people in the
organization. Pre-merger survey and summarization of varying cultures of different companies merging,
needs to be carried out. People belonging to the each defined culture need to be acquainted with other
cultures of other merging companies. They need to be mentally prepared to adopt the good points of other
cultures and shed the blockades of their own cultures. Such an open approach will make the fusion of
cultures and ethos easy and effective.
The successful merger demands that strategic planners are sensitive to the human issues of the
organizations. For the purpose, following checks have to be made constantly to ensure that:
sensitive areas of the company are pinpointed and personnel in these sections carefully monitored;
serious efforts are made to retain key people;
a replacement policy is ready to cope with inevitable personnel loss;
records are kept of everyone who leaves, when, why and to where;
employees are informed of what is going on, even bad news is systematically delivered. Uncertainty
is more dangerous than the clear, logical presentation of unpleasant facts;
training department is fully geared to provide short, medium and long term training strategy for both
production and managerial staff;
likely union reaction be assessed in advance;
estimate cost of redundancy payments, early pensions and the like assets;
comprehensive policies and procedures be maintained up for employee related issues such as
office procedures, new reporting, compensation, recruitment and selection, performance,
termination, disciplinary action etc.;
new policies to be clearly communicated to the employees specially employees at the level of
managers, supervisors and line manager to be briefed about the new responsibilities of those
reporting to them;
family gatherings and picnics be organized for the employees and their families of merging
companies during the transition period to allow them to get off their inhibitions and breed familiarity.
Cultural Factors and post merger examples
1. Acquisition of Wellcome group by Glaxo.
The classic examples of effective human resource management is the acquisition of Wellcome group by
Glaxo.
Wellcome and Glaxo were profoundly different companies, both structurally as well as culturally. Wellcome
was more of an academic culture and Glaxo more of a commercial, business driven culture. Everything was
different between the companies, from finance to information technology, the structure of sales
representatives to legal side. Less diplomatic Glaxo staff saw Wellcome as an over-centralised organisation
Lesson 12
211
with employees who were unrealistic in their expectations for the businesss financial success. Academia-like
penny-pinching officials had saddled Wellcome with out-of-date information technology.
Wellcome staff, in contrast, saw Glaxo as overly commercial mercenaries assaulting their worthy enterprise
and driven by cash. They argued, in its enthusiasm for the latest high-tech research gadgetry the Glaxo
officials refused to study tropical diseases where sufferers could not afford western prices.
To try to combat such sentiments, management declared that both old companies were history and decreed
that a new company was to be built in its place. But, the most difficult aspect of merger was to lay off staff
both on account of closing down of certain manufacturing units as well as to cut down on excess costs. To
overcome the difficulties, management offered a very lucrative package. The solution was expensive but
unavoidable, given that Glaxo management was trying not to give the impression that it was steamrolling
Wellcome.
In France, the company established an organisation called Competence Plus, comprising employees who
had been made redundant. They were guaranteed up to 15 months on full salary and given training courses
on everything from networking to new skills. They were also the first to be interviewed for any vacancies
that arose within the new group during that period. Employees hired by other companies for trial periods had
their salaries paid by Glaxo-Wellcome. For those who remained, there were improvements too. Glaxo staff
worked a 39-hour week, whereas Wellcome did 37 hours. Now Glaxo-Wellcome people work 37 hours. We
were concerned not to make mistakes in the social sphere, said Mangeot, the Chairman of Glaxo-Wellcome,
France.
2. Hindustan Lever Ltd. (HLL) and Tomco merger
In Hindustan Lever Ltd. (HLL) and Tomco merger case, HLL had been known for its result oriented, systems
driven work environment, where a strong emphasis is placed on performance. Accordingly, it always has/had
and strives for a team of high performing and high profile executives, carefully selected from the best
management institutes. Discussing product profitability and target achievement is the only language that its
managers understand. The work culture is very demanding and only the best survive. In fact, about 100
managers at that time for Unilever group companies had quit their jobs, as they were unable to cope with the
demanding work culture.
It was felt that the more difficult part would be the management of the two very different work cultures and
ethos, after the merger. In TOMCO the employee productivity was only 60% of HLL. It was opined that HLL
would have to rationalize TOMCOs work force. HLL itself had launched a voluntary retirement package, in
order to get rid of about 500 workers, however only a few resigned. However TOMCO employees had been
assured that their employment conditions were to be protected and service conditions would be honoured.
All the employees of TOMCO were to be absorbed as HLL employees.
It is probably not an exaggeration to assert that most cross-border deals run into difficulties because of
failures in the integration process. What is acquisition integration? First and foremost, it is the process of
realizing the strategic benefits of a merger. In other words, it is everything merging companies must do to
achieve synergies and position the new firm for growth. It requires effective interaction and coordination
between merging firms to realize the strategic potential of the deal at the same time that it necessitates
special attention to human resource concerns. Stated in this way, it is a tall order, and indeed seems
absolutely critical to M&A success.
Differences among management and workers can sometimes spiral into broader community and political
problems. Such was the case in the 1988 acquisition of Rowntree, headquartered in York, England by
Nestle, the Swiss foods giant. Concerns about the future of Rowntree workers, facilities, and even the town
212 PP-CRVI
of York itself created uproar in the UK, involving Members of Parliament, political parties, and the Archbishop
of York. In the end, Nestle was forced to make several concessions to public opinion in its integration of
Rowntree, including retaining York facilities and making certain guarantees with respect to the job security o
Rowntree workers.
Lesson 12
213
There are broadly four possible reasons for business growth and expansion which is to be achieved by the
merged company. These are (1) Operating economies, (2) Financial economies, (3) Growth and
diversification, and (4) Managerial effectiveness. These are explained in detail below:
1. Operating Economies
Whenever two or more firms combine, certain economies are likely to be realised as a result of larger volume
of operations resulting in economies of scale. These economies may arise due to better utilisation of
production capacities, distribution network, engineering services, research and development facilities and so
on. The operating economies (economies of scale) would be the maximum in the case of horizontal mergers
where intensive utilisation of production capacities will result in benefits for the merged firm.
On the other hand, in the case of vertical mergers, the benefits would accrue from better co-ordination of
facilities, both backward and forward, reduction in inventory levels and higher market power of the combined
firms. Operating economies in the form of reduction or elimination of certain overhead expenses may also
arise even in the case of conglomerate mergers. The net result of realising economies of scale would be a
decrease in the cost of production. But if the scale of operations or size of the merged firm becomes too
large and unwieldy, then dis-economies of scale may also arise and the unit cost of production would show
a rising trend.
2. Financial Economies
Merger of two or more firms brings about the following financial advantages for the merged firm:
(a) Relief under the Income Tax Act
Under Section 72A of the Income Tax Act, 1961 carry forward and setting off of accumulated losses and
unabsorbed depreciation of the amalgamating company is allowed against the future profits of the
amalgamated company in order to encourage revival of sick units.
(b) Higher Debt Capacity
The merged firm would enjoy higher debt capacity because the combination of two or more firms provide
greater stability to the earnings level. This is an important consideration for the lenders since the possibility of
default in repayment of loan and interest is reduced to a great extent. A higher debt capacity if utilised, would
mean greater tax advantage for the merged firm leading to higher value of the firm.
(c) Reduction in Floatation Costs
Whenever the merged firm raises funds from the market through public issue of shares or debentures, it can
reduce the floatation costs as compared to the similar amount being raised independently by the merging
firms. Such reduction in the floatation costs represents a real benefit to the merged firm.
Apart from the above, earnings and cash flows are primary financial outcomes that need to be tracked since
valuation are built on them. Particular attention should be given to the components of these measures,
namely, revenue, costs, investments and net working capital. The extent to which these components show
progress will determine whether value is being created or not.
214 PP-CRVI
A merger proposal has a very high growth appeal, and its desirability should always be judged in the ultimate
analysis in terms of its contribution to the market price of the shares of the merged firm.
The merged firm can also seek reduction in the risk levels through diversification of the business operations.
The extent to which risk is reduced, however, depends on the correlation between the earning of the merging
(combining) firms. A negative correlation between the combining firms is less risky whereas a positive
correlation is more risky.
The business firm may pursue the objective of diversification with maximum advantage under the following
circumstances:
(1) If a firm is saddled with problems which can lead to bankruptcy or jeopardise its very existence, then
its merger with another firm can save it from such undesirable consequences. Indian industrial
sector is faced with the problems of the creation of splintered capacities. As a result, many firms
with minimum economic size, such as manufacturers of light commercial vehicles, mini steel plants,
mini paper plants, mini dry cell battery plants, mini sponge iron plants, mini cement plants, etc. were
created. Many of these units have either closed down or are incurring substantial losses. A few of
them, though earning profits today, may fall sick in future due to the increasing competition. In such
a situation mergers and takeovers can bring about consolidation of capacities, lead to the revival of
sick units and also prevent the occurrence of sickness.
(2) If the shares of one of the combining firms are not traded at the stock exchange then creative
diversification would be the only feasible route to reduce the level of risk for the investment in these
firms.
4. Managerial Effectiveness
It has been pointed out by various studies that incompetency of management has been the most important
reason for firms becoming sick. If a sick firm is merged with another well managed company, it will lead to
better co-ordination of human resources of both the companies. Managerial effectiveness can also bring
substantial gains to the merging firms if two well managed firms combine together to take advantage of
valuable human resources.
Customer Reactions
It is necessary to ensure that customers are not adversely affected during a merger or acquisition as losing
either profitable customers or a percentage of their business may have a negative impact on earnings and
cash flows, especially if the customer represents a large percentage of companys revenues and profits.
Several indicators may be deployed such as customer satisfaction, retention, acquisition, market share etc.
Keeping track of market value and sales volume of each segment is also useful. Often during mergers and
acquisitions competitors attempt to disrupt the relationship between an acquirer and its customers. This
implies that a company needs to do more than just maintain customer relationships. It has to make an extra
effort to ensure that its business does not erode.
Employee Reactions
Employees are capable of having an impact on productivity and customer satisfaction, especially in service
business. Employee assessments made at multiple times and with relevant measures may allow better
changes to take place. It should be analysed whether employees understand the expected contribution to be
made to new organization; the view of employees towards various aspects of organisation and leadership;
commitment to the newly formed organization; performance and productivity expected etc.
Lesson 12
215
Successfully integrating two or more organizations after a merger requires many things, but above all, it
requires strong effective leadership, a plan, and a commitment to ongoing evaluation and adaptation. It must
be ensured that both the integration process and the programmatic work of the organization continue to
move forward in tandem.
An integration plan is also essential. Leaders with experience in integrating two or more organizations
emphasise the need for a plan than almost any other factor for success in integration. It was concluded in a
series of interviews conducted with leaders who had been through a merger that a integration plan was a key
factor for success.
Lastly, an organization and its leadership must be proactive in evaluating progress throughout the integration
process. Its desired outcomes and outcome targets must be regularly revisited and progress against them
must be measured. A thoughtful leader will be responsive to such ongoing evaluation, and adapt both the
integration plan and the organizations course of action accordingly.
A successful integration moulds not only the various tehcnical aspects of the businesses but also the
different cultures. The best way to do so is to get people working together quickly to solve business problems
and accomplish results that could not have been achieved before.
Thus, the aspect of post-merger reorganisation is not exhaustive and the parameters of the same would
have to be established by the management of the companies, depending upon the organisational
requirements, corporate policies and plans and the objectives of the merger etc. sought to be met.
LESSON ROUND UP
Post-merger reorganization is a wide term which encompasses the reorganization of each and every
aspect of the companys functional areas to achieve the objectives planned and aimed at.
There are certain parameters to measure post merger efficiency. Some of them are - successful merger
creates a larger organization than before, net profit is more, there is sustained increase in earnings,
continuous dividend distribution etc.
There are broadly four possible reasons for business growth and expansion which is to be achieved by the
merged company. These are (1) Operating economies, (2) Financial economies, (3) Growth and
diversification, and (4) Managerial effectiveness.
There is a spurt of mergers and acquisitions in the last two to three years as is evident from the recent
acquisition of Anglo Dutch steel company Corus by India based Tata Steel. Other recent examples are
suitably discussed under the chapter.
To implement the objectives of mergers or acquisitions, some factors are required to be considered for post
merger integration legal requirements, combination of operations, top management changes,
management of financial resources, rationalization of labour cost, production and marketing management
and corporate planning and control.
Fair market value is one of the valuation criteria for measuring the success of post merger company. In
valuing the whole enterprise, one must seek financial data of comparable companies in order to determine
ratios that can be used to give an indication of the companys position.
The earning performance of the merged company can be measured by return on total assets and return on
net worth.
In general, growth in profit, dividend payouts, companys history and increase in size provides the base for
future growth and are also the factors which help in determining the success or failure of a merged company.
216 PP-CRVI
Lesson 13
Case Studies
LESSON OUTLINE
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Restructuring may make in various forms depending
Demerger L&T
Dr
Reddy
Laboratoriesrestructuring strategies.
Multiple
218 PP-CRVI
CASE STUDIES
1. DEMERGER - LARSEN &TOUBRO LIMITED
Introduction
L&T was established in 1942. Within a span of fifty years L&T became a leading manufacturer and engineer
in turnkey projects having diversified activities in electrical and electronics; construction projects; cement
manufacturing; medical equipment; shipping; earthmoving equipment; heavy engineering and information
technology. From the year 2000, the company was planning to restructure some of its business divisions
through demerger and consolidation in order to concentrate more on infrastructure and turnkey businesses.
Why demerger?
Grasim Industries Ltd. (GIL) a flagship company of Aditya Birla Group was trying to take over control in L&T
management by purchasing shares of L&T from the open market. The company first acquired 15 percent
stake in L&T and also made an open offer to L&T shareholders to increase its stake which does not succeed.
In the year 2004, shareholders approved the demerger of L&T's cement division with a resulting entity
named UltraTech CemCo Ltd. (UCL).
Second Phase
In the second phase, GIL would buy 8.5 percent of UCL from L&T @ ` 342.60 per share and make an open
offer to other shareholders of another 30 percent at the same price. It would take GIL's stake to 51 percent in
UCL, if this offer was fully subscribed, and on the sale of its stake in UCL, L&T would realize ` 3.62 billion.
Third Phase
In the third phase, L&T Employee Welfare Foundation would acquire the GILs 15.3 percent stake in the
residual engineering company.
Hence, after the demerger, GIL gave an open offer to UCL shareholders and purchased the shares to cover
a 51 percent hold in UCL. Immediately after the acquisition, GIL finally changed the name from UltraTech
CemCo Ltd. to UltraTech Cement Ltd.
Lesson 13
Case Studies
219
220 PP-CRVI
ICICI Bank
ICICI Bank was originally promoted in 1994 by ICICI Limited, an Indian financial institution, and was its
wholly-owned subsidiary. ICICIs shareholding in ICICI Bank was reduced to 46% through a public offering of
shares in India in fiscal 1998, and an equity offering in the form of ADRs listed on the NYSE in fiscal 2000,
RBI Announcement
The RBI announced in April, 2001 that it would consider proposals from Development Financial Institutions
wishing to transform themselves into banks.
The Merger
After consideration of various corporate structuring alternatives in the context of the emerging competitive
scenario in the Indian banking industry, and the move towards universal banking, the managements of ICICI
and ICICI Bank formed the view that the merger of ICICI with ICICI Bank would be the optimal strategic
alternative for both entities, and would create the optimal legal structure for the ICICI groups universal
banking strategy. The merger would enhance value for ICICI shareholders through the merged entitys
access to low-cost deposits, greater opportunities for earning fee-based income and the ability to participate
in the payments system and provide transaction-banking services. The merger would enhance value for
ICICI Bank shareholders through a large capital base and scale of operations, seamless access to ICICIs
strong corporate relationships built up over five decades, entry into new business segments, higher market
share in various business segments, particularly fee-based services, and access to the vast talent pool of
ICICI and its subsidiaries
In October 2001, the Board of Directors of ICICI and ICICI Bank approved the merger of ICICI and two of its
wholly-owned retail finance subsidiaries, ICICI Personal Financial Services Limited and ICICI Capital
Services Limited, with ICICI Bank.
The merger was approved by shareholders of ICICI and ICICI Bank in January 2002, by the High Court of
Gujarat at Ahmedabad in March 2002, and by the High Court of Judicature at Mumbai and the Reserve Bank
of India in April 2002.
Consequent to the merger, the ICICI groups financing and banking operations, both wholesale and retail,
have been integrated in a single entity.
Lesson 13
Case Studies
221
The acquisition of the domestic formulations business by Abbott Healthcare Private Limited (AHPL), an
Indian subsidiary of Abbott Laboratories, USA (Abbott Lab), from Piramal Healthcare Limited (PHL).
During May 2010 PHL declared the execution of definitive agreements with Abbott Lab for the sale of its
Formulation Business to AHPL by way of a business transfer as a going concern. The acquisition of the
Formulation Business was done for a total consideration of USD 3.72 billion. The assets transferred include
PHLs manufacturing facilities at Baddi, Himachal Pradesh and rights to approximately 350 brands and
trademarks.
The transaction for sale of the Formulation Business was structured as a slump sale/Business Transfer
under Section 293(1)(a) of the Companies Act pursuant to a Business Transfer Agreement dated May 21,
2010 entered into between PHL and AHPL. The said Business Transfer involves the transfer of all the
assets and liabilities of the Formulation Business excluding cash and cash equivalents and any liability
relating to indebtedness of the Company, taxes, employee and other claims, environmental matters and any
actual or potential litigation.
The Business Transfer has been undertaken for an all cash consideration of USD 3.72 billion. Out of the said
amount USD 2.12 billion would be payable by AHPL to Piramal Healthcare on closing of the sale and a
further USD 400 million payable upon each of the subsequent four anniversaries of the closing commencing
in 2011.
Business Transfer requires approval of the shareholders only and not the high court
Section 293(1)(a) of the Companies Act mandates every company to obtain prior approval of its
shareholders to undertake a sale of whole or substantial part of its undertaking. Such an approval has to be
obtained by way of an ordinary resolution (simple majority). Besides, the Companies (Passing of the
Resolution by Postal Ballot) Rules, 2001, makes it mandatory for all listed companies to obtain such approval
of shareholders by way of a postal ballot and not in any ordinary meeting of shareholders. Further Transfer
of business undertaking need not be approved by the High Courts. Accordingly, pursuant to the approval of
the board of directors of the Company on May 21, 2010, necessary steps were taken to seek the approval of
equity shareholders of Piramal Healthcare vide postal ballot. The results of the said postal ballot were
announced on June 25, 2010 and both the resolutions mentioned above were approved by the shareholders
of Piramal Healthcare by an overwhelming majority.
Non-Compete clause
The business transfer agreement has a Non-Compete clause which prohibits Piramal Enterprises, Piramal
Healthcare and their respective associates from engaging in any business that competes with the
Formulation Business either in India or in the emerging markets for a period of eight years from the date of
closing of the Business Transfer.
222 PP-CRVI
The following table provides the chronology of growth through various restructuring
Strategies.
Event
Year
Incorporation
1984
1985
IPO
1986
Acquires Benzex Laboratories Pvt. Limited to expand its Bulk Actives business
1988
1994
1999
2001
2002
2004
10
2005
11
2006
12
2008
13
2008
14
2009
15
2009
Lesson 13
Case Studies
223
The analysis of above chronology of restructuring events reveals that the restructuring has taken in the
following forms.
Domestic Acquisitions
Overseas acquisitions
Domestic and overseas Listing
Internal reorganization etc.
224 PP-CRVI
SPVs, which mostly feature in large acquisitions, are often used to convey the impression to investors that
companies are not taking huge dollops of debt. In this instance, the SPV has to repay the debt from the
cashflows of the African business. But Bharti will have to step in case of a default. Thus, Bharti Airtel has
structured the acquisition strategically and routed it through the SPVs keeping Bharti Airtels standalone
financials intact. However, that does not absolve Bharti Airtel from overall responsibility of a borrower since it
has provided a guarantee to bankers for the loan that will be in the SPVs books.
Acquisition stages
Date
Particulars
Lesson 13
Case Studies
225
September 4, 2008
November 7, 2008
Daiichi acquires balance 11.42% shares from the Promoters off the stock market
and the deal is concluded. Daiichis equity stake in Ranbaxy reached up to 63.92%
Approvals Obtained
Ministry of Finance mandates prior approval of FIPB, if the foreign investor is already having an existing joint
venture or technology transfer / trademark agreement in the same field, as on January 12, 2005. Since
Daiichi was already holding equity stake in Uni-Sankyo Limited, a company engaged in same business as
Ranbaxy, prior approval of FIPB was obtained. As this foreign investment required prior approval of Cabinet
Committee on Economic Affairs (CCEA), the clearance was received from CCEA by Daiichi in the month of
October, 2008.
Synergies
The Synergies are
1. Their respective presence in the developed and emerging markets. Ranbaxys strengths in the 21
emerging generic drug markets can allow Daiichi Sankyo to tap the potential of the generics
business,
2. Both Daiichi Sankyo and Ranbaxy possess significant competitive advantages, and have profound
strength in striking lucrative alliances with other pharmaceutical companies.
3. R&D perhaps playing the most important role in the success of these two players.
4. The patent perspective of the merger clearly indicates the intentions of both companies in filling the
respective void spaces of the other and emerge as a global leader in the pharmaceutical industry.
According to Ranbaxy newsletter it will provide a new and stronger platform to harness Ranbaxys
capabilities in drug discovery/development, manufacturing and global reach, helping it establish a significant
milestone in the Companys mission of becoming a Research based International Pharmaceutical
Company.
This transaction will create significant long-term value for all stakeholders through:
A complementary business combination that provides sustainable growth by diversification, that
spans the full spectrum of the pharmaceutical business;
An expanded global reach that enables leading market positions in both mature and emerging
markets with proprietary and nonproprietary products;
226 PP-CRVI
Strong growth potential by effectively managing opportunities across the full pharmaceutical life
cycle, cost competitiveness by optimizing usage of R&D and manufacturing facilities of both
companies, especially in India.
Ranbaxy will be able to leverage its extensive front-end presence through a larger product flow and
ascend the pharma value chain by enhancing drug discovery capabilities. It will also widen the scale
and scope of the biosimilars opportunity.
Ranbaxy has also established the Synergy Office in July 2009 which has the task of promoting synergies
and thereby helping maximize the opportunities for Ranbaxy and Daiichi Sankyo to expand their global
operations.
Pharmaceutical companies are working together on a number of areas including drug discovery and
development, marketing and manufacturing. Surely a healthy trend, it will go a long way in addressing the
growing imperative of the global pharmaceutical industry to lower the cost of medicines while addressing
availability challenges around the world.
Lesson 13
Case Studies
227
LESSON ROUND UP
The study has dealt with various case studies which throw light on the latest trends in mergers, takeovers,
amalgamations etc.
Illustrations enable the students to appreciate and apply various methods and strategies in different kinds of
restructuring process.
228 PP-CRVI
Lesson 14
Valuation Introduction and Techniques
LESSON OUTLINE
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Introduction
Valuation motives
General principles
Valuation methods
Assets based
Earning based
Market based
Valuation standards
230 PP-CRVI
INTRODUCTION
Valuation is an exercise to assess the worth of an enterprise or a property. In a merger or amalgamation or
demerger or acquisition, valuation is certainly needed. It is essential to fix the value of the shares to be
exchanged in a merger or the consideration payable for an acquisition.
Lesson 14
8. For determining fair price for effecting sale or transfer of shares as per Articles of Association of the
Company.
9. As required by the agreements between two parties.
10. For purposes of arriving of Value of Shares for purposes of assessments under the Wealth Tax Act.
11. To determine purchase price of a block of shares, which may or may not give the holder thereof a
controlling interest in the company.
12. To value the interest of dissenting shareholders under a scheme of Amalgamation merger or
reconstruction.
13. Conversion of Debt Instruments into Shares.
14. Advancing a loan against the security of shares of the company by the Bank/Financial Institution.
15. As required by provisions of law such the Companies Act, 1956 or Foreign Exchange Management
Act, 1999 or Income Tax Act, 1961 or the SEBI (Substantial Acquisition of Shares and Takeovers)
Regulations, 2011 [the Takeover Code] or SEBI (Employee Stock Option Scheme and Employee
Stock Purchase Scheme) Guidelines, 1999 or SEBI (Buy Back of Securities) Regulations, 1998 or
Delisting Guidelines.
Valuation/Acquisition Motives
An important aspect in the merger/amalgamation/takeover activity is the valuation aspect. The method of
valuation of business, however, depends to a grant extent on the acquisition motives. The acquisition
activity is usually guided by strategic behavioural motives. The reasons could be (a) either purely financial
(taxation, asset-stripping, financial restructuring involving an attempt to augment the resources base and
portfolio-investment) or (b) business related (expansion or diversification). The (c) behavioural reasons
have more to do with the personnel ambitions or objectives (desire to grow big) of the top management.
The expansion and diversification objectives are achievable either by building capacities on ones own or
by buying the existing capacities. (Do a make (build) or buy decision of capital nature.
The decision criteria in such a situation would be the present value of the differential cash flows. These
differential cash flows would, therefore, be the limit on the premium which the acquirer would be willing to
pay. On the other hand, if the acquisition is motivated by financial considerations (specifically taxation and
asset-stripping), the expected financial gains would form the limit on the premium, over and above the price
of physical assets in the company. The cash flow from operations may not be the main consideration in such
situations. Similarly, a merger with financial restructuring as its objective will have to be valued mainly in
terms of financial gains. It would, however, not be easy to determine the level of financial gains because the
financial gains would be a function of the use of which these resources are put.
The acquisitions are not really the market driven transactions, a set of non-financial considerations will also
affect the price. The price could be affected by the motives of other bidders. The value of a target gets
affected not only by the motive of the acquirer, but also by the target companys own objectives.
232 PP-CRVI
determination of its future earnings potential, the risks inherent in those future earnings, Strictly speaking, a
companys fair market value is the price at which the business would change hands between a willing buyer
and a willing seller when neither are under any compulsion to buy or sell, and both parties have knowledge
of relevant facts.
The question that then arises is How do buyers and sellers arrive at this value?
Arriving at the transaction price requires that a value be placed on the company for sale. The process of
arriving at this value should include a detailed, comprehensive analysis which takes into account a range of
factors including the past, present, and most importantly, the future earnings and prospects of the company,
an analysis of its mix of physical and intangible assets, and the general economic and industry conditions.
The other salient factors include:
(1) The stock exchange price of the shares of the two companies before the commencement of
negotiations or the announcement of the bid.
(2) Dividends paid on the shares.
(3) Relative growth prospects of the two companies.
(4) In case of equity shares, the relative gearing of the shares of the two companies.
(gearing means ratio of the amount of Issued preference share capital and debenture stock to the
amount of issued ordinary share capital.)
(5) Net assets of the two companies.
(6) Voting strength in the merged (amalgamated) enterprise of the shareholders of the two companies.
(7) Past history of the prices of shares of the two companies.
Also the following key principles should be kept in mind:
(1) There is no method of valuation which is absolutely correct. Hence a combination of all or some
may be adopted.
(2) If possible, the seller should evaluate his company before contacting potential buyers. In fact, it
would be wiser for companies to evaluate their business on regular basis to keep themselves aware
of its standing in the corresponding industry.
(3) Go for a third party valuation if desirable to avoid overvaluation of the company which is a
common tendency on the sellers part.
(4) Merger and amalgamation deals can take a number of months to complete during which time
valuations can fluctuate substantially. Hence provisions must be made to protect against such
swings.
General Principles of Business valuation
1. Value is determined at a specific point in time.
2. Value is prospective. It is equivalent to the present value, or economic worth, of all future benefits
anticipated to accrue from ownership.
3. The market determines the required rate of return.
4. Value is influenced by liquidity.
5. The higher the underlying net tangible asset value base, the higher the going concern value.
Lesson 14
234 PP-CRVI
values have a tendency to become minimum prices and the greater the proportion of purchase price is
represented by tangible assets, the less risky its acquisition is perceived to be.
Valuation of a listed and quoted company has to be done on a different footing as compared to an unlisted
company. The real value of the assets may or may not reflect the market price of the shares; however, in
unlisted companies, only the information relating to the profitability of the company as reflected in the
accounts is available and there is no indication of the market price. Using existing public companies as a
benchmark to value similar private companies is a viable valuation methodology.
The comparable public company method involves selecting a group of publicly traded companies that, on
average, are representative of the company that is to be valued. Each comparable companys financial or
operating data (like revenues, EBITDA or book value) is compared to each companys total market
capitalization to obtain a valuation multiple. An average of these multiples is then applied to derive the
companys value.
An asset-based valuation can be further separated into four approaches:
1. Book value
The tangible book value of a company is obtained from the balance sheet by taking the adjusted historical
cost of the companys assets and subtracting the liabilities; intangible assets (like goodwill) are excluded in
the calculation.
Statutes like the Gift Tax Act, Wealth Tax Act, etc., have in fact adopted book value method for valuation of
unquoted equity shares for companies other than an investment company. Book value of assets does help
the valuer in determining the useful employment of such assets and their state of efficiency. In turn, this
leads the valuer to the determination of rehabilitation requirements with reference to current replacement
values.
In all cases of valuation on assets basis, except book value basis, it is important to arrive at current
replacement and realization value. It is more so in case of assets like patents, trademarks, know-how, etc.
which may posses value, substantially more or less than those shown in the books.
Using book value does not provide a true indication of a companys value, nor does it take into account the
cash flow that can be generated by the companys assets.
2. Replacement cost
Replacement cost reflects the expenditures required to replicate the operations of the company. Estimating
replacement cost is essentially a make or buy decision.
3. Appraised value
The difference between the appraised value of assets, and the appraised value of liabilities is the net
appraised value of the firm.
This approach is most commonly used in a liquidation analysis because it reflects the divestiture of the
underlying assets rather than the ongoing operations of the firm.
4. Excess earnings
In order to obtain a value of the business using the excess earnings method, a premium is added to the
appraised value of net assets. This premium is calculated by comparing the earnings of a business before a
sale and the earnings after the sale, with the difference referred to as excess earnings.
In this approach, it is assumed that the business is run more efficiently after a sale; the total amount of
Lesson 14
excess earnings is capitalized (e.g., the difference in earnings is divided by some expected rate of return)
and this result is then added to the appraised value of net assets to derive the value of the business.
P
EPS
In the case of a merger, where the shares of one of the companies under consideration are not
listed on any stock exchange
In case of companies, where there is an intention to liquidate it and to realise the assets and
distribute the net proceeds.
(ii) In case of significant and unusual fluctuations in market price the market price may not be indicative
of the true value of the share. At times, the valuer may also want to ignore this value, if according to
the valuer, the market price is not a fair reflection of the companys underlying assets or profitability
status. The Market Price Method may also be used as a back up for supporting the value arrived at
by using the other methods.
(iii) It is important to note that Regulatory bodies have often considered market value as one of the very
important basis Preferential allotment, Buyback, Open offer price calculation under the Takeover
Code.
(iv) In earlier days due to non-availability of data, while calculating the value under the market price
method, high and low of monthly share prices where considered. Now with the support of
236 PP-CRVI
technology, detailed data is available for stock prices. It is now a usual practice to consider
weighted average market price considering volume and value of each transaction reported at the
stock exchange.
(v) If the period for which prices are considered also has impact on account of Bonus shares, Rights
Issue, etc., the valuer needs to adjust the market prices for such corporate events.
MARKET COMPARABLES
This method is generally, applied in case of unlisted entities. This method estimates value by relating the
same to underlying elements of similar companies for past years. It is based on market multiples of
comparable companies. For example
Though this method is easy to understand and quick to compute, it may not capture the intrinsic value and
may give a distorted picture in case of short term volatility in the markets. There may often be difficulty in
identifying the comparable companies.
Lesson 14
There are some business based real risks like acquired company loosing a contract, or new competitor
entering the market or an adverse regulation passed by government, which necessitated discounting of cash
flows.
The discounted cash flow (DCF) model is applied in the following steps:
1. Estimate the future cash flows of the target based on the assumption for its post-acquisition
management by the bidder over the forecast horizon.
2. Estimate the terminal value of the target at forecast horizon.
3. Estimate the cost of capital appropriate for the target.
4. Discount the estimated cash flows to give a value of the target.
5. Add other cash inflows from sources such as asset disposals or business divestments.
6. Subtract debt and other expenses, such as tax on gains from disposals and divestments, and
acquisition costs, to give a value for the equity of the target.
7. Compare the estimated equity value for the target with its pre-acquisition stand-alone value to
determine the added value from the acquisition.
8. Decide how much of this added value should be given away to target shareholders as control
premium.
Valuation by team of experts
Valuation is an important aspect in merger and acquisition and it should be done by a team of experts
keeping into consideration the basic objectives of acquisition. Team should comprise of financial experts,
accounting specialists technical and legal experts who should look into aspects, of valuation from different
angles.
Accounting expert has to foresee the impact of the events of merger on profit and loss account and balance
sheet through projection for next 5 years and economic forecast. Using the accounting data he must
calculate performance ratios, financial capacity analysis, budget accounting and management accounting
and read the impact on stock values, etc. besides, installing accounting and depreciation policy, treatment of
tangible and intangible assets, doubtful debts, loans, interests, maturities, etc.
Technician has its own role in valuation to look into the life and obsolescence of depreciated assets and
replacements and adjustments in technical process, etc. and form independent opinion on workability of
plant and machinery and other assets.
Legal experts advice is also needed on matters of compliance of legal formalities in implementing
acquisition, tax aspects, review of corporate laws as applicable, legal procedure in acquisition strategy, laws
affecting transfer of stocks and assets, regulatory laws, labour laws preparing drafts of documents to be
executed or entered into between different parties, etc.
Nevertheless, the experts must take following into consideration for determining exchange ratio.
A. Market Price of Shares
If the offeree and offeror are both listed companies, the stock exchange prices of the shares of both the
companies should be taken into consideration which existed before commencement of negotiations or
announcement of the takeover bid to avoid distortions in the market price which are likely to be created by
interested parties in pushing up the price of the shares of the offeror to get better deal and vice versa.
238 PP-CRVI
B. Dividend Payout Ratio (DPR)
The dividend paid in immediate past by the two companies is important as the shareholders want continuity
of dividend income. In case offeree company was not paying dividend or its DPR was lower than the
offerors, then its shareholders would opt for share exchange for the growth company by sacrificing the
current dividend income for prospects of future growth in income and capital appreciation.
C. Price Earning Ratio (PER)
Price earning ratios of both the offeror and offeree companies be compared to judge relative growth
prospects. Company with lower PER show a record of low growth in earning per share which depresses
market price of shares in comparison to high growth potential company. Future growth rate of combined
company should also be calculated.
D. Debt Equity Ratio
Company with low gearing offers positive factor to investors for security and stability rather than growth
potential with a geared company having capacity to expand equity base.
E. Net Assets Value (NAV)
Net assets value of the two companies be compared as the company with lower NAV has greater chances of
being pushed into liquidation.
Having taken all the above factors into consideration, the final exchange ratio may depend upon factors
representing strength and weakness of the firm in the light of merger objectives including the following:
Liquidity, strategic assets, management capabilities, tax loss carry overs, reproduction costs, investment
values, market values (combined companies shares) book values, etc.
Valuation by experts: effect
It is well settled that the valuation of shares is a technical matter, requiring considerable skill and expertise. If
the same has been worked out and arrived at by experts then the same should be accepted, more so, if the
same has the approval of the shareholders. That is to say, where the valuation done by the companys
auditors is approved by the majority of shareholders and is also confirmed by eminent experts, who are
appointed by the court to examine the valuation so made, as fair, and the valuation is not shown to be
patently unfair or unjust, it would be extremely difficult to hold that the valuation so made is unfair, and, then,
the court shall have to be slow to set at naught the entire scheme of amalgamation. The court does not go
into the matter of fixing of exchange ratio in great detail or to sit in appeal over the decision of the chartered
accountant. If a chartered accountant of repute has given the exchange ratio as per valuation made by him
and the same is accepted by the requisite majority of the shareholders, the court will only see whether there
is any manifest unreasonableness or manifest fraud involved in the matter.
So, the exchange ratio of shares in the case of scheme of amalgamation, when supported by an opinion of
accounting, technicians & legal experts and approved by a very large number of shareholders concerned, is
prima facie to be accepted as fair, unless proved otherwise by the objectors. It is also well established, that
there are number of bases on which valuation or the offered exchange ratio, which ultimately is a matter of
opinion, can be founded and final determination can be made by accepting one of amalgamation of various
consideration. It is also well settled by the Supreme Court in Hindustan Lever Employees Union v.
Hindustan Lever Ltd., that mathematical precision is not the criterion for adjudging the fair exchange ratio.
Thus, now, the law has been well settled by the Supreme Court in Miheer H. transferee company to be
Lesson 14
allotted to the holders of the transferor company has been worked out by a recognised firm of chartered
accountants who are experts in the field of valuation, and if no mistake can be pointed out in the said
valuation, it is not for the court to substitute its exchange ratio, especially when the same has been accepted
without demur by the overwhelming majority of the shareholders of the two companies or to say that the
shareholders in their collective wisdom should not have accepted the said exchange ratio on the ground that
it will be detrimental to their interest. It is not the part of the judicial process, said the Supreme Court in
Hindustan Lever Employees Union v. Hindustan Lever Ltd., to examine entrepreneurial activities to ferret out
flaws. The court is least equipped for such oversights, nor indeed is it a function of the judges in our
constitutional scheme. It cannot be said that the internal management, business activity or institutional
operation of public bodies, can be subjected to inspection by the court. To do so is incompetent and
improper and, therefore, out of bounds.
Where the determination of the market price has been entrusted to a reputed valuer, there no reason to
doubt his competence unless mala fides are established against him. Allegations of mala fides are easy to
make but difficult to substantiate. Unless the person who challenges the valuation satisfies the court that the
valuation arrived at is grossly unfair, the court will not disturb the scheme of amalgamation which has been
approved by the shareholders of two companies, who are, by and large well informed men of commercial
world. It is difficult to set aside the valuation of experts in the absence of fraud or mala fides on the part of the
experts.
Fair value of shares
Valuation can be done on the basis of fair value also. However, resort to valuation by fair value is appropriate
when market value of a company is independent of its profitability.
The fair value of shares is arrived at after consideration of different modes of valuation and diverse factors.
There is no mathematically accurate formula of valuation. An element of guesswork or arbitrariness is
involved in valuation. The following four factors have to be kept in mind in the valuation of shares. These are:
(1) Capital cover,
(2) Yield,
(3) Earning capacity, and
(4) Marketability.
For arriving at the fair value of share, three well-known methods are applied:
(1) the manageable profit basis method (the earning per share method).
(2) the net worth method or the break-up value method, and
(3) the market value method.
The fair value of a share is the average of the value of shares obtained by the net assets method and the
one obtained by the yield method. This is, in fact not a valuation, but a compromise formula for bringing the
parties to an agreement.
The average of book value and yield-based value incorporates the advantages of both the methods and
minimizes the demerits of both the methods. Hence, such average is called the fair value of share or
sometimes also called the dual method of share valuation.
The fair value of shares can be calculated by using the formula:
Fair value of shares =
240 PP-CRVI
Valuation of equity shares must take note of special features, if any, in the company or in the particular
transaction. These are briefly stated below:
Statutory valuation
Valuation of shares may be necessary under the provisions of various enactments like the Wealth tax Act,
Companies Act, Income-tax Act, etc. e.g. valuation is necessary under the Companies Act in the case of an
amalgamation and under the Income-tax Act for the purposes of capital gains.
Some of the other enactments have laid down rules for valuation of shares. The rules generally imply
acceptance of open market price i.e. stock exchange price for quoted shares and asset based valuation for
unquoted equity shares and average of yield and asset methods i.e. fair value, in valuing shares of
investment companies.
Lesson 14
Valuation Standards
Valuation Standards aims to provide uniformity in valuation of various tangible and intangible classes of
assets that provides consistent delivery of standards.
Valuation for financial transactions such as acquisitions, mergers, leveraged buyouts, initial public
offerings, employee stock ownership plans and other share based plans, partner and shareholder
buy-ins or buyouts, and stock redemptions.
Valuation for Dispute Resolution and/ or litigation/pending litigation relating to matters such as
marital dissolution, bankruptcy, contractual disputes, owner disputes, dissenting shareholder and
minority ownership oppression cases, employment disputes and intellectual property disputes.
Other purposes like valuation for planning, Internal use by the owners etc.
The same business may have different values if different standard of value is used and different
approaches are adopted. The rising demand for valuation services has given new avenues for the
finance professionals. Going forward more and more professional would be engaged in performing
valuation services.
LESSON ROUND UP
There are a number of situations in which a business or a share or any other property may be required to
be valued. Valuation is essential for (i) strategic partnerships, (ii) mergers or acquisitions of shares of a
company and/or acquisition of a business. (iii) Valuation is also necessary for introducing employee stock
option plans (ESOPs) and joint ventures. From the perspective of a valuer, a business owner, or an
interested party, a valuation provides a useful base to establish a price for the property or the business or to
help determine ways and means of enhancing the value of his firm or enterprise.
The valuation methods can be divided into three broad categories viz., asset based, earning based and
market based methods.
Asset based valuation method is based on the simple assumption that adding the value of all the assets of
the company and subtracting the liabilities, leaving a net asset valuation, can best determine the value of a
242 PP-CRVI
business. However, for the purposes of the amalgamation the amount of the consideration for the
acquisition of a business may be arrived at either by valuing its individual assets and goodwill or by valuing
the business as a whole by reference to its earning capacity.
Valuation based on earnings based on the rate of return on capital employed is a more modern method
being adopted. From the last earnings declared by a company, items such as tax, preference dividend, if
any, are deducted and net earnings are taken.
The Market Price Method evaluates the value on the basis of prices quoted on the stock exchange.
Lesson 15
Regulatory Aspects of Valuation With
Reference to Corporate Strategies
LESSON OUTLINE
of
shares
under
SEBI
Regulations
Taxation aspects
Valuation of different strategies
Demerger
Slump sale
Liquidation
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
There are various methodologies for valuing a
business, all having different relevance depending on
the purpose of valuation. There are many
methodologies that a valuer may use to value the
Shares of a Company/Business. In practice, the
valuer normally uses different methodologies of
valuation and arrives at a fair value for the entire
business by combining the values arrived using
various methods. These methodologies includes
asset based approach, earnings based approach and
market based approach. The concepts of these
approaches are dealt in the previous lesson. Besides
regulatory aspects also impact valuation. For
example there are regulatory prescriptions for
valuation of shares under SEBI (SAST) Regulations,
SEBI (ICDR) Regulations, SEBI(ESOP) Guidelines,
FEMA/Consolidated FDI Policy, Income Tax Act
1961 etc., After reading this lesson you will be able to
understand the regulatory aspects of valuation,
different valuation methodologies
strategies including taxation aspects.
for
different
Warren Buffet
244 PP-CRVI
INTRODUCTION
Understanding Corporate valuation is not only a pre-requisite during different types of restructuring phase of
the company. It is required at frequent intervals to identify the economic value creation and any destruction if
any occurred. It is also important to note that value is different from the price. The process of valuation
includes a detailed and comprehensive analysis taking into an account the past present and future earnings
prospects and analysis of physical and intangible assets and general economic and industry conditions.
Determination of realistic value of a firm is indeed a difficult process. Some times market price of the share of
the company may be an approximate indication of the firm. Market price again depends on current earnings
and the future growth. Market price of shares may not be feasible for unlisted company for which asset
based approach of valuation might be a feasible option.
The Ministry of Corporate Affairs (the then Department of Company Affairs) has constituted an Expert Group
in 2002 under the Chairmanship of Mr. Shardul S. Shroff to suggest guidelines on valuation of shares in
connection with amalgamation, merger, de-merger, acquisition, buy-back, etc.,
The Expert Group is of the view that there are two circumstances under which the prescribed valuation
guidelines may apply to the companies.
These are:
(i) Circumstances under which a valuation from the Registered Valuer(s) is mandatory and
(ii) Circumstances under which a valuation from the Registered Valuer(s) is recommended but not
mandatory.
The Expert Group has adopted two basic principles for identifying the circumstances under which the
mandatory valuation is required. These circumstances includes:
(i) Whenever a shareholders resolution, ordinary or special, is required to authorize the transaction
under the Companies Act, 1956 (Companies Act) or where the shareholders are required to take a
decision on values which may have a bearing on or help in making the decision ; and
(ii) All Related Party transactions described herein.
Without limiting the generality of the above, some of the specific circumstances under which the Expert
Group opines that the company/Board of Directors should seek a mandatory valuation from a Registered
Valuer(s) are:
(i) All Schemes of Compromise and Arrangement under Sections 391 to 394 of the Companies Act.
(ii) Sale of a business, including investment business and disposal of a controlling interest in an
undertaking or a company, through disposal of shares, an undertaking or a substantial part thereof
including a slump sale / itemised sale under Section 293(i)(a) of the Companies Act;
(iii) All equity and equity linked investments where shareholders approval is required under Section
372A of the Companies Act;
(iv) Purchases, Sales, combinations and restructuring entailing acquisition or disposal of business, an
undertaking or part of an undertaking, securities, equity and preference capital, and outstanding
debt and liabilities, where Related Parties are counterparties.
However, the valuation should not be mandatory for transactions, which are not material in nature.
Lesson 15
The Expert Group is of the view that it cannot straightjacket the test of materiality either on a
monetary test or a pro rata principle without reference to the context and purpose, e.g. the transfer
of a small percentage may result in a change of control and would be considered material.
Materiality may be in the context of liabilities, contingent liabilities or valuable transferred rights.
While the test of materiality must therefore be applied in each case, due consideration should be
given to asset/liability value, turnover and profit contribution in making this determination;
(v) All preferential allotments made to Related Parties and persons Controlling the company under
Section 81(1A) of the Companies Act; and
(vi) Specified recapitalisation situations - whether effected through a buyback of shares under the SEBI
(Buy-back of Securities) Regulations, 1998 or Open Offers by persons in management or
promoters, or a capital reduction under Section 100 or in any other manner, which have the effect of
squeezing out minority shareholders, for enhancing the control of the promoters or persons in
management beyond 90% or more of the issued share capital, or which have the declared or stated
objective of delisting the company. Mandatory valuations are also recommended where persons in
management or the promoters become shareholders of 90% or more of the issued share capital of
the company and seek to negotiate the exit of minority shareholders, provided there is substantial
minority interest in such a situation.
The Expert Group is of the view that under the following circumstances, a valuation opinion may not be
prescribed as a company activity requiring disclosure to shareholders. These circumstances includes :
(i) Capital reduction under Section 100 of the Companies Act, unless covered in paragraph 2.2.3 (v)
above;
(ii) Issue of shares to public through a public offering;
(iii) Rights issue under the Companies Act;
(iv) Disinvestment of Central and State Public Sector Undertaking; and
(v) Family settlements.
VALUATION DOCUMENTATION
Valuation exercise is based on observation, inspection, analysis and calculation. During this process, the
valuer goes through various documents, records his observation, makes relevant calculation and records
these calculation and analysis results. In this process a lot of documents are generated which forms the
basis of his conclusion on the valuation of the subject matter. It is very necessary for his to preserve all such
records so that these documents may help him in substantiate his conclusion on valuation. Moreover these
documents also become a matter of reference in future.
The Valuers report assertion that the valuation exercise was performed with due diligence and in
accordance of generally accepted valuation principles and
The Valuers conclusions about Valuation of the subject matter of the Valuation exercise and other
related aspects of valuation.
Valuation documentation must clearly demonstrate that the Valuation exercise was in fact performed in
246 PP-CRVI
compliance with generally accepted valuation principles and applicable standards. It must provide a clear link
to valuation conclusions and must contain sufficient information, in sufficient detail, for a clear understanding
of the following
The source of the information analyzed and supporting evidential matter obtained, examined, and
evaluated; and
The following are the more specific purposes of documentation in Valuation exercise:
Assisting those responsible to direct, supervise, and review the work performed;
Providing and demonstrating the accountability of those performing the work (i.e., compliance with
applicable standards);
Assisting quality-control reviewers to understand and assess how the engagement team reached
and supported significant conclusions;
Enabling internal and external inspection teams and peer reviewers to assess compliance with
professional, legal, and regulatory standards and requirements; and
Inadequate documentation makes it difficult or impossible to determine if the Valuation exercise was actually
done.
LIST OF DOCUMENTS
During the course of Valuation exercise, a valuation expert collects/prepares various documents. The
documents so obtained or prepared may be different from assignment to assignment but an indicative list of
documents to be maintained is as given
1. Documents pertaining to Basic information of client entity i.e. Details about Company Promoters,
Key Management professional of the Company, Memorandum of Association, Article of Association,
Prospectus, prior three years financial statement.
2. Copy of valuation engagement with the Client
3. Copy of Previous valuation report of the subject matter of valuation exercise if any.
4. Documents which are pertaining to Assumptions and limiting conditions in the valuation assignment.
5. Information gathered and analyzed to obtain an understanding of matters that may affect the value
of the subject interest
6. Documents pertaining to selection of Valuation approach used in the valuation assignment including
the rationale and support for their use
7. Any restriction or limitation on the scope of the Valuers work or the data available for analysis
8. Basis for using any valuation assumption during the valuation engagement
Lesson 15
9. Documents pertaining to any rule of thumb used in the valuation, source(s) of data used, and how
the rule of thumb was applied
Other documentation considered relevant to the engagement by the Valuer
DOCUMENTATION RETENTION
Generally Valuation exercise is done in connection of Statutory, legal or personal matters. It is necessary
that documents pertaining to valuation should be maintained as per applicable legislation on subject matter
of valuation.
Documentation pertaining to Valuation exercise needs to maintained at
1. Valuers End
2. Client Party End in form of valuation report along with annexure and exhibits.
Period for Retention of Documents at Valuers end
No legislation has been framed yet which specifies the period for documentation retention at valuers end.
However Government or professional Institute may bring guidelines about this matter. Standard on Auditing
(SA) 230 on Audit documentation, an Auditor should retain the documentation pertaining to an Audit
assignment for a period of 7 years.
Period for Retention of Documents at Clients end
Retention period of Valuation document at Clients party end would depend on the purpose of valuation
exercise. If valuation has got carried on for the purpose of Companies Act, Companies (Preservation and
Disposal of Records) Rules, 1966 will apply. Similarly If valuation has got carried on for the purpose of
Income tax Act, provision relating to Income Tax Act, 1961 and Income Tax Rules, 1962 will apply.
248 PP-CRVI
In Hindustan Lever Employees Union v. Hindustan Lever Limited [1995] (Supp.) (1) SCC 499 at 517(519),
the Honble Court stated:
The valuation of shares is a technical matter. It requires considerable skill and experience. There are bound
to be differences of opinion among accountants as to what is the correct value of the shares of a company. It
was emphasized that more than 99% of the shareholders had approved the valuation. The test of fairness of
this valuation is not whether the offer is fair to a particular shareholder. who may have reasons of his own
for not agreeing to the valuation of the shares, but the overwhelming majority of the shareholders have
approved of the valuation. The Court should not interfere with such valuation.
The Hindustan Lever case also repelled the case that valuation particulars needed a proper disclosure as
material facts in the Explanatory Statement. It confirmed the judgment of Jitendra R. Sukhadia v. Alembic
Chemical Works Co. Ltd.,(1987) 3 Comp.L.J 141 (Guj) as follows:
How this exchange ratio was worked out, however, was not required to be stated in the statement
contemplated under Section 394(1)(a).
The Hindustan Levers judgment (1995) Supp. (1) SCC 499 at 502 noted:
In the absence of it being shown to be vitiated by fraud and malafide, the mere fact that the determination
done by slightly different method might have resulted in different conclusion would not justify interference of
Court.
Pricing in Public Issue as per SEBI (Issue of Capital and Disclosure Requirements)
Regulaions, 2009
Pricing
(1) An issuer may determine the price of specified securities in consultation with the lead merchant banker or
through the book building process.
(2) An issuer may determine the coupon rate and conversion price of convertible debt instruments in
consultation with the lead merchant banker or through the book building process.
Differential pricing
An issuer may offer specified securities at different prices, subject to the following:
(a) retail individual investors or retail individual shareholders or employees of the issuer entitled for
Lesson 15
reservation made under regulation 42 making an application for specified securities of value not
more than one lakh rupees, may be offered specified securities at a price lower than the price at
which net offer is made to other categories of applicants:
Provided that such difference shall not be more than ten per cent of the price at which specified
securities are offered to other categories of applicant;
(b) in case of a book built issue, the price of the specified securities offered to an anchor investor shall
not be lower than the price offered to other applicants;
(c) in case of a composite issue, the price of the specified securities offered in the public issue may be
different from the price offered in rights issue and justification for such price difference shall be
given in the offer document.
250 PP-CRVI
(2) The disclosure about the face value of equity shares (including the statement about the issue price being
X times of the face value) shall be made in the advertisements, offer documents and application forms in
identical font size as that of issue price or price band.
Lesson 15
1. If the shares are listed on more than one stock exchange, but quoted only on one stock exchange
on the given date, then the price on that stock exchange shall be considered.
2. If the share price is quoted on more than one stock exchange, then the stock exchange where there
is highest trading volume during that date shall be considered.
3. If shares are not quoted on the given date, then the share price on the next trading day shall be
considered.
As per the sweat equity regulations, the intellectual property or the value addition in respect of which the
company intends to issue the sweat equity should also be valued in accordance with the valuation
requirements contained in the said regulations.
252 PP-CRVI
month in which the recognised stock exchanges were notified of the board meeting in which the delisting
proposal was considered, is less than five per cent. (by number of equity shares) of the total listed equity
shares of that class and the term frequently traded shall be construed accordingly.
(3) The floor price shall be determined by the promoter and the merchant banker taking into account the
following factors:
(a) the highest price paid by the promoter for acquisitions, if any, of equity shares of the class sought to
be delisted, including by way of allotment in a public or rights issue or preferential allotment, during
the twenty six weeks period prior to the date on which the recognised stock exchanges were notified
of the board meeting in which the delisting proposal was considered and after that date upto the
date of the public announcement; and,
(b) other parameters including return on net worth, book value of the shares of the company, earning
per share, price earning multiple vis--vis the industry average.
Valuation of Shares under the Sweat Equity Unlisted Companies (Issue of Shares) Rules,
2003
Under the Unlisted Companies (Issue of Sweat Equity Shares) Rules, 2003, the price of sweat equity shares to
be issued to employees and directors shall be at a fair price calculated by an independent valuer. The valuation
of the intellectual property or of the know-how provided or other value addition to consideration at which sweat
equity capital is issued, shall be carried out by a valuer. The valuer should consult such experts, as he may
deem fit, having regard to the nature of the industry and the nature of the property or the value addition. The
valuer should submit a valuation report to the company giving justification for the valuation. A copy of the
valuation report of the valuer should be sent to the shareholders with the notice of the general meeting;
Highest negotiated price per share under the share purchase agreement (SPA) triggering the
offer;
Volume weighted average price of shares acquired by the acquirer during 52 weeks preceding
the public announcement (PA);
Highest price paid for any acquisition by the acquirer during 26 weeks immediately preceding the
PA;
Volume weighted average market price for sixty trading days preceding the PA.
If the target companys shares are infrequently traded then the open offer price for acquisition of shares
under the minimum open offer shall be highest of the following:
Highest negotiated price per share under the share purchase agreement (SPA) triggering the
offer;
Volume weighted average price of shares acquired by the acquirer during 52 weeks preceding
the public announcement (PA);
Lesson 15
Highest price paid for any acquisition by the acquirer during 26 weeks immediately preceding the
PA;
The price determined by the acquirer and the manager to the open offer after taking into account
valuation parameters including book value, comparable trading multiples, and such other
parameters that are customary for valuation of shares of such companies.
It may be noted that the Board may at the expense of the acquirer, require valuation of shares by an
independent merchant banker other than the manager to the offer or any independent chartered accountant
in practice having a minimum experience of 10 years.
Sale/ Purchase of Intangible assets including brands, patents, copyrights, trademarks, rights.
Liquidation/Insolvency of company
Takeover of Companies
254 PP-CRVI
need to maintain confidentiality.
Background Information
Identity of the valuer and any other experts involved in the valuation
Sources of Information
Valuation Methodology
Conclusion
1. Background Information
The valuation report should briefly cover the following:
Proposed Transaction
Capital structure of the company, if relevant, and any changes as a result of the proposed
transaction
Shareholding pattern, any significant changes (Promoters/FIs), and any changes as a result of the
transaction (Note a table of before and after shareholding patterns ought to be disclosed)
3. Identity of the valuer and any other experts involved in the valuation
Identity of the Registered Valuer (with his registration number) as well as organization doing the valuation
and any other experts consulted in the process of valuation. The separation of the advisory team and details
of the Chinese walls maintained between the independent valuer team and the advisory team, if appointed
with particulars of the degree of strict separation and compliance of Chinese walls should be mentioned.
Lesson 15
6. Sources of Information
The valuer should clearly indicate in the report the principal sources of information, both internal and
external, which have been relied upon for the purpose of valuation.
Industry Analysis
SWOT Analysis
an affirmative statement on adequacy of information and time for carrying out the valuations; with
such modifications as may be appropriate and warranted. The affirmative statement shall not negate
the professional liability for expertise applied in determining value and if the degree of inadequacy of
information is severe, fundamental questions and information as assessed by the valuer as key for
the appropriate stage of valuation needs to be disclosed.
8. Valuation Methodology
Whereas one method may be more or less applicable to a particular case, they are often used in conjunction
to arrive at the fair value of a company/asset/business. The following are some of the methods which are
often used for valuations. The methods enumerated below are merely illustrative and not exhaustive.
Asset Approach
Book Value, Adjusted Book Value, and Liquidation Value
Income Approach
Capitalization of Earnings, Capitalization of Excess Earnings, and
Discounted Future Earnings/Cash Flows.
Market Approach
Current Market Prices, Historical Market Prices, Price to Earnings, Price to Revenue, Price to Book
Value, Price to Enterprise Value, etc.
256 PP-CRVI
Comparable Transactions/Valuations
Comparable International and Domestic Transactions.
The valuation methodology adopted by the valuer has to be disclosed. The valuer should mention in
the report the rationale and appropriateness for the adoption of a particular method or a combination
of methods and emphasis/reliance placed on the chosen method/combination of methods in
reaching the final conclusion.
10. Conclusion
In conclusion, the report must contain a clear statement of the value ascribed to the business/assets in
question.
Lesson 15
structuring the foreign ventures, Ranbaxy focused on the entire value chain to maximize margins. In
February 2004, Ranbaxy crossed as $1 billion mark in its turnover.
In 2003, a gain a strategic planning revival exercise took place with a new plan in place called Vision 2012:
-
The company has decided to focus on the following therapeutic areas to meet its Vision 2012:
-
Inflammatory/Respiratory diseases
Rheumatoid Arthritis).
(Asthma, Chronic
These choices allow Ranbaxy to enter large markets with significant unattended medical needs and to build
on its research strengths. In 2008, Ranbaxy achieved a consolidated sale of $ 1.7 billion. Its geographic and
therapeutic sales break up is shown in Table 12.6 below:
Table 1 Geographic and Therapeutic Sales of Ranbaxy in 2008
Region
Major Therapy
North America
27
Anti-infective
37
European Union
20
Cardiovascular
16
India
18
Gastrointestinal
NA
Musculoskeletal
Respiratory
12
Particulars
Number of Shares
92,519,126
% of
Shareholding
22.01
258 PP-CRVI
46,258,063
11.00
81,913,234
19.49
48,020,900
11.42
268,711,323
63.92
Total
How much did Daiichi-Sankyo pay
Nature of Transaction
169,407
230,970
(Gain of Promoters)
Share purchases by issuances of new shares
85,001
2,974
Total
488,352
78.8
2.0
10.0
5.9
41.0
6.9
(20.0)
(45.0)
408.7
483.3
737
th
593/300
30982 crores
$8.5 billion
th
10434 crores
83.69
Lesson 15
In Yens
Billion
97.6
(215.5)
413.8
264.3
49.4
0.1
Remarks
Recording of Y 351.3 billion in extraordinary
losses due to a one-time write-off goodwill
pertaining to the investment in Ranbaxy.
Financing of Deal
Daiichi-Sankyo funded the acquisition through debt and existing cash reserves. Daiichi-Sankyo has taken a
short and long term loans of 240 billion yens. Thats almost 50% of the total funding requirement of the deal2.
Strategic Reasons
The acquisition shall pave this way for creating a new and complementary hybrid business model that
provides sustainable growth by diversification that spans the full spectrum of pharma business. The expected
synergistic benefits are summarized in the exhibit below:
Presence in
Emerging
Markets for
Daiichi-Sankyo
Geographic
Entry into
non-proprietary
drugs for
Daiichi-Sankyo
Product extention
Synergy
Realisation of
Sustainable
Growth through a
complementary
business model
Acceleration
of innovation
drug creation
by optimizing
value chain
efficiency
FIGURE 4
1.
Global down turn and financial crisis has made Daiichi take a huge hit on its balance sheet due to the acquisition of Ranbaxy.
2.
the datas mentioned here in the case has been compiled from Ranbaxy annual report 2008, DIS annual report, websites of
Ranbaxy and DIS.
260 PP-CRVI
While DIS grew at 4.7% in 2007 to $7.12 billion, Ranbaxy grew at over 10% to $ 1.6 billion. While the world
pharma industry grew at 6%, the generic segment is growing at 11%. The pursuit of the hybrid business
model would help DIS to improve its growth rate substantially. Daiichi would be able to extend its reach to 56
countries from 21 countries where they currently operate.
Benefits to Daiichi Sankyo
In addition to the expected synergies, DIS will be benefited most by the low-cost manufacturing infrastructure
and supply chain strengths of Ranbaxy. Further, DIS will be able to bring in efficiency in its operations by
sourcing APIs6 and finished dosage products from Ranbaxys 9 manufacturing plants in India and many
more in other countries.
The R&D facilities of Ranbaxy would be used by DIS to not only reduce some of its R&D expenses, but also
use competencies of Ranbaxy scientists to faster new product development. DIS is also expected to get
Zenotechs expertise in the areas of biologies, oncology and specialty injectibles. (i)
Benefits to Ranbaxy
According to the promoters of Ranbaxy, the deal was meant to take it to the next level of growth. With India
honouring the product Patent regime from 2005, Generic drug companies are finding it more difficult to make
similar versions of innovative drugs. (ii) further, tough times ahead has forced global generic majors to merge
or buy or become generic behemoths, e.g., Sandozs acquisition of German company Hexal in 2005.
Besides, there was a strong feeling that perhaps the game is over for Indian drug companies unless they pull
up their socks and strengthen their R&D. Analysts feel that promoters of Ranbaxy could visualize this in
advance and got the best possible deal while the going was still good and made a very decent, honorable
and attractive exit.
Risk Involved
The Food and Drug Administration (FDA) issued two warning letters to Ranbaxy Laboratories and an Import
Alert for generic drug produced by Ranbaxys Dewas and Paonta Sahib plants in India on 16 September
2008. US officials could detain at the US border, any API and finished drugs manufactured at these plants.
Analysts estimate the loss of business to Ranbaxy as a result of this development to be at $40 million. This
development has resulted in sharp fall of Ranbaxy share price by 6.6% on BSE.
Just a week after DIS announcement Ranbaxy announced the settlement of its protracted multi-country
battle over Pfizers $12 billion cholesterol drug lipitor. Ranbaxy had entered into an agreement wit Pfizer Inc.
to settle most of the patent litigation worldwide over lipitor. After the announcement, Ranbaxy shares saw a
dip by 7.7% as against Bombay Stock Exchange (B.S.E.) dip of 2.2%.
Analysts have expressed their doubt about the price paid for the acquisition as it was quite high compared to
the present pricing of other Indian generic drug making companies. This many put severe strain on DISs
financials.
Notes:
1. In October 03, 2007, Ranbaxy entered into share purchase agreement with the promoters of
Zenotech Laboratories Ltd. (ZLL) for acquiring 27.35% shares of ZLL at a price of 160 per share.
On the completion of the above acquisition, Ranbaxy made the public announcement to the
shareholders of ZLL to acquire upto 20% shares at a price of 160 per share. On the completion of
the above acquisition, Ranbaxy holds 46.79% shares of ZLL. As on October 20, 2008, Ranbaxy
held 46.85% shares of ZLL. As a result of acquisition of Ranbaxy by DIS, DIS has indirectly
Lesson 15
acquired 46.85% shares of ZLL. In July, the Madurai bench of the Madras High Court had given
stay on the open offer, following complaints made by minority shareholders. However, DIS got relief
from the Supreme Court to go ahead with the offer.
2. India changed its policy of Patent regime from product to process in 1970 after enactment of Indian
Patent Act. This has opened doors of reverse engineering to prepare formulations. This has helped
Indian pharma companies in developing their capabilities at manufacturing low cost APIs, which
global majors were selling at extremely high prices. In 2005, the wheel of patent perfection came a
full circle as India amended the Patent Act, to recognize the product patent under the obligation of
WTO regime.
3. Under the agreement, Ranbaxy will delay the start of its 180 days exclusively period for a generic
version of lipitor, until November 2011. While the settlement avoided further legal cost for Ranbaxy
in fighting Pfizer, if it had won the case, Ranbaxy could have introduced generic version as early as
March 2010.
4. DIS plans to record a valuation loss of $3.99 billion on its shares in its India based subsidiary
Ranbaxy Laboratories to reflect the decline in the market value of shares.
On a non correlated basis DIS plans to record a non-cash valuation loss of $3.99 billion on its shares in
Ranbaxy in its third quarter to reflect a more than 50% decline in market value of these securities versus the
purchase price. The company said in a statement on the companys website.
DIS sees no impact on its forecasts for non-consolidated net-sales, operating income or ordinary income for
the third-quarter as a result of these anticipated extraordinary losses. The company also sees no impact in
cash flows. However, these items will have a significant negative impact on the companys consolidated
financial results for the net income for the year 2008-09. Reacting to this news DIS shares fell 1.2% on the
Tokyo stock exchange.
262 PP-CRVI
transaction may not be covered by Section 2(42C). The consideration for transfer is a lump sum
consideration. This consideration should be arrived at without assigning values to individual assets and
liabilities.
As regards the valuation of slump sale it is appropriate to brief the provisions of Section 50B of the Income
Tax Act, 1961.
Section 50B provides the mechanism for computation of capital gains arising on slump sale. Capital gains
arising on slump sale are calculated as the difference between sale consideration and the net worth of the
undertaking. Net worth is deemed to be the cost of acquisition and cost of improvement for the purpose of
calculation of capital gains tax.
Net worth is defined in Explanation 1 to Section 50B as the difference between the aggregate value of total
assets of the undertaking or division and the value of its liabilities as appearing in books of account
The aggregate value of total assets of the undertaking or division is the sum total of :
1. WDV as determined u/s.43(6)(c)(i)(C) in case of depreciable assets.
2. The book value in case of other assets.
Lesson 15
Explanation 2.For the purposes of this clause, the liabilities referred to in sub-clause (ii), shall include
(a) the liabilities which arise out of the activities or operations of the undertaking;
(b) the specific loans or borrowings (including debentures) raised, incurred and utilised solely for the
activities or operations of the undertaking; and
(c) in cases, other than those referred to in clause (a) or clause (b), so much of the amounts of general
or multipurpose borrowings, if any, of the demerged company as stand in the same proportion
which the value of the assets transferred in a demerger bears to the total value of the assets of such
demerged company immediately before the demerger.
Explanation 3.For determining the value of the property referred to in sub-clause (iii), any change in the
value of assets consequent to their revaluation shall be ignored.
Explanation 4.For the purposes of this clause, the splitting up or the reconstruction of any authority or a
body constituted or established under a Central, State or Provincial Act, or a local authority or a public sector
company, into separate authorities or bodies or local authorities or companies, as the case may be, shall be
deemed to be a demerger if such split up or reconstruction fulfils 81[such conditions as may be notified in the
Official Gazette 82, by the Central Government];
As per Section 19AAA demerged company means the company whose undertaking is transferred, pursuant
to a demerger, to a resulting company;
A demerger scheme usually involves the allotment of shares in the transferee company to the shareholders
of the transferor company, in lieu of their reduction of their interest in the transferee company having a mirror
image of shareholdings. If post demerger as part of strategy, intention is to create holding subsidiary
relationship or retain part stake than it is possible to allot shares of the transferee company to the transferor
company.
In the context of a demerger scheme, a valuation exercise is mandatory in order to determine the number of
shares to be issued to the shareholders of the transferor company in consideration for the spin off/demerger
of the undertaking or undertakings If demerger is going to be in Shell Company, than valuation is primarily
to determine the capital structure of the Transferee/Resultant Company.
If the demerged and resulting companies belong to same group of management and shareholders are
common, share exchange ratio based on Net Asset Based valuation model may be adopted. Any other
business valuation method may also be adopted considering the same shareholding as it will not impact
value for the shareholders in demerged company post-demerger. In ideal situation like the companies are
profitable and shareholders are different, it is recommendable to use Profit Based Valuation model for
deciding on the share exchange ratio. While demerging to the shell company, there is no value of the shell
company. Therefore, any no of shares may be issued to the shareholders of the demerged company as
there will not be any impact on the shareholders wealth.
There may be various situations and objectives wherein demerger schemes are implemented. Fair valuation
only considers the status of the businesses and other macro factors but it also considers very big picture of
implication of valuation/share exchange ratio. It does also consider costs such as stamp duty involved in
adopting any valuation model.
VALUATION OF BRANDS
Blacks Dictionary defines it as a word, mark, symbol, design, term, or a combination of these, both visual
and oral, used for the purpose of identification of some product or service.
It is the hallmark of a shrewd businessman to commence his business with a roadmap of his plans. In the
264 PP-CRVI
course of his business, he applies a unique mark or symbol or word to his goods. When his customer base
increases, his goods acquire reasonable reputation and his customers begin identifying his goods by the
unique mark or symbol or word he had so adopted, his goods earn the reputation of being branded goods.
What applies to goods applies to services also. When brands take charge of consumers minds, the name of
its proprietor takes the backseat. There lies the power of brands.
Functions of Brands
Brands indicate the
origin of goods
Brands connect the consumers
mind to the manufacturer or
service provider
Lesson 15
To ensure that attempts to use fake brands that are similar or deceptively similar are challenged
with full force so as to spread the message that the Company is conscious of the value of its brand
and it will be aggressive in taking steps not only to put an end to such illegal, dishonest and
unauthorized use but also to punish such users and claim exemplary damages from those who had
passed off their goods to people and those who are found to be guilty of infringement.
To ensure that there is always a budget allocation for promoting the brand and the Company should
devise a continuous process for being present in the existing markets and prospective markets.
To ensure that there is a conspicuous distinction in the description of the brand when it is used to
sell premium products as opposed to use of the same brand for selling goods to the masses.
To ensure that the extent of growth in the value of the brand very year is always higher than the
depreciation or dent that existing or new competition may cause.
To adopt a proper policy with regard to slogans and catchy phrases so that the Company does not
knowingly cause any infringement of the industrial and intellectual property rights of any other
person in any country or territory.
To adopt a proper policy with regard to statements made in advertisements carrying the brand in
order to ensure that those statements are not mere attractive words and they would stand the test of
the market.
To adopt a proper policy to augment IP profile of the Company and constantly update and upgrade
the same.
For the purpose of valuation of brands, it may be necessary to make a through enquiry into the policies and
business of the company to the extent they relate to brands. For such enquiry, the following questionnaire
may prove to be helpful:
Sl. No.
Query
1.
What are the brands requiring valuation? Please mention all its variants and styles also.
2.
3.
Does the company use the brand owned by any third party?
4.
What are goods or products that are sold under those brands?
5.
6.
7.
8.
Whether the brands of the company have been registered under the Trademarks Act, 1999?
9.
Whether there has been any opposition to registration of the any of the Brands of your
company?
10.
What are the Brands/Trademarks which have not yet been registered though necessary
applications have been filed already with the Registrar of Trademarks?
11.
Whether the artistic works contained in the brands of the company have been registered
under the Copyrights Act,1957?
12.
Whether your company has adopted any slogan or catchy phrase to highlight the policy of
your company or its branded goods?
266 PP-CRVI
13.
What is the turnover of the company from goods sold under brand? (Brand-wise data from
three financial years may be provided)
14.
15.
16.
How does the company take its products to its ultimate customers?
17.
Has the company any brand adoption policy? Please furnish a copy of the policy.
18.
Has the company granted may permission to any party for brand use? Please provide a copy
of Licence agreement if any.
19.
20.
Has there been any advertisement about the brands? Please furnish complete details
regarding advertisements in the print media/electronic media?
21.
Whether there have been any radio commercial programmes of your companys brands?
22.
Hs there been any use of the brand in any country other than India?
23.
What are the most prominent states in India where the branded goods of the company sell
significantly?
24.
Can you give product wise turnover for three financial years?
25.
Can you furnish state wise turnover for three financial years?
26.
Can you furnish names of the States where the products of the Company are not sold at all?
27.
Can you furnish details of those products, which though manufactured by the company are
sold without applying any brand?
28.
Can you furnish details of those goods that are sold by your company as branded goods
even though they are simultaneously sold without applying those brands?
29.
Is there any product that the company gets manufactured through any other party (such as a
sub-contractor) who puts the brand of the company upon those goods and delivers to the
company?
30.
What is the budget of the company for its advertisement and publicity for three financial
years? How much of the same could be related to brand promotion?
31.
Who are the major competitors of your companys goods? What are their brands? How those
brands are superior or inferior to your companys brands?
32.
What is the total market India for the goods of your company? Please give details in value
terms and in quantity terms if possible.
33.
34.
35.
In your opinion would the price of branded goods sold is higher than the price of same goods
sold without brands? (You may consider a market place where two traders are selling the
same or similar goods, your company selling those goods as branded goods and the other
trader selling his goods without any brand).
Lesson 15
36.
Do you think because of Brands the goods of your company have been commanding higher
(premium) valuation?
37.
Do you think your company has not reached out to customers adequately in respect of any
territory?
38.
Could you please provide financial projections for the next three financial years?
39.
Has there been any raid or criminal action against sale of spurious goods similar to your
goods upon which the Brands of your company or any brand deceptively similar to the
Brands of your company have been used?
40.
Has your company ever given any warning or caution notice about Brands of your company?
41.
Has your company at any time opposed the registration of any brand or trademarks of any
other person?
42.
Has your company issued any legal notice to any party against misuse of any Brands of your
company?
43.
Has there been any suit against any party for passing off or infringement of any of the Brands
of your company?
44.
Has there been any legal notice or legal action against your company alleging copying or
misuse of brands of others?
45.
Has there been any valuation of any of the Brands of your company at any time before this?
VALUATION APPROACH
Basically in an enterprise, physical resources are of the following two types:
Machinery, that work with applied force;
Men who work.
Both the above assets are capable of being organized provided the two vital inputs are present; viz., money
and knowledge.
Brands belong to a different species. While physical resources could be created easily if augmenting
financial resources is not a problem, same is not the case of brands. That is why there is always a premium
price for buying branded goods rather than the business or plants and equipments. In the case of Brands,
the ability of the Company to leverage the same to bring revenues in other territories and markets is of
paramount importance.
As already seen, the value of an enterprise could be estimated on a going-concern basis by computing the
earning capacity. Net Asset Value method may not be ideal in the cases enterprises with depreciating assets
unless the enterprise in question is asset intensive. For instance, in the case of company engaged in real
estate sector, the lands in the hands of the company on ownership basis could be a stock in trade and they
may be highly valuable. However, in the case of Brands, which form the lifeline of the Company, there has to
be a different approach.
According to an Article that appeared in the Hindu Business Line (of Mr. G. Ramachandran, a financial
analyst and Mr. R. Vijay Shankar, Director of SSN School of Management and Computer Applications) the
hands that hold a brand will determine how much value will be created. Therefore, a brands value is
268 PP-CRVI
inestimable. There are no commodity-like, normative valuation methods. Brands will defy any attempts aimed
at valuing them. That is what makes brands mystical. They will trample upon the egos of those that are
mechanistically minded. Mr. David Haigh, Chief Executive, Brand Finance, and Mr. M. Unni Krishnan,
Country Manager, Brand Finance, are of the view that traditional measures of financial performance do not
reveal fully the value of brands (Praxis, Business Lines Journal on Management, May 2005). Mr. Haigh and
Mr. Krishnan bemoan the fact that earnings per share (EPS) and dividend yield look back rather than
forward.
Cost Approach for valuation of Brands may not help. The cost incurred in the initial years would not have
been very high as all resources should have been used up for setting up manufacturing facility and sales
force to give customers high quality Products for value and to ensure that customers are happy. In the case
of a premium brand, a company may be incurring expenditure in order to capitalize the position and expand
the territories and to ward off competition. Therefore for every rupee incurred by the Company on an
established brand, returns would be manifold. This enables the Company to introduce the brand for new
products and new markets. In order to retain the ability of the Brand to reach an expanded customer base, it
is essential that the company have adequate physical resources and a favourable industrial outlook. Thus
depending upon the facts and circumstances of each case, suitable method of valuation of the brands should
be adopted. In the case of a premium brand, the price of the products that are sold under the premium brand
may command a premium price as compared to any other similar product that is sold under an ordinary
brand or without any brand. The price differential between the goods carrying premium brand and other
similar goods would show the extent of premium the branded goods command. Taking the said premium as
an indicator, it is possible to evaluate the value of the brand using the usual cash flow model of valuation.
Students should refer to the section on case studies to see a case of typical brand valuation.
Investors have become more active in protecting their value. Any transaction of purchase/ sale of business/
companies require determination of fair value for the transaction to satisfy stakeholders and/or Regulators.
Business valuation is an unformulated and subjective process. Understanding the finer points of valuing a
business is a skill that takes time to perfect. There are various methodologies for valuing a business, all
having different relevance depending on the purpose of valuation. Key aspects of valuation along with
various restructuring options have been explained hereunder:
A clear understanding of the purpose for which the valuation is being attempted is very important aspect to
be kept in mind before commencement of the valuation exercise. The structure of the transactions also plays
very important role in determining the value. For example, if only assets are being transferred out from a
Company, valuation of equity shares is of no importance. The general purpose value may have to be
suitably modified for the special purpose for which the valuation is done. The factors affecting that value with
reference to the special purpose must be judged and brought into final assessment in a sound and
reasonable manner.
LESSON ROUND UP
Corporate valuation is not only a pre-requisite during different types of restructuring phase of the company.
It is required at frequent intervals to identify the economic value creation and any destruction if any
occurred.
The process of valuation includes a detailed and comprehensive analysis taking into an account the past
present and future earnings prospects and analysis of physical and intangible assets and general economic
and industry conditions.
The valuation of shares is a technical matter. It requires considerable skill and experience. There are bound
to be differences of opinion among accountants as to what is the correct value of the shares of a company.
Lesson 15
Slump sale as transfer of one or more undertakings as a result of the sale for a lump sum consideration
without values being assigned to the individual assets and liabilities.
Section 50B of the Income Tax Act, 1961 provides the mechanism for computation of capital gains arsing
on slump sale. Capital gains arising on slump sale are calculated as the difference between sale
consideration and the net worth of the undertaking. Net worth is deemed to be the cost of acquisition and
cost of improvement for the purpose of calculation of capital gains tax.
Demerged company means the company whose undertaking is transferred, pursuant to a demerger, to a
resulting company.
A demerger scheme usually involves the allotment of shares in the transferee company to the shareholders
of the transferor company, in lieu of their reduction of their interest in the transferee company having a
mirror image of shareholders. If post demerger as part of strategy, intention is to create holding subsidiary
relationship or retain part stake than it is possible to allot shares of the transferee company to the transferor
company.
Blacks Dictionary defines brand as a word, mark, symbol, design, term, or a combination of these, both
visual and oral, used for the purpose of identification of some product or service.
270 PP-CRVI
Lesson 16
Insolvency Concepts and Evolution
LESSON OUTLINE
Insolvency/Bankruptcy-the concepts
Historical developments
Laws in India
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
The laws relating to insolvencies and bankruptcies in
of Insolvency
A brief on historical
insolvency laws in UK
background
of
272 PP-CRVI
The most relevant laws at present, governing corporate insolvency and bankruptcy in India are:
The Companies Act of 1956. The Companies Act governs liquidation of a company in financial
distress via: (i) voluntary winding-up; (ii) involuntary winding-up by the courts; or (iii) winding-up
Lesson 16
subject to supervision by the courts which has been deleted by Companies (Amendment Act)
2002 and yet to be notified.
The Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 (SICA). SICA was developed as
Indias version of a comprehensive bankruptcy framework for sick industrial companies and
provides a program for the reconstruction of these companies under the supervision of the Board
for Industrial and Financial Reconstruction (BIFR). SICA, however, only applies to sick
companies in select industries that have been incorporated for at least five years, have at least
50 workers on any day in the preceding 12 months and have a factory license. Although
technically, SICA has been repealed by the Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions)
Repeal Act, 2003 (the Repealing Act), it still continues to be good law today because, to date,
the Repealing Act has not yet come into force.
The Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security Interests
Act, 2002 (SARFAESIA). SARFAESIA empowers banks or financial institutions with a presence
in India or which have been notified by the Government of India to recover on non-performing
assets without court intervention. An asset is classified as non-performing if interest or
installments of principal due remain unpaid for more than 180 days. SARFAESIA provides three
alternative methods for recovery of non-performing assets, including taking possession, selling
and leasing the assets underlying the security interests such as movable property (tangible or
intangible, including accounts receivable) and immovable property without the intervention of the
courts. The SARFESIA is not available to secured creditors, which are not Indian banks, or
financial institutions notified.
274 PP-CRVI
Company Liquidators
The Tribunal may appoint Provisional Liquidator or the Company Liquidator from a panel maintained
by the Central Government consisting of Company Secretaries, Chartered Accountants, Advocates
and Cost and Works Accountants.
United Kingdom
A Brief on Historical background on UK insolvency framework
In England, the first bankruptcy law was enacted in 1542, being Statute 34 Henry VIII. Under this act a
debtor was still looked upon as in a sense an offender, and the law was mainly for the benefit of creditors,
providing for an equal distribution of the debtor's assets among his creditors, but not releasing the debtor
from his debts. The early bankruptcy laws of England was exclusively an instrument of debt-collection: its
finality was to seize the debtors assets against the strong protections to private property offered by the
Common law, since medieval times. The procedure thus worked rather as a continuation of private remedies,
with different, collective, legal instruments.
The Current Regulatory Framework in UK
The 1982 Report of the Insolvency Law review Committee, Insolvency Laws and Practice (commonly known
as the Cork Report) recommended the adoption in the United Kingdom of Unified Insolvency legislation.
Ultimately the Insolvency Act, 1986 (UK) was enacted and this encompasses both types of insolvency
administrations, including corporate restructuring.
The existing UK insolvency framework is defined by the Insolvency Act 1986. According to the Act, failing
companies are either liquidated or submitted to an insolvency process that may allow them to be rescued as
going concerns.
The Insolvency Act, 1986 deals the insolvency of individuals and companies. The Act is divided into three
groups and 14 Schedules as follows:
Group 1 deals with Company Insolvency
Group 2 deals with Insolvency of Individuals and
Group 3 deals with Miscellaneous Matters Bearing on both Company & Individual Insolvency
Lesson 16
Basically, a company in financial difficulties may be made subject to any of five statutory procedures.
1. administration;
2. company voluntary arrangement;
3. scheme of arrangement;
4. receivership (including administrative receivership); and
5. liquidation (winding-up).
With the exception of schemes of arrangement, which fall within the ambit of the Companies Act, 2006, these
are formal insolvency procedures governed by the Insolvency Act, 1986.
The administration procedure was introduced by the insolvency Act, 1986 and substantially revised by the
Enterprise Act, 2002 to include a streamlined procedure allowing the company or (more often) its directors to
appoint an administrator without the involvement of the Court subject to conditions.
Firms are in fact liquidated if they become the subject of a compulsory liquidation order obtained from the
court by a creditor, shareholder or director. Alternatively, the company may itself decide to pass a liquidation
resolution subject to the approval of a creditors' meeting for the company to be wound-up (a Creditors
Voluntary Liquidation). Either way, the result of both these procedures is the winding-up of the company.
Neither process makes any attempt to rescue or sustain the company as a legal entity.
The Insolvency Act 1986 also introduced three new procedures that held out the possibility of a company
being brought back to life as a viable entity. These measures represented an attempt to emulate the rescue
culture that characterised the corporate sector in the US.
The first of these procedures company voluntary arrangements (CVAs) provides a way in which a
company in financial difficulty can come to a binding agreement with its creditors.
The second procedure administration offers companies a breathing space during which creditors are
restrained from taking action against them. During this period, an administrator is appointed by a court to put
forward proposals to deal with the companys financial difficulties.
A third option administrative receivership permits the appointment of a receiver by certain creditors
(normally the holders of a floating charge) with the objective of ensuring repayment of secured debts.
The Enterprise Act 2002 attempted to embed a rescue culture by creating entry routes into administration
that did not require a court order, and simplified the means by which a company could emerge from
administration. It also prohibited with certain exceptions the right of creditors to appoint an administrative
receiver (which had previously blocked a companys ability to opt for administration).
In addition, the Act explicitly established a hierarchy of purposes for the administration process. The primary
duty of administrators was defined as rescuing the company as a going concern (a duty that does not exist
for an administrative receiver). Only if this is not practicable or not in the interests of creditors as a whole
is the administrator allowed to consider other options, such as realising the value of property in order to
make a distribution to creditors.1
1 Inputs taken from Does the UK need Chapter 11 Written by Dr Roger Barker, Head CG at IOD.
276 PP-CRVI
US Bankruptcy laws2
The evolution of Insolvency Laws in US along with timeline
As we read earlier, England first established a bankruptcy law in 1542. Under the English law, bankruptcy
was treated as a criminal act punishable by imprisonment or death. Only merchants were eligible for
bankruptcy and only creditors could institute bankruptcy proceedings.
The English bankruptcy system was the model for bankruptcy laws in the English colonies in America and in
the American states after independence from England in 1776.
Early American bankruptcy laws were only available to merchants and generally involved imprisonment until
debts were paid or until property was liquidated or creditors agreed to the release of the debtor. The laws
were enacted by each individual state and were inconsistent and discriminatory. For example, the laws and
courts of one state might not enforce debts owed to citizens of other states or debts of certain types. The
system was not uniform and some states became known as debtors havens because of their unwillingness
to enforce commercial obligations.
The lack of uniformity in bankruptcy and debt enforcement laws hindered business and commerce between
the states. The United States Constitution as adopted in 1789 provides in Article I, Section 8, Clause 4 that
the states granted to Congress the power to establish uniform laws on the subject of bankruptcies throughout
the United States.
To establish an uniform Rule of Naturalization, and uniform Laws on the subject of Bankruptcies throughout
the United States;
Article I, Section 8, Clause 4 of US Constitution
However, until 1898 there was no bankruptcy law in continuous effect in the United States. The Congress
enacted temporary bankruptcy statutes in 1800, 1841 and 1867 to deal with economic downturns. However,
those laws were temporary measures and were repealed as soon as economic conditions stabilized. The
Act of 1800 was repealed in 1803. The Act of 1841 was repealed in 1843 and the Act of 1867 only lasted
until 1878.
These early laws only permitted merchants, traders, bankers and factors to be placed in bankruptcy
proceedings. The Acts of 1800 and 1841 vested jurisdiction in the federal district courts. The district court
judges were given the power to appoint commissioners or assignees to take charge of and liquidate a
debtors property.
A permanent bankruptcy statute was not enacted until 1898. The National Bankruptcy Act of 1898 was
based upon the liquidation of a debtors non-exempt assets to pay creditors. In 1938 the law was amended
to provide for the rehabilitation or reorganization of a debtor as an alternative to liquidation of assets. The
Bankruptcy Act of 1898, together with its amendments, was known as the Bankruptcy Act. Under the
Bankruptcy Act, the district court had jurisdiction over bankruptcy cases, but could appoint a referee in
bankruptcy to oversee the administration of bankruptcy cases, the allowance of claims and the distribution of
payments to creditors. The Bankruptcy Act governed bankruptcy in the United States for 80 years.
After a series of critical studies and review of the then existing law and practice, Congress passed the
Bankruptcy Reform Act of 1978.
Some inputs in the given paragraphs were taken from the Article by History Of Bankruptcy Law In The United States, Prepared by
J. Michael Deasy,United States Bankruptcy Judge, District of New Hampshire in May 2004
Lesson 16
Since 19783
The US Congress enacted the "Bankruptcy Code" in 1978. The Bankruptcy Code, which is codified as title
11 of the United States Code, has been amended several times since its enactment. It is the uniform federal
law that governs all bankruptcy cases.
The procedural aspects of the bankruptcy process are governed by the Federal Rules of Bankruptcy
Procedure (often called the "Bankruptcy Rules") and local rules of each bankruptcy court. The Bankruptcy
Rules contain a set of official forms for use in bankruptcy cases. The Bankruptcy Code and Bankruptcy
Rules (and local rules) set forth the formal legal procedures for dealing with the debt problems of individuals
and businesses.
Six basic types of bankruptcy cases are provided for under the Bankruptcy Code.
Chapter 11, entitled Reorganization, ordinarily is used by commercial enterprises that desire to
continue operating a business and repay creditors concurrently through a court-approved plan of
reorganization..
Chapter 12 allows a family farmer or fisherman to continue to operate the business while the
plan is being carried out.
Chapter 13, enables individuals with regular income to develop a plan to repay all or part of
their debts. Under this chapter, debtors propose a repayment plan to make installments to
creditors over three to five years.
Chapter 15 is to provide effective mechanisms for dealing with insolvency cases involving
debtors, assets, claimants, and other parties of interest involving more than one country.
1787 - The U.S. Constitution (Article I, sec. 8) authorizes Congress to establish uniform
bankruptcy laws throughout the nation..
Bankruptcy Act of 1800, the first federal bankruptcy law, the Act authorizes district court judges
to appoint nonjudicial commissioners to oversee and help administer bankruptcy proceedings.
1803- Citing excessive costs and corruption, Congress repeals the Act of 1800.
Bankruptcy Act of 1841 grants district courts jurisdiction in all matters and proceedings in
bankruptcy, including developing rules for proceedings and appointing bankruptcy commissioners and assignees.
1843 High administrative costs, lack of state law exemptions, and creditor frustration lead to the
1841 Acts repeal.
278 PP-CRVI
Bankruptcy Act of 1867(14 Stat. 517) marks the first time Congress refers to district courts as
constituted courts of bankruptcy with original jurisdiction in all bankruptcy matters.
1874 Congress amends the 1867 Act so that debtors can create a plan for distributing assets
among creditors as a way to settle a case
1878 In response to abuses and excessive fees, Congress repeals the Acts of 1867 and 1874.
Bankruptcy Act of 1898(30 Stat. 544), is the first long-term bankruptcy legislation. In effect for
the next 80 years, the Act establishes the position of referee to oversee administration of
bankruptcy cases. Referees are appointed to two-year terms by the district judge and can be
removed only for incompetency, misconduct, or neglect of duty. They are paid a percentage of
funds brought into the estate. Besides the referee position, the 1898 Act establishes the office of
trustee (previously assignee) in bankruptcy. In general, the Act is perceived as pro-debtor,
establishing relatively narrow exceptions to discharge. Corporations are ineligible for voluntary
relief, but some can be involuntary debtors. (Amendments enacted in 1910 make corporations
eligible for voluntary bankruptcy.
Chandler Act of 1938 (52 Stat. 840, 841), an overhaul of the 1898 Act, reworks previous
reorganization amendments into Chapters:
Bankruptcy Reform Act of 1978 (92 Stat. 2657), superseding the 1898 Act, establishes
bankruptcy courts in each district and allows for separate bankruptcy judges, appointed by the
President and confirmed by the Senate, to serve 14-year terms beginning in 1984. While
bankruptcy courts may now hear all matters arising in or related to bankruptcy cases, judges
remain non- Article III adjuncts of the district courts. Also, a new Chapter 11 (replacing X, XI, and
XII) and Chapter 13, which offers a super discharge, make filing and reorganizing easier for
businesses and individuals.
Bankruptcy Reform Act of 1994(Public Law 103-394) creates the second National Bankruptcy
Commission to investigate changes in bankruptcy law. The Act expands bankruptcy courts
ability to hold jury trials in some proceedings and encourages circuit councils to establish
bankruptcy appellate panels.
Bankruptcy Abuse Prevention and Consumer Protection Act of 2005 attempts to overhaul
1978 code with specific reference to consumer protection, restoring personal responsibilities and
integrity in the bankruptcy system.
LESSON ROUND UP
Insolvency is when an individual, corporation, or other organization cannot meet its financial obligations for
paying debts as they are due. Bankruptcy is not exactly the same as insolvency.
The Presidency Towns Insolvency Act, 1909 and Provisional Insolvency Act, 1920 are two major
enactments that deal with personal insolvency.
Corporate insolvencies in India are majorly governed by the Companies Act, SICA, The Securitisation and
Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security Interests Act, 2002.
In England, the first bankruptcy law was enacted in 1542, being Statute 34 Henry VIII.
Six basic types of bankruptcy cases are provided for under the Bankruptcy Code.
Lesson 16
Chapter 11, entitled Reorganization, ordinarily is used by commercial enterprises that desire to continue
operating a business.
Chapter 12 allows a family farmer or fisherman to continue to operate the business while the plan is being
carried out.
Chapter 13, enables individuals with regular income to develop a plan to repay all or part of their debts.
Chapter 15 is to provide effective mechanisms for dealing with insolvency cases involving debtors, assets,
claimants, and other parties of interest involving more than one country.
280 PP-CRVI
Lesson 17
Revival and Restructuring of Sick
Companies
LESSON OUTLINE
Background SICA
Genesis-SICA
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
In the wake of the widespread industrial sickness
during the eighties, the Government of India enacted a
special legislation namely the Sick Industrial
Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 (SICA) for
determining the preventive, ameliorative, remedial and
other measures which were required to be taken in
respect of sick industrial companies and for
expeditious enforcement of the measures determined.
The major constraint of the Act was that it was
applicable only to sick industrial companies keeping
away other companies which are in trading, service or
other activities. Secondly the immunity was provided
under Section 22 of SICA was being misused. Thus
the legislative intent of revival and rehabilitation of sick
companies could not be fulfilled. Hence Companies
(Second Amendment) Act, 2002 brought certain
amendments under which the powers of BIFR (Board
for Industrial and Financial Reconstruction) were to be
exercised by NCLT (National Company Law Tribunal)
to be constituted under Section 10FB of Companies
Act, 1956 and appeal against order of NCLT could be
referred to NCLAT (National Company Law Appellate
Tribunal) to be constituted under Section 10FR of
Companies Act, 1956. However, these amendments
are not yet notified.
Further, the Companies Bill 2012 provides for time
bound rehabilitation or liquidation process and winding
up is resorted only when the revival is not feasible.
After reading this lesson you should be able to
understand the existing law and procedure provided
under Sick Industrial Companies Act, 1956, an over
view of revival mechanism provided under the
companies bill 2012.
282 PP-CRVI
1. Background SICA1
In the wake of sickness in the countrys industrial climate prevailing in the eighties, the Government of India
set up in 1981, a Committee of Experts under the Chairmanship of Shri T.Tiwari to examine the matter and
recommend suitable remedies therefore. Based on the recommendations of the Committee, the Government
of India enacted a special legislation namely, the Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 (1
of 1986) commonly known as the SICA.
The main objective of SICA is to determine sickness and expedite the revival of potentially viable units or
closure of unviable units (unit here in refers to a Sick Industrial Company). It was expected that by revival,
idle investments in sick units will become productive and by closure, the locked up investments in unviable
units would get released for productive use elsewhere.
The Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 (hereinafter called the Act) was enacted with a
view to securing the timely detection of sick and potential sick companies owning industrial undertakings, the
speedy determination by a body of experts of the preventive, ameliorative, remedial and other measure
which need to be taken with respect to such companies and the expeditious enforcement of the measures so
determined and for matters connected therewith or incidental thereto.
The Board of experts named the Board for Industrial and Financial Reconstruction (BIFR) was set up in
th
January, 1987 and functional with effect from 15 May 1987. The Appellate Authority for Industrial and
Financial Reconstruction (AAIRFR) was constituted in April 1987. Government companies were brought
under the purview of SICA in 1991 when extensive changes were made in the Act including, inter-alia,
changes in the criteria for determining industrial sickness.
The major constraint of the SICA was that it was applicable only to sick industrial companies keeping away
other companies which are in trading, service or other activities. The Act was modified in 1991 to include
within its purview the Government companies by Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Amendment Act,
1991 which came into force w.e.f. 28.12.91.
However, the overall experience was not satisfactory because of various factors including non-applicability of
SICA to non industrial companies and small/ancillary companies, misuse of immunity provided under Section
22 of SICA etc. Hence vide Companies (Second Amendment) Act, 2002, the powers of BIFR (Board for
Industrial and Financial Reconstruction) were to be exercised by NCLT (National Company Law Tribunal) to
be constituted under Section 10FB of Companies Act, 1956 and appeal against order of NCLT could be
referred to NCLAT (National Company Law Appellate Tribunal) to be constituted under Section 10FR of
Companies Act, 1956. These provisions are yet to be notified. Further, Companies Bill 2012 also provides
for speedy recovery of sick companies.
Students may note that though Companies(Amendment) Act 2002 have been passed by Parliament, SICA
has not yet been repealed and also Part VI A consisting of Section 424A to 424L inserted by the
Companies (Second Amendment) Act 2002 has not yet been made effective. Till SICA is repealed the sick
companies (including government companies) will continue to be under BIFR.
1 http://bifr.nic.in/aboutus.htm
Lesson 17
Government had earlier tried to counter the sickness with some ad-hoc measures.
Nationalisation of Banks and certain other measures provided some temporary relief.
A study group, came to be known as Tandon Committee was appointed by RBI in 1975.
The committee submitted its report to the Govt. in September 1983 and suggested the following:
Thus the SICA came into existence in 1985 and BIFR started functioning from 1987.
The objectives
The preamble of SICA reads as follows:
The Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 (SICA) is an act which makes in public
interest, special provisions, with a view to securing timely detection of sick and potentially sick companies
owning industrial undertakings, speedy determination by a Board of experts of the preventive, ameliorative,
remedial and other measures which need to be taken with respect to such companies and expeditious
enforcement of measures so determined and for matters connected therewith or incidental thereto.
Supreme court in Namit R Kamani v. R.R. Kamani (1988) 4 SCC 387 (1989) 2 Comp LJ 391/AIR 1989 SC
9/(1989) 66 Comp Cas 132(SC) had explained the object of SICA as (a) affording maximum protection to
employment (b) optimising the use of funds and available production assets (c) realising amounts due to
banks, institutions, creditors and (d) providing efficient authority consisting of experts for expeditious
determination of measures to avoid time consuming procedures.
The Statement of Objects and Reasons for enacting the Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act,
1985, (SICA) stated that in order to fully utilise the productive industrial assets, to afford maximum protection
of employment and optimise the use of the funds of the banks and financial institutions, it would be
imperative to revive and rehabilitate the potentially viable, sick industrial companies as quickly as possible. It
also stated that it would be also equally imperative to salvage any productive assets and realise the amounts
due to the banks and financial institutions, to the extent possible, from the non-viable sick industrial
companies.
Applicability
SICA applies to companies both in public and private sectors owning industrial undertakings:(a) pertaining to industries specified in the First Schedule to the Industries (Development and
Regulation) Act, 1951, (IDR Act) except the industries relating to ships and other vessels drawn by
2 http://bifr.nic.in/aboutus.htm
284 PP-CRVI
power and;
(b) not being "small scale industrial undertakings or ancillary industrial undertakings" as defined in
Section 3(j) of the IDR Act.
(c) The criteria to determine sickness in an industrial company are (i) the accumulated losses of the
company to be equal to or more than its net worth i.e. its paid up capital plus its free reserves (ii) the
company should have completed five years after incorporation under the Companies Act, 1956 (iii) it
should have 50 or more workers on any day of the 12 months preceding the end of the financial
year with reference to which sickness is claimed. (iv) it should have a factory license.
Do you know?
Small scale industrial undertakings or ancillary industrial undertakings" as defined in Section 3(j)
of the IDR Act are excluded from the definition of Sick Industrial Company under SICA.
Only scheduled industries as specified in the first schedule of IDR Act are covered under SICA
and not trading, service and other sectors.
Small scale/ancillary, trading and service companies cannot be referred to BIFR, even it
becomes a sick company and requires revival, as it is not covered under the definition of the sick
company.
As per section 3(1)(e) industrial company means a company which owns one or more industrial undertaking. As per the definition
of industrial undertaking in Section 3(1)(f) , it is an industrial undertaking pertaining to a scheduled industry, excluding small scale
industry and ancillary industry as defined in IDR Act.
Net worth means sum total of the paid-up capital and free reserves.
Lesson 17
Operating agency
Under SICA (Section 3(1)(i)
Operating agency means any public financial institution, State level institution, scheduled bank or any other
person as may be specified by general or special order as its agency by the Board for Industrial and
Financial Reconstruction (BIFR).
Under the Companies Act 1956(Section 31AA)
(31AA) "operating agency" means any group of experts consisting of persons having special knowledge of
business or industry in which the sick industrial company is engaged and includes public financial
institutions, State level institution, scheduled bank or any other person as may be specified as the operating
agency by the Tribunal
Where financial assets have been acquired by any securitization company or reconstruction company
No reference shall be made to the Board for Industrial and Financial Reconstruction after the
commencement of the Securitization and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security
Interest Act, 2002, where financial assets have been acquired by any securitization company or
reconstruction company under sub-section (1) of section 5 of that Act.
After the commencement of the Securitization and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of
Security Interest Act, 2002, where a reference is pending before the Board for Industrial and Financial
Reconstruction, such reference shall abate if the secured creditors, representing not less than three-fourth in
value of the amount outstanding against financial assistance disbursed to the borrower of such secured
creditors, have taken any measures to recover their secured debt under sub-section (4) of Section 13 of that
Act.
286 PP-CRVI
information received with respect to such company or upon its own knowledge as to the financial
condition of the company, may make such inquiry as it may deem fit for determining whether the
industrial company has become a sick industrial company.
BIFR may require, by order, any operating agency to enquire into and make a report and complete
its inquiry as expeditiously as possible.
Endeavour should be made to complete the inquiry within sixty days from the commencement of the
inquiry.
As per the explanation given under this section, an inquiry shall be deemed to have commenced
upon the receipt by BIFR of any reference or information or upon its own knowledge reduced to
writing by BIFR.
BIFR has powers to appoint one or more persons to be a special director or special directors of the
company if it deems it necessary to make an inquiry or to cause an inquiry as mentioned above to
be made into any industrial company.
BIFR may issue necessary directions to special directors for proper discharge of duties.
The appointment of a special director referred to in Sub-section (4) shall be valid and effective
notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in the Companies Act, 1956, or in any other law
for the time being in force or in the memorandum and articles of association or any other instrument
relating to the industrial company.
Any provision regarding share qualification, age limit, number of directorships, removal from office
of directors and such like conditions contained in any such law or instrument aforesaid, shall not
apply to any special director appointed by BIFR.
The special director will hold office only during the pleasure of BIFR. He does not incur any
obligation or liability by reason only of his being a director or for anything done or omitted to be done
in good faith in the discharge of his duties as a director or anything in relation thereto. He is not
liable to retirement by rotation and shall not be taken into account for computing the number of
directors liable to such retirement. He is not liable to be prosecuted under any law for anything done
or omitted to be done in good faith in the discharge of his duties in relation to the sick industrial
company.
Lesson 17
operating agency would normally be a public financial institution notified as such by the Board through a
general or special order.
288 PP-CRVI
power in directing reduction of share capital and in issuing further capital at specified rates
without going through process of special resolution
(ii) Merely because NSIC was a Government company within meaning of Companies Act, which had
invested in share capital of SIL, did not imply that petitioner was covered under section 19(1)
(iii) Since publication of proposed scheme had taken place in a State level newspaper, it could be
said that provisions of section 18(3)(a) had been complied with but direction passed by BIFR that
salient features of scheme should be published in one leading newspaper and one State level
vernacular newspaper could not be said to be complied with. However, such a technical defect
should not now be made a reason to negate scheme when various parties had altered their
positions in terms of aspect of reduction of shareholding and consequential acts .
Lesson 17
(b) suggesting a scheme for the financial reconstruction of the sick industrial company.
The Board may, within sixty days of the receipt of the application under sub-section (1), pass such orders
therein as it may deem fit.
290 PP-CRVI
and 32 of that makes it clear that from the date of commencement of an inquiry in regard to any
reference received under Section 15, till passing of an order of winding up by the High Court under
Section 20(2) of SICA, BIFR retains absolute control over the affairs of the company and can either
prevent any sale or permit any sale and the sick industrial company is entirely governed by the
provisions of SICA. On the other hand, once an order of winding up is made by the High Court
under Section 20(2) of SICA, acting on the opinion of BIFR under Section 20(1), the control and
jurisdiction over the company, its affairs and assets passes over to the High Court and BIFR ceases
to have any power to pass any orders or give any directions. The division bench further held that
the company court does not sit in appeal over the orders of BIFR nor exercise power under Articles
226 and 227 of the Constitution.
In the BPL Limiteds case cited above, the court held that the sale of assets of a company by a
secured creditor as per directions of BIFR, prior to the date of winding up order, is not void for want
of leave of the court and there is no question of obtaining any leave or permission of this court.
In National Organic Chemical Industries Limited and Ors. v. N.O.C.I.L. Employees Union 2005 (126)
Companies Cases 922, Sharp Industries Limited (2006) 131 Company Cases, 535 (Bom.) and in
Pharmaceutical Products of India Ltd. in re (2006) 131 Company Cases 747, the Bombay High
Court have held that during pendency of a reference before BIFR, a scheme under Section 319
could be sanctioned. However in Ashok Organic Industries Ltd v. ARCIL, [2008] 114 Comp Cas 144
(Bom.), the Bombay High Court had set aside all the above decisions and held that once the
Industrial Company makes a reference under Section 15 of the SICA, the Company Court would
have no jurisdiction for sanctioning the scheme of arrangement of compromise with its creditors and
shareholders and neither will it have jurisdiction to take cognisance of such an application during the
pendency of the reference.
The High Court has no jurisdiction to sanction a scheme of arrangement presented by a sick
company when the revival scheme of the company was pending before the AAIFR. [Tata Motors
Ltd. v. Pharmaceutical Products of India Ltd. & Anr. (2008 ) 144 Comp Cas 178 (SC)].
when an inquiry under Section 16 is pending in relation to the said industrial company or
when any scheme referred to under Section 17 is under preparation or consideration or a sanctioned
scheme is under implementation or
Where the management of the sick industrial company is taken over or changed in pursuance of any
scheme sanctioned under Section 18, notwithstanding anything contained in the Companies Act,
1956, or any other law or in the memorandum and articles of association of such company or any
instrument having effect under the said Act or other law (a) it shall not be lawful for the
shareholders of such company or any other person to nominate or appoint any person to be a
director of the company; (b) no resolution passed at any meeting of the shareholders of such
company shall be given effect to unless approved by BIFR.
Lesson 17
BIFR may by order declare with respect to the sick industrial company concerned that the operation of all or
any of the contracts, assurances of property, agreements, settlements, awards, standing orders or other
instruments in force, applicable to the sick industrial company in question shall remain suspended or that all
or any of the rights, privileges, obligations, and liabilities accruing or arising thereunder before the said date,
shall remain suspended or shall be enforceable with such adaptations and in such manner as may be
specified by BIFR. Provided that such declaration shall not be made for a period exceeding two years which
may be extended by one year at a time so, however, that the total period shall not exceed seven years in the
aggregate. Any such declaration is valid and is protected notwithstanding anything contained in the
Companies Act, 1956, or any other law or agreement or instrument or any decree or order of a court,
Tribunal, officer or other authority or of any submission, settlement or standing order.
Accordingly, any remedy for the enforcement of any right, privilege, obligation and liability suspended or
modified by such declaration, and all proceedings relating thereto pending before any court, Tribunal, officer
or other authority shall remain stayed or be continued subject to such declaration. On the declaration ceasing
to have effect (i) any right, privilege, obligation or liability so remaining suspended or modified, shall
become revived and enforceable as if the declaration had never been made; and (ii) any proceeding so
remaining stayed shall be proceeded with, subject to the provisions of any law which may then be in force,
from the stage which had been reached when the proceedings became stayed. Obviously from a perusal of
the language contained in Section 22(1) of SICA, it is clear that Section 22 does not grant any immunity
against criminal proceedings against the company or its directors.
The apex court Maharashtra Tubes Limited v. State Industrial and Investment Corporation of Maharashtra
Limited [1993] 78 Comp Cas 803 (SC) held that the idea underlying Section 22(1) of SICA is that every such
action (against the company or its guarantors for recovery of money or enforcement of security) should be
frozen unless expressly permitted by the specified authority until the investigation for the revival of the industrial
undertaking is finally determined. The apex court in Patheja Bros. Forgings and Stamping v. ICICI Limited AIR
2000 CLC 1492: (2000) 4 Comp LJ 9 (SC) held that the words Section 22 are clear and unambiguous and that
they provide that no suit for the enforcement of a guarantee in respect of any loan or advance granted to the
concerned industrial company will lie or can be proceeded with without the consent of BIFR or the appellate
authority. When the words of a legislation are clear, the court must give effect to them as they stand and cannot
demur on the ground that the legislature must have intended otherwise. The apex court clearly held that any
suit for enforcement of the guarantee in respect of loans granted to a sick industrial company cannot be
proceeded with unless consent as required under Section 22 of SICA is obtained.
In, Sun Industries v.Sharda Synthetics (P.) Ltd. [2010] 101 SCL 1 (BOM.) the petitioner-company filed winding
up petition under section 433 of the 1956 Act against the respondent-company claiming unpaid price of goods
sold. The respondent-company contended that it was entitled to protection under section 22 of the 1985 Act in
view of the fact that a reference was registered before the BIFR. The petitioner contended that the orders for
purchase of goods were placed by the respondent after the reference was registered with the BIFR and,
therefore, the respondent must pay for the goods and then seek protection under section 22 of the 1985 Act.
It was held that the respondent-company was not entitled to invoke the protection of section 22 of the 1985
Act in respect of transactions for purchase of goods after the reference was registered with the BIFR. Indeed,
section 22 of the 1985 Act cannot be used as a shield against the recovery of debts such as unpaid price of
goods, particularly when the goods have been purchased after the reference has been registered since such
transactions and the debts incurred thereon are outside the provisions which culminate in a scheme.
The contention of the respondent that the reference was registered with the BIFR on 15-12-2005 and the
company had been declared to be a sick company in the year 2007, as yet no scheme had been framed and,
therefore, unless the scheme was framed the debt could not be construed to be outside the scheme and,
292 PP-CRVI
therefore, the proceedings for winding up would not be tenable by virtue of section 22 of the 1985 Act
appeared attractive, but it was not liable to be accepted having regard to the purpose of the law. [Para 7]
In Unilab Chemicals and Pharmaceuticals v. Smith Stanistreet Pharma-ceuticals Ltd. [2001] 103 Comp. Cas
122 (Bom.) and Vibgyar Ink Chem (P.) Ltd. v. Safe Pack Polymers Ltd. [1998] 93 Comp. Cas. 407 (AP), the
Courts have observed that no proceedings for the recovery, distress or the like should be permitted where a
debt features in the sanctioned scheme because that would upset the arrangement made by the scheme.
That is the real reason for the view that a debt which does not feature in the scheme would not attract the
provisions of section 22 of the 1985 Act. The Courts have held that the bar of section 22 of the 1985 Act
would have no application where in spite of proceedings under the 1985 Act and particularly where a scheme
is framed, the company continues to incur the debts and liability and pleads the bar of section 22 to prevent
recovery of dues under the transactions. In the circumstances, it was to be held that where a company has
consciously entered into transactions, created liabilities and incurred debts, whether an enquiry is pending or
whether the scheme has been framed under the 1985 Act, the bar under section 22 of the 1985 Act would
not apply. There was, thus, no merit in the respondents contention. In the result, the petition was to be
allowed.
Section 22 of SICA cannot be used as a shield against the recovery of debts such as unpaid price of
goods particularly when the goods have been purchased after the reference has been registered.
Can a company make repeated references to BIFR to take shelter under Section 22 SICA?
In case of Alcatel - Lucent India (P) Ltd. vs Usha India Ltd(2012).The petitioner had a monetary decree in its
favour but had not been able to execute the same because of the protection enjoyed by the respondent
under of the Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act 1985. The respondent had been filing
repeated references before the BIFR and getting for itself protection of the provisions of the Act. In a petition,
the petitioner pleaded that the high court should lay down suitable guidelines directing the BIFR to perform a
pre-registration scrutiny (as required in law) before registering future references filed by the respondent to
ensure that there were new and genuine grounds entitling respondent to file the reference and that the
reference was not based on the same grounds, which the BIFR and AAIFR had repeatedly disallowed. The
high court, noting that the instant case appeared to be one where prima facie the provisions of Section 22 of
the Act were taken undue advantage of, disposed of the petition with the direction that BIFR should formulate
necessary Practice Directions within three months and issue the same for compliance.
Revival and rehabilitation of Sick Companies Under the Companies Bill 2012
The concept of Industrial company/undertaking and criterion of Net Worth (as was there in SICA) has been
dropped under this Companies Bill. Sickness has been linked with cash flows and the rights of majority
Secured Creditors are being protected under these provisions. If any Company has failed to
Lesson 17
pay/secure/compound their debt within 30 days of notice to company, they may file an application to Tribunal
for determination of company as sick company.
Where the Tribunal is satisfied that a company has become sick company, it shall after considering all the
relevant facts and circumstances of the case, decide, as soon as may be, by an order in writing, whether it is
practicable for the company to make the repayment of its debts within a reasonable time.
On the determination of sickness by the tribunal, the applicant shall make an application within 60 days of
determination, for measures to be adopted for revival or rehabilitation.
Where the Tribunal determines the Company as Sick and where the company has no draft scheme for its
revival and rehabilitation, the Tribunal may direct the Interim administrator who shall be appointed by
Tribunal from a panel maintained by the Central Govt. When the interim administrator submits his report
about the possibility of revival, then company administrator is appointed who undertakes the approval
process by creditors and submits the same to the tribunal who would sanction the scheme within 60 days of
approval by creditors. The process involved is depicted in the following flow chart for better clarity.
Demand Notice by Secured Creditors
Yes
Issue is settled
Is
Debtor
Satisfy Demand
within 30
days
No
Secured Creditors/Company
Applying to Tribunal to get a
Declaration that the Company
is a Sick Company
294 PP-CRVI
Yes
No
Possibility of
Revival
Appoint Company
Administrator
LESSON ROUND UP
SICA was enacted to evaluate the viability of sick industrial companies with a view to rehabilitate them and
to protect the interest of employees as far as practicable.
Once a company becomes sick, a reference is made to BIFR for determination of measures to be adopted
with respect to company.
Enquiry under Section 16 into working of sick industrial company is made. After being satisfied of sickness
and if there is a scope to make the networth exceed the accumulated losses, it appoints an operating
agency for preparation of scheme for revival under Section 18. Otherwise an opinion of Board is forwarded
to High Court for winding up.
Section 22, one of the important provisions of SICA, provides for immunity from certain litigations.
The companies bill 2012 prescribes time bound rehabilitation process by Trinunal.
Lesson 18
Securitization
LESSON OUTLINE
Introduction
Important provisions
Offences
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
The banks and financial institutions (FIs) were facing
numerous problems in recovery of defaulted loans on
account of delays in disposal of recovery
proceedings. The Government, therefore, enacted
the RDBFI Act in 1993 and SARFAESI Act in 2002
for the purpose of expeditious recovery of nonperforming assets (NPAs) of the banks and FIs.
Although these two acts have helped in reducing the
NPAs, banks have sent certain suggestions for
further strengthening of the secured creditor rights.
The Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial
Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest Act,
2002 enacted with a view to regulate securitisation
and reconstruction of financial assets and
enforcement of security interest and for matters
connected therewith or incidental thereto. The Act
enables the banks and financial institutions to realise
long-term assets, manage problems of liquidity, asset
liability mis-match and improve recovery by
exercising powers to take possession of securities,
sell them and reduce non-performing assets by
adopting measures for recovery or reconstruction.
The said Act further provides for setting up of asset
reconstruction companies which are empowered to
take possession of secured assets of the borrower
including the right to transfer by way of lease,
assignment or sale and realise the secured assets
and take over the management of the business of the
borrower. The Securities and Reconstruction of
Financial assets and enforcement of Security Interest
Act, 2002 was amended in 2004 and 2012
respectively.
The objective of the study lesson is to familiarize the
students with the legal requirements stipulated under
the SARFAESI Act.
296 PP-CRVI
INTRODUCTION
In the traditional lending process, a bank makes a loan, maintaining it as an asset on its balance sheet,
collecting principal and interest, and monitoring whether there is any deterioration in borrower's
creditworthiness.
This requires a bank to hold assets till repayment of loan. The funds of the bank are blocked in these loans
and to meet its growing fund requirement a bank has to raise additional funds from the market. Securitisation
is a way of unlocking these blocked funds.
One of the most prominent developments in international finance in recent decades and the one that is likely
to assume even greater importance in future, is securitisation. Securitisation is the process of pooling and
repackaging of homogenous illiquid financial assets into marketable securities that can be sold to investors.
Basically Securitisation is a method of raising funds by way of selling receivables for money.
The process leads to the creation of financial instruments that represent ownership interest in, or are secured
by a segregated income producing asset or pool of assets. The pool of assets collateralises securities.
These assets are generally secured by personal or real property (e.g. automobiles, real estate, or equipment
loans), but in some cases are unsecured (e.g. credit card debt, consumer loans).
Securitisation is a method of raising funds by way of selling receivables for money.
Source: rbi.org.in
Lesson 18
Securitization 297
Steps in securitisation:
(i) Acquisition of Financial Assets by Securitisation Company or Reconstruction Company (i.e SPVs)
from the originator. Here financial assets are loans backed by properties. The originator is banks or
FIs who has lent money to the original borrower.
(ii)
the SPV, with the help of an investment banker, issues security receipts which are distributed to
investors; and
(iii) the SPV pays the originator for the financial assets purchased with the proceeds from the sale of
securities.
Parties involved in Securitisation
Primary parties
The Originator(Banks/FIs who has lent loan against properties)
SPVs(Securitisation Company or Reconstruction Company)
Investors (To whom securities are issued, which is a participative interest against the pool of
receivables which is bought by the SPVs from the originator)
Besides above parties the following are involved in the process of securitizations:
The obligator (i.e. original borrower of the loan)
Rating agency
Administrator etc.
298 PP-CRVI
piece of legislation which has far reaching consequences. This Act is having the overriding power over the
other legislation and it shall go in addition to and not in derogation of certain legislation.
Lesson 18
Securitization 299
the legislation. Leading the charge against the said Act was Mardia Chemicals in its plea against notice
served by ICICI Bank. The Government had, however, argued that the legislation would bring about a
financial discipline and reduce the burden of Non Performing Assets (NPAs) of banks and institutions.
In Mardia Chemicals Ltd. v. UOI [2004] 59 CLA 380 (SC), it was urged by the petitioner that
(i) there was no occasion to enact such a draconian legislation to find a short-cut to realise nonperforming assets (NPAs) without their ascertainment when there already existed the Recovery of
Debts Due to Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993 (Recovery of Debt Act) for doing so;
(ii) no provision had been made to take into account lenders liability;
(iii) that the mechanism for recovery under Section 13 does not provide for an adjudicatory forum of
inter se disputes between lender and borrower; and
(iv) that the appeal provisions were illusory because the appeal would be maintainable after possession
of the property or management of the property was taken over or the property sold and the appeal is
not entertainable unless 75 per cent of the amount claimed is deposited with the Debts Recovery
Tribunal (DRT).
The Honable Supreme Court held that though some of the provisions of the Act 2002 be a bit harsh for
some of the borrowers but on those grounds the impugned provisions of the Act cannot be said to
unconstitutional in the view of the fact that the objective of the Act is to achieve speedier recovery of the
dues declared as NPAs and better availability of capital liquidity and resources to help in growth of economy
of the country and welfare of the people in general which would sub-serve the public interest.
The Supreme Court observed that the Act provides for a forum and remedies to the borrower to ventilate his
grievances against the bank or financial institution, inter alia, with respect to the amount of the demand of the
secured debt. After the notice is sent, the borrower may explain the reasons why the measures may or may
not be taken under Sub-section (4) of Section 13. The creditor must apply its mind to the objections raised in
reply to such notice. There must be meaningful consideration by the Court of the objections raised rather
than to ritually reject them and to proceed to take drastic measures under Sub-section (4) of Section 13. The
court held that such a procedure/mechanism was conducive to the principles of fairness and that such a
procedure was also important from the point of view of the economy of the country and would serve the
purpose in the growth of a healthy economy. It would serve as guidance to secured debtors in general in
conducting their affairs.
The court opined that the fairness doctrine, cannot be stretched too far, such communication is only for the
purposes of the secured debtors knowledge and cannot give an occasion to the secured debtor to resort to
any proceeding, which are not permissible under the provisions of the Act. Thus, a secured debtor is not
allowed to challenge the reasons communicated or challenge the action likely to be taken by the secured
creditor at that point of time unless his right to approach the DRT as provided under section 17 matures on
any measure having been taken under Sub-section (4) of Section 13.
Moreover, another safeguard is also available to a secured borrower within the framework of the Act i.e. to
approach the DRT under Section 17 though such a right accrues only after measures are taken under Subsection (1) of Section 13.
The Honble Supreme Court, however, found that the requirement of deposit of 75 per cent of the amount
claimed before entertaining an appeal (petition) under Section 17 is an oppressive, onerous and arbitrary
condition and against all the canons of reasonableness. Held this provision to be invalid and ordered that it
was liable to be struck down.
300 PP-CRVI
ENFORCEMENT OF SECURITY
(AMENDMENT) ACT, 2012
INTEREST
AND
RECOVERY
OF
DEBTS
LAWS
Enforcement of Security Interest and Recovery of Debts Laws (Amendment) Act, 2012 amended the
Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest (SARFAESI) Act
and Recovery of Debts due to Banks & Financial Institutions (RDBF) Act so as to strengthen the regulatory
and institutional framework related to recovery of debts due to banks and financial institutions.
Amendment Act, 2012 enable banks to improve their operational efficiency, deploy more funds for credit
disbursement to retail investors, home loan borrowers, etc. without fearing for recovery, thus bringing about
equity. Further, mandatory registration of subsisting security interest (equitable mortgages) promote
innovation in credit information.
Amendment Act, 2012 strengthen the ability of banks to recover debts due from the borrowers, enhance the
ability of the banks to extend credit to both corporate and retail borrowers, reduce the cost of funds for banks
and their customers and reduce the level of non-performing assets.
Salient features of Enforcement of Security Interest and Recovery of Debts Laws (Amendment) Act,
2012
provides for conversion of any part of debt into shares of a borrower company and such
conversion shall be deemed always to have been valid as if the provisions of said conversion
were in force at all material times;
included the multi-State co-operative banks in the definition of 'bank' under clause (c) of section
2 of the said Act;
increased the period of response to be sent by the banks or financial institutions to the
representation of the borrower from seven days to fifteen days;
empowers the banks or financial institutions to accept the immovable property in full or partial
satisfaction of the claim of the bank against the defaulting borrower;
enables the banks or any person to file a caveat so that before granting any stay, the bank or
such person is heard by the Debts Recovery Tribunal;
Definitions
Section 2 of the The Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security
Interest Act, 2002 defines various terms used in the Act, as given under:
Bank
As per Section 2(1) (c) bank means(i) a banking company; or
(ii) a corresponding new bank; or
(iii) the State Bank of India; or
(iv) a subsidiary bank; or
Lesson 18
Securitization 301
Financial Assets
Securitisation Company
Reconstruction Company
Originator
Security Receipts
"Financial Asset"
Financial asset under Section 2(1)(I) means debt or receivables and includes
any debt or receivables secured by, mortgage of, or charge on, immovable property; or
any right or interest in the security, whether full or part underlying such debt or receivables; or
any beneficial interest in property, whether movable or immovable, or in such debt, receivables,
whether such interest is existing, future, accruing, conditional or contingent; or
"Securitization Company"
Securitization company under Section 2(1)(za) means any company formed and registered under the
Companies Act, 1956 (1 of 1956) for the purpose of securitisation;(in common parlance called Special
Purpose Vehicle (SPV);
"Reconstruction Company"
"Reconstruction company" under Section 2(1)(v) means a company formed and registered under the
Companies Act, 1956 for the purpose of asset reconstruction;
Asset Reconstruction
Asset reconstruction
under Section 2(1)(b) means acquisition by any securitisation company or
reconstruction company of any right or interest of any bank or financial institution in any financial assistance
for the purpose of realisation of such financial assistance;
302 PP-CRVI
Originator"
Originator" under Section 2(1)(r) means the owner of a financial asset which is acquired by a securitisation
company or reconstruction company for the purpose of securitisation or asset reconstruction;
"Security Receipt"
Security receipt under Section 2(1)(zg) means a receipt or other security, issued by a securitisation
company or reconstruction company to any qualified institutional buyer pursuant to a scheme, evidencing the
purchase or acquisition by the holder thereof, of an undivided right, title or interest in the financial asset
involved in securitization;
Qualified Institutional Buyer
Qualified institutional buyer means a financial institution, insurance company, bank, State Financial Corporation, State Industrial Development Corporation, trustee or securitisation company or reconstruction company
which has been granted a certificate of registration under sub-section (4) of section 3 or any asset
management company making investment on behalf of mutual fund or a foreign institutional investor
registered under the Securities and Exchange Board of India Act, 1992 (15 of 1992) or regulations made
thereunder, or any other body corporate as may be specified by the Board;
Non-Performing Assets
As per Section 2(1)(o) Non-Performing Asset means an asset or account of a borrower, which has been
classified by a bank or financial institution as sub-standard, doubtful or loss asset
(a) in case such bank or financial institution is administered or regulated by an authority or body
established, constituted or appointed by any law for the time being in force, in accordance with the
directions or guidelines relating to assets classifications issued by such authority or body;
(b) in any other case, in accordance with the directions or guidelines relating to assets classifications
issued by the Reserve Bank.
Classification of Non-Performing Assets
Banks are required to classify non-performing assets further into the following three categories based on the
period for which the asset has remained non-performing and the realisability of the dues:
(a) sub-standard assets,
(b) doubtful assets, and
(c) loss assets.
Lesson 18
Securitization 303
their business. ARCs may be able to mix up their assets, both good and bad, in such a manner to make
them saleable.
The main objective of asset reconstruction company (ARC) is to act as agent for any bank or financial
institution for the purpose of recovering their dues from the borrowers on payment of fees or charges, to act
as manager of the borrowers asset taken over by banks, or financial institution, to act as the receiver of
properties of any bank or financial institution and to carry on such ancillary or incidental business with the
prior approval of Reserve Bank wherever necessary. If an ARC carries on any business other than the
business of asset reconstruction or securitisation or the business mentioned above, it shall cease to carry on
any such business within one year of doing such other business.
304 PP-CRVI
(g) that securitisation company or reconstruction company has complied with or is in a position to
comply with prudential norms specified by the Reserve Bank.
(h) that securitisation company or reconstruction company has complied with one or more
conditions specified in the guidelines issued by the Reserve Bank for the said purpose."
4. The Reserve Bank may, after being satisfied that the conditions above are fulfilled, grant a
certificate of registration to the securitisation company or the reconstruction company to commence
or carry on business of securitisation or asset reconstruction, subject to such conditions, as it
deems fit to impose. The conditions may vary from case to case.
5. The Reserve Bank may reject the application made, if it is satisfied that the conditions specified
above are not fulfilled. However, before rejecting the application, the applicant shall be given a
reasonable opportunity of being heard. The company whos application has been rejected is entitled
to know the reasons for its rejection.
No Securitisation company or Reconstruction company can commence business without obtaining a
Certificate of Registration from RBI.
Lesson 18
Securitization 305
Appeal
A securitisation company or reconstruction company aggrieved by the order of rejection or cancellation of
certificate of registration may prefer an appeal, within a period of thirty days from the date on which such
order of cancellation is communicated to it, to the Central Government.
It may be noted that before rejecting an appeal such company shall be given a reasonable opportunity of
being heard.
A securitisation company or reconstruction company, which is holding investments of qualified institutional
buyers and whose application for grant of certificate of registration has been rejected or certificate of
registration has been cancelled shall, notwithstanding such rejection or cancellation, be deemed to be a
securitisation company or reconstruction company until it repays the entire investments held by it (together
with interest, if any) within such period as the Reserve Bank may direct.
306 PP-CRVI
Transfer of pending applications to any one of Debts Recovery Tribunals in certain cases
(Section 5A)
(1) If any financial asset, of a borrower acquired by a securitisation company or reconstruction
company, comprise of secured debts of more than one bank or financial institution for recovery of
which such banks or financial institutions has filed applications before two or more Debts Recovery
Tribunals, the securitisation company or reconstruction company may file an application to the
Appellate Tribunal having jurisdiction over any of such Tribunals in which such applications are
pending for transfer of all pending applications to any one of the Debts Recovery Tribunals as it
deems fit.
(2) On receipt of such application for transfer of all pending applications under sub-section (1), the
Appellate Tribunal may, after giving the parties to the application an opportunity of being heard,
pass an order for transfer of the pending applications to any one of the Debts Recovery Tribunals.
(3) Notwithstanding anything contained in the Recovery of Debts Due to Banks and Financial
Institutions Act, 1993, any order passed by the Appellate Tribunal under sub-section (2) shall be
binding on all the Debts Recovery Tribunals referred to in sub-section (1) as if such order had been
passed by the Appellate Tribunal having jurisdiction on each such Debts Recovery Tribunal.
(4) Any recovery certificate, issued by the Debts Recovery Tribunal to which all the pending
applications are transferred under sub-section (2), shall be executed in accordance with the provisions contained in sub-section (23) of section 19 and other provisions of the Recovery of Debts Due
to Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993 shall, accordingly, apply to such execution
Proper management of the business of the borrower, by change in, or take over of, the
management of the business of the borrower.
Taking possession of secured assets in accordance with the provisions of the Act.
Lesson 18
Securitization 307
It may be noted that no securitisation company or Reconstruction Company shall act as a manager if acting
as such gives rise to any pecuniary liability.
It is important to note here that securitisation company or reconstruction company which has been granted a
certificate of registration cannot commence or carry on any business other than that of securitisation or asset
reconstruction without prior approval of the Reserve Bank.
308 PP-CRVI
postponed for want of a bid of an amount not less than such reserve price, it shall be lawful for any officer of
the secured creditor, if so authorised by the secured creditor in this behalf, to bid for the immovable property
on behalf of the secured creditor at any subsequent sale.
(5B) Where the secured creditor, referred to in sub-section (5A), is declared to be the purchaser of the
immovable property at any subsequent sale, the amount of the purchase price shall be adjusted towards the
amount of the claim of the secured creditor for which the auction of enforcement of security interest is taken
by the secured creditor, under sub-section (4) of section 13.
(5C) The provisions of section 9 of the Banking Regulation Act, 1949 shall, as far as may be, apply to the
immovable property acquired by secured creditor under sub-section (5A).
(6) Any transfer of secured asset after taking possession thereof or take over of management, by the
secured creditor or by the manager on behalf of the secured creditor shall vest in the transferee all rights in,
or in relation to, the secured asset transferred as if the transfer had been made by the owner of such secured
asset.
(7) Where any action has been taken against a borrower, all costs, charges and expenses which, in the
opinion of the secured creditor, have been properly incurred by him or any expenses incidental thereto, shall
be recoverable from the borrower and the money which is received by the secured creditor shall, in the
absence of any contract to the contrary, be held by him in trust, to be applied, firstly, in payment of such
costs, charges and expenses and secondly, in discharge of the dues of the secured creditor and the residue
of the money so received shall be paid to the person entitled thereto in accordance with his rights and
interests.
(8) If the dues of the secured creditor together with all costs, charges and expenses incurred by him are
tendered to the secured creditor at any time before the date fixed for sale or transfer, the secured asset shall
not be sold or transferred by the secured creditor, and no further step shall be taken by him for transfer or
sale of that secured asset.
(9) In the case of financing of a financial asset by more than one secured creditors or joint financing of a
financial asset by secured creditors, no secured creditor shall be entitled to exercise any or all of the rights
conferred on him unless exercise of such right is agreed upon by the secured creditors representing not less
than sixty per cent in value of the amount outstanding as on a record date and such action shall be binding
on all the secured creditors :
However, in the case of a company in liquidation, the amount realised from the sale of secured assets shall
be distributed in accordance with the provisions of section 529A of the Companies Act, 1956:
In the case of a company being wound up on or after the commencement of this Act, the secured creditor of
such company, who opts to realise his security instead of relinquishing his security and proving his debt
under proviso to sub-section (1) of section 529 of the Companies Act, 1956 (1 of 1956), may retain the sale
proceeds of his secured assets after depositing the workmens dues with the liquidator in accordance with
the provisions of section 529A of that Act : The liquidator shall intimate the secured creditor the workmens
dues in accordance with the provisions of section 529A of the Companies Act, 1956 and in case such
workmens dues cannot be ascertained, the liquidator shall intimate the estimated amount of workmens
dues under that section to the secured creditor and in such case the secured creditor may retain the sale
proceeds of the secured assets after depositing the amount of such estimated dues with the liquidator :
In case the secured creditor deposits the estimated amount of workmens dues, such creditor shall be liable
to pay the balance of the workmens dues or entitled to receive the excess amount, if any, deposited by the
Lesson 18
Securitization 309
secured creditor with the liquidator: and that the secured creditor shall furnish an undertaking to the liquidator
to pay the balance of the workmens dues, if any.
(a) record date means the date agreed upon by the secured creditors representing not less than sixty
per cent in value of the amount outstanding on such date;
(b) amount outstanding shall include principal, interest and any other dues payable by the borrower to
the secured creditor in respect of secured asset as per the books of account of the secured creditor.
(10) Where dues of the secured creditor are not fully satisfied with the sale proceeds of the secured assets,
the secured creditor may file an application in the form and manner as may be prescribed to the Debts
Recovery Tribunal having jurisdiction or a competent court, as the case may be, for recovery of the balance
amount from the borrower.
(11) Without prejudice to the rights conferred on the secured creditor under or by this section, the secured
creditor shall be entitled to proceed against the guarantors or sell the pledged assets without first taking any
of the measures specified in point not 4.
(12) The rights of a secured creditor under this Act may be exercised by one or more of his officers
authorised in this behalf in such manner as may be prescribed.
(13) No borrower shall, after receipt of notice from the secured creditor transfer by way of sale, lease or
otherwise (other than in the ordinary course of his business) any of his secured assets referred to in the
notice, without prior written consent of the secured creditor.
In the case of Nik-Nish Retail Pvt. Ltd & Anr. Versus Union Bank & Ors. G.A. 1380 of
2012 in W.P. 6 of 2010 25 June, 2012, Dipankar Datta, J, the Calcutta High Court held
that the scheme of the Act envisages grant of 60 days time to the defaulter for
clearance of the liability or to raise objection. Even if the defaulting party falls short of
paying Rs. 1/- of the amount specified in the demand notice within the permitted
period, its account would still be a 'non- performing asset' and continue to be treated as such and the
secured creditor is, in the circumstances, entitled to initiate further action in terms of provisions of the Act
including taking measures to take possession of the secured assets after the period of 60 days has expired if
no objection is received in the meantime or the objection to the demand notice has been overruled. Question
of waiver does not and cannot arise simply because certain payments had been credited in the cash credit
account. The period of 60 days is the time limited for clearing the liability and if the liability does not stand
cleared, notwithstanding part payment the secured creditor is well within its right to exercise power conferred
by Section 13(4) of the Act.
Accounting aspects
These companies should follow all the Accounting Standards issued by the Institute of Chartered
Accountants of India as required under Sub-section (3A) of Section 211 of the Companies Act, 1956. They
should also follow the guidelines and prudential norms/accounting standards issued by Reserve Bank from
time to time.
310 PP-CRVI
proviso does not apply to a public financial institution. Therefore, the ARC can invite any number of qualified
institutional buyers to subscribe to its debentures, bonds, units, etc., issued for financing the acquisition of
assets of the defaulting borrowers of any bank/financial institution. It has to create a debentures redemption
reserve for the redemption of debentures and adequate amount should be credited to such reserve from out
of its profits every year until such debentures are redeemed, as provided in Section 117C of the Companies
Act, 1956.
Any application by the secured creditor shall be accompanied by an affidavit duly affirmed by the authorised
officer of the secured creditor, declaring that
(i) the aggregate amount of financial assistance granted and the total claim of the Bank as on the date
of filing the application;
(ii) the borrower has created security interest over various properties and that the Bank or Financial
Institution is holding a valid and subsisting security interest over such properties and the claim of the
Bank or Financial Institution is within the limitation period;
(iii) the borrower has created security interest over various properties giving the details of properties
above;
(iv) the borrower has committed default in repayment of the financial assistance granted aggregating
the specified amount;
(v) consequent upon such default in repayment of the financial assistance the account of the borrower
has been classified as a nonperforming asset;
(vi) affirming that the period of sixty days notice as required by the provisions of sub-section (2) of
section 13, demanding payment of the defaulted financial assistance has been served on the
borrower;
(vii) the objection or representation in reply to the notice received from the borrower has been
considered by the secured creditor and reasons for non-acceptance of such objection or
representation had been communicated to the borrower;
(viii) the borrower has not made any repayment of the financial assistance in spite of the above notice
and the Authorised Officer is, therefore, entitled to take possession of the secured assets under the
provisions of sub-section (4) of section 13 read with section 14 of the principal Act;
(ix) that the provisions of the Act and the rules made thereunder had been complied with.
Lesson 18
Securitization 311
On receipt of the affidavit from the Authorised Officer, the District Magistrate or the Chief Metropolitan
Magistrate, as the case may be, shall after satisfying the contents of the affidavit pass suitable orders for the
purpose of taking possession of the secured assets.
312 PP-CRVI
or takeover the management of business of the borrower on any of the following grounds:
(a) the borrower makes a wilful default in repayment of the amount due under the relevant loan
agreement/s;
(b) the SC/RC is satisfied that the management of the business of the borrower is acting in a manner
adversely affecting the interest of the creditors (including SC/RC) or is failing to take necessary
action to avoid any events which would adversely affect the interest of the creditors;
(c) SC/RC is satisfied that the management of the business of the borrower is not competent to run the
business resulting in losses/non-repayment of dues to SC/RC or there is a lack of professional
management of the business of the borrower or the key managerial personnel of the business of the
borrower have not been appointed for more than one year from the date of such vacancy which
would adversely affect the financial health of the business of the borrower or the interests of the
SC/RC as a secured creditor;
(d) the borrower has without the prior approval of the secured creditors (including SC/RC), sold,
disposed of, charged, encumbered or alienated 10 per cent or more (in aggregate) of its assets
secured to the SC/RC;
(e) there are reasonable grounds to believe that the borrower would be unable to pay its debts as per
terms of repayment accepted by the borrower;
(f) the borrower has entered into any arrangement or compromise with creditors without the consent of
the SC/RC which adversely affects the interest of the SC/RC or the borrower has committed any act
of insolvency;
(g) the borrower discontinues or threatens to discontinue any of its businesses constituting 10 per cent
or more of its turnover;
(h) all or a significant part of the assets of the borrower required for or essential for its business or
operations are damaged due to the actions of the borrower;
(i) the general nature or scope of the business, operations, management, control or ownership of the
business of the borrower are altered to an extent, which in the opinion of the SC/RC, materially
affects the ability of the borrower to repay the loan;
(j) the SC/RC is satisfied that serious dispute/s have arisen among the promoters or directors or
partners of the business of the borrower, which could materially affect the ability of the borrower to
repay the loan;
(k) failure of the borrower to acquire the assets for which the loan has been availed and utilization of
the funds borrowed for other than stated purposes or disposal of the financed assets and misuse or
misappropriation of the proceeds;
(l) fraudulent transactions by the borrower in respect of the assets secured to the creditor/s.
Explanation A: For the purpose of this paragraph, wilful default in repayment of amount due, includes
(a) non-payment of dues despite adequate cash flow and availability of other resources, or
(b) routing of transactions through banks which are not lenders/consortium members so as to avoid
payment of dues, or
(c) siphoning off funds to the detriment of the defaulting unit, or misrepresentation/falsification of
records pertaining to the transactions with the SC/RC.
Lesson 18
Securitization 313
Explanation B: The decision as to whether the borrower is a wilful defaulter or not, shall be made by the
SC/RC keeping in view the track record of the borrower and not on the basis of an isolated
transaction/incident which is not material. The default to be categorized as wilful must be intentional,
deliberate and calculated.
(iii) Policy regarding change in or takeover of management
(A) Every SC/RC shall frame policy guidelines regarding change in or takeover of the management of
the business of the borrower, with the approval of its Board of Directors and the borrowers shall be
made aware of such policy of the SC/RC.
(B) Such policy shall generally provide for the following :
(i) The change in or takeover of the management of the business of the borrower should be done
only after the proposal is examined by an Independent Advisory Committee to be appointed by
the SC/RC consisting of professionals having technical/finance/legal background who after
assessment of the financial position of the borrower, time frame available for recovery of the
debt from the borrower, future prospects of the business of the borrower and other relevant
aspects shall recommend to the SC/RC that it may resort to change in or takeover of the
management of the business of the borrower and that such action would be necessary for
effective running of the business leading to recovery of its dues.
(ii) The Board of Directors including at least two independent directors of the SC/RC should
deliberate on the recommendations of the Independent Advisory Committee and consider the
various options available for the recovery of dues before deciding whether under the existing
circumstances the change in or takeover of the management of the business of the borrower is
necessary and the decision shall be specifically included in the minutes.
(iii) The SC/RC shall carry out due diligence, exercise and record the details of the exercise,
including the findings on the circumstances which had led to default in repayment of the dues by
the borrower and why the decision to change in or takeover of the management of the business
of the borrower has become necessary.
(iv) The SC/RC shall identify suitable personnel/agencies, who can takeover the management of
the business of the borrower by formulating a plan for operating and managing the business of
the borrower effectively, so that the dues of the SC/RC may be realized from the borrower
within the time-frame.
(v) Such plan will also include procedure to be adopted by the SC/RC at the time of restoration of
the management of the business to the borrower in accordance with paragraph 3 above,
borrowers rights and liabilities at the time of change in or takeover of management by the
SC/RC and at the time of restoration of management back to the borrower, rights and liabilities
of the new management taking over management of the business of the borrower at the behest
of SC/RC. It should be clarified to the new management by the SC/RC that the scope of their
role is limited to recovery of dues of the SC/RC by managing the affairs of the business of the
borrower in a prudent manner.
Explanation: To ensure independence of members of Independent Advisory Committee (IAC), such
members should not be connected with the affairs of the SC/RC in any manner and should not receive any
pecuniary benefit from the SC/RC except for services rendered for acting as member of IAC.
314 PP-CRVI
(iv) Procedure for change in or takeover of management
(a) The SC/RC shall give a notice of 60 days to the borrower indicating its intention to effect change in
or takeover the management of the business of the borrower and calling for objections, if any.
(b) The objections, if any, submitted by the borrower shall be initially considered by the IAC and
thereafter the objections along with the recommendations of the IAC shall be submitted to the Board
of Directors of the SC/RC. The Board of Directors of SC/RC shall pass a reasoned order within a
period of 30 days from the date of expiry of the notice period, indicating the decision of the SC/RC
regarding the change in or takeover of the management of the business of the borrower, which shall
be communicated to the borrower.
(v) Reporting
SC/RCs shall report to the Bank all cases where they have taken action to cause change in or takeover the
management of the business of the borrower for realization of its dues from the borrower in terms of circular
DNBS (PD) CC. No. 12/SCRC/ 10.30.000/2008-09, dated September 26, 2008.
Right to appeal
Section 17 of the Act provides that any borrower or any other person aggrieved by the action of the secured
creditors can file an appeal to the concerned Debt Recovery Tribunal (DRT).
Such appeal can also be filed by any person aggrieved by the action of the secured creditor without being
required to deposit any amount with the DRT. Such provisions will take care of any third party interest in the
secured assets which need to be considered before sale of securities. Any person aggrieved by the order of
DRT, may prefer an appeal to the Appellate Tribunal within thirty days from the date of receipt of the order of
Debt Recovery Tribunal.
Lesson 18
Securitization 315
serve notice of the caveat by registered post, acknowledgement due, on the person by whom the application
has been or is expected to be made under sub-section (1);
(b) any person by whom the caveat has been lodged (hereafter referred to as the caveator) shall serve
notice of the caveat by registered post, acknowledgement due, on the person by whom the application has
been or is expected to be made under sub-section (1).
After a caveat has been lodged under subsection (1), any application or appeal is filed before the Tribunal or
the court of District Judge or the Appellate Tribunal or the High Court, as the case may be, the Tribunal or
the District Judge or the Appellate Tribunal or the High Court, as the case may be, shall serve a notice of
application or appeal filed by the applicant or the appellant on the caveator.
Where a notice of any caveat has been served on the applicant or the Appellant, he shall periodically furnish
the caveator with a copy of the application or the appeal made by him and also with copies of any paper or
document which has been or may be filed by him in support of the application or the appeal.
Where a caveat has been lodged under sub-section (1), such caveat shall not remain in force after the expiry
of the period of ninety days from the date on which it was lodged unless the application or appeal referred to
in sub-section (1) has been made before the expiry of the said period.
Filing of Particulars
The particulars of every transaction of securitization asset reconstruction or creation of security interest is
required to be filed with the Central Registrar in the manner and on payment of such fee as may be
prescribed within 30 days after the date of such transaction or creation of security by the securitisation/
reconstruction company or secured creditor as the case may be. The Central Registrar shall have the power
to allow extension of 30 days on payment of such additional fee not exceeding 10 times the amount of such
fee.
The particulars of any change in the terms and conditions or the extent or operation of the security interest
registered under this chapter shall be sent to the Registrar by the securitisation/reconstruction company or
secured creditor.
316 PP-CRVI
Right to Inspect
As per Section 26 of the Act, the Central Register maintained by the Central Registrar (both in electronic and
non-electronic form) shall be open for inspection by any person during the business hours on payment of
prescribed fee.
Penalties
If a default is made in filing the particulars of every transaction of any securitisation or asset reconstruction or
security interest created by a securitisation company or reconstruction company or secured creditor; or in
sending the particulars of the modification or in giving intimation under Section 25, every company and every
officer of the company or the secured creditor and every officer of the secured creditor who is in default shall
be punishable with fine which may extend to five thousand rupees for every day during which the default
continues.
Offences
Any person who contravenes the provisions of this Act or of any rules made thereunder shall be punishable
with imprisonment for a term which may extend to one year, or with fine, or with both.
Lesson 18
Securitization 317
(e) any conditional sale, hire-purchase or lease or any other contract in which no security interest has
been created;
(f) any rights of unpaid seller under Section 47 of the Sale of Goods Act, 1930;
(g) any properties not liable to attachment (excluding the properties specifically charged with the debt
recoverable under this Act)] or sale under the first proviso to Sub-section (1) of Section 60 of the
Code of Civil Procedure, 1908;
(h) any security interest for securing repayment of any financial asset not exceeding one lakh rupees;
(i) any security interest created in agricultural land;
(j) any case in which the amount due is less than twenty per cent of the principal amount and interest
thereon.
318 PP-CRVI
and no injunction shall be granted by any court or any other authority in respect of any action taken or to be
taken in pursuance of any power conferred by or under this Act or under the Recovery of Debts Due to
Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993.
Therefore it shall not be possible to get any injunction from any Court of Law. Moreover SRFAESI Act, 2002
has also amended following legislations:
1. The Companies Act, 1956: The definition of Public Financial Institution under Section 4A has been
altered and it now includes securitisation company or reconstruction Company.
2. The Securities Contract (Regulation) Act, 1956: Section 2 has been amended to include the
definition of Security Deposit as defined in 2 (kg) of SRFAESI Act, 2002.
3. The Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 has been amended to the extent it
provides that after the commencement of SRFAESI Act, 2002 and if the financial assets have been
acquired by securitisation or reconstruction company, no reference shall be made to BIFR.
Moreover, after the commencement of SRFAESI Act, 1956 and if the reference is pending, then the
reference shall abate, if 75% of the Secured Creditors have taken measures to recover their
Secured Debts.
Lesson 18
Securitization 319
It may be noted that where there are more than one borrower, the demand notice shall be served on each
borrower.
320 PP-CRVI
(i) in the case of a debt, prohibiting the borrower from recovering the debt or any interest
thereon and the debtor from making payment thereof and directing the debtor to make
such payment to the authorised officer; or
(ii) in the case of the shares in a body corporate, directing the borrower to transfer the same to
the secured creditor and also the body corporate from not transferring such shares in
favour of any person other than the secured creditor. A copy of the notice so sent may be
endorsed to the concerned body corporates Registrar to the issue or share transfer
agents, if any;
(iii) in the case of other movable property (except as aforesaid), calling upon the borrowers
and the person in possession to hand over the same to the authorised officer and the
authorised officer shall take custody of such movable property in the same manner as
provided in sub-rules (1) to (3) above;
(iv) movable secured assets other than those covered in this rule shall be taken possession of
by the authorised officer by taking possession of the documents evidencing title to such
secured assets.
Lesson 18
Securitization 321
(d) time and place of public auction or the time after which sale by any other mode shall be completed;
(e) depositing earnest money as may be stipulated by the secured creditor;
(f) any other thing which the authorised officer considers it material for a purchaser to know in order to
judge the nature and value of movable secured assets.
(3) Sale by any methods other than public auction or public tender, shall be on such terms as may be settled
between the parties in writing.
322 PP-CRVI
(c) by holding public auction; or
(d) by private treaty.
(6) The authorised officer shall serve to the borrower a notice of thirty days for sale of the immovable
secured assets, under sub-rule (5) :
Provided that if the sale of such secured asset is being effected by either inviting tenders from the public or
by holding public auction, the secured creditor shall cause a public notice in two leading newspapers one in
vernacular language having sufficient circulation in the locality by setting out the terms of sale, which shall
include,
(a) the description of the immovable property to be sold, including the details of the encumbrances
known to the secured creditor;
(b) the secured debt for recovery of which the property is to be sold;
(c) reserve price, below which the property may not be sold;
(d) time and place of public auction or the time after which sale by any other mode shall be completed;
(e) depositing earnest money as may be stipulated by the secured creditor;
(f) any other thing which the authorised officer considers it material for a purchaser to know in order to
judge the nature and value of the property.
In the case of Pvt. Ltd. & Ors vs Union Of India & Ors on 14 November, 2011 writ
petition no. 1956 of 2011 decided on 14 November 2011Dr. D.Y. Chandrachud, A.A.
Sayed JJ in the High Court of judicature at Bombay held that Rule 8(6) of the Rules
of 2002 provides the necessary safeguard if the action is taken in arbitrary and
unreasonable manner and if the valuation of the property is not properly fixed. The
whole object of Rule 8 (6) of the Rules of 2002 appears to be that the borrower gets clear thirty days' notice
before the sale takes place. During this period, the borrower can raise objections and can also point out
before the appropriate forum as regards the correct and true valuation of the property. The essential purpose
of sub-rule (5) of Rule 8 of the Rules of 2002 is to see that there is proper valuation by an approved valuer,
who would be considered as an expert, and the view of the secured creditor on the aspect of fixation of
reserved price is taken into consideration by the authorized officer. Just because the borrower is excluded
from Rule 8 (5) of the Rules of 2002 or has no voice at the time when the valuation is fixed and the reserved
price is also fixed, by itself will not render Rule 8 (5) unconstitutional.
(7) Every notice of sale shall be affixed on a conspicuous part of the immovable property and may, if the
authorised officer deems it fit, put on the web-site of the secured creditor on the Internet.
(8) Sale by any method other than public auction or public tender, shall be on such terms as may be settled
between the parties in writing.
Time of sale, issue of sale certificate and delivery of possession, etc. (Rule 9)
(1) No sale of immovable property under these rules shall take place before the expiry of thirty days from the
date on which the public notice of sale is published in newspapers as referred to in the proviso to sub-rule (6)
or notice of sale has been served to the borrower.
(2) The sale shall be confirmed in favour of the purchaser who has offered the highest sale price in his bid or
tender or quotation or offer to the authorised officer and shall be subject to confirmation by the secured
creditor:
Lesson 18
Securitization 323
Provided that no sale under this rule shall be confirmed, if the amount offered by sale price is less than the
reserve price, specified under sub-rule (5) of rule 9 :
Provided further that if the authorised officer fails to obtain a price higher than the reserve price, he may, with
the consent of the borrower and the secured creditor effect the sale at such price.
(3) On every sale of immovable property, the purchaser shall immediately pay a deposit of twenty-five per
cent of the amount of the sale price, to the authorised officer conducting the sale and in default of such
deposit, the property shall forthwith be sold again.
(4) The balance amount of purchase price payable shall be paid by the purchaser to the authorised officer on
or before the fifteenth day of confirmation of sale of the immovable property or such extended period as may
be agreed upon in writing between the parties.
(5) In default of payment within the period mentioned in sub-rule (4), the deposit shall be forfeited and the
property shall be resold and the defaulting purchaser shall forfeit all claim to the property or to any part of the
sum for which it may be subsequently sold.
(6) On confirmation of sale by the secured creditor and if the terms of payment have been complied with, the
authorised officer exercising the power of sale shall issue a certificate of sale of the immovable property in
favour of the purchaser in the form given in Appendix V to these rules.
(7) Where the immovable property sold is subject to any encumbrances, the authorised officer may, if he
thinks fit, allow the purchaser to deposit with him the money required to discharge the encumbrances and
any interest due thereon together with such additional amount that may be sufficient to meet the
contingencies or further cost, expenses and interest as may be determined by him.
Provided that it after meeting the cost of removing encumbrances and contingencies there is any surplus
available out of the money deposited by the purchaser such surplus shall be paid to the purchaser within
fifteen day, from date of finalisation of the sale.
(8) On such deposit of money for discharge of the encumbrances, the authorised officer [shall issue or cause
the purchaser to issue notices to the persons interested in or entitled to the money deposited with him and
take steps to make the payment accordingly.
(9) The authorised officer shall deliver the property to the purchaser free from encumbrances known to the
secured creditor on deposit of money as specified in sub-rule (7) above.
(10) The certificate of sale issued under sub-rule (6) shall specifically mention that whether the purchaser
has purchased the immovable secured asset free from any encumbrances known to the secured creditor or
not.
324 PP-CRVI
deemed to be an agent of the borrower and the borrower shall be solely responsible for the commission or
omission of acts of the Manager unless such commission or omission are due to improper intervention of the
secured creditor or the authorised officer.
(3) The Manager shall have power by notice in writing to recover any money from any person who has
acquired any of the secured assets from the borrower, which is due to may become due to the borrower.
(4) The Manager shall give such person who has made payment under sub-rule (3) a valid discharge as if he
has made payments to the borrower.
(5) The Manager shall apply all the monies received by him in accordance with the provisions contained in
sub-section (7) of section 13 of the [Act].
LESSON ROUND UP
The Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest Act, 2002
enacted with a view to regulate securitisation and reconstruction of financial assets and enforcement of
security interest and for matters connected therewith or incidental thereto.
Enforcement of Security Interest and Recovery of Debts Laws (Amendment) Act, 2012 amended the
Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest (SARFAESI)
Act and Recovery of Debts due to Banks & Financial Institutions (RDBF) Act so as to strengthen the
regulatory and institutional framework related to recovery of debts due to banks and financial institutions.
Amendment Act, 2012 enable banks to improve their operational efficiency, deploy more funds for credit
disbursement to retail investors, home loan borrowers, etc. without fearing for recovery, thus bringing about
equity. Further, mandatory registration of subsisting security interest (equitable mortgages) promote
innovation in credit information.
Any security interest created in favour of any secured creditor may be enforced, without the intervention of
the court or tribunal, by such creditor in accordance with the provisions of this Act.
Lesson 18
Securitization 325
Any borrower or any other person aggrieved by the action of the secured creditors can file an appeal to the
Any person aggrieved by the order of DRT, may prefer an appeal to the Appellate Tribunal within thirty days
from the date of receipt of the order of Debt Recovery Tribunal.
In exercise of the powers conferred by subsection (1) and CL (b) of sub-section (2) of Sec. 38 read with
sub-sections (4), (10) and (12) of Sec. 13 of the Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and
Enforcement of Security Interest Act, 2002, the Central Government notified Security Interest
(Enforcement) Rules, 2002.
Rule 8(6) of the Rules of 2002 provides the necessary safeguard if the action is taken in arbitrary and
unreasonable manner and if the valuation of the property is not properly fixed. The whole object of Rule 8
(6) of the Rules of 2002 appears to be that the borrower gets clear thirty days' notice before the sale takes
place. During this period, the borrower can raise objections and can also point out before the appropriate
forum as regards the correct and true valuation of the property.
Explain the overriding power of SARFAESI Act, 2002 over Companies Act with decided case law.
326 PP-CRVI
Lesson 19
Debt Recovery
LESSON OUTLINE
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Important Definitions
Powers of Tribunal
chapter
contains
overview
of
the
Act,
Recovery of Debts Due to Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993 is an Act to provide for the establishment of
Tribunals for expeditious adjudication and recovery of debts due to banks and financial institutions and for matters
connected therewith or incidental thereto.
328 PP-CRVI
Lesson 19
Constitutional validity of the Recovery of Debts Due to Banks and Financial Institutions Act,
1993
In case of Union of India v. Delhi High Court Bar Association, (2002) 4 SCC 275, the
petitioners have challenged the constitutional validity of the Recovery of Debts Due to
Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993 on the ground that the Act is unreasonable
and is violative of Art. 14 of the Constitution and that it is beyond the legislative
competence of the Parliament to enact such a law. This Act had been challenged for
depriving a person of legal remedies in ordinary civil courts. However, the Supreme
Court held that there is no such right that the dispute should be adjudicated only by a civil court, and the
replacement of the jurisdiction of civil courts by independent and specialized tribunals is completely legal and
constitutional.
ENFORCEMENT OF SECURITY
(AMENDMENT) ACT, 2012
INTEREST
AND
RECOVERY
OF
DEBTS
LAWS
Enforcement of Security Interest and Recovery of Debts Laws (Amendment) Act, 2012 amended the
Recovery of Debts due to Banks & Financial Institutions (RDBFI) Act so as to strengthen the regulatory and
institutional framework related to recovery of debts due to banks and financial institutions.
To ensure expeditious adjudication and recovery of dues of banks and financial institutions, remove legal
anomalies and strengthen the Recovery Tribunals, the said Act was amended in the years 1995, 2000 and
2004. The measures of recovery through the Debts Recovery Tribunal are not available to multi-State cooperative banks. In order to provide an additional and effective recovery mechanism to multi-State cooperative banks, it is considered necessary to give an option to the multi-State co-operative banks either to
initiate proceedings for recovery of its debts under the Multi-State Co-operative Societies Act, 2002 or the
Debts Recovery Tribunal under the Recovery of Debts Due to Banks and Financial Institutions Act, 1993,
amended the Enforcement of Security Interest and Recovery of Debts Laws (Amendment) Act, 2012
Salient features of the Enforcement of Security Interest and Recovery of Debt Laws
(Amendment) Act, 2012 as under
(a) Included the multi-State co-operative banks in the definition of 'bank' under clause (d) of section 2 of
the said Act;
(b) Permitted the multi State co-operative banks, with respect to debts due before or after the
commencement of the proposed legislation, to opt either to initiate proceedings under the MultiState Co-operative Societies Act, 2002 or to initiate the proceedings before the Debts Recovery
Tribunal;
(c) Enabled the banks and financial institutions to enter into settlement or compromise with the
borrower and also to empower the Debts Recovery Tribunal to pass an order acknowledging such
settlement or compromise;
(d) Recovery proceedings pending before the commencement of the Enforcement of Security Interest
and Recovery of Debts Laws (Amendment) Act, 2012 in relation to recovery of debts due to any
multi-State co-operative bank shall be continued in the same manner as the proposed amendments
had not come into force.
Important Definitions
Section 2 of the Recovery of Debt due to Banks and Financial Institution Act, 1993 defines various terms
used in the Act, as given under:
330 PP-CRVI
Appellate Tribunal
Appellate Tribunal means an Appellate Tribunal established under sub-section (1) of Section 8.
Bank
Under section 2(d) bank means
(i) banking company;
(ii) a corresponding new bank;
(iii) State Bank of India;
(iv) a subsidiary bank; or
(v) a Regional Rural Bank;
(vi) a multi -State co-operative bank.
Banking Company
Under section 2 (e) banking company shall have the meaning assigned to it in clause (c) of section 5 of the
Banking Regulation Act, 1949.
Chairperson
As per Section 2(ea) of the Act Chairperson means a chairperson of an Appellate Tribunal appointed under
Section 9.
Presiding officer
As per Section 2(ja) of the Act Presiding officer means the presiding officer of the Debts Recovery Tribunal
appointed under Sub-section (1) of Section 4.
Financial institution
Under Section 2(h) Financial institution means
(i) a public financial institution within the meaning of Section 4A of the Companies Act, 1956;
(ia) the securitisation company or reconstruction company which has obtained a certificate of
registration under sub-section (4) of section 3 of the Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial
Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest Act, 2002 (54 of 2002)
(ii) such other institution as the Central Government may, having regard to its business activity and the
area of its operation in India, by notification, specify.
Tribunal
As per Section 2(o) Tribunal means the Tribunal established under Sub-section (1) of Section 3.
ESTABLISHMENT OF TRIBUNAL
The Act provides that the Central Government shall by notification; establish one or more Tribunals, to be
known as the Debts Recovery Tribunal, to exercise the jurisdiction, powers and authority conferred on such
Tribunal by or under this Act. The Central Government shall also specify in the notification the areas within
which the Tribunal may exercise jurisdiction for entertaining and deciding the applications filed before it. The
Lesson 19
setting up of a Debt Recovery Tribunal is dependent upon the volume of cases. Higher the number of cases
within a territorial area, more the Debt Recovery Tribunals would be set up. Some cities have more than one
Debt Recovery Tribunal located therein. On the other hand, there are number of states that do not have Debt
Recovery Tribunals.
The details of the Tribunals constituted as of now
Debt Recovery Appellate Tribunals (DRATs)
DRAT Allahabad, DRAT Chennai, DRAT Delhi, DRAT Kolkata, DRAT Mumbai.
Debt Recovery Tribunals
DRT-I Ahmedabad, DRT-II Ahmedabad, DRT Allahabad, DRT Aurangabad, DRT Bangalore, DRT-I
Chandigarh, DRT-II Chandigarh, DRT-1 Chennai, DRT-2 Chennai, DRT Coimbatore, DRT Cuttak, DRT
Ernakulam, DRT Guwahati, DRT Hyderabad, DRT Jabalpur, DRT Jaipur, DRT-1 Kolkata, DRT-2 Kolkata,
DRT-3 Kolkata, DRT Lucknow, DRT-1 Mumbai, DRT-2 Mumbai, DRT-3 Mumbai, DRT Nagpur, DRT-1 New
Delhi, DRT-2 New Delhi, DRT-3 New Delhi, DRT Patna, DRT Pune, DRT Visakhapatnam, DRT Ranchi, DRT
Madurai.
Composition of Tribunal
The Act provides that a Tribunal shall consist of one person only, to be called the Presiding Officer, to be
appointed, by notification, by the Central Government. The Central Government may also authorise the
Presiding Officer of one Tribunal to discharge also the functions of the Presiding Officer of another Tribunal.
Any person who is, or who has been, or is qualified to be, a District Judge may be appointed as the Presiding
Officer, who shall, hold office for a term of five years from the date on which he enters his office or until he
attains the age of sixty-two years, whichever is earlier.
The Central Government shall also appoint one or more Recovery Officers and such other officers and
employees as the Government may think fit. The Recovery Officers and other officers and employees of a
Tribunal shall discharge their functions under the general superintendence of the Presiding Officer.
332 PP-CRVI
or each of the defendants where there are more than one, at the time of making the application, actually and
voluntarily resides, or carries on business or personally works for gain; or any of the defendants, where there
are more than one, at the time of making the application, actually and voluntarily resides, or carries on
business, or personally works for gain; or the cause of action, wholly or in part, arises.
Provided that the bank or financial institution may, with the permission of the Debts Recovery Tribunal, on an
application made by it, withdraw the application, whether made before or after the Enforcement of Security
Interest and Recovery of Debts Laws (Amendment) Ordinance, 2004 for the purpose of taking action under
the Securitisation and Reconstruction of Financial Assets and Enforcement of Security Interest Act, 2002 if
no such action had been taken earlier under that Act:
Provided further that any application made under the first proviso for seeking permission from the Debts
Recovery Tribunal to withdraw the application made under sub-section (1) shall be dealt with by it as
expeditiously as possible and disposed of within thirty days from the date of such application:
Provided also that in case the Debts Recovery Tribunal refuses to grant permission for withdrawal of the
application filed under this sub-section, it shall pass such orders after recording the reasons therefor.
Section 19(1A) of the Act, provides that every bank being, multi-State co-operative bank may, at its option,
opt to initiate proceedings under the Multi-State Co-operative Societies Act, 2002 to recover debts, whether
due before or after the date of commencement of the Enforcement of the Security Interest and Recovery of
Debts Laws (Amendment) Act, 2012 from any person instead of making an application under Chapter III of
the Recovery Debts Act, 1993.
Section 19(1B) states that in case, a bank being, multi-State co-operative bank has filed an application under
Chapter III of the Recovery Debts Act, 1993 and subsequently opts to withdraw the application for the
purpose of initiating proceeding under the Multi-State Co-operative Societies Act, 2002 to recover debts, it
may do so with the permission of the Tribunal and every such application seeking permission from the
Tribunal to withdraw the application made under sub-section (1A) shall be dealt with by it as expeditiously as
possible and disposed of within thirty days from the date of such application:
It may be noted that in case the Tribunal refuses to grant permission for withdrawal of the application filed
under Section 19 (1B), it shall pass such orders after recording the reasons therefor.
Further, when a Bank or a financial institution, which has to recover its debt from any person, has filed an
application to the Tribunal and against the same person and another bank or financial institution also has a
claim to recover its debt, then, the later bank or financial institution may join the applicant bank or financial
institution at any stage of the proceedings, before the final order is passed by making an application to that
Tribunal.
Every application has to be made in such form and be accompanied by such documents or other evidence
and by such fee as may be prescribed.
Section 19(3A) provides that if any application filed before the Tribunal for recovery of any debt is settled
prior to the commencement of the hearing before that Tribunal or at any stage of the proceedings before the
final order is passed, the appplicant may be granted refund of the fees paid by him at such prescribed rates .
On receipt of application, the Tribunal shall issue summons requiring the defendant to show cause within
thirty days of the service of summons as to why the relief prayed for should not be granted.
The defendant shall, within a period of thirty days from the date of service of summons, present a written
statement of this defence:
Lesson 19
However, when the defendant fails to file the written satatement within the said period of thirty days, the
Presiding Officer may, in exceptional cases and in special circumstances to be recorded in writing, allow not
more than two extensions to the defendant to file the written statement.
After hearing of the application has commenced, it shall be continued from day-to-day until the hearing is
concluded. Tribunal may grant adjournments if sufficient cause is shown, but no such adjournment shall be
granted more than three times to a party and where there are three or more parties, the total number of such
adjournments shall not exceed six. The Presiding Officer may grant such adjournments on imposing such
costs as may be considered necessary.
Where the defendant claims to set-off against the applicants demand any ascertained sum of money legally
recoverable by him from such applicant, the defendant may, at the first hearing of the application, but not
afterwards unless permitted by the Tribunal, present a written statement containing the particulars of the debt
sought to be set-off.
Section 19(7) provides that the written statement shall have the same effect as a plaint in a cross suit so as
to enable the Tribunal to pass a final order in respect of both the original claim and of the set off.
The defendant in an application may, in addition to his right of pleading a set off, set up, by way of counterclaim against the claim of the applicant, any right or claim in respect of a cause of action accruing to the
defendant against the applicant either before or after the filing of the application but before the defendant has
delivered his defence or before the time limited for delivering his defence has expired, whether such counterclaim is in the nature of a claim for damages or not.
Tribunal may, after giving the applicant and the defendant an opportunity of being heard, pass such orders
on the application as it deems fit to meet the ends of justice. A counter-claim shall have the same effect as a
cross-suit so as to enable the Tribunal to pass a final order on the same application, both on the original
claim and on the counter-claim.
The applicant shall be at liberty to file a written statement in answer to the counterclaim of the defendant
within such period as may be fixed by the Tribunal.
Where a defendant sets up a counterclaim and the applicant contents that the claim thereby raised ought not
be disposed of by way of a counter-claim but in an independent action, the applicant may, at any time before
issues are settled in relation to the counter-claim, apply to the Tribunal for an order that such counterclaim
may be excluded, and the Tribunal may, on hearing of such application, make such order as it thinks fit.
The Tribunal may make an interim order (whether by way of injunction or stay or attachment) against the
defendant to debar him from transferring, alienating or otherwise dealing with, or disposing of, any property
and assets belonging to him without the prior permission of the Tribunal.
The objective behind empowering the Tribunals for issuing such a wide variety of interim orders is to prevent
unscrupulous persons from stripping the properties and/or encumbering them in such a manner so as to
defeat the lenders attempt at recovering the amounts advanced by them. The Tribunals can get the property
vacated, attach rents, appoint Commissioner to take inventory of the property and the stocks. The Tribunals
can go ahead and attach Bank Accounts, seal lockers and much more.
However, there are a number of judgements of the Supreme Court and the High Court which have laid down
conditions which must be followed by the Tribunals before passing orders which have pernicious effects on
current and running business establishments. Therefore, even though the Tribunals can pass orders of wide
variety, they are slow and cautious while passing such orders. Generally, they would first listen to the
defendants before the orders are passed.
334 PP-CRVI
Where at any stage of the proceedings, the Tribunal is satisfied by affidavit or otherwise, that the defendant,
with intent to obstruct or delay or frustrate the execution of any order for recovery of the debt that may be
passed against him,
(i) is about to dispose of the whole or any part of his property; or
(ii) is about to remove the whole or any part of his property from the local limits of the jurisdiction of the
Tribunal; or
(iii) is likely to cause any damage or mischief to the property or effect its value by misuse or creating
third party interest,
the Tribunal may direct the defendant, within a time fixed by the Tribunal, either to furnish security, in such
sum as may be specified in the order, or to appear and show cause why he should not furnish security.
Where the defendant fails to show cause why he should not furnish security, or fails to furnish the security
required, within the time fixed by the Tribunal, the Tribunal may order the attachment of the whole or such
portion of the properties claimed by the applicant as the properties secured is his favour or otherwise owned
by the defendant as appears sufficient to satisfy any certificate for the recovery of debt.
The applicant shall, unless the Tribunal otherwise directs, specify the property required to be attached and
estimate the value thereof.
The Tribunal may also in the order direct the conditional attachment of the whole or any portion of the
property. In case of disobedience of an order made by the Tribunal or breach of any of the terms on which
the order was made, the Tribunal may order the properties of the person to be attached and may also order
such person guilty of such disobedience or breach be detained in the civil prison for a term not exceeding
three months, unless in the meantime the Tribunal directs his release.
Where it appears to the Tribunal to be just and convenient, it may, by order
(a) appoint a receiver of any property, whether before or after the grant of certificate for recovery of
debt;
(b) remove any person from the possession or custody of the property;
(c) commit the same property to the possession, custody or management of the receiver;
(d) confer upon the receiver all such powers, as to bringing and defending suits in the courts, or filing
and defending applications before the Tribunal and for the realization, management, protection,
preservation and improvement of the property, the collection of rents and profits thereof, the
application and disposal of such rents and profits, and the execution of documents as the owner
himself has, or such of those powers as the Tribunal thinks fit; and
(e) appoint a Commissioner for preparation of an inventory of the properties of the defendant or for the
sale thereof.
Where the certificate of recovery is issued against a company registered under the Companies Act, 1956,
the Tribunal may order the sale proceeds of the company to be distributed among its secured creditors in
accordance with the provisions of Section 529A of the Companies Act, 1956 and to pay the surplus, if any, to
the company.
The Tribunal may, after giving the applicant and the defendant an opportunity of being heard, pass such
interim or final order, including the order for payment of interest from date on or before which payment of the
amount is found due upto the date of realization or actual payment, on the application as it thinks fit to meet
the ends of justice.
Lesson 19
Where it is proved to the satisfaction of the Tribunal that the claim of the applicant has been adjusted wholly
or in part by any lawful agreement or compromise in writing and signed by the parties or where the defendant
has repaid or agreed to repay the claim of the applicant, the Tribunal shall pass orders recording such
agreement, compromise or satisfaction of the claim.
The Tribunal shall send a copy of every order passed by it to the applicant and the defendant. The
Chairperson shall issue a certificate under his signature on the basis of the order of the Tribunal, to the
Recovery Officer for recovery of the amount of debt specified in the certificate. Where the Tribunal, which
has issued a certificate of recovery, is satisfied that the property is situated within the local limits of the
jurisdiction of two or more Tribunals, it may send the copies of the certificate of recovery for execution to
such other Tribunals where the property is situated. Provided that in case where the Tribunal to which the
certificate of recovery is sent for execution finds that it has no jurisdiction to comply with the certificate of
recovery, it shall return the same to the Tribunal which has issued it.
The application made to the Tribunal shall be dealt with by it as expeditiously as possible and endeavour
shall be made by it to dispose of the application finally within one hundred and eighty days from the date or
receipt of the application. The Tribunal may make such orders and give such directions as may be necessary
or expedient to give effect to its orders or to prevent abuse of its process or to secure the ends of justice.
336 PP-CRVI
The Tribunal and the Appellate Tribunal shall have, for the purposes of discharging their functions under this
Act, the same powers as are vested in a civil court under the Code of Civil Procedure, 1908, while trying a
suit, in respect of the following matters, namely:
(a) summoning and enforcing the attendance of any person and examining him on oath;
(b) requiring the discovery and production of documents;
(c) receiving evidence on affidavits;
(d) issuing commissions for the examination of witnesses or documents;
(e) reviewing its decisions;
(f) dismissing an application for default or deciding it ex parte;
(g) setting aside any order of dismissal of any application for default or any order passed by it ex parte;
(h) any other matter which may be prescribed.
Any proceeding before the Tribunal or the Appellate Tribunal shall be deemed to be a judicial proceeding
within the meaning of Sections 193 and 228, and for the purposes of Section 196, of the Indian Penal Code,
1860 and the Tribunal or the Appellate Tribunal shall be deemed to be a civil court for all the purposes of
Section 195 and Chapter XXVI of the Code of Criminal Procedure, 1973.
Limitations
The provisions of the Limitation Act, 1963, shall, as far as may be, apply to an application made to a
Tribunal.
Lesson 19
tribunal shall intimate to the Recovery Officer any order withdrawing or cancelling a certificate or any
correction made by him.
338 PP-CRVI
post office, bank, financial institution, or an insurer, it shall not be necessary for any pass book, deposit
receipt, policy or any other document to be produced for the purpose of any entry, endorsement or the like to
be made before the payment is made notwithstanding any rule, practice or requirement to the contrary.
Any claim respecting any property in relation to which a notice under this sub-section has been issued
arising after the date of the notice shall be void as against any demand contained in the notice. Where a
person to whom a notice under this sub-section is sent, objects to it by a statement on oath that the sum
demanded or the part thereof is not due to the defendant or that he does not hold any money for or on
account of the defendant, then, nothing contained in this sub-section shall be deemed to require such person
to pay any such sum or part thereof, as the case may be, but if it is discovered that such statement was false
in any material particular, such person shall be personally liable to the Recovery Officer to the extent of his
own liability to the defendant on the date of the notice, or to the extent of the defendants liability for any sum
due under this Act, whichever is less.
The Recovery Officer may, at any time or from time to time, amend or revoke any notice under this subsection or extend the time for making any payment in pursuance of such notice. This Recovery Officer shall
grant a receipt for any amount paid in compliance with a notice issued under this sub-section, and the person
so paying shall be fully discharged from his liability to the defendant, to the extent of the amount so paid.
Any person discharging any liability to the defendant after the receipt of a notice under this sub-section shall
be personally liable to the Recovery Officer to the extent of his own liability to the defendant so discharged or
to the extent of the defendants liability for any debt due under this Act, whichever is less.
If the person to whom a notice has been sent under this sub-section, fails to make payment in pursuance
thereof to the Recovery Officer, he shall be deemed to be a defendant in default in respect of the amount
specified in the notice and further proceedings may be taken against him for the realization of the amount as
if it were a debt due from him, in the manner provided in Section 25, 26 and 27 and the notice shall have the
same effect as an attachment of debt by the Recovery Officer in exercise of his powers under Section 25.
The Recovery Officer may apply to the court in whose custody there is money belonging to the defendant for
payment to him of the entire amount of such money, or if it is more than the amount of debt due, an amount
sufficient to discharge the amount of debt so due.
The Recovery Officer may, by order, at any stage of the execution of the certificate of recovery, require any
person, and in case of a company, any of its officers against whom or which the certificate or recovery is
issued, to declare on affidavit the particulars of his or its assets. The Recovery officer may recover any
amount of debt due from the defendant by distraint and sale of his movable property in the manner laid down
in the Third Schedule to the Income-Tax Act, 1961.
Lesson 19
Income and the Income Tax (Certificate Proceedings) Rules, 1962, have become applicable for the
realization of the dues by the Recovery Officer. Detailed procedure for recovery is contained in these
Schedules to the Income Tax Act, including provisions relating to arrest and detention of the defaulter. It
cannot, therefore, be said that the Recovery Officer would act in an arbitrary manner.
Furthermore, Section 30, after amendment by the Amendment Act, 2000, gives a right to any person
aggrieved by an order of the Recovery Officer, to prefer an appeal to the Tribunal. Thus now an appellate
forum has been provided against any orders of the Recovery Officer which may not be in accordance with
the law. There is, therefore, sufficient safeguard which has been provided in the event of the Recovery
Officer acting in an arbitrary or an unreasonable manner.
340 PP-CRVI
Sub- section (2) states that the provisions of this Act or the rules made thereunder shall be in addition to,
and not in derogation of, the Industrial Finance Corporation Act, 1948, the State Financial Corporations Act,
1951, the Unit Trust of India Act, 1963, the Industrial Reconstruction Bank of India Act, 1984, the Sick
Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 (1 of 1986) and the Small Industries Development Bank
of India Act, 1989 (39 of 1989)].
In the case of Official Liquidator, U.P and Uttarakhand v. Allahabad Bank and
Others[2013] 177 Comp Cas 426 (SC) Supreme Court observed that Section 34 of the
RDB Act would have overriding effect. The RDB Act is a comprehensive Code dealing
with all the facets pertaining to adjudication, appeal and realization of the dues payable
to the banks and financial institutions. The Debt Recovery Tribunal has exclusive jurisdiction
exclusive jurisdiction to sell the properties in proceeding instituted by bank or financial institution, but at the
time of auction sale, it is required to associate the Official Liquidator.
LESSON ROUND UP
Recovery of Debts Laws Act, 1993 is an Act to provide for the establishment of Tribunals for xpeditious
adjudication and recovery of debts due to banks and financial institutions and for matters connected
therewith or incidental thereto.
Enforcement of Security Interest and Recovery of Debts Laws (Amendment) Act, 2012 amended the
Recovery of Debts due to Banks & Financial Institutions (RDBFI) Act so as to strengthen the regulatory and
institutional framework related to recovery of debts due to banks and financial institutions.
The Act was passed to provide for the speedy adjudication of matters relating to recovery of debts due to
banks and financial institutions.
The RDB Act is a comprehensive Code dealing with all the facets pertaining to adjudication, appeal and
realization of the dues payable to the banks and financial institutions.
Section 19 of the Act deals with the procedure for making application to the Tribunal.
Section 20 of the Act deals with provisions for an appeal to an Appellate Tribunal having jurisdiction in the
matter.
The Tribunal and the Appellate Tribunal have the same powers as are vested in a Civil Court under the
Code of Civil Procedure, 1908.
The Recovery Officer may proceed to recover the amount of debt by any of the specified modes under
Section 25 of the Act.
Any person who is aggrieved by an order of Recovery Officer may prefer an appeal to the Tribunal. The
Debts Recovery Tribunal has the powers under the RDBFI Act, 1993 to make an enquiry as it deems fit and
confirm, modify or set aside the order made by the Recovery Officer. The auction, sale and challenge are
completely codified under the Act, regard being had to the special nature of the legislation.
The provisions of the Limitation Act, 1963, shall, as far as may be, apply to an application made to a
Tribunal.
Lesson 19
342 PP-CRVI
Lesson 20
Winding Up
LESSON OUTLINE
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Corporate Collapse implies business failure of the
company, which may occur due to inadequate capital,
fraudulent business practices, management inexperience
and incompetence, failure to respond to change,
recession, obsolescence, excessive gearing etc.
Introduction
Meaning of winding up
Modes of winding up
Outsourcing
Professionals.
Responsibility
of
344 PP-CRVI
INTRODUCTION
Winding-up of a company is a process of putting an end to the life of a company. It is a proceeding by means
of which a company is dissolved and in the course of such dissolution its assets are collected, its debts are
paid off out of the assets of the company or from contributions by its members, if necessary. If any surplus is
left, it is distributed among the members in accordance with their rights.
Winding-up is the process by which management of a companys affairs is taken out of its directors hands,
its assets are realized by a liquidator and its debts are realized and liabilities are discharged out of proceeds
of realization and any surplus of assets remaining is returned to its members or shareholders. At the end of
the winding up the company will have no assets or liabilities and it will, therefore, be simply a formal step for
it to be dissolved, that is, for its legal personality as a corporation to be brought to an end.
The main purpose of winding up of a company is to realize the assets and pay the debts of the company
expeditiously and fairly in accordance with the law. However, the purpose must not be exploited for the
benefit or advantage of any class or person entitled to submit petition for winding up of a company. It may be
noted that on winding up, the company does not cease to exist as such except when it is dissolved. The
administrative machinery of the company gets changed as the administration is transferred in the hands of
the liquidator. Even after commencement of the winding-up, the property and assets of the company belong
to the company until dissolution takes place. On dissolution the company ceases to exist as a separate entity
and becomes incapable of keeping property, suing or being sued. Thus in between the winding up and
dissolution, the legal status of the company continues and it can be sued in the court of law.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 345
from the burden of its debts. The liquidator winds up its affairs and then terminates it through
dissolution.
3. Although in the administration of the assets of an insolvent company the insolvency rules apply,
they are, however, not identical with those of insolvency. For example, the reputed ownership
clause of insolvency law has no application in the case of a company in liquidation.
4. In the case of an individual, the administration of his property by the Official Assignee or the Official
Receiver occurs only if he is declared an insolvent by the Court. But the assumption of the directors
powers by the liquidator, occurs even if the company is fully solvent. Liquidation or winding up, even
of an solvent company can be proceeded with the aid of the court, as in voluntary winding up.
346 PP-CRVI
MODES OF WINDING UP
A company registered under the Companies Act, 1956 may be wound up in any of the following modes:
1
Lesson 20
Winding Up 347
(h) if the company has acted against the interests of the sovereignty and integrity of India, the security
of the state, friendly relations with foreign states, public order, decency or morality; or (It may be
noted that the tribunal shall make an order for winding up of a company under clause (h) on
application made by the Central Government or a State Government)
(i) If the tribunal is of opinion that the company should be wound up under the circumstances specified
in Section 424 G (i.e winding up of a sick company):
348 PP-CRVI
ground for a Court to order winding up of a company. It has to be found out whether the non-commencement
or suspension of business is for good reason. The decisive question is whether there is reasonable hope of
the company commencing or resuming business and doing it at profit and whether substratum of the
company has disappeared. Another consideration is taking into account the wishes of majority of
shareholders about continuing the business.
Further, a company will not be wound up because it has ceased to carry on one of its several businesses
unless that business is the main object of the company. In Re. Amalgamated Syndicate [(1897) 2 Ch. D.
600], nor can a company which has amalgamated with another company be wound up on the ground that it
has ceased to carry on business as a separate company. If the company has made all possible efforts to
proceed with business but due to unforeseen circumstances beyond its control, company could not proceed,
company can not be ordered to be wound up under Section 433(c). [Bikkim Gopalakrishna Rao v. Seavally
Resorts (2000) 27 SCL 242].
In Surendra Kumar Pareek v. Shree Guru Nanak Oils (P) Ltd. (1995) 82 Comp. Cases 642 (Raj.), the
business of the company was suspended for over a year, the number of members was reduced to less than
two, all directors but one were absconding and the assets were taken over by the lending institutions, the
winding up was admitted despite objection from the lending institution that the winding up was being resorted
to, to estable the remaining liability to the Institution.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 349
assets and liabilities. The company is liable to be wound up if it is unable to pay its current demands
even though the assets, when realised, would exceed its liabilities or where its assets are locked up
and it is running at a loss. The important aspect to be examined in this situation is whether in a
commercial sense the company is in a position to pay its existing liabilities while it continues to carry
on its business.
A debt must be a definite sum of money payable immediately or at a future date. A contingent or conditional
liability is not a debt unless the contingency or condition has already happened [Registrar of Companies v.
Kavita Benefit Pvt. Ltd. (1978) 48 Comp. Cas. 231]. If the Court is satisfied that the company cannot pay its
admitted or undisputed debts, it may order the company to be wound up, however small such debts may be.
It is not necessary that demand should have been made or the execution levied. In Re. Globe Steel & Co. (7
Eq. 337), the company accepted a bill of exchange in part payment for goods bought. No demand had been
made nor execution levied. This bill was dishonoured. It was held that it was sufficient proof of the companys
inability to pay its debts. The Central Government is entitled to apply and obtain an order, for the compulsory
winding up of a company if the company is unable to pay a large sum lawfully due to it as income-tax
[Coimbatore Transport Co. Ltd. v. Governor General in Council (1948) 1 M.L.J. 407].
Where a debt is bona fide disputed by the company and the Court is satisfied with the companys defence,
there is no neglect to pay and therefore a winding up order will not be made [Piara Singh (S) v. S.H.R.
Properties Pvt. Ltd. (1993) 10 CLA 83]. Bona fide dispute implies the existence of a substantial ground for
the dispute raised. In other words, where there is scope for honest differences of opinion and disputes in
respect of the claim made, the Court will not entertain a winding up petition. [Bhabesh Chandra Guha Roy v.
Bisserwarlal Sharma, 1973 Tax LR 2331 (Cal)]. The Court may however at its discretion direct the company
to furnish security.
While hearing a winding up petition, the court decides only whether the company is liable to be wound up or
not. A winding up application can not be used for obtaining decision for recovery of debts due to any banks
or financial institution. The Tribunals constituted under the Recovery of Debts due to Banks and Financial
Institutions Act, 1993, does not have the jurisdiction to entertain an application for winding up of a company.
Such an application can be made only under the Companies Act, 1956 [Andhra Steel Corpn. Ltd. v. Bank of
Baroda (1996) 1 Comp. LJ 313].
A notice under Section 434 is a serious matter. If the notice is validly given, its effect would be to raise a
presumption as to the inability of the company to pay the debt and as to its insolvency rendering it liable to
be wound up by the Court. Such a notice must comply with the requirements of the statute. All that is
required by a statute is that the notice must be in respect of an existing and presently payable debt
exceeding ` 500/-. The notice will not be invalid merely because sum demanded is more than the sum
actually due. In such a case the sum due remains included in the demand (Ofu Lynx Ltd. v. Simon Carves
India Ltd., AIR 1970 Cal 418). The expression three weeks means three clear weeks from the date of the
demand. The date on which the demand is made is excluded. [In Re. Lympane Investments Ltd., (1972) 2
All. E.R. 385]. As for the second proposition it is sufficient if the company has informed a judgment-creditor
that it has no assets on which to levy execution or the payment was demanded from it by the petition or
without any success. [In Re. Flag Staff Co. of Utah, (1875) R. 20 Eq. 268]. If company persistently fails to
honour its commitment made at various stages to discharge its financial obligations, it has to held that it was
unable to pay its debts and is therefore liable to be wound up. [Bharwan Bros. v. Motorola (India) Ltd. (2000)
25 SCL 517 (Guj HC)].
It is not the requirement of Section 434 that the creditor in his notice must mention that in the event of noncompliance, the creditor will apply for winding up. No form has been prescribed for the notice. [Color Coats v.
Venkataramanas Hotels Ltd. AIR 1999 AP 16]. Notice is valid even in absence of stipulation of period of
350 PP-CRVI
three weeks notice and expression winding up proceedings, if the notice specifically states that in the event
of default in payment of debt due, appropriate legal proceedings will be taken. [J.G. Finance v. Hansaflon
Plastochem (2001) 30 SCL 430].
Lesson 20
Winding Up 351
directors have cheated several thousand investors, banks and FIs, company has not filed balance
sheet for two years and no reply from company to advertisement under Rule 24, the company is
liable to be wound up [ROC v. Country Informtech Services P. Ltd. (2002) 39 SCL 504 (All HC)].
The following are some of the cases in which winding up was not ordered under just and
equitable clause:
(i) Where the company was under a loss but there was a chance of its making profit and the majority of
shareholders were against winding up.
(ii) Where the directors in the exercise of their powers to do so, refused to register the executors of the
deceased shareholder even when this caused hardship to the shareholders.
(iii) Where there is honest difference between the petitioner, a director and the other directors and he
has been outvoted.
(iv) Where the business of the company was temporarily suspended owing to trade depression and was
intended to be continued when conditions improved.
(v) Where there was a deadlock in management of a public company.
(vi) If the just and equitable ground does not exist at the time of hearing the petition though it might
have existed at the time of presenting the petition.
Winding up by the Court1 or compulsory winding up is initiated by an application by way of petition to the
appropriate Court1 for a winding up order. A winding up petition has to be resorted to only when other means
of healing an ailing company are of absolutely no avail. Remedies are provided by the statute on matters
concerning the management and running of company. The extreme and irretrievable step of winding up must
be resorted to only in very compelling circumstances. [Daulat Makanmal Luthrid v. Solatire Hotels (1993) 76
Comp. Cas. 215 (Bom. HCD)]. It is primarily the High Court which has the jurisdiction to wind up companies
under Section 10 of the Companies Act, 1956 in relation to the place at which registered office of the
company concerned is situated except to the extent to which jurisdiction has been conferred on any District
or District Courts subordinate to the High Court. The Central Government may empower any District Court to
exercise that jurisdiction, presumably to reduce the burden of the High Court, only in respect of small
companies with the paid-up capital of not more than one lakh of rupees and having their registered office
within the District, with a view to achieving expeditious and efficient disposal of winding up proceedings. The
Act, therefore, under Sections 435 to 438,1 confers wide powers upon the High Court to regulate the conduct
of such proceedings. Accordingly the High Court which is the winding up Court may direct a District Court to
retain and continue winding up proceedings which should not really have been commenced in that Court
(Section 437). It may also withdraw any winding up which is in progress in a District Court from that Court
and proceed with the winding up itself, or transfer it to another District Court (Section 436), and with respect
to all proceedings subsequent to its own order of winding up, direct them to be had in a District Court or with
the consent of any other High Court, in such High Court or in a District Court subordinate to that High Court,
whereupon the Court in respect of which such direction is given shall be deemed to be the Court with all
powers and jurisdiction of the High Court under the Act (Section 435). Lastly, the High Court can pass orders
under any of the foregoing sections at any time and at any stage, whether or not an application in that behalf
is made by any of the parties to the proceedings (Section 438). There must be strong reasons to order
winding up as it is a last resort to be adopted. Temporary difficulty cannot be ground for liquidating company
when company is on path of revival. D. Ashokan v. S.T. Reddiar & Sons (2002) 40 SCL (Ker. HC DB).
1 Sections 435 to 438 have been omitted by Companies (Second Amendment) Act, 2002 w.e.f. a date yet to be notified.
352 PP-CRVI
In the case of Tower Vision India Pvt. Ltd. vs. Procall Private Limited CO.PET. 302/2009 CO.PET.
458/2010 & CA No.2179/2010 decided on 24th August, 2012[2012]115SCL 840/26 TAXMANN.COM
201(Delhi) the issue involved is whether in a contract for rendering of services/use of site, a stipulation to pay
an amount for lock-in-period, as an admitted debt within the meaning of section 433(e) or whether the same
is in the nature of damages. The Delhi High Court held that due to the following factors the amount of
unexpired lock-in period can not be treated as debt or liquidated damages:
(i) Whether a particular clause about pre-determined liquidated damages represents genuine covenanted
pre-estimate of damages or it is in the nature of penalty has to be judged in the facts of each case and in the
background of relevant factors which are case specific. In that case, no facts and circumstances were
pleaded to show that clause relating to lock-in period was a genuine pre-estimate of damages which the
petitioner would have suffered in case the respondent company vacated the premises before the expiry of
lock-in period.
(ii) In order to prove that amount mentioned as payable for the lock-in period is genuine pre-estimate of
damages, proper evidence is required of specific nature, namely, the landlord had altered its position by
making the premises available to the tenant keeping in view the tenants requirements and spending
thereupon. Certain expenditure was incurred on infrastructure specifically provided to the tenant as per
tenants requirements; certain other expenditure incurred on whitewashing, fixtures and fittings and the
landlord was forced to incur such expenditure again before giving the premises to new tenant and, therefore,
lock-in period was treated as reasonable period to avoid duplication of such expenditure, etc.
(iii) The doctrine of mitigation of damages may also apply in such cases and even if the tenant had
committed breach by leaving the premises before the expiry of lock-in period, it was for the landlord to prove
that he had taken reasonable steps to minimize the loss, but could not award the loss to the extent
mentioned in the clause and, therefore, the same is to be treated as genuine pre-estimation of the loss.
On this reasoning, in that case, winding up petition was dismissed.
Who may file Petition for the Winding up?
An application for the winding up of a company has to be made by way of petition to the Court. A petition
may be presented under Section 439 by any of the following persons:
(a) the company; or
(b) any creditor or creditors, including any contingent or prospective creditor or creditors; or
(c) any contributory or contributories; or
(d) all or any of the parties specified above in clauses (a), (b), (c) whether together or separately; or
(e) the Registrar; or
(f) any person authorised by the Central Government in the case falling under Section 243, i.e.,
following upon a report of inspectors; or
1
(g) in case falling under clause (h) of Section 433, by the Central Government or State Government
i.e. Company acing against the interest of the sovereignty and integrity of India.
1 Inserted by Companies (Second Amendment) Act, 2002 w.e.f. a date yet to be notified.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 353
354 PP-CRVI
pay off the dues, that could only be possible upon sale of those assets and the company would hardly have
anything left to carry on its day-to-day business. The petition was maintainable in terms of section 433(e)
and (f) read with section 439(1)(b) and (2) of the 1956 Act.
That non-receipt of the acknowledgment card for the statutory notice sent by the creditor by itself could not
be a ground to deny admission of the petition and that this irregularly could not be presumed mala fide. The
order of the single judge was set aside and the petition remanded to the single judge for necessary direction
with regard to admission and advertisement.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 355
356 PP-CRVI
The object of making these provisions is to prevent a person buying a share or two in order to qualify himself
as a contributory to wreck the company.
In Re. Gattapardo Ltd. (1969) 2 All. ER 344, a transfer of shares had been executed, stamped and dated in
June, 1967. The company did not register it until October, 1968. The shareholder presented a petition for the
winding up of the company in December, 1968. It was held that the petition did not lie, as the petitioner
shareholder did not hold her shares for six months as required by the Act. However, where the company has
been ordered by the Court to allot shares and had failed to do so, the person in whose favour the order had
been made was qualified to apply [In Re. Petent Steam Engines Co. (1878) 8 Ch.D. 464].
A petition for the winding up of a company can be presented by a contributory notwithstanding the fact that
he may be holder of fully paid-up shares or the company may have no assets at all or may have no surplus
assets at all or may have no surplus assets left for distribution amongst the shareholders after satisfaction of
its liabilities towards creditors. A contributory is, thus, entitled to present a winding up petition even when the
company is insolvent and is not in a position to satisfy even the creditors and the contributory have no
tangible interest is as much as nothing is left back for distribution amongst the shareholders.
It may be noted that an insolvent shareholder whose name still appears on the register of members as holder
of the shares may present petition as a contributory at the instance of the Official Assignee or Receiver, but
the Official Assignee or Receiver himself cannot petition as he is not a contributory. Again, a legal
representative of a deceased shareholder can present petition for a winding up order.
By virtue of Section 243, if any report of an inspector appointed under Section 235 or 237 to investigate
1 Powers are now delegated to Regional Directors.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 357
358 PP-CRVI
proceeding. The Court to which application is so made may stay or restrain the proceedings accordingly on
such terms as it thinks fit (Section 442): [See also Governor General-in Council v. Shiromani Sugar Mills,
AIR (1946) FC 16].(This provision has been omitted by Companies(Second Amendment) Act, 2002. How
ever effective date is yet to be notified)
(v) Two companies cannot be wound up by the same order.
(vi) In case several petitions are presented; they rank according to the date of presentation.
(vii) On hearing the petition, the Court may either
(a) dismiss it, with or without costs, or
(b) adjourn the hearing conditionally or unconditionally, or
(c) make any interim order that it thinks fit, or
(d) make a compulsory order for winding up the company with or without costs, or any other order that
it may deem fit [Section 443(1)].
[(xi) 1[As soon as the Court makes an order for the winding up of a company, the court shall forthwith cause
intimation thereof to be sent to the Official Liquidator and the Registrar. This is necessary so that Official
Liquidator can take up the administration of the Company in winding up immediately (Section 444).]
In the case of Laguna Holdings P. Ltd. And Others v. Edin Park Hotels P. Ltd. And others [2013] 176 Comp
Cas 118 & 119 (Delhi), maintainability of winding up petition, to be taken as a preliminary issue. The
admission of a petition for winding up itself and the public advertisement which has to be effected being a
necessary corollary of its admission would cause irreparable harm to the company if the petition ultimately
fails. This is especially so if it is a solvent company. Relied on the case of Mridula Bhaskar(Smt) v. Iswar
Industries Ltd. , Delhi high Court held that Section 433(f) of the Companies Act, 1956, has necessarily to be
read along with Section 443(2) of the Act which stipulates that the court may refuse to make an order for
winding up where the just and equitable ground is being pressed if there is an alternative remedy available
to the petitioner and the court prima facie holds that the petition seeking winding up of the company on this
just and equitable clause is an unreasonable demand made by the petitioner.
The settled legal position is that the partnership principle for winding up a company would be applicable only
in cases where the deadlock is complete and irresoluble under its constitution.
Those who take advantage of a corporate body must be held bound by the provisions of the Act and the
averments that a limited company should be treated as a quasi partnership should not be easily accepted.
Once the partnership principle is rejected, the petitioner has to prove almost the same grounds for
succeeding in the petition and sections 397 and 398 must be treated as another alternative and effective
remedy. Thus, wherever an alternative remedy is available to a party, the just and equitable clause cannot
be resorted to casually. It is not the interest of the petitioner alone which has to be considered but the
general interest of the company; fairness demands that even of the just and equitable ground for winding
up is satisfied, the alternate remedy being available under section 397 of the 1956 Act, an order for winding
up should not be made and this is particularly so in a solvent and healthy company.
Under section 344 of the said Act the court at the time of hearing of winding up petition, may either dismiss it
1
Substituted by Companies (Second Amendment) Act, 2002 w.e.f. a date yet to be notified as:
Where the tribunal makes an order for the winding up of the company, the tribunal shall within a period not exceeding two weeks
from the date of passing the order, cause intimation thereof to be sent to the official liquidator and the Registrar.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 359
with or without costs or in the second alternate, it may adjourn the hearing conditionally or unconditionally.
The third alternative gives powers to the Court to make any interim order as it thinks fit. Lastly it may make
an order for winding up of the company or any other order as it thinks fit. The words any other order as it
thinks fit have necessarily to be read ejusdem generis and in the context of the words preceding in the subclause meaning thereby that in the fourth alternate, the company judge may either wind up the company or
pass any other order in the course of its winding up of in its relation thereto.
(xii) On the making of a winding up order, it is the duty of the petitioner in the winding up proceedings and of
the company to file with the Registrar a certified copy of the order in e-form 21, within 30 days from the date
of making of the order. The Registrar shall thereupon make a minute thereof in his books relating to the
company and shall notify in the Official Gazette that such an order has been made. Such order shall be
deemed to be the notice of discharge to the officers and employees of the company, except when the
business of the company is continued. In computing the period of 30 days from the date of the making of a
winding up order under this section, the time requisite for obtaining certified copy of the order shall be
excluded [Section 445].
(xiii) When a winding up order has been made or the Official Liquidator has been appointed as Provisional
Liquidator, no suit or other legal proceedings shall be commenced, or if pending at the date of the winding
order, shall be proceeded with, against the company, except by leave of the Court and subject to such terms
as the Court may impose [Section 446].
(xiv) As per Section 449 of the Companies Act, 1956, on the issue of the winding up order, the Official
Liquidator becomes the liquidator of the company by virtue of his office.
In Mafatbhai v. Shah v. Secretary (2000) 27 SCL 361, it was held that if Official Liquidator does not have
adequate staff and is not in a position to look after properties of the company which are wound up under
orders of the Court, he can get Receiver appointed with the leave of the Court. The Court can pass
appropriate orders.
(xv) The Court shall also settle the list of contributories, make calls and determine any other question arising
in winding up on the application of the liquidator (Section 467).
(xvi) Where the Court has made the order or appointed the Official Liquidator, the directors, secretary,
manager or chief officer of the company shall make out and submit to the Official Liquidator, a statement as
to the affairs of the company in the prescribed form, verified by an affidavit, containing the following
particulars:
(a) the assets of the company stating separately the balance in hand and at the bank and the
negotiable securities, if any, held by the company;
(b) its debts and liabilities;
(c) the names, residences and occupations of its creditors, stating separately the amount of secured
and unsecured debts; and in the case of secured debts particulars of securities, their values and
their dates;
(d) the debts due to the company and the names and addresses of the debtors and the amount likely to
be realised thereupon [Section 454(1)];
(e) such further or other information as may be prescribed, or as the official liquidator may require.
This statement has to be submitted within 21 days from the date of the appointment of provisional liquidator
or if no such appointment is made, the date of winding up order. The Official Liquidator or the Court, for
360 PP-CRVI
special reasons, may extend this time up to three months. The persons making the statement and affidavit
are to be paid by the Official Liquidator or Provisional Liquidator out of the assets of the company, such costs
and expenses incurred as the Official Liquidator may consider reasonable subject to an appeal to the Court.
If any person without reasonable excuse makes a default in complying with any requirements of this section,
he is liable to be punished with imprisonment for a term which may extend to two years or to a fine not
exceeding `1,000 for every day during which the default continues. This is a criminal liability triable by the
winding up Court, which is a High Court itself. For speedy administration of liquidation proceedings it is
necessary that Official Liquidator should know all the assets and liabilities with necessary details at an early
date. If directors and officers commit default, without reasonable excuse then they are criminally liable to
severe punishment.
In Official Liquidator v. P.R. Mehta (2000) 36 CLA 210, it was held that the prosecution has to prove that the
person has failed to submit the statement without reasonable cause. If a person was not director on relevant
date or if there was reasonable cause for non-filing for statement, liability under this provision would not be
there. In Indla Satya Raju v. Sramika Agro Farm (2002) 39 SCL 940, it was held that a person cannot be
prosecuted and convicted order Section 454 merely for reason that he committed default in complying with
any requirements of Section 454. In addition to establishing default, prosecution is also required to establish
that the said person, without reasonable excuse, committed such fault.
(xvii) After the receipt of the above statement the Official Liquidator prepares and submits a preliminary
report to the winding up Court within six months or such extended period as may be allowed by the Court
stating the amount of capital issued, subscribed and paid-up and the estimated amount of assets and
liabilities of the company in liquidation giving separately, under the heading of assets, particulars of:
1. Cash and negotiable securities;
2. Debts due from contributories;
3. Debts due to the company and security, if any, available in respect thereof;
4. Moveable and immovable properties belonging to the company; and
5. Unpaid calls (Section 455).
If the liquidator is of the opinion that a fraud has been played in relation to the company and if he thinks fit he
may submit a further report to the Court in this regard [Section 455(2)]. This report of the Official Liquidator is
absolutely privileged. The preliminary report of the Official Liquidator shall be heard by the judge in
Chambers. The Judge can give such directions as he may consider necessary. On further report there can
be a direction about the public examination of the directors (Section 478).
(xviii) The Official Liquidator shall take into his custody or control all the property, effects an actionable claims
to which the company is or appears to be entitled. For this purpose, he can take help of the Chief Presidency
Magistrate or District Magistrate (Section 456). The Official Liquidator then acts as a custodian. His position
is that of a receiver and an officer of the Court. The liquidator has to realise all the assets. For that he may
institute various legal proceedings, sell the immovable and movable property and actionable claims of the
company and distribute these assets (Section 457). For this purpose he has to invite claims from creditors,
settle them and make payments to creditors as per their respective rights (Sections 528 to 530).
A Liquidator is an agent employed for the purpose of winding up of the company. In some respects he is a
trustee, but he is not a trustee for each individual creditor. His principal duties are to take possession of
assets, to make out the requisite list of contributories and of creditors, to have disputed cases adjudicated
upon, to realize the assets subject to the control of the Court in certain matters and to apply the proceeds in
Lesson 20
Winding Up 361
payment of the companys debts and liabilities in due course of administration and having done that, to divide
the surplus amongst the contributories and to adjust their rights [Discount Bank of India Ltd. (in liquidation) v.
Trilok Nath (1952) 54 Punj LR 335].
In Remu Pipes v. IFCI (2002) 35 SCL 358, it was held that ownership of assets of company in liquidation
remains with the company but by a legal fiction the properties are taken to be vested in the Court. The
Official Liquidator takes properties under his control and custody with the permission of Court and under its
superintendence. The Official Liquidator is custodian of property and statutory trustee. Assets of company in
liquidation vest in Court and not in Official Liquidator. Official Liquidator can not sell property without sanction
of Court. He has no absolute say in the matter of disposal of the companys property. While granting
sanction, the Court can issue suitable directions as it may think fit and proper.
On commencement of winding up, the limitation ceases to run in favour of the company. The period from the
date of commencement of winding to up date of the making of the winding up order (both inclusive) and a
period of one year from the date of winding up order is excluded for computing the period of limitation for any
suit or application in the name and on behalf of the company, notwithstanding the provisions of the Limitation
Act, 1963 or any other law for the time being in force. The suit or application must satisfy both the conditions,
i.e., it must be in the name and on behalf of the company [Section 458(A)].
This relaxation and extension is only in favour of the company i.e. it is only in respect of suit or application in
the name and on behalf of the company. It is not applicable to suits filed against the company. However, if
the debt was time barred on date of winding up (i.e. when application for winding up was made) and was not
enforceable, it does not get revived on filing of winding up application and passing of winding up order.
[Karnataka Steel v. Kohinoor Rolling Shutters (2002) AIR SCW 4613].
(xix) By virtue of Section 482, any order made by a Court for, or in the course of, winding up a company is
enforceable at any place in India other than that over which such Court has jurisdiction, by the Court which
would have jurisdiction if the registered office of the company had been situated at such place, and in the
same manner in all respects as if the order had been made by that Court. The section may be illustrated by a
decision of the Andhra Pradesh High Court in Tulasamma v. Subhadaya Publications Ltd., AIR 1969 AP 207
that the District Court in Andhra Pradesh has jurisdiction to execute the order of the Madras High Court
calling upon a judgment-debtor to pay call money which was sent to the Andhra Pradesh High Court for
enforcement.
The expression in the course of winding up as used in the section is not limited to what happens after a
winding up order is made. As was pointed out by Sir George Jessel, M.R. in [ In Re. International Pulp and
Paper Co. (1876) 3 Ch.D. 594], it would defeat the object of enabling the Court, once a winding up petition is
presented, to see that the creditors of the company share rateably in the assets and that one particular
creditor is not enabled to jump the gun by taking an enforcement proceeding to any part of the country. The
words have accordingly been widely interpreted to mean that once a winding up petition has been presented,
everything thereafter is in the course of winding up a company, although it does not necessarily follow that a
winding up order will eventually be made [In Re. Dynamics Corporation of America, (1976) 2 All ER 669].
362 PP-CRVI
supervision of matters as distinguished from an order which decides the rights of parties or confers or
refuses to confer rights to property which are the subject of adjudication before the Court. Thus, where the
Court confirms the winding up sale after hearing the two contending parties and the order vitally affects the
rights of such parties, the Court in making the order acts in a judicial way, and the order is a judicial way, and
not a procedural or administrative one so as to be inherently incable of being brought up in appeal
[Shankarlal v. Shankarlal, AIR 1965 SC 507]. On the same principle, an order refusing stay of the winding up
proceedings is a judicial order in the matter of winding up and is appealable (Jagannath Gupta & Co. v.
Mulchand Gupta, AIR 1969 Cal 363). The stay order made in this case was set aside by the Supreme Court.
On the other hand, no appeal would lie against an order removing a liquidator since such order cannot be
said to be an order determining or affecting any rights of the parties in the winding up (Gordhan Das v.
Shilwate Deve, AIR 1963 All. 606).
Similarly, an order dropping the misfeasance proceedings under Section 543 against some of the directors at
an initial stage on the ground that there is no prima facie case against them directing them to continue
against the other is not appealable since it cannot be said to decide finally the rights and liabilities even in
respect of the former and the Court can reopen the inquiry in respect of them on the basis of fresh materials
or otherwise according to law (D.C. Mehta v. Lakshmipat, AIR 1968 Pat. 280).
The expression in the matter of the winding up of a company as used in the Section would include the case
of an application made under Section 446 of the Act for leave to file a suit against the company, and the
order made on such application would be appealable under the Section (Balkrishna Mahadeo Vertak v.
Indian Associate Chemical Industries Ltd., 60 Bom. LR 30). The expression also includes an order directing
advertisement of the winding up petition and an appeal would lie against such order (Western India Theatres
Ltd. v. Ishwarbhai Somabhai Patel, AIR 1959 Bom. 386); [Golcha Investment (P) Ltd., v. S.C.Bafna, AIR
1970 SC 1850]. In the latter case, the Supreme Court further held that, by virtue of Rule 966-A in Chapter XII
of the Bombay High Court Rules, such an appeal was entitled to be admitted as a matter of course and could
not be summarily dismissed as was done by the High Court treating the order appealed against as
interlocutory order.
The second part of the section which refers to the manner in which and the conditions subject to which
appeals may lie must be construed as merely regulating the procedure to be followed in the presentation of
the appeal and of hearing them, the period of limitation within which the appeal is to be presented and the
forum to which the appeal would lie, and not as restricting or impairing the substantial right of appeal which
has been conferred by the opening words of the section. It must be noted, however, that though the rights of
appeal under the section is a substantive right, since the procedure applicable to regular appeals under the
Civil Procedure Code is applicable to the appeals under the section, the right to file a cross-appeal or a
cross-objection to any such appeal is a matter of procedure as comprised in Order 41, Rule 22 of that Code.
Consequently, the respondent to any such appeal is entitled to file a cross objection under that provision of
the Code [The Central Provinces Syndicate (Private) Ltd. v. Sita Devi, AIR 1973 MP 134].
Lesson 20
Winding Up 363
Where an order in the above circumstances is made by the Court, the company will be dissolved from the
date of the order of the Court. Within 30 days from the date of the order, the liquidator must send a copy of
the order to the Registrar. On the dissolution, the corporate existence of the company comes to an end.
After order of dissolution, the company has no legal existence. Thus no suit can lie by or against the
company after order of dissolution. In Narendra Bahadur Tandon v. Shanker Lal AIR (1980) SC 575, it was
held that after company is dissolved, liquidator can not represent company and execute a deed of sale. Once
company is dissolved, it ceases to exist and official liquidator can not represent a non-existent company.
The property of dissolved company vest in Government and not in the trustee. Hence shareholders or
creditors of dissolved company cannot be regarded as heirs and successors. They cannot maintain any
action for recovery of assets.
The Court may at any time declare the dissolution void within two years from the date of dissolution on
application by the liquidator of the company or by any other person who appears to the Court to be
interested. Thereupon such proceedings may be taken as might have been taken if the company had not
been dissolved (Section 559).
In Rishabh Agro Industries Ltd. v. PNB Capital Services Ltd. (2000) AIR SCW, it was observed that winding
up order passed under the Companies Act is not the culmination of proceedings pending before company
Judge but is in effect the commencement of the process. The ultimate order to be passed in such a petition
is the dissolution under Section 481.
364 PP-CRVI
(iii) He should help in preparation of the statement of affairs of the company in the precribed form for
submission to the Official Liquidator. He should see that it is properly verified by an affidavit.
(iv) He should give all necessary information to the Court, when called upon by it during the course of
the winding up.
(v) He should see that all documents, correspondence etc., issued by the company during the period of
winding up contain a statement that the company is being wound up.
VOLUNTARY WINDING UP
The companies are usually wound up voluntarily as it is an easier process of winding up. It is altogether
different from a compulsory winding up. In voluntary winding up the company and its creditors are left to
settle their affairs without going to a Court, although they may apply to the Court for directions or orders, as
and when necessary. One or more liquidators are to be appointed by the company in general meeting for the
purpose of winding up the affairs and distributing the assets of the company. The remuneration of the
liquidators is also required to be fixed by the company in general meeting. Unless the remuneration as
aforesaid is fixed the liquidators shall not take charge of his/their offices (Section 490). The circumstances in
which a company may be wound up voluntarily are:
(a) when the period fixed for the duration of the company as mentioned in its articles has expired; or
(b) the event, on the happening of which the articles provide that the company is to be dissolved has
occurred; and
(c) the company passes a special resolution that the company be wound up voluntarily [Section 484
(1)].
Thus, a company may be wound up voluntarily on the expiry of the term fixed for duration of the company or
on the occurrence of the event as provided in its articles. In these two cases only an ordinary resolution may
be passed in the general meeting of the company. Apart from these two cases, a company may be
voluntarily wound up for any other reason as well for which a company has to pass a special resolution. A
proper notice required for the respective meetings must be given to all the members and in the latter case
the text of the special resolution to be passed together with the reason to wind up voluntarily must be
mentioned therein.
The resolution (whether ordinary or special), when passed, must be advertised within 14 days of the passing
of the resolution in the Official Gazette and also in some newspaper circulating in the district where the
registered office of the company is situated. A default in complying with the above requirements renders the
company and every officer of the company, who is in default, liable to a penalty which may extend to five
hundred rupees for every day during which the default continues. A liquidator of the company is deemed to
an officer of the company for the purposes of the above requirements (Section 485).
A voluntary winding up commences from the date of the passing of the resolution for voluntary winding up.
This is so even when after passing a resolution for voluntary winding up, a petition is presented for winding
up by the Court.
The effect of the voluntary winding up is that the company ceases to carry on its business except so for as
may be required for the beneficial winding up thereof. The corporate status and the powers of the company,
however, continue until it is dissolved [Section 487].
Lesson 20
Winding Up 365
366 PP-CRVI
made by it under Section 490, of every vacancy occurring in the office of the liquidator, and of the name of
the liquidator or liquidators appointed to fill every such vacancy under Section 492. The notice aforesaid shall
be given by the company in within 10 days of the event to which it relates. In case of default, the company
and every officer of the company (including every liquidator or continuing liquidator) who is in default, shall
be punishable with fine extending up to ` 1,000 for every day till the default continues [Section 493]. The
liquidator must also inform the Registrar of his appointment within thirty days thereof and publish the notice
in the Official Gazette (Section 516). He is also required to file Form No. 152 of the Companies (Court)
Rules, 1959 with Registrar. He is also required to notify his appointment to the Income-tax Officer who is
entitled to assess the income of the company. He must also comply with the other provisions of the Section
178 of the Income Tax Act.
(vi) The liquidator (under members voluntary winding up) may transfer the whole or any part of the
companys business or property to another company (called the transferee company) and receive, with the
sanction of the special resolution of the transferor company by way of compensation for the transfer or sale,
shares, policies or other like interests in the transferee company, for distribution among the members of the
transferor company or may enter into any other arrangement whereby the members of the transferor
company may in lieu of receiving cash, shares, policies, or other like interests participate in the profits or
receive any benefit from the transferee company. Any sale or arrangement made by the liquidator shall be
binding on the members of the transferor company [Section 494(1) and (2)].
If any member of the transferor company, who did not vote in favour of the special resolution, objects to the
arrangement entered into by the liquidator, he may express his dissent in writing addressed to the liquidator
and leave it at the registered office of the company within seven days after the passing of the resolution and
he may also require the liquidator either to abstain from carrying the resolution into effect or to purchase his
interest at a price to be determined by arrangement or by arbitration. If the liquidator decides to purchase the
dissenting members interest, the purchase money shall be paid before the company is dissolved [Section
494(3) and (4)].
(vii) In the event of the winding up continuing for more than one year, the liquidator is required to call general
meeting of the company at the end of the first year from the commencement of the winding up, and at the
end of the each succeeding year, or as soon thereafter as may be convenient within three months from the
end of the year or such longer period as the Central Government1 may allow, and must lay before the
meeting an account of his acts and dealings and of the conduct of the winding up during the preceding year,
together with a statement in the prescribed form containing the prescribed particulars with respect to the
proceedings and position of liquidation. In case of default, the liquidator is liable to a fine not exceeding
`1,000 (Section 496).
(viii) As soon as the affairs of the company are fully wound up, the liquidator has to make an account of the
winding up showing how the winding up has been conducted and the property of the company has been
disposed of and is required to summon a general meeting of the company for the purpose of laying the
account before it and giving any explanation thereof. The meeting must be called by giving a months notice
specifying the time, place and object of the meeting and the notice must appear in the Official Gazette and
also in some newspaper circulating in the district where the registered office of the company is situate. Within
one week after the meeting, the liquidator must send to the Registrar and the Official Liquidator a copy of the
account and shall make a return to each of them of the date and holding of the meeting. If a quorum is not
present at this meeting, the liquidator shall make a return that the meeting was duly called but the quorum
was not present [Section 497(1) to (4)].
Lesson 20
Winding Up 367
(ix) The Registrar, on receiving account and the return shall forthwith register them. The Official Liquidator,
on receiving the account and the return shall, as soon as may be, make and the liquidator and all officers,
past or present, of the company shall give the official liquidator all reasonable facilities to make a scrutiny of
books and papers of the company and if on such scrutiny the official liquidator makes a report to the Court
that the affairs of the company have not been conducted in a manner prejudicial to the interest of its
members or to public interest then from the date of submission of such report the company shall be deemed
to be dissolved. The Official Liquidator scrutinise the accounts of pre-liquidation as well as of post-liquidation
period and for discharging this duty the Voluntary Liquidator and all past and present Officers of the company
shall give to the Official Liquidator all reasonable facilities.
If on such scrutiny the Official Liquidator makes a report to the Court that the affairs of the company have
been conducted in a manner prejudicial to the interest of its members or to public interest, the Court shall by
order direct the Official Liquidator to make a further investigation of the affairs of the company and for that
purpose shall invest him with all such powers as the Court may deem fit.
On the receipt of the report of the Official Liquidator on such further investigation, the Court may either make
an order that the company shall stand dissolved with effect from the date to be specified by the Court therein
or make such other order as the circumstances of the case brought out in the report permit. If the liquidator
fails to call a general meeting of the company, he is also liable to fine extending up to `5,000 [Section 497(5)
to (7)].
368 PP-CRVI
is in default is liable to a fine which may extend to `500 for every day till the default continues. For this
purpose, a liquidator of the company shall be deemed to be an officer of the company [Section 501].
(v) The creditors and the company at their respective meetings mentioned in Section 500 may nominate a
person to be liquidator, but the person nominated by the creditors shall become the liquidator subject to an
application to the Court. If no person is nominated by the creditors, the person nominated by the company
shall be liquidator. Further if no person is nominated by the company, the person nominated by the creditors
shall be liquidator. (Section 502).
(vi) The creditors may at the same or subsequent meeting appoint a Committee of Inspection consisting of
not more than five members. If such a committee is appointed, the company may also at the same or any
subsequent general meeting appoint such number of persons not exceeding five as they think fit to act as
members of the committee. In any case, the creditors may resolve that all or any of the persons so appointed
by the company ought not to be members of the committee of Inspection, whereupon the persons mentioned
in the companys resolution shall not be qualified to act as members of the committee unless the Court
otherwise directs. The Act provides that the powers and proceedings of such Committee of Inspection are
the same as those of a Committee of Inspection appointed in a winding up by Court (compulsory winding up)
and as provided in Section 465 (Section 503).
(vii) The remuneration to be paid to the liquidator in creditors voluntary winding up is to be fixed either by the
Committee of Inspection or by creditors. Where the remuneration is not so fixed, it shall be determined by the
Court. Any remuneration fixed by the Committee or creditors cannot be increased in any circumstances
whatsoever whether with or without the sanction of the Court (Section 504).
(viii) On the appointment of a liquidator, all the powers of the Board of directors shall cease, except in so far
as the Committee of Inspection, or if there is no such committee, the creditors in general meeting may
sanction the continuance thereof (Section 505).
(ix) If a vacancy in the office of Liquidator occurs by death, resignation or otherwise (other than a liquidator
appointed by or by the direction of the Court) the creditors in general meeting may fill the vacancy. (Section
506)
Section 508 of the Act requires the liquidator, in creditors winding up, to call a general meeting of the
company and a meeting of the creditors at the end of the first year from the commencement of the winding
up and at the end of each succeeding year or as soon thereafter as may be convenient, within three months
from the end of the year or such longer period as the Central Government may allow. At this meeting he
must lay accounts of his acts and dealings and of the conduct of winding up during the preceding year
together with a statement in Form No. 153 of the Companies (Court) Rules, 1959, containing the prescribed
particulars with respect to the proceedings in, and position of, the winding up.
Section 509 provides that as soon as the affairs of the company in creditors winding up are fully wound up
the liquidator shall make up an account of the winding up showing how the winding up has been conducted
and the property of company has been disposed of. Thereafter he will call general meeting of the company
and of the creditors for the purposes of laying the accounts before the meeting and giving explanations
thereof as may be required. The procedure for calling the meeting, filing of the return with the Registrar and
the Official Liquidator, making of the report to the Court by the Official Liquidator for dissolution of the
Company etc., is the same as prescribed in the case of final meeting of a company in members voluntary
liquidation.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 369
370 PP-CRVI
(iii) To sell the immovable and movable property and actionable claims of the company by public
auction or private contract, with power to transfer the whole thereof to any person or body
corporate, or to sell the same in parcels.
(iv) To raise on the security of the asset of the company any money requisite.
(b) The liquidator may, without sanction referred to in (a) above, exercise any of other powers.
(c) He may exercise the power of the Court, under this Act, of settling a list of contributories and of making
calls.
(d) He may call general meeting of the company for the purpose of obtaining the sanction of the company by
ordinary or special resolution, as the case may require or for any other purpose he may think fit.
(e) The liquidator shall pay the debts of the company and shall adjust the rights of the contributories among
themselves.
(f) When several liquidators are appointed, one or more of them may exercise such powers as may be
determined at the time of their appointment (Section 512).
Lesson 20
Winding Up 371
Registrar in e-form 62 for registration, a notice of his appointment in the form prescribed. He cannot escape
the statutory liability by disputing the legality of his own appointment. Emperor v. Satish Ch. Ghose, ILR 39
ALL 412. In case of default, the liquidator is liable to punishment with fine up to ` 500 per day till the default
continues (Section 516).
372 PP-CRVI
(v) To see that the general meeting of members is duly held and a special resolution, for winding up the
company and appointing a liquidator, is duly passed thereat [Section 502].
(vi) According to Sections 500, 502 and 504 of the Companies Act, he should see that the creditors
meeting is duly held, the statement of affairs and creditors list is duly placed before the meeting and
a resolution, approving the winding up appointing a liquidator and fixing his remuneration, is duly
passed thereat.
(vii) He should see that a statement of affairs of the company in Form No. 57 is duly verified by affidavit
and submitted in duplicate to the liquidator within 21 days of the commencement of the winding up
[Section 454].
(viii) He should intimate to the Income-tax Officer about the winding up of the company within 15 days.
(ix) He should file the notice of the resolution passed at the creditors meeting with the Registrar within
10 days of passing of the resolution (Section 501).
(x) He should file a copy of special resolution for winding up in e-Form No. 23 with the Registrar within
30 days of the passing of it (Section 192).
(xi) He should get a copy of the resolution published in the Official Gazette and newspapers within 14
days of its passing (Section 485).
(xii) All correspondence and documents issued by the company during the period of the winding up
contain a statement that the company is being wound up.
(xiii) He should assist the liquidator in every possible way and see that all books, papers and documents,
as well as movable and immovable properties of the company are delivered to liquidator as and
when directed, and to appear before the Court, if directed, and give evidence regarding the affairs of
the company (Sections 519 and 538).
Lesson 20
Winding Up 373
374 PP-CRVI
In the case of Employees Provident Fund Commissioner v. O.L. of Esskay Pharmaceuticals Limited With
C IVIL APPEAL NO. 9633 O F 2011 D/-8.11.2011 AIR 2012 SUPREME COURT 11(PARA 42&43) Supreme
Court held that Section 529A inserted in the Companies Act by Act No.35 of 1985 Parliament, in its wisdom,
did not declare the workmens dues (this expression includes various dues including provident fund) as first
charge. The effect of the amendment made in the Companies Act in 1985 is only to expand the scope of the
dues of workmen and place them at par with the debts due to secured creditors and there is no reason to
interpret this amendment as giving priority to the debts due to secured creditor over the dues of provident
fund payable by an employer.
It is also important to bear in mind that even before the insertion of proviso to Sections 529(1), 529(3) and
Section 529A and amendment of Section 530(1), all sums due to any employee from a provident fund, a
pension fund, a gratuity fund or any other fund established for welfare of the employees were payable in
priority to all other debts in a winding up proceedings [Section 530(1)(f)]. Even the wages, salary and other
dues payable to the workers and employees were payable in priority to all other debts. What Parliament has
done by these amendments is to define the term workmens dues and to place them at par with debts due
to secured creditors to the extent such debts rank under clause (c) of the proviso to Section 529(1).
However, these amendments, though subsequent in point of time, cannot be interpreted in a manner which
would result in diluting the mandate of Section 11 of the EPF Act, sub-section (2) whereof declares that the
amount due from an employer shall be the first charge on the assets of the establishment and shall be paid
in priority to all other debts. The words all other debts used in Section 11(2) would necessarily include the
debts due to secured creditors like banks, financial institutions etc. The mere ranking of the dues of workers
at par with debts due to secured creditors cannot lead to an inference that Parliament intended to create first
charge in favour of the secured creditors and give priority to the debts due to secured creditors over the
amount due from the employer under the EPF Act. 43. At the cost of repetition, we would emphasize that in
terms of Section 530(1), all revenues, taxes, cesses and rates due from the company to the Central or State
Government or to a local authority, all wages or salary or any employee, in respect of the services rendered
to the company and due for a period not exceeding 4 months all accrued holiday remuneration etc. and all
sums due to any employee from provident fund, a pension fund, a gratuity fund or any other fund for the
welfare of the employees maintained by the company are payable in priority to all other debts. This provision
existed when Section 11(2) was inserted in the EPF Act by Act No. 40 of 1973 and any amount due from an
employer in respect of the employees contribution was declared first charge on the assets of the
establishment and became payable in priority to all other debts. Of course, after the amount due from an
employer under the EPF Act is paid, the other dues of the workers will be treated at par with the debts due to
secured creditors and payment thereof will be regulated by the provisions contained in Section 529(1) read
with Section 529(3), 529A and 530 of the Companies Act.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 375
(iii) the dominant motive of the company, acting by its directors was to prefer one creditor to another;
(iv) the transaction was made in favour of a creditor.
There is no fraudulent preference when a debtors dominant intention is to benefit himself rather than to
confer an advantage on his creditor. Thus where a company created a legal mortgage in favour of a bank in
the hope that by keeping good faith with the bank it could get further advance from the bank which could be
utilized to revive the company, the mortgage was held not to be a fraudulent preference even though the
mortgage was ceased after it was fairly clear that the company had become insolvent. [Re. F.L.E. Holdings
Ltd. (1967) 3 ALL ER 353.]
The essence of fraudulent preference is the giving of an improper benefit to a few creditors leading to
inequality between them and the generality of the creditors. In order to establish fraudulent preference it is
not enough only to show that the preference was to a particular creditor, it must also be proved that it was
done with a view to giving him a favoured treatment. The dominant motive attending transfer has to be
ascertained and if it is tainted with an element of dishonesty, the question of fraud arises. The probe into the
debtors mind and an assessment of the various motives that animate his conduct is thus involved. There
must be solid grounds for drawing an inference of dishonesty. Mere suspicion, however strong, is not
sufficient. There is no fraudulent preference if the transfer is not voluntary. [Official Liquidator, Kerala High
Court v. Victory Hire Purchasing Co. (P) Ltd., (1982) 52 Comp. Cas. 88 (Ker)].
376 PP-CRVI
The liquidator may, with the leave of the Court, disclaim any such property. The Court will assist the
liquidator to get rid of onerous and burdensome contracts whenever it is necessary to safeguard in full the
interests of the body of creditors and the shareholders of the company. The right of disclaimer can be
exercised in relation only to property which in effect has ceased to be an asset and has become a liability.
The disclaimer should be made in writing signed by the liquidator within 12 months after the commencement
of the winding up or such extended period as the Court may allow. If the liquidator does not come to know of
the existence of an onerous property within one month of the commencement of the winding up, the period of
12 months begins from the date of his knowledge.
The disclaimer shall operate to determine, as from the date of disclaimer, the rights, interests and liabilities of
the company. It release the company and the property from liability. However, it does not affect the rights
and liabilities of any other person in respect of the property. Any person injured by the operation of a
disclaimer is deemed to be a creditor of the company to the amount of the compensation or damages
payable in respect of the injury, and may accordingly prove the amount as a debt in the winding up. The
Court may, require notices to be given to persons interested in the property before granting the disclaimer.
Where a person interested in the property has required the liquidator to decide whether he will or will not
disclaim the property, the liquidator should, within 28 days, give notice to the applicant that he intends to
apply to the Court for leave to disclaim. If he fails to do so, he shall not be entitled to disclaim the property
and where the property is a contract which he has not disclaimed within the aforesaid time, he shall be
deemed to have adopted it.
(ix) Any attachment and sale of the estate properties or effects of the company, after the
commencement of the winding up will be void
Section 537 declares that any attachment and sale of the estate properties or effects of the company, after
the commencement of the winding up will be void. In the case of winding up by the Court any attachment,
distress or execution put in force, without leave of the Court against the estate or effects of the company
after the commencement of the winding up will be void. Similarly any sale held, without leave of the Court, of
any of the properties or effects of the company after the commencement of the winding up will be void. But
with leave of the Court, attachment and sale of the properties of the company will be valid even if such
attachment and sale are made after the commencement of the winding up of the company. Besides, this
section does not apply to any proceedings for the recovery of any tax or impost or any dues payable to the
Government. In Titan Industries v. Punwire Mobile Communications (2002) 40 SCL 117, it was held that
Section 537 being a central legislation prevails over state law in case of conflict/overlapping and Registrar of
Cooperative Societies cannot attach property of company under liquidation.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 377
the company or alteration in the status of its members made after the commencement of the winding up is
void unless Court otherwise orders.
CONSEQUENCES OF WINDING UP
The process of winding up has important consequences for different parties - contributories, creditors,
officers of the company and so on. Firstly, we shall deal with the consequences of winding up as to different
parties and other aspects of the administration of company law subsequently.
378 PP-CRVI
independence of the rights which the company had before winding up. [Pokhar Mal v. Flour and Oil Mills Co.
Ltd. AIR (1934) Lah. 1015].
Section 429 expressly defines the liability of contributory, and states that the liability of a contributory shall
create a debt accruing due from him at the time when his liability commenced, but payable at the time
specified in the calls made on him for enforcing the liability (by the liquidator). This means that the liability of
a member arises as soon as he makes a contract with the company under which he becomes a member and
during winding up it is only contingent until a call is made by the liquidator.
It has been held in numerous cases that after winding up the liability of a contributory is ex lege (legal) and
not ex contract (contractual) and is the direct result of his being a member of the company with his name
appearing on the register of members [Lakshmi Narasa Reddy v. O.L. Shree films Ltd., AIR (1951) Mad.
890]. As the liability of a contributory is legal and statutory because his name appears on the register of
members, he will not be allowed to say that, although his name is on the register of members, he is not liable
because the allotment of shares to him was void. The Court has power to rectify the register of members, if
required (Section 467). Unless the Court orders the rectification of register of members, the liability of a
contributory is absolute. [Mohd. Akbar v. Official Liquidator, AIR 1950 Bom. 386]. In Re. Whitehouse & Co.,
(1878) 9 ch. D. 595, Jessel M.R. said: After winding up the liability is a new liability: the contributory is to
contribute, it is a new contribution; it is a liability to be enforced by the liquidator. Thus, the time will not run
as against the liquidator as soon as the company goes into liquidation, for the liability to contribute does not
arise unless and until a call is made by the liquidator (L.Gupta v. Vishnu Sarvate, AIR 1956 Nag. 204).
In the absence of a proceeding for rectification of the register of members before winding up, the contributory
has been held out of the public as a member of the company. Whatever may have been the rights and
liabilities of the shareholders before the winding up, the position is altered by the happening of that event. His
name appears on the register of members at the commencement of the winding up with his full knowledge
and assent. On the winding up, his liability under Section 426 in respect of shares held by him is statutory
and absolute and flows from the fact of his being on the register of members in respect of those shares.
Hence, his liability in respect of unpaid calls is absolute even though the calls were made by the company for
their realisation had become barred by time under Article 112 of the Schedule to the Limitation Act, 1963.
The estate of the deceased contributory is liable to the same extent as it would have been if he had been
alive. The legal representatives of a deceased contributory are liable to contribute to the assets of the
company in discharge of the liability. If a contributory becomes insolvent after the commencement of winding
up, he becomes a stranger to the company, and his assignee in insolvency (Official Assignee or Official
Receiver) represents him for all purposes and is deemed to be a contributory.
List of Contributories
On winding up a list called the list of contributories is prepared by the liquidator and settled by the Court in a
compulsory winding up. In a voluntary winding up the list is both prepared as well as settled by the liquidator.
The list consists of two parts, namely:
(a) the list of present members, i.e. those whose names appear on the register of members at the
commencement of winding up, called the A List, and
(b) the list of past members, i.e. those who ceased to be members of the company within one year
before the commencement of winding up, called the B List. Past members, therefore, include
persons whose shares have been forfeited, surrendered or transferred within twelve months before
the commencement of winding up, but not a person who has died.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 379
Extent of Liability
By virtue of Section 426, in the event of the company being wound up every present and past member is
liable to contribute to the assets of the company to an amount sufficient for payment of its debts and liabilities
and the costs, charges and expenses of winding up, and for the adjustment to the rights of the contributories
among themselves. Subject to the provisions of Section 427 and subject also to the following qualifications,
namely:
(a) a past member shall not be liable to contribute if he has ceased to be a member for one year or
more before the commencement of the winding up;
(b) a past member shall not be liable to contribute in respect of any debt or liability contracted by the
company after he ceased to be a member;
(c) a past member shall not be liable to contribute unless it appears to the court that the present
members are unable to satisfy the contribution required to be made by them in pursuance of the
Act;
(d) In the case of a company limited by shares, the present and past members shall not be liable to
contribute more than the unpaid amount, if any, in respect of his shares.
(e) In the case of a company limited by guarantee, the present and the past members shall not be liable
to contribute more than the amount, undertaken to be contributed by them in the event of the
company being wound up;
(f) Any sum due to the present or past member by way of dividend, profits or otherwise shall not be
deemed to be a debt payable by the company in case of competition between himself and the
creditors but any such amount shall be taken into consideration for the purpose of final adjustment
of the rights of the contributories among themselves.
The relation of present and past members is one of primary and secondary liability, and they do not in any
way, stand to each other in the relation of principal and surety. The liquidator cannot call upon the past
members to contribute before the present ones. The measure of liability of A List contributory is the full
amount unpaid on his shares. He is primarily liable and must be tried first. The liability of B List contributory
is equated by the Act and arises only:
(i) if it appears to the Court that the present members are unable to satisfy the contribution required to
be made by them, within a reasonable time;
(ii) the debt or liability was incurred while he was a member; and
(iii) he had not ceased to be a member for one year or upward before the commencement of the
winding up, i.e., to be liable he must have ceased to be a member within 12 months immediately
before the commencement of the winding up.
It is to be noted that B List can be resorted to only when the A List has been exhausted and part of the
debts have been paid. Even when he resorts to B List, he can only claim from a B List member when the
corresponding A List member has been unable to pay.
Let us suppose that there is a debt of Rs. 50,000 contracted before six B List contributories had transferred
their shares. There are many debts amounting to Rs. 50,000 in all contracted after all the B List members
had transferred their shares. The total liability on shares of the six B List members is Rs. 10,000. In such
case the liquidator can demand from them only `5,000, and he must apply this `5,000 pari passu towards all
the debts. It is clear that if he has `5,000 to apply towards debts of `50,000 + ` 5,000 = `55,000, each
380 PP-CRVI
creditor will receive one-eleventh (`55,000 : ` 5,000) of the amount which he is owned. The single B List
creditor will, therefore, receive one-eleventh of `5,000, yet there is still a liability on the B List shares of
`5,000.
As per Section 427, in the winding up of a limited company, any director, or manager whether past or
present, whose liability is unlimited (under the provisions of the Act) shall be liable to contribute to the assets
of the company to an unlimited extent, over and above his ordinary liability to contribute as an ordinary
member.
There are three exceptions to the rule contained in Section 427 of the Companies Act, 1956 Firstly, past
director or manager shall not be liable to make such further contribution if he has ceased to hold office for a
year or more before the commencement of winding up. Secondly, past director or manager shall not be liable
to make such further contribution in respect of any debt or liability of the company contracted after he ceased
to hold office. Subject to the articles of the company, a director or manager shall not be liable to make such
further contribution, unless the Court deems it necessary to require the contribution in order to satisfy the
debts and liabilities of the company and the costs, charges and expenses of the winding up.
Set Off
A person, as observed earlier, who is both a contributory and a creditor of the company (in respect of
dividends, profits or otherwise) cannot set off his debts against his liability for calls even if there is an express
agreement to do so whether the call was made before or after winding up [Rameshwar Prasad v. Simla
Banking & Industrial Co. etc. Ltd., (1955) 25 Comp. Cas. 475]. The principle underlying denial of right of set
off is that where a person entitled to participate in a fund is also bound to make a contribution in aid of that
fund, he cannot be allowed to participate until he has discharged his obligation [Re. Peruvian Railway
Constructions Co. (1915) 2 Ch. 442]. When all the creditors have been paid in full, the debts due from the
company to the contributory in respect of independent dealing or contracts may be set off against debts due
to the company in the case of an unlimited company. Such an allowance may be made, in the case of a
limited company, to any director or manager whose liability is unlimited.
A creditor to whom money is due from the company, other than in his capacity as a member of the company,
may claim set off against the money owed by him to the company. In Official Liquidator, High Court of
Karnataka v. Smt. V. Lakshmi Kutty, (1981) - 51 Comp. Cas. 566 (SC), it has been held by the Supreme
Court that Sections 529 and 530 of the Companies Act should be read together whenever any creditor seeks
to prove his debt against the company in liquidation, the rule enacted in Section 46 of the Provincial
Insolvency Act, 1920, should apply and only that amount which is found due from him at the foot of the
account in respect of the mutual dealings should be recoverable from him and not that the amount due from
the company in liquidation should rank in payment after the preferential claims prescribed under Section 530
have been paid. The set off is allowed where the dealings are mutual. In the case of chit fund transactions
the subscribers can set off the debts owing to them by chit fund company against the debts due by them to
the chit fund company. The cut off date for the purpose of set off is the date of commencement of the
winding up. Therefore, any claim arising after the commencement of the winding up cannot be set off.
Consequences as a Creditor
A company, as observed earlier, cannot be adjudged an insolvent, although it may become insolvent in the
Lesson 20
Winding Up 381
sense that it is unable to pay its debts. As to the rights of the creditors in winding up, a distinction between
solvent and insolvent companies has to be made.
Where a solvent company is being wound up, all debts payable on a contingency, and all claims against the
company, present or future, certain or contingent, are admissible to proof against the company, a just
estimate being made as far as possible, of the value of such debts or claims as may be subject to any
contingency or for some other reason do not bear a certain value. No difficulty arises in the case of an
insolvent company, as when the claims are proved they are paid off according to the availability of the
assets.
In the winding up of an insolvent company, the same rules shall prevail as in the case of insolvency law, in
respect of:
(i) debts provable,
(ii) the valuation of annuities and future and contingent liabilities, and
(iii) the respective rights of secured and unsecured creditors [Section 529].
Secured Creditors
A secured creditor is defined in the Insolvency Act to mean a person who holds a mortgage, charge or lien
on the companys property or any part of it as security for any debt due to him from the company.
The effect of the provisions of Section 529 is that the secured creditor may either:
(i) rely on the security and ignore the liquidation altogether;
(ii) value his security and prove for the balance of his debt; or
(iii) give up his security and prove for the whole amount as an unsecured creditor.
The secured creditor can, on his option, stand wholly outside the winding up proceedings. He need not prove
his debts out of that security with the leave of the winding up Court. If the security is insufficient to pay his
debt fully, he may exhaust the security and prove for the deficiency in the winding up. Alternatively, he can
assess the value of his security and prove for the balance. The liquidator can redeem the security from the
secured creditors at the value assessed by him. With the amendment of Section 529 by the Companies
(Amendment) Act, 1985 the law about realisation of dues by the secured creditors has now been amended
w.e.f. 1st May, 1985. Now Section 529 has been amended by making wide amendments and also by
inserting a new Section 529A. Henceforth the security of other secured creditors shall be deemed to be
subject to a pari passu charge in favour of the workmen to the extent of their dues. The Official Liquidator
has been given the duty of representing the workmen to enforce their charge over the property. The dues of
the workmen are to be paid in full but if the assets are insufficient to meet them, then, in such a case the
dues of the workmen shall abate in equal proportions alongwith the secured creditors. A secured creditor
who realises his security is liable to reimburse the liquidator for all expenses incurred by the latter for the
preservation of the security before the realisation. The secured creditor is liable to pay the whole of the
expenses but if workmen are participating in the security, then such expenses should be apportioned
between the secured creditors and workers in the proportion of the amount to be distributed to them.
382 PP-CRVI
security and prove for balance due to him. However, if the secured creditor seeks to prove whole of his debt
in winding up proceedings, he must relinquish his security for benefit of general body of creditors, before
proving his debt. [Canfin Homes v. Lloyds Steel Industries Ltd. (2001) 32 SCL 283 (Bom. HC).]
Unsecured Creditors
Unsecured creditors of an insolvent company are paid in the following order:
(i) Over-riding preferential payments under Section 529A.
(ii) Preferential payments under Section 530;
(iii) Other debts pari passu.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 383
employer liable to make contribution of provident fund of ESIC contribution [Rohtas Industries Ltd. (In
liquidation) - In re. (2000) 99 Comp. Cas. 503 (Pat HC)].
Section 457 confers on the liquidator in a winding up by the Court, certain specific powers necessary for the
performance of his duties in relation to winding up. Under Sub-section (1) of Section 457, the liquidator has
following powers with the sanction of the Court:
(a) to institute or defend any suit, prosecution or other legal proceeding, civil or criminal, in the name
and on behalf of the company;
(b) to carry on the business of the company so far as may be necessary for the beneficial winding up of
the company;
(c) to sell the immovable and movable property and actionable claims of the company by public auction
or private contract, with power, to transfer the whole thereof to any person or body corporate or the
sell the same in parcels;
(d) to raise on the security of the assets of the company any money requisite;
(e) to do all such other things as may be necessary for winding up the affairs of the company and
distributing its assets;
As per Section 459, the liquidator may, with the sanction of Court, appoint an advocate, attorney or pleader
entitled to appear before the Court to assist him in the performance of his duties.
Under Section 546, the liquidator may exercise the following powers with the sanction of the Court in winding
up by or under the supervision of the Court, and with the sanction of the special resolution of the company in
voluntary winding up:
(i) to pay any classes of creditors in full:
(ii) to make any compromise or arrangement with creditors or persons claiming to be creditors or
having or alleging themselves to have any claim, present or future, certain or contingent,
ascertained or sounding only in damages, against the company or whereby the company may be
rendered liable; or
(iii) to compromise any call or liability to call, debt and liability capable of resulting in a debt, and any
claim, present or future, certain or contingent, ascertained or sounding only in damages, subsisting
or alleged to subsist between the company and a contributory or alleged contributory or other debtor
or person apprehending liability to the company, and all questions in any way relating to or affecting
the assets or liabilities or the winding up of the company, on such terms as may be agreed, and take
any security for the discharge of any such call, debt, liability or claim, and give a complete discharge in
respect thereof.
The exercise of aforesaid powers by the liquidator in the case of voluntary winding up is subject to the control
of the Court.
Under Sub-section (2) of Section 457, the liquidator has following powers without obtaining any sanction of
the Court:
(a) to do all acts and to execute in the name and on behalf of the company and to execute all deeds,
receipts and other documents and for that purpose to use, when necessary the companys seal;
(b) to inspect the records and returns of the company on the files of the Registrar without payment of
any fee;
384 PP-CRVI
(c) to prove, rank and claim in the insolvency of any contributory for any balance against his estate and
to receive dividends in the insolvency in respect of that balance as a separate debt due from the
insolvent, and rateably with other separate creditors;
(d) to draw, accept, make and endorse any negotiable instruments in the name and on behalf of the
company in the course of its business;
(e) to take out, in his official name, letters of administration to any deceased contributory and to do in
his official name any other act necessary for obtaining payment of any money due from a
contributory or his estate;
(f) to appoint an agent to do any business which the liquidator is unable to do himself.
(2A)1 The liquidator shall
(a) appoint security guards to protect the property of the company taken into his custody and to make
out an inventory of the assets in consultation with secured creditors after giving them notice;
(b) appoint, as the case may be, valuer, chartered surveyors or chartered accountant to assess the
value of the companys assets within fifteen days after taking into custody of property, assets
referred to in sub-clause (a) and effects or actionable claims subject to such terms and conditions
as may be specified by the Tribunal;
(c) give an advertisement, inviting bids for sale of the assets of the company, within fifteen days from
the date of receiving valuation report from the valuer, chartered surveyors or chartered accountants
referred to in clause (b), as the case may be.
(2B) The liquidator shall, immediately after the order for winding up or appointing the liquidator as provisional
liquidator is made, issue a notice requiring any of the persons mentioned in Sub-section (2) of Section 454,
to submit and verify a statement of the affairs of the company and such notice shall be served by the
liquidator.
(2C) The liquidator may apply to the Tribunal for an order directing any person who, in his opinion, is
competent to furnish a statement of the affairs under Sections 439A and 454 and such person shall for the
said purpose be served a notice by the liquidator in the manner as may be prescribed.
(2D) The liquidator may, from time to time, call any person for recording any statement for the purpose of
investigating the affairs of the company which is being wound up and it shall be the duty of every such
person to attend to the liquidator at such time and place as the liquidator may appoint and give the liquidator
all information which he may require and answer all such questions relating to winding up of company as
may be put to him by the liquidator.
(2E) Every bidder shall, in response to the advertisement referred to in clause (c) of Sub-section (2A),
deposit, his offer in the manner as may be prescribed, with liquidator or provisional liquidator, as the case
may be, within forty-five days from the date of the advertisement and the liquidator or provisional liquidator
shall permit inspection of property and assets in respect of which bids were invited:
Provided that such bid may be withdrawn within three days before the last day of closing of the bid.
Provided further that the inspection of property shall be open for not more than five days before closing of the bid.
1 Inserted by the Companies (Second Amendment) Act, 2002 w.e.f. a date yet to be notified.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 385
(2F) The advertisement inviting bids shall contain the following details, namely:
(a) name, address of registered office of the company and its branch offices factories and plants and
the place where assets of the company are kept and available for sale;
(b) last date for submitting bids which shall not exceed ninety days from the date of advertisement;
(c) time during which the premises of the company shall remain open for inspection;
(d) the last date for withdrawing the bid;
(e) financial guarantee which shall not be less than one-half of the value of the bid;
(f) validity period of the bids;
(g) place and date of opening of the bids in public;
(h) reserve price and earnest money to be deposited along with the bid;
(i) any other terms and conditions of sale which may be prescribed.
(2G) The liquidator appointed shall
(a) maintain a separate bank account for each company under his charge for depositing the sale
proceeds of the assets and recovery of debts of each company;
(b) maintain proper books of account in respect of all receipts and payments made by him in respect of
each company and submit half yearly return of receipts and payments to the Tribunal.
Although the liquidator is not required to obtain sanction of the Court before exercising any of the foregoing
powers yet he is subject to the control of the Court, and any contributory or creditor may apply to the Court
with respect to any exercise of any such powers. He should have regard to any directions which may be
given by resolutions of creditors or contributories in their respective meetings, called by the liquidator. The
liquidator may summon general meetings of creditors and contributories, whenever he thinks fit, to ascertain
their wishes. He is bound to call such meetings at such times as the creditors or contributories may by
resolutions direct or whenever requested in writing to do so by not less than 1/10th in value of creditors or
contributories (Sections 458 and 460).
The liquidator is required to present to the Court twice a year an account of his receipts and payments as
liquidator. The Court gets the accounts audited; and the liquidator has to send a copy of the printed accounts
to every creditor and contributory. A copy is also filed with the Registrar.
The Central Government is conferred with the power to take cognizance of the conduct of liquidators of
companies which are being wound up by the Court. If it appears that a liquidator is not faithfully performing
his duties or is not observing the requirements of the Act or if any complaint is made by a creditor or a
contributory, the Central Government shall inquire into the matter and take necessary action (Section 463).
386 PP-CRVI
the case of a creditors voluntary winding up, with the sanction of the Court or the Committee of Inspection
or, if there is no Committee of Inspection, with the sanction of the creditors:
(a) to institute or defend any suit, prosecution or other legal proceedings, civil or criminal, in the name
and on behalf of the company;
(b) to carry on the business of the company so far as may be necessary for the beneficial winding up of
the company;
(c) to sell immovable or movable property and actionable claims of the company; and
(d) to raise on the security of the assets of the company any money requisite.
The following powers can be exercised by voluntary liquidator without any sanction:
(i) to do all acts and to execute, in the name and on behalf of the company all deeds, receipts and
other documents, and for that purpose to use, when necessary, the companys seal.
(ii) to inspect the records and returns of the company on the files of the Registrar without payment of
any fee.
(iii) to prove, rank and claim in the insolvency of any contributory.
(iv) to draw, accept, make and endorse any bill of exchange, hundi or promissory note in the name and
on behalf of the company.
(v) to take out, in his official name, letters of administration to any deceased contributory, and to do in
his official name any other act necessary for obtaining payment of any money due from a
contributory or his estate.
(vi) to appoint an agent to do any business which the liquidator is unable to do himself.
(vii) to exercise the power of the Court of setting the list of contributories (which shall be prima facie
evidence of the liability) of the persons named therein to be contributories.
(viii) to exercise the power of the court of making calls.
(ix) to call general meetings of the company for the purpose of obtaining the sanction of the company by
ordinary resolution or special resolution, as the case may require, or for any other purpose he may
think fit.
(x) to pay the debts of the company and adjust the rights of the contributories among themselves.
Although the foregoing powers can be exercised by the voluntary liquidator without any sanction, they are,
nevertheless, subject to the control of the Court inasmuch as any creditor or contributory may apply to the
Court with respect to any exercise or proposed exercise of any of these powers. For example, a contributory,
whose name has been settled on the list of contributories by the voluntary liquidator, may apply to the Court
with the prayer that his name ought not to have been so settled on the list as he is not a member or had
ceased to be a member more than 12 months before the commencement of winding up. Or a creditor may
apply to the Court against the decision of the voluntary liquidator to admit his claim.
When more than one liquidators are appointed, the manner and extent of their powers are determined at the
time of their appointment by the authority appointing them. If the powers of the liquidators are not so
determined on their appointment, then any of the aforesaid powers is exercisable only jointly by all or by not
less than 2 of them.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 387
Status of Liquidator
The liquidator in a winding up by the Court or under the supervision of the Court, is an officer of the Court,
and as such is required to exercise a high degree of honesty and fairness towards the creditors and the
members of the company. he is also the agent of the company and incurs no personal liability when he
enters into any contracts as a liquidator.
388 PP-CRVI
In a voluntary winding up, the liquidator is more rightly described as the agent of the company. He is not an
officer of the Court. As a paid agent of the company he has statutory duties towards the creditors and
contributories including the administration of the assets of the company.
Both in a compulsory winding up and voluntary winding up, a liquidator as an agent of the company, must
exercise a high degree of care and diligence in discharging his statutory duties. He may be liable in damage
to a creditor or contributory for injury caused to him as a result of his breach of statutory duties.
A liquidator is not a trustee. The property of the company is not vested in him. But he is in a fiduciary position
in relation to any property of the company and is in the position of a trustee, or what is sometimes stated, he
is a statutory trustee. Accordingly, if he pays an invalid claim, even without willful default, he is liable to
misfeasance proceedings. He is not a trustee for individual creditors or contributories.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 389
390 PP-CRVI
In the case of P. V. R.S. Manikumar vs. Official Liquidator, High Court of Madras [2013] 176 Comp Cas
547(Mad) Section 454 of the Companies Act, 1956 was inserted with a definite purpose of helping the
Official Liquidator to verify the factual position of the company including financial background. It is only for
that purpose, the legislature has incorporated a specific provision casting a duty on the official of the
Company including the ex-directors to submit the statement of the affairs of the company, before the official
liquidator. Since the absence of reasonable excuse is an essential ingredient of an offence punishable under
sub-section (5) of section 454 of the Act. The initial burden is on the official Liquidator to prove the said fact.
Madras High Court held that the failure on the part of the appellant to submit the statement of affairs of the
company was not willful and the official liquidator failed to prove that the default was without reasonable
excuse. Since the single judge had found merit in the contention raised by the appellant that he had no
access to the records and entertained a doubt with regard to the discharge of obligation by the official
liquidator, necessarily the benefit of doubt should have been given to the appellant. Section 633 gave wide
powers to the court to grant relief in appropriate cases, provided the court was convinced that the accused
acted honestly and reasonably. The observation of the single judge with regard to failure on the part of the
official liquidator to prove the case itself was sufficient to acquit the accused.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 391
The committee of inspection may inspect the accounts of the liquidator at all reasonable times [Section
465(2)].
The committee of inspection will meet at such times as it may from time to time appoint and the liquidator or
any member of the committee may also call a meeting of the committee as and when he thinks necessary.
The quorum for a meeting of the committee shall be one-third of the total number of the members or two
whichever is higher. The committee may act by a majority of its members present at a meeting but shall not
act unless a quorum is present. A member of the committee may resign by notice in writing signed by him
and delivered to the liquidator. If a member is adjudged an insolvent or compounds or arranges with his
creditors or is absent from five consecutive meetings of the committee without leave of those members who,
together with himself, represent the creditors or contributories, his office shall become vacant.
A member of the Committee of Inspection may be removed at a meeting of the creditors, if he represents
creditors, or at a meeting of contributories if he represents contributories, by an ordinary resolution of which
seven days notice has been given stating the object of the meeting. When any vacancy has occurred in the
committee the liquidator shall call a meeting of the creditors or contributories, as the case may be, and the
meeting may re-appoint the same person or appoint some other person to fill the vacancy. However, the
liquidator may apply to the Court that in the circumstances of the case the vacancy need not be filled. The
Court may make an order accordingly.
392 PP-CRVI
his custody relating to the company. It may be remembered that the auditor is also an officer of the company
for this purpose.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 393
(v) fails for a period of one month to inform the liquidator about any false debts having been proved
within his knowledge;
(vi) attempts to account for any part of the property of the company by fictitious losses or expenses
within 12 months next before the commencement of the winding of the creditors of the company or
any of them to an agreement with reference to the affairs of the company or to the winding up.
No Court shall take cognizance of any offence against the Act, (other than an offence with respect to which
proceedings are instituted under Section 545), which is alleged to have been committed by any officer of the
company, except on the complaint in writing of the Registrar, or of a shareholder of the company, or of a
person authorised by the Central Government or of a person authorised by SEBI.
The burden of proof to establish the offence and bring the case within any one of the aforesaid clauses is on
the prosecution. It is good defence to the accused to show that he had no intent to defraud or that he had no
intent to conceal the true state of affairs of the company.
394 PP-CRVI
(b) where the business of the company has involved dealing in goods, statements of the annual stock
takings and (except in the case of goods sold by way of ordinary retail trade) of all goods sold and
purchased, showing the goods and the buyers and sellers thereof in sufficient details to enable
those goods and those buyers and sellers to be identified.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 395
396 PP-CRVI
Examples of misfeasance are:
(i) improper payment of dividends, e.g. out of capital;
(ii) ultra vires investment;
(iii) director selling his own property to the company without disclosure;
(iv) allotting shares in breach of Section 69;
(v) knowingly allotting shares to a minor.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 397
(b) in the case of members voluntary winding up in the manner as the company may, by special
resolution, direct;
(c) in the case of creditors voluntary winding up, in such manner as the Committee of Inspection or, if
there is no such Committee, as the creditors of the company may direct.
The company or liquidator or the person to whom custody of books and papers is entrusted is not
responsible for producing the books and papers after the expiry of a period of five years from the date of
dissolution.
The Central Government may frame rules to prevent the destruction of the books and papers of the company
which has been wound up and of its liquidator for such period as it may think proper but not exceeding five
years.
Rule 15 of the Companies (Central Governments) General Rules and Forms, 1956 provides that these
books and papers shall not be destroyed for a period of five years. Any contributory or creditor or liquidator of
the company, may make a representation of destroying these books and papers at a period earlier than five
years. After considering as may be concerned with the matter, the Central Government may decide to
reduce the period as may be considered proper or keep the period unaltered. An appeal against the
directions of the Central Government can be made to the Court.
398 PP-CRVI
Lesson 20
Winding Up 399
400 PP-CRVI
that all or any part of the property of all description shall vest in the Official liquidator by his official name. The
liquidator may bring or defend in his official name, any suit or other legal proceedings relating to the property
or necessary to be brought or defended for the purpose of effectually winding up the company and
recovering its property (Section 588). All these provisions relating to the winding up of an unregistered
company are in addition to other provisions/relating to winding up of companies by the Court.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 401
by the secretary and the verified statement shall be submitted to the Official Liquidator or liquidator within
twenty-one days of the extended time limit, as the case may be.
The secretary may submit a bill for his actual expenses for the preparation and making of the statement of
affairs. Such costs and expenses shall not be paid until the statement of affairs, verified by an affidavit, has
been submitted to the Official Liquidator or liquidator, as the case may be.
The secretary is required to attend on the Official Liquidator or the liquidator if required so to do at such time
and place as may be appointed by him. He is further required to answer all such questions as may be put to
him by the Official Liquidator or the liquidator. The Official Liquidator or liquidator is required to maintain
minutes of such interviews or the memorandum containing the substances of such interviews.
Any default, without any reasonable excuse, in complying with the requirements of law of making a
statement of affairs is a punishable offence and may be punished with imprisonment for a term which may
extend to two years or a daily fine of rupees one hundred for every day during which the default continues, or
with both. The offence is triable only by the winding up Court.
After the statement of affairs has been made, the Official Liquidator is required to make a preliminary report
to the Court not later than six months from the date of the winding up order or within such extended period as
the Court may allow. Where the making of statement of affairs is dispensed with, such preliminary report
shall be submitted as soon as practicable after the commencement of the winding up.
A creditor or contributory has a right to inspect the statement of affairs and the preliminary report submitted
by the Official Liquidator at all reasonable times and to obtain copies there of or extracts therefrom on
payment of the prescribed charges.
The Official Liquidator may also submit further report or reports:
(a) stating the manner in which the company was promoted or formed and whether, in his opinion, any
fraud has been committed by any person in its promotion or formation or by any officer of the
company in relation to the company since the formation thereof; and
(b) any other matter which in his opinion, it is desirable to bring to the notice of the Court.
Such report shall set out the names of the persons by whom the fraud, in the opinion of the Official Liquidator
or liquidator was committed and the facts on which such opinion is based.
On a consideration of the report made by the Official Liquidator, or liquidator, the Court may direct the public
examination of the promoters, directors or officers of the company (which will include secretaries) with a view
to discovering the facts. The object of the public examination is to get information to enable the Court to
determine what course is to be followed with reference to the winding up. After the public examination, the
Court may, if it is of opinion that a fraud has been committed.
(a) by any person in the promotion or formation of the company; or
(b) by any officer of the company in relation to the company since its formation,
direct the public examination of such person or officer.
Where an order has been made for public examination of any person, the examination shall be held before
the judge. The liquidator is to take part in the public examination and employ such legal assistance as may
be sanctioned by the Court. Any creditor or contributory may also take part in the public examination and
may appear personally or through an advocate. The person who is examined publicly is to be examined on
oath and is required to answer all such questions as the Court may allow to be put to him. A person who is
402 PP-CRVI
ordered to be publicly examined is required to be furnished, at his own cost, with a copy of the liquidators
report. He may, at his own cost, with a copy of the liquidators report. He may, at his own cost, engage a
lawyer to defend his case. The notes of the public examination are to be taken down in writing and are
required to be read over and signed by the person examined.
After the public examination, the Court may start misfeasance proceedings against any officer of the
company who is found to have misappropriated or misapplied or retained any money or property of the
company or who has become liable or accountable for any money or property of the company or has been
guilty of wrongful exercise of lawful authority or breach of trust in relation to the company. The misfeasance
proceedings may be started within 5 years from the commencement of the winding up, mis-application,
retainer, misfeasance or breach of trust, whichever is longer.
As a result of the misfeasance proceedings any amount belonging to the company which is found to have
been misappropriated, misapplied or retained or in respect of which any wrongful exercise of any lawful
authority has been made or breach of trust has been committed, may be recovered from the concerned
officer of the company.
Every officer of the company who is found guilty is also liable to be prosecuted for negligence, default,
breach of duty, misfeasance or breach of the trust. But every such offence is non-cognizable and no
prosecution can be launched except when a complaint in writing has been made by the Registrar of
Companies or a shareholder of the company or any person authorised by the Central Government.
Legal Position
At present Private Liquidator may be appointed only in case of Voluntary Winding Up either by Members or
Creditors.
After the commencement of the Companies (Second Amendment) Act, 2002 Private Liquidator may be
appointed by Tribunal in cases of Winding up other than Voluntary Winding Up and National Company Law
Tribunal authorized to appoint liquidator who may also be called as deputy or assistant liquidator from the
panel of professionals in the cases of winding up.
Responsibilities
General Duties
(a) To act in good faith and for proper purpose.
(b) Not allow a conflict of interest and duty.
(c) Be impartial.
(d) To exercise a degree of care and skill.
Lesson 20
Winding Up 403
Specific Duties
To call meetings of the Members/Creditors as per provisions of the Act.
Meetings are required to be held at specific intervals and happenings of certain events as provided in
the Act.
To give notices of appointment to all concerned authorities
Notice of appointment shall be given to Income Tax, Sales Tax, Excise, Property Tax and other
concerned authorities. It is expected that they shall expedite the assessment and crystallize the
liability.
To keep proper books of accounts & other books
Maintenance of proper records is very important part of liquidators duty. He is required to submit half
yearly report to the ROC in Form 153 and give report on liquidation proceedings. Maintenance of
other books does help him in preparing the same. This report covers areas such as receipt and
payment statement for the period, statement of status of assets, status of creditors, estimation of
outstanding to be realized, causes for delay, if any, probable date of completion of winding up,
statement of pending legal cases etc.
To maintain all records of proceedings of liquidation
It is expected to maintain various books as provided in the court rules.
To secure control of the assets and papers
Control of assets includes insurance of property and providing security to protect the assets.
To realize assets and debts
It seems to be very simple duty to realize assets and debts but practically most difficult part, buyers
do talk about only defects in the assets. They try to buy the same at scrap value. Also debtors do not
respond at all or claim that they had paid the dues. Even after getting ex-parte decree difficulties are
faced in tracing the debtors and execution of decree by attachment.
To ascertain liabilities and discharge them
Here also liabilities of creditors can be fixed faster but liability of Tax authorities and workmen are
most difficult to be fixed in time. One has to face trade union and their abnormal demands.
To distribute surplus to the contributories
Problem can be there in finalizing list of contributories even though list is provided. As the company
is in existence all types of transactions do continue like Demat facility, transfer and transmission
cases etc.
To comply with all applicable laws and Court Rules for dissolution
To name few - Company Law, Labour Laws, Income Tax, Sales Tax, Pollution Control, National Statistics,
Provident Fund, ESI, Banking, Municipal Law, Depository Act, Securities Contract Act, SEBI, Listing
Agreement, Specific law applicable to that industry.
Authority
Private liquidator has authority:
(a) To institute or defend any suit or prosecution.
404 PP-CRVI
(b) To carry on business necessary for beneficial winding up.
(c) To sell immovable and movable assets.
(d) To raise security on assets.
(e) To do all necessary things for winding up the affairs.
In case of voluntary winding up liquidator is entering the shoes of Board of Directors. Enjoying full authority to
decide the matter but he has to discharge his responsibilities and comply with applicable provisions of
various laws. Company remains live till the order of dissolution by the Tribunal and hence liquidator is
required to submit all necessary returns in time. Consider the provisions of TDS, Capital Gain and finally
sales tax set off. After the amendment Act in other cases of winding up liquidator will be under the
supervision and control of Company Law Tribunal as at presently Official Liquidator is under the supervision
and control of the court.
Remuneration
Most important aspect for any practitioner is reward for his efforts. One must be very cautious while fixing the
remuneration because no one is having the authority to increase the same subsequently.
As the Company remains live till dissolution liquidator is expected to follow the procedure as given in tax
laws i.e. preparation of balance sheet and filing the same with Income Tax. Accounts of liquidator can be of
different period but the Balance sheet must be as of 31st March. TDS deduction and filing of return is must.
Sales Tax returns are required to be filed till the cancellation of sales tax number even though they are nil
returns. Demat facility continues. Listing continues with the exchange though they do not allow trading of
scrip. Nothing is automatic in Voluntary winding up including retrenchment of workers.
Keeping in view the large role for professionals and experts in the insolvency process, the Irani Committee
has recommended the recognition of the concept of insolvency Practitioners in its report. If the
recommendations of the Irani Committee including those extracted above meet the favour of policy makers,
the Indian insolvency system will undergo a revolutionary change bringing it at par with the international
benchmark. The professionals will get the opportunity to participate and perform various roles in the
insolvency process. The professionals would be able to get appointed as liquidators, administrators, valuers,
turnaround advisors, and supervisors besides performing the services such as representing and advising
creditor committees, individual creditors and other stakeholders, investigator, inspector, auctioneer, trustees,
security advisors, etc.
LESSON ROUND UP
Corporate Collapse implies business failure of the company, which may occur due to inadequate capital,
fraudulent business practices, management inexperience and incompetence, failure to respond to change,
recession, obsolescence, excessive gearing etc.
There are fundamental differences between winding up and dissolution as regards the legal procedures are
involved.
A company may be wound up by the Court i.e. compulsory winding up; by voluntary winding up (members
voluntary winding up or creditors voluntary winding up).
Contributory means every person liable to contribute to the assets of a company in the event of its being
Lesson 20
Winding Up 405
wound up, and includes holders of any shares which are fully paid-up and for the purposes of all
proceedings for determining, and all proceedings prior to the final determination of, the persons who are
deemed to be contributories, includes any person alleged to be a contributory.
If in the course of winding up of a company, it appears that any business of the company has been carried
on, with intent to defraud creditors of the company, or any other person, or for any fraudulent purpose, the
Court on the application of the liquidator or any creditor or contributory of the company may, if it thinks
proper, declare that any persons who were knowingly parties to the carrying on the business in the manner
aforesaid shall be personally responsible, without any limitation of liability, for all or any of the debts or other
liabilities of the company as the Court may direct.
Unregistered companies may be wound up by the order of the Court under the provisions of Part X of the
Act.
A company incorporated outside India (i.e. a foreign company) has been carrying on business in India,
ceases to carry on business in India, it may be ordered to be wound up as an unregistered company, even
though the company has been dissolved or ceases to exist by virtue of the laws of the country under which
it was incorporated.
When an order for winding up of a company has been made or a provisional liquidator has been appointed
or where a resolution for voluntary winding up has been passed, the secretary is required to make out and
submit to the Official Liquidator or to provisional liquidator, or the liquidator, as the case may be, within 21
days from the date of appointment of the provisional liquidator or from the commencement of the winding
up, a statement, verified by an affidavit, as to the affairs of the company.
406 PP-CRVI
Lesson 21
Cross Border Insolvency
LESSON OUTLINE
Corporate
insolvency
Insolvency
Vs.
Individual
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Although the number of cross-border insolvency
cases has increased significantly since the 1990s,
the adoption of national or international legal regimes
equipped to address the issues raised by those
cases has not kept pace. The lack of such regimes
has often resulted in inadequate and uncoordinated
approaches to cross-border insolvency that are not
only unpredictable and time-consuming in their
application, but lack both transparency and the tools
necessary to address the disparities and, in some
cases, conflicts that may occur between national
laws and insolvency regimes. These factors have
impeded the protection of the value of the assets of
financially troubled businesses and hampered their
rescue.
United Nation Commission on International Trade
Law (UNCITRAL), with the general mandate to
further the progressive harmonization and unification
of the law of international trade, has developed a
Model Law which is designed to assist States to
equip their insolvency laws with a modern legal
framework to more effectively address cross-border
insolvency
proceedings
concerning
debtors
experiencing severe financial distress or insolvency.
Further, the World Bank and Asian Development
Bank have also contributed to legislative
developments in dealing with cross border
insolvency. Chapter 11 of US Bankruptcy code is
considered as one of the effective ways of
rehabilitation of bankrupt corporates.
After reading this lesson you will be able to
understand the overall view of UNCITRAL model law,
world bank principles, Chapter 11 of US Bankruptcy
Code and other emerging aspects of insolvency
laws.
408 PP-CRVI
INTRODUCTION
The law of Insolvency in India owes its origin to English law. Before the British came to India there was no
indigenous law of Insolvency in the country.
The earliest rudiments of insolvency legislation can be traced to sections 23 and 24 of the Government of
India Act, 1800, which conferred insolvency jurisdiction on the Supreme Court.
The passing of Statute 9 in 1828 (Geo. IV. c. 73) can be said to be the beginning of the special insolvency
legislation in India. Under this Act, the first insolvency courts for relief of insolvent debtors were established
in the Presidency-towns. A further step in the development of Insolvency Law was taken when the law in
1848 (11 and 12 Viet. c. 21) was passed. The Provisions of the Indian Insolvency Act, 1848, were, however,
found to be inadequate to meet the changing conditions. However, the Act of 1848 was in force in the
Presidency-towns until the enactment in 1909 of the present Presidency-towns Insolvency Act, 1909.
Individual Insolvency
In case of individuals there are two insolvency Act, one for the presidency towns and the other for the rest of
the country. The Presidency Towns Insolvency Act, 1909 and The Provincial Insolvency Act, 1920
respectively.
Corporate Insolvency
Indian insolvency law is contained in the Companies Act, 1956 (1956 Act) under which winding up of
companies is carried out and Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 (SICA) which deals
with revival and rehabilitation of sick companies.
Companies Act, 1956
In India the Companies Act, 1956 provides for the law relating to corporate insolvency and inter alia contains
the provisions for winding up of companies.
A company can be wound up in one of the following ways:
Voluntary winding up
Members voluntary winding up
In addition, the Registrars of Companies are empowered under section 560 to strike off the name of a
defunct company from the register. An unregistered company or a foreign company can also be wound up
under the provisions of the Companies Act.
Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985
The process for rehabilitation, regulated by the Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act 1985 is
done through the institutional structure of Board of Industrial and Financial Restructuring (BIFR).
Lesson 21
National insolvency laws of different countries have by and large not kept pace with the trend.
Inadequate and inharmonious legal approaches due to differences in regulatory platform across
countries that hampers the rescue of financially troubled businesses and impede the protection
of the assets of the insolvent debtor against dissipation.
410 PP-CRVI
(c) Fair and efficient administration of cross-border insolvencies that protects the interests of all
creditors and other interested persons, including the debtor;
(d) Protection and maximization of the value of the debtors assets; and
(e) Facilitation of the rescue of financially troubled businesses, thereby protecting investment and
preserving employment.
Key provisions of Model Law
The model law focuses on four identified elements viz
(a) access,
(b) recognition,
(c) relief (assistance) and
(d) cooperation.
(a) Access
The provisions relating
(i) to access give representatives of foreign insolvency proceedings and creditors a right of access to
the courts of an enacting (domestic) country to seek assistance, and
(ii) to authorize representatives of local proceedings being conducted in the enacting country
(domestic) to seek assistance elsewhere.
For Example, in a cross border insolvency involving Indian and Australian companies, the access is with
respect to representatives of Australian proceedings to Indian court and vice versa.
(b) Recognition
These core provisions accord recognition to orders issued by foreign courts commencing qualifying foreign
proceedings and appointing the foreign representative of those proceedings. Provided it satisfies specified
requirements, a qualifying foreign proceeding should be recognized as either a main proceeding, taking
place where the debtor had its centre of main interests at the date of commencement of the foreign
proceeding or a non-main proceeding, taking place where the debtor has an establishment. Recognition of
foreign proceedings under the Model Law has several effects - principal amongst them is the relief accorded
to assist the foreign proceeding.
(c) Relief
A basic principle of the Model Law is that the relief considered necessary for the orderly and fair conduct of
cross-border insolvencies should be available to assist foreign proceedings. By specifying the relief that is
available, the Model Law neither imports the consequences of foreign law into the insolvency system of the
enacting State nor applies to the foreign proceedings the relief that would be available under the law of the
enacting State.
Key elements of the relief include interim relief at the discretion of the court between the making of an
application for recognition and the decision on that application, an automatic stay upon recognition of main
proceedings and relief at the discretion of the court for both main and non-main proceedings following
recognition.
Lesson 21
Access to local representatives for foreign records and access to foreign representatives to local
records
GENERAL PROVISIONS
Scope of application (Article 1)
According to Article 1 of the Model Law, it applies where:
(a) Assistance is sought in the enacting State by a foreign court or a foreign representative in
connection with a foreign proceeding; or
412 PP-CRVI
(b) Assistance is sought in a foreign State in connection with a proceeding under the laws of the
enacting State relating to insolvency; or
(c) A foreign proceeding and a proceeding under the laws of the enacting State relating to insolvency in
respect of the same debtor are taking place concurrently; or
(d) Creditors or other interested persons in a foreign State have an interest in requesting the
commencement of, or participating in, a proceeding under the laws of the enacting State relating to
insolvency.
It further says that the Model Law does not apply to a proceeding concerning any types of entities, such as
banks or insurance companies, that are subject to a special insolvency regime in a State and that State
wishes to exclude from the Law (the type of entity to be excluded may be designated).
Banks or insurance companies are mentioned as examples of entities that the enacting State might decide to
exclude from the scope of the Model Law. The reason for the exclusion would be that the insolvency of such
entities gives rise to the particular need to protect vital interests of a large number of individuals, or that the
insolvency of those entities usually requires particularly prompt and circumspect action (for instance to avoid
massive withdrawals of deposits). For those reasons, the insolvency of such types of entities is in many
States administered under a special regulatory regime. The enacting State might decide to exclude the
insolvency of entities other than banks and insurance companies.
Types of foreign proceedings covered
To fall within the scope of the Model Law, a foreign insolvency proceeding needs to possess certain
attributes. These include the basis in insolvency-related law of the originating State; involvement of creditors
collectively; control or supervision of the assets and affairs of the debtor by a court or another official body;
and reorganization or liquidation of the debtor as the purpose of the proceeding. Within those parameters, a
variety of collective proceedings would be eligible for recognition, be they compulsory or voluntary, corporate
or individual, winding-up or reorganization. It also includes those in which the debtor retains some measure
of control over its assets, albeit under court supervision (e.g. suspension of payments, "debtor in
possession"). An inclusive approach is used also as regards the possible types of debtors covered by the
Model Law.
Principle of supremacy of international obligations (Article 3)
Article 3 provides that to the extent that the Model Law conflicts with an obligation of the state enacting the
Model Law arising out of any treaty or other form of agreement to which it is a party with one or more other
States, the requirements of the treaty or agreement prevail.
Competent court or authority (Article 4)
The functions under the Model Law relating to recognition of foreign proceedings and cooperation with
foreign courts shall be performed by the court, courts, authority or authorities as specified in the Model Law
who are competent to perform those functions in the enacting State.
Lesson 21
414 PP-CRVI
the court must be satisfied that the interests of the creditors and other interested persons, including
the debtor, are adequately protected (Article 22, paragraph 1);
the court may subject the relief it grants to conditions it considers appropriate; and
the court may modify or terminate the relief granted, if so requested by a person affected thereby
(Article 22, paragraphs 2 and 3).
In addition to those specific provisions, the Model Law in a general way provides that the court may refuse to
take an action governed by the Model Law if the action would be manifestly contrary to the public policy of
the enacting State (Article 6).
Notification to foreign creditors of a proceeding (Article 14)
Article 14 of the Model Law provides that whenever under laws of the enacting State relating to insolvency, a
notification is to be given to creditors, such notification shall also be given to the known creditors that do not
have addresses in the State. The court may order that appropriate steps be taken with a view to notifying any
creditor whose address is not yet known. The main purpose of notifying foreign creditors is to inform them of
the commencement of the insolvency proceeding and of the time-limit to file their claims.
Such notification shall be made to the foreign creditors individually, unless the court considers that, under the
circumstances, some other form of notification would be more appropriate. No letters rogatory or other,
similar formality is required. When a notification of commencement of a proceeding is to be given to foreign
creditors, the notification shall:
(a) Indicate a reasonable time period for filing claims and specify the place for their filing;
(b) Indicate whether secured creditors need to file their secured claims; and
(c) Contain any other information required to be included in such a notification to creditors pursuant to
the law of this State and the orders of the court.
Lesson 21
The Model Law presumes that documents submitted in support of the application for recognition need not be
authenticated in any special way, in particular by legalization. According to Article 16, the court is entitled to
presume that those documents are authentic whether or not they have been legalized. "Legalization" is a
term often used for the formality by which a diplomatic or consular agent of the State in which the document
is to be produced certifies the authenticity of the signature, the capacity in which the person signing the
document has acted and, where appropriate, the identity of the seal or stamp on the document.
In respect of the provision relaxing any requirement of legalization, the question may arise whether that is in
conflict with the international obligations of the enacting State. Several States are parties to bilateral or
multilateral treaties on mutual recognition and legalization of documents. According to Article 3 of the Model
Law, if there is still a conflict between the Model Law and a treaty, the treaty will prevail. In order not to
prevent recognition because of non-compliance with a mere technicality, the law allows evidence other than
that specified; that provision, however, does not compromise the courts power to insist on the presentation
of evidence acceptable to it.
It further requires that an application for recognition must be accompanied by a statement identifying all
foreign proceedings in respect of the debtor that are known to the foreign representative. That information is
needed by the court not so much for the decision on recognition itself but for any decision granting relief in
favour of the foreign proceeding. In order to tailor such relief appropriately and make sure that the relief is
consistent with any other insolvency proceeding concerning the same debtor, the court needs to be aware of
all foreign proceedings concerning the debtor that may be under way in third States.
Decision to recognize a foreign proceeding (Article 17)
Subject to Article 6, a foreign proceeding shall be recognized if:
(a) The foreign proceeding is a proceeding within the meaning as defined under Article 2;
(b) The foreign representative applying for recognition is a person or body within the meaning as
defined under Article 2;
(c) The application meets the requirements of Article 15; and
(d) The application has been submitted to the court referred to in Article 4.
The foreign proceeding shall be recognized as a foreign main proceeding if it is taking place in the State
where the debtor has the centre of its main interests; or as a foreign non-main proceeding if the debtor has
an establishment within the meaning of subparagraph (f) of Article 2 in the foreign State.
The purpose of Article 17 is to indicate that, if recognition is not contrary to the public policy of the enacting
State and if the application meets the above said requirements, recognition will be granted as a matter of
course. A decision to recognize a foreign proceeding would normally be subject to review or rescission, as
any other court decision.
Subsequent information (Article 18)
The foreign representative shall inform the court immediately, if from the time of filing the application for
recognition of the foreign proceeding, there is:
(a) Any substantial change in the status of the recognized foreign proceeding or the status of the
foreign representatives appointment; and
(b) Any other foreign proceeding regarding the same debtor that becomes known to the foreign
representative.
416 PP-CRVI
It is possible that, after the application for recognition or after recognition, changes may occur in the foreign
proceeding that would have affected the decision on recognition or the relief granted on the basis of
recognition. For example, the foreign proceeding may be terminated or transformed from a liquidation
proceeding into a reorganization proceeding, or the terms of the appointment of the foreign representative
may be modified or the appointment itself terminated. The technical modifications in the status of the
proceedings or the terms of the appointment are frequent, but that only some of those modifications are such
that they would affect the decision granting relief or the decision recognizing the proceeding; therefore, the
provision only calls for information of "substantial" changes.
Relief that may be granted upon application for recognition of a foreign proceeding (Article 19)
According to Article 19, from the time of filing an application for recognition until the application is decided
upon, the court may, at the request of the foreign representative, where relief is urgently needed to protect
the assets of the debtor or the interests of the creditors, grant relief of a provisional nature, including:
(a) Staying execution against the debtors assets;
(b) Entrusting the administration or realization of all or part of the debtors assets located in a State to
the foreign representative or another person designated by the court, in order to protect and
preserve the value of assets that, by their nature or because of other circumstances, are perishable,
susceptible to devaluation or otherwise in jeopardy;
(c) Any relief mentioned in Article 21.
Relief available under Article 19 is provisional in the sense that, the relief terminates when the application for
recognition is decided upon; however, the court is given the opportunity to extend the measure, as provided
in Article 21. The court may refuse to grant relief under this Article if such relief would interfere with the
administration of a foreign main proceeding.
Effects of recognition of a foreign main proceeding (Article 20)
Once foreign proceeding is recognized which is a foreign main proceeding, the following are the effects:
(a) Commencement or continuation of individual actions or individual proceedings concerning the
debtors assets, rights, obligations or liabilities is stayed;
(b) Execution against the debtors assets is stayed; and
(c) The right to transfer, encumber or otherwise dispose of any assets of the debtor is suspended.
The effects provided by Article 20 are not discretionary in nature. These flow automatically from recognition
of the foreign main proceeding. The automatic effects under Article 21 apply only to main proceedings.
Relief that may be granted upon recognition of a foreign proceeding (Article 21)
Upon recognition of a foreign proceeding, whether main or non-main, where necessary to protect the assets
of the debtor or the interests of the creditors, the court may, at the request of the foreign representative,
grant any appropriate relief, including:
(a) Staying the commencement or continuation of individual actions or individual proceedings
concerning the debtors assets, rights, obligations or liabilities, to the extent they have not been
stayed under Article 20;
(b) Staying execution against the debtors assets to the extent it has not been stayed under Article 20;
(c) Suspending the right to transfer, encumber or otherwise dispose of any assets of the debtor to the
extent this right has not been suspended under Article 20;
Lesson 21
(d) Providing for the examination of witnesses, the taking of evidence or the delivery of information
concerning the debtors assets, affairs, rights, obligations or liabilities;
(e) Entrusting the administration or realization of all or part of the debtors assets located in this State to
the foreign representative or another person designated by the court;
(f) Extending relief granted under Article 19;
(g) Granting any additional relief that may be available to a person or body administering a
reorganization or liquidation under the law of the enacting State under the laws of that State.
Upon recognition of a foreign proceeding, whether main or non-main, the court may, at the request of the
foreign representative, entrust the distribution of all or part of the debtors assets located in the State
enacting the Model Law to the foreign representative or another person designated by the court, provided
that the court is satisfied that the interests of creditors are adequately protected.
In granting relief under this Article to a representative of a foreign non-main proceeding, the court must be
satisfied that the relief relates to assets that, under the law of the enacting State, should be administered in
the foreign non-main proceeding or concerns information required in that proceeding.
Protection of creditors and other interested persons (Article 22)
The court may under Article 22, at the request of the foreign representative or a person affected by relief
granted, or at its own motion, modify or terminate such relief. In granting or denying relief under Article 19 or
21, or in modifying or terminating relief, the court must be satisfied that the interests of the creditors and
other interested persons, including the debtor, are adequately protected.
The idea underlying Article 22 is that there should be a balance between relief that may be granted to the
foreign representative and the interests of the persons that may be affected by such relief.
Actions to avoid acts detrimental to creditors (Article 23)
Under many national laws both individual creditors and insolvency administrators have a right to bring
actions to avoid or otherwise render ineffective acts detrimental to creditors. Such a right, insofar as it
pertains to individual creditors, is often not governed by insolvency law but by general provisions of law (such
as the civil code); the right is not necessarily tied to the existence of an insolvency proceeding against the
debtor so that the action may be instituted prior to the commencement of such a proceeding. The person
having such a right is typically only an affected creditor and not another person such as the insolvency
administrator. Furthermore, the conditions for these individual-creditor actions are different from the
conditions applicable to similar actions that might be initiated by an insolvency administrator.
The procedural standing conferred by Article 23 extends only to actions that are available to the local
insolvency administrator in the context of an insolvency proceeding, and the Article does not equate the
foreign representative with individual creditors who may have similar rights under a different set of
conditions. Such actions of individual creditors fall outside the scope of Article 23.
The Model Law expressly provides that a foreign representative has "standing" to initiate actions to avoid or
otherwise render ineffective legal acts detrimental to creditors. The provision is drafted narrowly in that it
does not create any substantive right regarding such actions and also does not provide any solution involving
conflict of laws. The effect of the provision is that a foreign representative is not prevented from initiating
such actions by the sole fact that the foreign representative is not the insolvency administrator appointed in
the enacting State.
418 PP-CRVI
Intervention by a foreign representative in proceedings (Article 24)
Upon recognition of a foreign proceeding, the foreign representative may, provided the requirements of the
law of the State are met, intervene in any proceedings in which the debtor is a party. The purpose of Article
24 is to avoid the denial of standing to the foreign representative to intervene in proceedings merely because
the procedural legislation may not have contemplated the foreign representative among those having such
standing. The Article applies to foreign representatives of both main and non-main proceedings.
Cooperation with Foreign Courts and Foreign Representatives
Chapter IV (Articles 25-27), on cross-border cooperation, is a core element of the Model Law. Its objective is
to enable courts and insolvency administrators from two or more countries to be efficient and achieve optimal
results. Cooperation as described in the chapter is often the only realistic way, for example, to prevent
dissipation of assets, to maximize the value of assets.
Articles 25 and 26 not only authorize cross-border cooperation, they also mandate it by providing that the
court and the insolvency administrator "shall cooperate to the maximum extent possible". The Articles are
designed to overcome the widespread problem of national laws lacking rules providing a legal basis for
cooperation by local courts with foreign courts in dealing with cross-border insolvencies.
Enactment of such a legal basis would be particularly helpful in legal systems in which the discretion given to
judges to operate outside areas of express statutory authorization is limited. However, even in jurisdictions in
which there is a tradition of wider judicial latitude, enactment of a legislative framework for cooperation has
proved to be useful. To the extent that cross-border judicial cooperation in the enacting State is based on the
principle of comity among nations, the enactment of Articles 25-27 offers an opportunity for making that
principle more concrete and adapted to the particular circumstances of cross-border insolvencies.
The Articles in chapter IV leave certain decisions, in particular when and how to cooperate, to the courts and,
subject to the supervision of the courts, to the insolvency administrators. For a court to cooperate with a
foreign court or a foreign representative regarding a foreign proceeding, the Model Law does not require a
previous formal decision to recognize that foreign proceeding.
Cooperation and direct communication between courts or foreign representatives (Article 25)
The court is entitled to communicate directly with, or to request information or assistance directly from,
foreign courts or foreign representatives. The ability of courts, with appropriate involvement of the parties, to
communicate "directly" and to request information and assistance "directly" from foreign courts or foreign
representatives is intended to avoid the use of time-consuming procedures traditionally in use, such as
letters rogatory.
Cooperation and direct communication between a person or body administering a reorganization or
liquidation under the law of the enacting State and foreign courts or foreign representatives (Article
26)
Article 26 on international cooperation between persons who are appointed to administer assets of insolvent
debtors reflects the important role that such persons can play in devising and implementing cooperative
arrangements, within the parameters of their authority. The provision makes it clear that an insolvency
administrator acts under the overall supervision of the competent court. The Model Law does not modify the
rules already existing in the insolvency law of the enacting State on the supervisory functions of the court
over the activities of the insolvency administrator.
According to Article 27, Cooperation may be implemented by any appropriate means, including:
(a) Appointment of a person or body to act at the direction of the court;
Lesson 21
420 PP-CRVI
Coordination of more than one foreign proceeding (Article 30)
Article 30 deals with cases where the debtor is subject to insolvency proceedings in more than one foreign
State and foreign representatives of more than one foreign proceeding seek recognition or relief in the
enacting State. The provision applies whether or not an insolvency proceeding is pending in the enacting
State. If, in addition to two or more foreign proceedings, there is a proceeding in the enacting State, the court
will have to act pursuant to both Article 29 and Article 30.
In respect of more than one foreign proceeding regarding the same debtor, the court shall seek cooperation
and coordination under Articles 25, 26 and 27, and the following shall apply:
(a) Any relief granted under Article 19 or 21 to a representative of a foreign non-main proceeding after
recognition of a foreign main proceeding must be consistent with the foreign main proceeding;
(b) If a foreign main proceeding is recognized after recognition, or after the filing of an application for
recognition, of a foreign non-main proceeding, any relief in effect under Article 19 or 21 shall be
reviewed by the court and shall be modified or terminated if inconsistent with the foreign main
proceeding;
(c) If, after recognition of a foreign non-main proceeding, another foreign non-main proceeding is
recognized, the court shall grant, modify or terminate relief for the purpose of facilitating
coordination of the proceedings.
The objective of Article 30 is similar to that of Article 29 in that the key issue in the case of concurrent
proceedings is to promote cooperation, coordination and consistency of relief granted to different
proceedings. Such consistency will be achieved by appropriate tailoring of relief to be granted or by
modifying or terminating relief already granted. Unlike Article 29, which, as a matter of principle, gives
primacy to the local proceeding, Article 30 gives preference to the foreign main proceeding if there is one.
Rule of payment in concurrent proceedings (Article 32)
Without prejudice to secured claims or rights in rem, a creditor who has received part payment in respect of
its claim in a proceeding, pursuant to a law relating to insolvency, in a foreign State, may not receive a
payment for the same claim in a proceeding under the laws of the enacting State relating to insolvency
regarding the same debtor, so long as the payment to the other creditors of the same class is proportionately
less than the payment the creditor has already received.
The rule set forth in Article 32, also referred to as the hotchpotch rule, is a useful safeguard in a legal regime
for coordination and cooperation in the administration of cross-border insolvency proceedings. It is intended
to avoid situations in which a creditor might obtain more favourable treatment than the other creditors of the
same class by obtaining payment of the same claim in insolvency proceedings in different jurisdictions.
Lesson 21
principally creditors and other stakeholders in the debtor's business; and public policy concerns, such as
employment and taxation. The Legislative Guide assists the reader to evaluate the different approaches and
solutions available and to choose the one most suitable to the local context.
The purpose of the Legislative Guide on Insolvency Law is
(i) to assist the establishment of an efficient and effective legal framework to address thefinancial
difficulty of debtors.
(ii) intended to be used as a reference by national authorities and legislative bodies when preparing
new laws and regulations or reviewing the adequacy of existing laws and regulations.
Key provisions
The Legislative Guide is divided into three parts.
Part one discusses the key objectives of an insolvency law, structural issues such as the relationship
between insolvency law and other law, the types of mechanisms available for resolving a debtor's financial
difficulties and the institutional framework required to support an effective insolvency regime.
Part two deals with core features of an effective insolvency law, following as closely as possible the various
stages of an insolvency proceeding from their commencement to discharge of the debtor and closure of the
proceedings. Key elements are identified as including: standardized commencement criteria; a stay to
protect the assets of the insolvency estate that includes actions by secured creditors; post-commencement
finance; participation of creditors; provision for expedited reorganization proceedings; simplified requirements
for submission and verification of claims; conversion of reorganization to liquidation when reorganization
fails; and clear rules for discharge of the debtor and closure of insolvency proceedings.
Part three addresses the treatment of enterprise groups in insolvency, both nationally and internationally.
While many of the issues addressed in parts one and two are equally applicable to enterprise groups, there
are that only apply in the enterprise group context. Part three thus builds upon and supplements parts one
and two. At the domestic level, the commentary and recommendations of part three cover various
mechanisms that can be used to streamline insolvency proceedings involving two or more members of the
same enterprise group. These include: procedural coordination of multiple proceedings concerning different
debtors; issues concerning post-commencement and post-application finance in a group context; avoidance
provisions; substantive consolidation of insolvency proceedings affecting two or more group members;
appointment of a single or the same insolvency representative to all group members subject to insolvency;
and coordinated reorganization plans. In terms of the international treatment of groups, part three focuses on
cooperation and coordination, extending provisions based upon the Model Law on Cross-Border Insolvency
to the group context and, as appropriate, considering the applicability to the international context of the
mechanisms proposed to address enterprise group insolvencies in the national context.
EFFECTIVE INSOLVENCY AND CREDITOR RIGHTS SYSTEMS - WORLD BANK PRINCIPLES
The World Bank Principles were originally developed in 2001 in response to a request from the international
community in the wake of the financial crises in emerging markets in the late 90s. At the time, there were no
internationally recognized benchmarks or standards to evaluate the effectiveness of domestic creditor rights
and insolvency systems. The World Banks initiative began in 1999, with the constitution of an ad hoc
committee of partner organizations, and with the assistance of leading international experts who participated
in the World Banks Task Force and Working Groups. The Principles were vetted in a series of five regional
conferences, involving officials and experts from some 75 countries, and drafts were placed on the World
Banks website for public comment. The Banks Board of Directors approved the Principles in 2001 for use in
422 PP-CRVI
connection with the joint IMF-World Bank program to develop Reports on the Observance of Standards and
Codes (ROSC), subject to reviewing the experience and updating the Principles as needed.
From 2001 to 2004, the Principles were used to assess country systems under the ROSC and Financial
Sector Assessment Program (FSAP) in some 24 countries in all regions of the world. Assessments using the
Principles have been instrumental to the Banks developmental and operational work, and in providing
assistance to member countries. This has yielded a wealth of experience and enabled the Bank to test the
sufficiency of the Principles as a flexible benchmark in a wide range of diverse country systems. In taking
stock of that experience, the Bank has consulted a wide range of interested parties at the national and
international level, including officials, civil society, business and financial sectors, investors, professional
groups, and others.
In 2003, the World Bank convened the Global Forum on Insolvency Risk Management (FIRM) to discuss the
experience and lessons from the application of the Principles in the assessment program. The forum
consisted of over 200 experts from 31 countries to discuss the lessons from the principles and to discuss
further refinements to them. During 2003 and 2004, the Bank also convened three working group sessions of
the Global Judges Forum, involving judges from approximately 70 countries, who have assisted the Bank in
its review of the institutional framework principles and in developing more detailed recommendations for
strengthening court practices for commercial enforcement and insolvency proceedings. Other regional fora
have also provided a means for sharing experience and obtaining feedback in areas of the Principles,
including the Forum on Asian Insolvency Reform (FAIR) from 2002-2004 (organized by OECD and cosponsored with the Bank and the Asian Development Bank), and Forum on Insolvency in Latin America
(FILA) in 2004 organised by the Bank.
In the area of the insolvency law framework and creditor rights systems, staffs of the Bank maintained
participation in the UNCITRAL working groups on insolvency law and security interests and liaised with
UNCITRAL staff and experts to ensure consistency between the Banks Principles and the UNCITRAL
Legislative Guide on Insolvency Law. The Bank has also benefited from an ongoing collaboration with the
International Association of Insolvency Regulators (IAIR) to survey regulatory practices of IAIR member
countries and develop recommendations for strengthening regulatory capacity and frameworks for
insolvency systems. A similar collaboration with INSOL International has provided feedback and input in the
area of director and officer liability and informal workout systems.
Based on the experience gained from the use of the Principles, and following extensive consultations, the
Principles have been thoroughly reviewed and updated. The revised Principles have benefited from wide
consultation and, more importantly, from the practical experience of using them in the context of the Banks
assessment and operational work.
The World Bank Principles have been designed as a broad-spectrum assessment tool to assist countries in
their efforts to evaluate and improve core aspects of their commercial law systems that are fundamental to a
sound investment climate, and to promote commerce and economic growth. Efficient, reliable and
transparent creditor rights and insolvency systems are of key importance for reallocation of productive
resources in the corporate sector, for investor confidence and forward looking corporate restructuring. These
systems also play a pivotal role in times of crisis to enable a country and stakeholders to promptly respond to
and resolve matters of corporate financial distress on systemic scales.
The Principles emphasize contextual, integrated solutions and the policy choices involved in developing
those solutions. The Principles highlight the relationship between the cost and flow of credit (including
secured credit) and the laws and institutions that recognize and enforce credit agreements (Part A). The
Principles also outline key features and policy choices relating to the legal framework for risk management
Lesson 21
and informal corporate workout systems (Part B), formal commercial insolvency law frameworks (Part C) and
the implementation of these systems through sound institutional and regulatory frameworks (Part D).
The principles have broader application beyond corporate insolvency regimes and creditor rights. The
Principles are designed to be flexible in their application, and do not offer detailed prescriptions for national
systems. The Principles embrace practices that have been widely recognized and accepted as good
practices internationally. As legal systems and business and commerce are evolutionary in nature, so too are
the Principles, and it is anticipated that these will continue to be reviewed going forward to take account of
significant changes and developments.
THE WORLD BANK PRINCIPLES A SUMMARY
A brief summary of the key elements of the World Bank Principles for effective insolvency and creditor rights
systems is given below:
1. Credit Environment
Compatible credit and enforcement systems. A regularized system of credit should be supported by
mechanisms that provide efficient, transparent and reliable methods for recovering debt, including seizure
and sale of immovable and movable assets and sale or collection of intangible assets, such as debt owed to
the debtor by third parties. An efficient system for enforcing debt claims is crucial to a functioning credit
system, especially for unsecured credit. A creditors ability to take possession of a debtors property and to
sell it to satisfy the debt is the simplest, most effective means of ensuring prompt payment. It is far more
effective than the threat of an insolvency proceeding, which often requires a level of proof and a prospect of
procedural delay that in all but extreme cases make it not credible to debtors as leverage for payment.
Collateral systems. One of the pillars of a modern credit economy is the ability to own and freely transfer
ownership interests in property, and to grant a security interest to credit providers with respect to such
interests and rights as a means of gaining access to credit at more affordable prices. Secured transactions
play an enormously important role in a well functioning market economy. Laws on secured credit mitigate
lenders risks of default and thereby increase the flow of capital and facilitate low cost financing.
Discrepancies and uncertainties in the legal framework governing security interests are the main reasons for
high costs and unavailability of credit, especially in developing countries.
The legal framework for secured lending addresses the fundamental features and elements for the creation,
recognition and enforcement of security interests in all types of assets, movable and immovable, tangible
and intangible, including inventories, receivables, proceeds and future property, and on a global basis,
including both possessory and non-possessory interests. The law should encompass any or all of a debtors
obligations to a creditor, present or future and between all types of persons. In addition, it should provide for
effective notice and registration rules to be adapted to all types of property, and clear rules of priority on
competing claims or interests in the same assets. For security rights and notice to third parties to be
effective, they must be capable of being publicized at reasonable costs and easily accessible to
stakeholders. A reliable, affordable, public registry system is therefore essential to promote optimal
conditions for asset based lending. Where several registries exist, the registration system should be
integrated to the maximum extent possible so that all notices recorded under the secured transactions
legislation can be easily retrieved.
Enforcement systems. A modern, credit-based economy requires predictable, transparent and affordable
enforcement of both unsecured and secured credit claims by efficient mechanisms outside of insolvency, as
well as a sound insolvency system. These systems must be designed to work in harmony. Commerce is a
system of commercial relationships predicated on express or implied contractual agreements between an
424 PP-CRVI
enterprise and a wide range of creditors and constituencies. Although commercial transactions have become
increasingly complex as more sophisticated techniques are developed for pricing and managing risks, the
basic rights governing these relationships and the procedures for enforcing these rights have not changed
much. These rights enable parties to rely on contractual agreements, fostering confidence that fuels
investment, lending and commerce. Conversely, uncertainty about the enforceability of contractual rights
increases the cost of credit to compensate for the increased risk of nonperformance or, in severe cases,
leads to credit tightening.
Credit information systems. A modern credit-based economy requires access to complete, accurate and
reliable information concerning borrowers payment histories. This process should take place in a legal
environment that provides the framework for the creation and operation of effective credit information
systems. Permissible uses of information from credit information systems should be clearly circumscribed,
especially regarding information about individuals. Legal controls on the type of information collected and
distributed by credit information systems may often be used to advance public policies, including antidiscrimination laws.
Privacy concerns should be addressed through notice of the existence of such systems, notice of when
information from such systems is used to make adverse decisions, and access by data subjects to stored
credit information with the ability to dispute and have corrected inaccurate or incomplete information. An
effective enforcement and supervision mechanism should be in place that provides efficient, inexpensive,
transparent and predictable methods for resolving disputes concerning the operation of credit information
systems along with proportionate sanctions which encourage compliance but that are not so stringent as to
discourage operations of such systems.
Informal corporate workouts. Corporate workouts should be supported by an environment that encourages
participants to restore an enterprise to financial viability. Informal workouts are negotiated in the shadow of
the law. Accordingly, the enabling environment must include clear laws and procedures that require
disclosure of or access to timely and accurate financial information on the distressed enterprise; encourage
lending to, investment in or recapitalization of viable distressed enterprises; support a broad range of
restructuring activities, such as debt write-offs, reschedulings, restructurings and debt-equity conversions;
and provide favorable or neutral tax treatment for restructurings. A countrys financial sector should promote
an informal out-of-court process for dealing with cases of corporate financial difficulty in which banks and
other financial institutions have a significant exposure especially in markets where enterprise insolvency is
systemic.
2. Insolvency Law Systems
Commercial insolvency. Though approaches vary, effective insolvency systems have a number of aims
and objectives. Systems should aspire to:
(i) integrate with a countrys broader legal and commercial systems;
(ii) maximize the value of a firms assets and recoveries by creditors;
(iii) provide for both efficient liquidation of nonviable businesses and those where liquidation is likely to
produce a greater return to creditors and reorganization of viable businesses;
(iv) strike a careful balance between liquidation and reorganization, allowing for easy conversion of
proceedings from one proceeding to another;
(v) provide for equitable treatment of similarly situated creditors, including similarly situated foreign and
domestic creditors;
Lesson 21
426 PP-CRVI
assembled and made readily available to other parties and, when combined with the good behavior of
corporate citizens, creates an informed and communicative environment conducive to greater cooperation
among all parties. Transparency and corporate governance are especially important in emerging markets,
which are more sensitive to volatility from external factors. Without transparency, there is a greater likelihood
that loan pricing will not reflect underlying risks, leading to higher interest rates and other charges.
Transparency and strong corporate governance are needed in both domestic and cross-border transactions
and at all phases of investmentat the inception when making a loan, when managing exposure while the
loan is outstanding, and especially once a borrowers financial difficulties become apparent and the lender is
seeking to exit the loan.
Transparency increases confidence in decision making and so encourages the use of out of- court
restructuring options. Such options are preferable because they often provide higher returns to lenders than
straight liquidation through the legal processand because they avoid the costs, complexities and
uncertainties of the legal process.
Predictability. Investment in emerging markets is discouraged by the lack of well defined and predictable
risk allocation rules and by the inconsistent application of written laws. Moreover, during systemic crises
investors often demand uncertainty risk premiums too onerous to permit markets to clear. Some investors
may avoid emerging markets entirely despite expected returns that far outweigh known risks. Rational
lenders will demand risk premiums to compensate for systemic uncertainty in making, managing and
collecting investments in emerging markets. The likelihood that creditors will have to rely on risk allocation
rules increases as fundamental factors supporting investment deteriorate. That is because risk allocation
rules set minimum standards that have considerable application in limiting downside uncertainty, but that
usually do not enhance returns in non-distressed markets. During actual or perceived systemic crises,
lenders tend to concentrate on reducing risk, and risk premiums soar. At these times the inability to predict
downside risk can cripple markets. The effect can impinge on other risks in the country, causing lender
reluctance even toward untroubled borrowers.
US BANKRUPTCY CODE
Six basic types of bankruptcy situations are dealt with under the US Bankruptcy Code.
Chapter 7 bankruptcy leading to liquidation. In this type of bankruptcy, a court-appointed trustee or
administrator takes possession of any nonexempt assets, liquidates these assets (for example, by selling at
an auction), and then uses the proceeds to pay creditors.
Chapter 9, entitled Adjustment of Debts of a Municipality, provides essentially for reorganization. Only a
"municipality" may file under chapter 9, which includes cities and towns, as well as villages, counties, taxing
districts, municipal utilities, and school districts.
Chapter 11, entitled Reorganization, ordinarily is used by commercial enterprises that desire to continue
operating a business and repay creditors concurrently through a court-approved plan of reorganization..
Chapter 12 allows a family farmer or fisherman to continue to operate the business while the plan is being
carried out.
Chapter 13, enables individuals with regular income to develop a plan to repay all or part of their debts.
Under this chapter, debtors propose a repayment plan to make installments to creditors over three to five
years.
Chapter 15 provides effective mechanisms for dealing with insolvency cases involving debtors, assets,
claimants, and other parties of interest involving more than one country.
Lesson 21
Companies dont file Chapter 11 to liquidate; they do so in order to continue operating and to take
the necessary steps to emerge as a financially stronger business, reorganizing their operations or
balance sheet or in some cases by selling substantially all its assets.
Management remains in control of the business during the chapter 11 rehabilitative process.
Trustees, administrators and monitors typically are not appointed.
The company is given breathing room during the process - an automatic stay generally prevents
parties from taking legal action against the company or taking the companys assets.
Most publicly-held companies prefer to file under Chapter 11 rather than Chapter 7 because they can
still run their business and control the bankruptcy process. Chapter 11 provides a process for
rehabilitating the business of the company.
Sometimes the company successfully works out a plan to return to profitability; sometimes, in the end, it
liquidates. Under Chapter 11 reorganization, a company usually keeps doing business and its stock and
bonds may continue to trade in securities markets.
The U.S. Trustee, the bankruptcy arm of the Department of Justice, appoints one or more committees to
represent the interests of creditors and stockholders in working with the company to develop a plan of
reorganization to enable it to get out of debt. The plan must be accepted by the creditors, bondholders, and
stockholders, and confirmed by the court. However, even if creditors or stockholders vote aginst the plan, the
court can disregard the vote and still confirm the plan if it finds that the plan treats creditors and stockholders
fairly.
428 PP-CRVI
Committees of creditors and stockholders negotiate a plan with the company to relieve the company from
repaying part of its debt so that the company is able to get back to its normal condition.
After the committees work with the company to develop a plan, the bankruptcy court must find that it legally
complies with the Bankruptcy Code before the plan can be implemented.
Thus, Chapter 11 bankruptcy involves a reorganization plan that accommodates debt reorganization through
a payment plan and the major advantage is that the debtors generally remain in possession of their property
and operate their business under the supervision of Court. Chapter 11 debtors also often keep a substantial
portion of their assets. The provisions of Chapter 11 allow the debtor relief from pending obligations and the
opportunity to reorganize its business and restructure debts while continuing to operate the business. Under
this chapter a company can choose to sell off particular assets. Accordingly, subsidiaries outside US need
not be included in the Chapter 11 filings.
There is therefore no change in the legal status of its subsidiaries that are kept out of Chapter 11 filings.
Further, Debtors Audit, Debtors Counselling, Mandatory debtor education etc are provided under US
Bankruptcy laws which help in minimizing the fraudulent bankruptcies. In the light of the above, a need is felt
to have similar legal framework in India which allows continuity of business during bankruptcy proceedings,
control over the management of company filing bankruptcy application, keeping subsidiaries / certain assets
outside the purview of bankruptcy application etc in line with Chapter 11 of US Bankruptcy Code.
6. REFORMS IN INSOLVENCY LAWS Indian Position
World over, insolvency procedures help entrepreneurs close down unviable businesses and start up new
ones. This ensures that the human and economic resources of a country are continuously rechannelised to
efficient use thereby increasing the overall productivity of the economy. It is in this context, free entry and exit
are sine qua non for attaining efficiency.
Indian insolvency law is contained in the Companies Act, 1956 (1956 Act) under which winding up of
companies is carried out and Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Act, 1985 (SICA) which deals
with revival and rehabilitation of sick companies. The two laws were enacted to cater to meet the
expectations of industries thriving in a protectionist environment unexposed to competition in a closed
economy. As India swiftly moves to the centre stage of world economy there has been a consistent effort by
the policy makers to undertake comprehensive reforms in the laws and systems to bring them at par with
international standards and incentivise the foreign investors to invest in the Indian economy.
Justice Eradi Committee
In the year 1999, the Government of India set up a High Level Committee headed by Justice V.B.Eradi, to
examine and make recommendations with regard to the desirability of changes in existing law relating to
winding up of companies so as to achieve more transparency and avoid delays in the final liquidation of the
companies; the mechanism through which the management of companies will be conducted after the
winding up order is issued and the authority which will supervise timely completion of proceedings; the rules
of winding up and adjudication of insolvency of companies; the manner in which the assets of the companies
are brought to sale and the proceeds are distributed efficiently; and a self-contained law on winding up of
companies having regard to SICA, and the Securities Contracts (Regulation) Act, 1956, with a view to
creating confidence in the minds of investors, creditors, labour and shareholders. The committee submitted
its report to the Central Government in the year 2000.
The Committee addressed and recommended the following key points:
The Committee recognized after considering international practices that the law of insolvency
Lesson 21
should not only provide for quick disposal of assets but in Indian economic scene, it should first look
at the possibilities of rehabilitation and revival of companies.
The Committee noted that there are three different agencies namely,
(i) the High Courts, which have powers to order winding up of companies under the provisions of
the Companies Act, 1956;
(ii) the Company Law Board to exercise powers conferred on it by the Act or the powers of the
Central Government delegated to it and
(iii) Board for Industrial and Financial Reconstruction (BIFR) which deals with the references
relating to rehabilitation and revival of companies.
The committee revealed data of time taken to wind up a company it may run on an average upto
25 years; Eastern region being the worst.
Position as on 31.3.1999 as indicated by Eradi Committee was as under:
0-5
years
5-10
Years
10-15
Years
15-20
Years
20-25
Years
25
Years
and
Above
Total
Northern
Region
259
130
86
56
47
66
644
Eastern
Region
126
77
83
73
71
293
723
Southern
region
325
212
89
68
51
78
823
Western
Region
355
184
224
124
82
36
1005
Total
1065
603
482
321
251
473
3195
Committee further noted that the High Courts are not able to devote exclusive attention to winding
up cases which is essential to conclude the winding up of companies quickly. The experiment with
BIFR for speedy revival of companies has also not been encouraging. Committee recognized that
there is a need for establishing a National Tribunal as a specialized agency to deal with matters
relating to rehabilitation, revival and winding up of companies. With a view to avoiding multiplicity of
fora, the National Tribunal should be conferred with jurisdiction and powers to deal with matters
under Companies Act, 1956 presently exercised by the Company Law Board; jurisdiction, power
and authority relating to winding up of companies vested with High Courts and power to consider
rehabilitation and revival of companies presently vested in the BIFR.
The Committee also recommended that the jurisdiction, power and authority relating to winding up
of companies should be vested in a National Company Law Tribunal instead of the High Court as at
present. The National Company Law Tribunal
(a) should have the jurisdiction and power presently exercised by Company Law Board under the
Companies Act, 1956;
(b) should have the power to consider rehabilitation and revival of companies a mandate
presently entrusted to BIFR/AAFIR under SICA;
(c) should have the jurisdiction and power relating to winding up of companies presently vested in
430 PP-CRVI
the High Courts. In view of above recommendations Article 323B of the Constitution should be
amended to set up National Tribunal. SICA should be repealed and the Companies Act, 1956
be amended accordingly.
(d) should be headed by a sitting judge or a former judge of a High Court and each of its Benches
should consist of a judicial member and a technical member.
(e) shall have such number of member as may be prescribed by the Central Government. The
principal Bench of the Tribunal should be located at New Delhi and its Benches should be
located at the principal seats of each High Court. The Central Government may set up more
such Benches if so required. While passing the order for winding up of a company, the Tribunal
shall have power to prescribe time limit for each step to be taken by the Liquidator in the course
of winding up process. The Tribunal shall also have power to prescribe the time limits for
compliance of each step by parties while considering the reference for revival of sick
companies.
(f) should be vested with the power to transfer all proceedings from one Private Liquidator to another
"Private liquidator" or to the "Official Liqudiator", as the circumstances of case may require. The
Tribunal shall have the power to direct the sale of business of the company as a going concern or
at its discretion to sell its asset in a piece-meal manner.
Tribunal may continue to have jurisdiction for winding up the companies on grounds stated in
section 433 but following further grounds may be added therein, namely:
a company has failed to file balance sheet and profit and loss accounts and/or annual returns
for last three years on due dates; or
any action of the company has or is likely to threaten the security or integrity of India. Share
holder or the Central Government will be entitled to file the petition under on aforesaid grounds.
There should be two distinct aspects of the liquidation:
(i) sale of assets (ii) distribution of sale proceeds
An all-out effort should be made by the Liquidator for sale of assets of the company promptly as in
absence of the receipt of sale proceeds, timely distribution among the creditors. The pending
references before BIFR/ AAIFR under SICA should abate in view of repeal of SICA
recommendations by the Committee. However, the winding up proceedings pending in High Courts
under Companies Act, 1956 shall stand transferred to National Tribunal for expeditious disposal of
those cases.
There is a need to encourage voluntary winding up of companies. To achieve this object, a
provision may be made in the Companies Act, 1956 to provide a company having paid-up capital of
`10 lac or more may submit a petition for its winding up in the process Tribunal and companies with
paid-up capital below that amount must resort to voluntary winding up. Creditors may approach the
Tribunal for winding up only if a company defaults in payment of undisputed debts exceeding `
1,00,000 and in other cases of default, creditors voluntary Winding up should be resorted. The
provisions regarding winding up subject for supervision of court may be deleted as such cases will
be taken care of by procedure of compulsory winding up by Court.
It should be obligatory for a company filing a winding up petition to submit the Statement of Affairs
along with the petition for winding up. In cases where the company opposes winding up petition, it
should file Statement of Affairs along with its counter affidavit/reply statement. The Statement of
Affairs should be accompanied by latest addresses of directors/company secretary of company, a
Lesson 21
details of location of assets and their value and debtors and creditors list with complete addresses.
This will ensure speedy winding up of the company.
"A Fund for Revival and Rehabilitation" preservation and protection of companies may be created
under the supervision and control of the Government. The Fund shall be maintained and operated
by an officer authorised in that behalf of such Government.
The winding up order passed by the Tribunal should be made available to the liquidator within a
period not exceeding two weeks from the date of passing of the order.
The directors and officers of the company should be responsible for ensuring that books of account
are completed and got audited up to the date of winding up order and submitted to the Tribunal at
the cost of company failing which such directors and officers should be subjected to monetary
penalty as well as imprisonment.
The present system of liquidator required to seek the courts directions, even for small matters
relating to routine administrative decisions not only causes delay in winding up but also takes
valuable time of the court. Therefore, the liquidator should not seek the sanction of the court except
for important matters such as confirmation of sale of assets and distribution of proceeds realised.
Appropriate legislative action must be taken to ensure that the claims of all employees of a
company and its secured creditors are ranked "pari-passu".
Specific provisions may be made in the Companies Act, 1956 that the liquidator may distribute
interim dividend.
There should be a two point criteria for determining the maintainability of the reference for revival
and rehabilitation to the of a company to the Tribunal, namely, that the company has suffered 50%
of erosion of its net worth or there is a debt default involving a sum of not less than `1 lakh in
respect of undisputed debts.
The reference to the Tribunal for revival by a company should be voluntary. As already stated the
jurisdiction of hearing references of revival and rehabilitation of companies will vest in the Tribunal and
not BIFR as at present.
An explicit provision need be made in the Companies Act giving a right to the secured creditors to
file proof of debt with the liquidator without surrendering his status as a secured creditor and get the
dividend in accordance with the priority to which he is entitled.
The committee further favoured the appointment of professionals as the Liquidators from a panel to
be prepared by the Government.
The repeal of SICA and the ameliorative, revival and reconstructionist procedures obtaining under it
to be reintegrated in a suitably amended form in the structure of the Companies Act 1956.
The committee considered the adoption of the UNCITRAL Model Law in the Companies Act itself to
deal with all cases of "Cross-Border Insolvency".
The Committee also considered that the principles enunciated under legal frame work of "Orderly
and Effective Procedure" recommended by IMF be incorporated in the Companies Act.
The Committee strongly recommended appointing Insolvency Professionals who are members of
Institute of Chartered Accountant of India (ICAI), Institute of Company Secretaries of India (ICSI),
Institute of Cost and Work Accountants of India (ICWAI), Bar Councils or corporate managers who
are well versed in Corporate management on lines of U.K. Insolvency Act. For this purpose Central
432 PP-CRVI
Government may maintain a panel of persons who may act as professional Insolvency practitioners
subject to their fulfilling of the qualification and experience as may be specified by rules.
DR. J.J. IRANI EXPERT COMMITTEE ON COMPANY LAW
Dr. J.J. Irani Expert Committee on Company Law was set up by the Government to recommend a new
company law as a part of the on-going legal and financial sector reform process in the country. Committee
submitted its report to the Government of India on 31 May, 2005.
The Committee proposed significant changes in the law to make the restructuring and liquidation process
speedy, efficient and effective. Recommendations are directed at restoring the eroded confidence of key
stakeholders in the insolvency system while balancing their interest.
The Committee noted that a beginning towards reform was made with the enactment of Companies (Second
Amendment) Act, 2002, which in addition to significant changes in the restructuring and liquidation provisions
provided for the setting up of a new institutional structure in the form of the National Company Law Tribunal
(NCLT)/Tribunal and its Appellate Body, the National Company Law Appellate Tribunal (NCLAT). The
highlights of the report of the Committee regarding Restructuring and Liquidation are given below:
Corporate insolvency to be addressed in company law. No need for a separate insolvency law.
Law to strike a balance between rehabilitation and liquidation process.
Rehabilitation and liquidation processes to be time bound.
Setting up of institutional structure in the form of NCLT/NCALT for overseeing such processes.
Winding up to be resorted to only when revival is not feasible.
Reasonable opportunity for rehabilitation of business before it is decided to be liquidated.
Period of one year to be adequate for rehabilitation from commencement of process to sanction of
plan.
Time bound procedures which limit the possibility of appeals and thereby delays.
Two years to be feasible for completion of liquidation.
Insolvency process to apply to all corporate entities except banks, financial institutions and
insurance companies.
Insolvent company to replace the concept of sick industrial company
Debtors and creditors to have fair access to insolvency system.
Rather than net worth erosion principle, test for insolvency should be default in payment of matured
debt on demand within a prescribed time [liquidity test].
Debtors seeking rehabilitation to approach the Tribunal only with a draft scheme. Creditors being at
least 3/4th in value may also file rehabilitation scheme.
If tribunal deems fit, liquidation proceedings may be converted into restructuring proceedings.
Law to impose certain duties and prohibitions to apply to debtors and creditors on admission of
rehabilitation application. Automatic prohibition on Debtors rights to transfer, sale or dispose off
assets or parts of the business except to the extent necessary to operate the business, with the
approval of the Tribunal.
There should be a duty cast on companies to convene creditors and shareholders meeting in case
Lesson 21
434 PP-CRVI
Provision for monitoring and effective implementation of the scheme/ plan to be made.
Provision should also be made to
amend the plan in the interest of rehabilitation
terminate the plan and to liquidate the company.
Discharge or for alternation of debts and claims that have been discharged or otherwise altered
under the plan.
National Company Law Tribunal (NCLT) envisaged as the forum to address Insolvency issues to be
constituted speedily.
Provisions to be made for ready access to court records, court hearings, debtors, financial data and
other public information.
Tribunal should have clear authority and effective methods of enforcing its judgments.
Encourage and recognize the concept of Insolvency Practitioners (Administrators, Liquidators,
Turnaround Specialists, Valuers etc). CA, CS and Cost Accountancy disciplines can offer high
quality professional for this purpose.
Insolvency Fund may be set up to meet the costs of the insolvency process.
Company under restructuring and liquidation to draw out of the Fund only in proportion of the
contribution made by it to the Fund in the pre-restructuring and pre-liquidation period. Application of
the Fund to the insolvency/ rehabilitation process be subject to the orders of the Tribunal.
International considerations
Insolvency law to provide for rules of jurisdiction, recognition of foreign judgments and co-operation
amongst courts in different countries.
Provisions to deal with issues concerning treaties and arrangements entered into with different
countries be framed.
LEGISLATIVE RESPONSE TO THE REFORM PROCESS
Companies (Second Amendment) Act, 2002
Companies (Second Amendment) Act, 2002, the objective of which provides to expedite the winding-up
process of the companies, facilitating rehabilitation of sick companies and protection of workers interest, is a
sound attempt towards creating a balance between reorganization and liquidation. The Second Amendment
has introduced some significant improvements in the law. Some of major provisions made under the
Companies (Second Amendment) Act, 2002 are briefly discussed below:
National Company Law Tribunal
The Companies (Second Amendment) Act, 2002 provides for setting up of a National Company Law Tribunal
(NCLT) and its Appellate Tribunal. The purpose of creation of the Tribunal is to avoid multiplicity of litigation
before various courts or quasi-judicial bodies or forums regarding revival or rehabilitation or merger and
amalgamation, and winding up of companies. NCLT will have2
The power to consider revival and rehabilitation of companies a mandate presently entrusted to
BIFR under SICA.
2. A new Part VIA (Section 424A to 424L) has been incorporated by the Companies (Second Amendment) Act, 2002.
Lesson 21
The jurisdiction and power relating to winding up of companies presently vested in the High Court.
The winding up proceeding pending in High Courts shall stand transferred to the Tribunal.
The jurisdiction and power exercised by the Company Law Board under the 1956 Act. The
Company Law Board will stand abolished.
Revival and rehabilitation of sick industrial companies
The Amendment Act has inserted a new Part VI-A in the Principal Act to provide for the revival and
rehabilitation of sick industrial companies.
Management of insolvency proceedings
The Second Amendment provides for appointment of court appointed professionals as Liquidators who will
be capable and competent of handling insolvency proceedings much more efficiently.
Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Repeal Act, 2003
Sick Industrial Companies (Special Provisions) Repeal Act, 2003 proposed to repeal the said Act, SICA,
1985 and dissolution of BIFR. The establishment of National Company Law Tribunal under the Companies
(Second Amendment) Act, 2002 and providing it with powers for expediting the winding up procedure is in a
way transfer of power and functions of BIFR to the Tribunal.
LESSON ROUND UP
A company is said to be insolvent when its liabilities exceed its assets which results in its liability to pay off
the debts. Cross border insolvency issues arise when a non-resident is either a debtor or contributory or
creditor.
Since National insolvency laws have by and large not kept pace with the trend, they are often ill equipped to
deal with cases of cross border nature. It hampers the rescue of financially troubled business. It hampers
the administration of cross border insolvencies. This gave the path for evolution of UNCITRAL Model law
on Cross-Border Insolvency in 1997.
UNICITRAL had also came out with the legislative guide on Insolvency Law in 2004.
The study deals with each article of the UNCITRAL Model law covering its purpose, scope, the process,
reliefs foreign courts, foreign proceedings etc. in a summarized and easy language.
The study further discusses about World Bank Principles which have been designed as a broad-spectrum
assessment tool to assist countries in their efforts to evaluate and improve core aspects of their commercial
law systems that are fundamental to a sound investment climate and to promote commerce and economic
growth.
These principles emphasize contextual, integrated solutions and the policy choices involved in developing the
solutions. The principles inter alia outline key features and policy choices relating to legal framework for risk
management and informal corporate work out systems, formal commercial insolvency law frame works etc.
The study discusses various suggestions by various committees on reforms in Insolvency law in India.
Engagement and participation of experts possessing appropriate knowledge and skills in insolvency
process becomes necessary for the quality and efficiency of the insolvency system. The suggestions as
highlighted under J.J. Irani Committee report on role of professionals in Insolvency process is discussed in
the study.
436 PP-CRVI
PROFESSIONAL PROGRAMME
CORPORATE RESTRUCTURING, VALUATION AND INSOLVENCY
PP-CRVI
TEST PAPERS
A Guide to CS Students
To enable the students in achieving their goal to become successful professionals, Institute has prepared a
booklet A Guide to CS Students providing the subject specific guidance on different papers and subjects
contained in the ICSI curriculum. The booklet is available on ICSI website and students may down load
from http://www.icsi.edu/Portals/0/AGUIDETOCSSTUDENTS.pdf
WARNING
It is brought to the notice of all students that use of any malpractice in Examination is misconduct as
provided in the explanation to Regulation 27 and accordingly the registration of such students is liable to be
cancelled or terminated. The text of regulation 27 is reproduced below for information:
27. Suspension and cancellation of examination results or registration
In the event of any misconduct by a registered student or a candidate enrolled for any examination
conducted by the Institute, the Council or the Committee concerned may suo motu or on receipt of a
complaint, if it is satisfied that, the misconduct is proved after such investigation as it may deem necessary
and after giving such student or candidate an opportunity to state his case, suspend or debar the person
from appearing in any one or more examinations, cancel his examination result, or studentship registration,
or debar him from future registration as a student, as the case may be.
Explanation - Misconduct for the purpose of this regulation shall mean and include behaviour in a disorderly
manner in relation to the Institute or in or near an Examination premises/centre, breach of any regulation,
condition, guideline or direction laid down by the Institute, malpractices with regard to postal or oral tuition or
resorting to or attempting to resort to unfair means in connection with the writing of any examination
conducted by the Institute".
437
438 PP-CRVI
PROFESSIONAL PROGRAMME
CORPORATE RESTRUCTURING, VALUATION AND INSOLVENCY
TEST PAPER 1
(This Test Paper is for recapitulate and practice for the students. Students need not
to submit responses/answers to this test paper to the Institute.)
Time Allowed: 3 hours
Maximum Marks: 100
PART A (50 Marks)
(Corporate Restructuring)
1. (a) Comment on the following statements.
(i) Cross border mergers are possible in India.
(ii) Reduction of capital is external restructuring leading to inorganic growth
(iii) Creation of synergies is a challenge in corporate mergers
(iv) Raising objections to the scheme of amalgamation is possible, even if the scheme is just and
equitable
(v) Joint applications to the court by transferor and transferee companies are possible.
(3 marks each)
(b) Competition Act 2002 prescribes thresholds as to combinations. Discuss.
(5 marks)
2. (a) Promoters did not participate in the buy-back scheme of ABC Limited, a listed company.
However, Promoter group shareholding increased from 60% to 76 % post buyback. Do you
think this situation attracts Securities and Exchange Board of India (Substantial Acquisition of
Shares and Takeovers) Regulations, 2011? Examine and comment on the situation.
(b) Discuss the taxation aspects of demerger and slump sale.
(c) Securities and Exchange Board of India (Substantial Acquisition of Shares and Takeovers)
Regulations, 2011 stipulates about interse transfers. Give five examples of interse transfers.
(5 marks each)
OR
2A. (a) In case of taking over of a listed company, draft a suitable Board Resolution with regard to the
following .
(i) Appointment of a merchant banker
(ii) opening of escrow account.
(5 marks each)
(b) Discuss the economic benefits of mergers.
(5 marks)
(5 marks each)
438
(5 marks each)
(5 marks each)
(5 marks).
(b) Discuss the duties of company secretary in case of voluntary winding up of a company.
(5 marks)
(c) Write short notes on the following:
(i)
(ii)
(5 marks each)
439
440 PP-CRVI
TEST PAPER 2
(This Test Paper is for recapitulate and practice for the students. Students need not
to submit responses/answers to this test paper to the Institute.)
Time Allowed: 3 hours
Maximum Marks: 100
PART A (50 Marks)
1. (a) Examine whether the following statements are correct, briefly citing the relevant regulatory
provisions.
(i)
Court cannot refuse to sanction a scheme of arrangement which has been approved by
majority of shareholders/creditors of the companies concerned.
(ii)
The order of court sanctioning the scheme of arrangement is final and effective.
Companies need not do anything thereafter in respect of courts sanction.
(ii)
Amalgamation cannot be sanctioned by the court when the transferee companys objects
do not cover business of the transferor company which the former proposes to carry on
after the amalgamation.
(iv)
Amalgamation between two banking companies is governed solely by the Companies Act,
1956.
(v)
Scheme of amalgamation which is not approved at a meeting by the requisite majority, but
is subsequently approved by individual affidavits is deemed to be validly approved.
(2 marks each)
(b) State the object and reasons for buy-back of shares. Explain the provisions relating to buy-back
of shares through book-building route.
(10 marks each)
2. (a) Reduction of capital is one of the modes of re-organisation of capital structure of the company.
Explain the procedural aspects involved in reduction of capital.
(b) Discuss various types of approvals required in a scheme of compromise or arrangement.
(c) Explain open offer thresholds under the SEBI (Substantial Acquisition of Shares and
Takeovers) Regulations 2011.
(5 marks each)
OR
2A. (a) What do you mean by combination?
Competition Act, 2002.
(b) Explain the provisions relating to escrow account under SEBI (Substantial Acquisition of
Shares and Takeovers) Regulations 2011.
(7 marks)
3. (a) Minority interest is to be considered in the course of mergers. Do you agree? Explain the same
with regulatory provisions.
(5 marks)
(b) Leveraged buyout is one of the effective ways of funding mergers. Explain the same with a
case study.
(10 marks)
PART B (30 Marks)
(Valuation)
4. (a) Elucidate the principles involved in valuation of business.
(b) What are the preliminary steps involved in business valuation?
440
(5 marks each)
441